The Cambridge International AS & A Level Business series consist of a Student’s Book, Boost eBook, Skills Workbook and Teacher’s Resource Pack. Cambridge International AS & A Level Business Second Edition 9781398308114 Cambridge International AS & A Level Business Second Edition Boost eBook 9781398308206 Cambridge International AS & A Level Business Skills Workbook 9781398308152 Cambridge International AS & A Level Business Teacher’s Resource Pack 9781398308138 To explore the entire series, visit www.hoddereducation.com/cambridge-alevel-Business Practice and apply what you have studied and develop independent learning skills by answering a range of questions and activities that are clearly linked to the content of the Student’s Book. ● Build confidence with extra practice to ensure that a topic is thoroughly understood before moving on. ● Explore and analyse international businesses through data response questions based on real case studies. ● Keep track of your work with ready-to-go write-in exercises. ● Answers can be found at hoddereducation.com/cambridgeextras. Save time marking and get support for delivering the revised Cambridge International AS & A Level Business syllabus (9609). ● Confidently deliver the revised syllabus with expert author guidance and the subject specific skills students will need, including how to interpret quantitative data. ● Familiarise students with the command words and improve their confidence with exam-style questions including sample answers. ● Save time marking and assess student progress with answers to all questions in the Student Book. Cambridge International AS & A Level Business Second edition Malcolm Surridge Andrew Gillespie 9781398308114.indb 1 05/03/21 11:06 AM Acknowledgements p.118 © Charlie Box/Dyson; p.131 © Courtesy of L’Oreal; p.262 © Abel, G. J. (2018). Estimates of global bilateral migration flows by gender between 1960 and 2015. International Migration Review, 52(3), 809-852; p.282 © Berkeley Earth. Retrieved from http://berkeleyearth.org/wp-content/uploads/2020/01/2019_Time_ Series.png; p.283 © Toshiba Corporation (2019). Environmental Report. Retrieved from https://www.toshiba. co.jp/env/en/communication/report/pdf/env_report19_all_e.pdf; p.290 © Acha Leke, Mutsa Chironga, and Georges Desvaux, Africa’s overlooked business revolution. McKinsey & Company. November 15, 2018. Retrieved from https://www.mckinsey.com/featured-insights/middle-east-and-africa/africas-overlooked-businessrevolution; p.292 © Colgate-Palmolive Company. Retrieved from https://investor.colgatepalmolive.com/staticfiles/a65490ac-2442-41e3-8751-e18a1471bd92; p.472 © BP p.l.c. Energy with Purpose. BP Annual Report and Form 20-F 2019. Retrieved from https://www.bp.com/content/dam/bp/business-sites/en/global/corporate/pdfs/ investors/bp-annual-report-and-form-20f-2019.pdf Every effort has been made to trace all copyright holders, but if any have been inadvertently overlooked, the Publishers will be pleased to make the necessary arrangements at the first opportunity. Although every effort has been made to ensure that website addresses are correct at time of going to press, Hodder Education cannot be held responsible for the content of any website mentioned in this book. It is sometimes possible to find a relocated web page by typing in the address of the home page for a website in the URL window of your browser. Hachette UK’s policy is to use papers that are natural, renewable and recyclable products and made from wood grown in well-managed forests and other controlled sources. The logging and manufacturing processes are expected to conform to the environmental regulations of the country of origin. Orders: please contact Hachette UK Distribution, Hely Hutchinson Centre, Milton Road, Didcot, Oxfordshire, OX11 7HH. Telephone: +44 (0)1235 827827. Fax: +44 (0)1235 400401. Email education@hachette.co.uk Lines are open from 9 a.m. to 5 p.m., Monday to Friday. You can also order through our website: www.hoddereducation.co.uk ISBN: 978 1 3983 0811 4 © Malcolm Surridge and Andrew Gillespie 2021 First edition published in 2014. This edition published in 2021 by Hodder Education, An Hachette UK Company Carmelite House 50 Victoria Embankment London EC4Y 0DZ www.hoddereducation.co.uk Impression number Year 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2025 2024 2023 2022 2021 All rights reserved. Apart from any use permitted under UK copyright law, no part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying and recording, or held within any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher or under licence from the Copyright Licensing Agency Limited. Further details of such licences (for reprographic reproduction) may be obtained from the Copyright Licensing Agency Limited, www.cla.co.uk Cover photo © tampatra - stock.adobe.com Illustrations by Integra Software Ltd. Typeset by Integra Software Ltd. Printed in Slovenia. A catalogue record for this title is available from the British Library. 9781398308114.indb 2 05/03/21 11:06 AM Contents Introduction vii AS LEVEL 1 Business and its environment 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 Enterprise 1 1.1.1 The nature of business activity 1.1.2 The role of entrepreneurs and intrapreneurs 1.1.3 Business plans 1 8 13 Business structure 16 1.2.1 Economic sectors 1.2.2 Business ownership Size of business 1.3.1 Measurements of business size 1.3.2 Significance of small businesses 1.3.3 Business growth Business objectives 1.4.1 Business objectives in the private sector and public sector 1.4.2 Objectives and business decisions Stakeholders in a business 1.5.1 Business stakeholders 1.5.2 The relative importance and influence of stakeholders on business activities 16 18 27 27 27 30 33 33 38 41 41 43 2 Human resource management 2.1 Human resource management 2.1.1 2.1.2 2.1.3 2.1.4 2.1.5 2.1.6 2.1.7 2.2 Motivation 2.2.1 2.2.2 2.2.3 2.2.4 2.3 Purpose and roles of human resource management Workforce planning Recruitment and selection Redundancy and dismissal Morale and welfare Training and development Management and workforce relations Motivation as a tool for management and leadership Human needs Motivation theories Motivation methods in practice Management 2.3.1 Management and managers 47 47 48 50 54 56 59 62 66 66 66 68 76 83 83 3 Marketing 3.1 The nature of marketing 3.1.1 Role of marketing and its relationship with other business activities 3.1.2 Demand and supply 3.1.3 Markets 9781398308114.indb 3 93 93 95 98 05/03/21 11:06 AM Contents 3.1.4 3.1.5 3.1.6 3.1.7 3.2 Market research 3.2.1 3.2.2 3.2.3 3.2.4 3.3 Consumer and industrial marketing Mass marketing and niche marketing Market segmentation Customer-relationship marketing Purposes of market research Primary research and secondary research Sampling Market research data The marketing mix 3.3.1 3.3.2 3.3.3 3.3.4 3.3.5 3.3.6 Elements of the marketing mix Products Product portfolio analysis Pricing methods Promotion methods Place (channels of distribution) 101 102 103 104 106 106 107 110 111 115 115 116 117 123 127 134 4 Operations management 4.1 The nature of operations 4.1.1 4.1.2 4.1.3 4.1.4 4.2 4.3 The transformational process Efficiency, effectiveness, productivity and sustainability Capital-intensive and labour-intensive operations Operations methods: job, batch, flow, mass customisation Inventory management 4.2.1 Managing inventory 4.2.2 Just in time Capacity utilisation and outsourcing 4.3.1 Significance and measurement of capacity utilisation 4.3.2 Outsourcing 142 142 144 148 149 151 151 155 157 157 160 5 Finance and accounting 5.1 5.2 Business finance 5.1.1 The need for business finance 5.1.2 Working capital Sources of finance 5.2.1 5.2.2 5.2.3 5.2.4 5.3 5.4 Forecasting and managing cash flows 5.3.1 Cash-flow forecasts Costs 5.4.1 5.4.2 5.4.3 5.4.4 5.5 Business ownership and sources of finance Internal and external sources of finance Factors affecting sources of finance Selecting the source of finance 162 162 166 169 169 170 176 178 180 180 187 Cost information Approaches to costing Uses of cost information Break-even analysis Budgets 5.5.1 The meaning and purpose of budgets 5.5.2 Variances 187 189 194 199 205 205 209 iv 9781398308114.indb 4 05/03/21 11:06 AM Contents A LEVEL 6 Business and its environment 6.1 6.2 External influences on business activity 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.3 External influences on business activity: Social and demographic 6.1.4 External influences on business activity: Technological 6.1.5 External influences on business activity: Competitors and suppliers 6.1.6 External influences on business activity: International 6.1.7 External influences on business activity: Environmental Business strategy 6.2.1 Developing business strategy 6.2.2 Corporate planning and implementation 214 214 227 255 266 271 274 281 287 287 304 7 Human resource management 7.1 Organisational structure 7.1.1 7.1.2 7.1.3 7.1.4 7.1.5 7.1.6 7.2 Business communication 7.2.1 7.2.2 7.2.3 7.2.4 7.2.5 7.3 7.4 Relationship between business objectives and structure Types of structure Delegation and accountability Control, authority and trust Centralisation and decentralisation Line and staff Purposes of communication Methods of communication Channels of communication Barriers to communication Role of management in facilitating communication Leadership 7.3.1 Leadership 7.3.2 Theories of leadership 7.3.3 Emotional intelligence/emotional quotient Human resource management strategy 7.4.1 Approaches to human resource management 7.4.2 Flexible workforces 7.4.3 Measurement, causes and consequences of poor employee performance 7.4.4 Strategies for improving employee performance 7.4.5 Roles of IT and AI in human resource management 313 313 316 321 323 324 325 328 328 330 334 335 336 341 341 343 346 349 349 352 358 360 363 8 Marketing 8.1 Marketing analysis 8.1.1 Elasticity 8.1.2 Product development 8.1.3 Sales forecasting 366 366 371 375 v 9781398308114.indb 5 05/03/21 11:06 AM Contents 8.2 Marketing strategy 8.2.1 Planning the marketing strategy 8.2.2 Approaches to marketing strategy 8.2.3 Strategies for international marketing 383 383 384 387 9 Operations management 9.1 Location and scale 9.1.1 9.1.2 Location Scale of operations 9.2 Quality management 9.2.1 9.2.2 Quality control and quality assurance Benchmarking 9.3 Operations strategy 9.3.1 9.3.2 9.3.3 9.3.4 9.3.5 Operations decisions Flexibility and innovation Enterprise resource planning Lean production Operations planning 394 394 400 406 406 410 412 412 414 416 417 422 10 Finance and accounting 10.1 Financial statements 10.1.1 10.1.2 10.1.3 10.1.4 Statement of profit or loss Statement of financial position Inventory valuation Depreciation 10.2 Analysis of published accounts 10.2.1 10.2.2 10.2.3 10.2.4 10.2.5 Liquidity ratios Profitability ratios Financial efficiency ratios Gearing ratios Investment ratios 10.3 Investment appraisal 10.3.1 10.3.2 10.3.3 10.3.4 The concept of investment appraisal Basic methods Discounted cash-flow methods Investment appraisal decisions 10.4 Finance and accounting strategy 10.4.1 Using accounting data to enable strategic decision-making 10.4.2 Using accounting data and ratio analysis in strategic decision-making 430 430 435 438 440 444 445 448 450 452 453 457 457 458 460 462 467 467 471 Index 481 Photo credits 488 vi 9781398308114.indb 6 05/03/21 11:06 AM This book introduces you to Business. It has been written to meet the requirements of the Cambridge International AS & A Level Business syllabus (9609) for examination from 2023. The syllabus (9609) The Cambridge International AS & A Level Business syllabus is based on five topics which are studied at both AS Level and A Level. These are: » Business and its environment » Human resource management (HRM) » Marketing » Operations management » Finance and accounting. The AS section of the syllabus gives you the opportunity to understand what happens inside businesses and introduces you to key business terminology. It also looks at the four internal functions of businesses providing an understanding of how they operate and how businesses manage workforces, research and satisfy customer needs, manage the process of creating goods and services and manage their finances. You are encouraged to consider the working of these internal functions in different business contexts. The A-Level material builds on AS content and is based around the concept of strategy. It looks in detail at the external influences on business activity and encourages you to take account of what is happening in the real world. The syllabus looks at ways in which businesses can develop, plan and implement corporate strategies. It also covers the strategic elements of the four business functions introduced at AS and encourages you to think about these in business-wide contexts. The features of the book The book will guide you through the Cambridge International AS & A Level Business programme of study, although you should supplement it with research into businesses in your own and other countries. You are fortunate that there is an immense amount of information available about businesses, their behaviour and the environments in which they operate. The internet is an enormous and valuable resource and you will also find that newspapers, magazines and television contain a lot of relevant information. However, business activity takes place around you all the time: when you are shopping, travelling to and from school or college or enjoying leisure activities such as visiting the cinema. There are many opportunities for you to see the operation of some of the models and theories you will study. This textbook includes the following features: Chapter overview At the outset of each chapter there is guidance on the material that is covered in the chapter. This shows the knowledge that can be gained from studying this chapter. The syllabus (9609) Introduction Glossary terms These boxes contain descriptions of highlighted glossary terms used throughout the book to help explain additional concepts. Handling data This feature is designed to help to develop relevant numerical skills such as conducting calculations and interpreting numerical data. Case study There is a diverse range of case studies to illustrate how theories and concepts operate in the real world. These all have questions to help you to develop the skills needed in preparation for your examinations. Study tip These appear throughout the book and are designed to help you to understand the material that you have studied and to prepare for your examinations. Test your learning At the end of each chapter there is a range of questions and activities to help you to reinforce your learning and to develop the necessary skills. The key concepts The syllabus is based on the six key concepts set out below which should underpin your study of the subject matter. Familiarity with these key concepts can help you to understand the material in this resource and the syllabus, and help you think about how these can be applied to diverse business scenarios and questions. As these concepts are an essential aspect of the syllabus, they have been signposted throughout the textbook using the associated icons. The syllabus definitions of these key concepts can be found within the syllabus on the Cambridge International website, but we discuss these further here: Change All businesses are subject to change and have to respond to it regularly and frequently. Change may be internal, perhaps following the appointment of a new leader which could, for example, result in a new organisational culture, new methods of production and the targeting of new markets. Alternatively, it may be external, perhaps as a consequence of a change in the business environment; the UK’s recent decision to leave the European Union is a prime example. Managing change effectively contributes to business success. vii 9781398308114.indb 7 05/03/21 11:06 AM Introduction Context Businesses operate in diverse contexts and these have a major influence on decision-making. A decision that might be appropriate and successful for a small family-owned business facing a drop in sales may be entirely unsuitable for a large multinational manufacturer facing the same problem. You need to understand the importance and impact of context. Decision-making Change can create a need for decision-making. Decisions can be taken by stakeholders within the business as well as those outside of it. Decisions may be based on instinct or a ‘hunch’, or on the analysis of the available quantitative and qualitative data. Decisions can be taken at different levels within an organisation and may impact on part or all of it. Enterprise Enterprise is the ability to make new ideas work and thus enables businesses to take advantages of opportunities that may exist. Enterprise is not simply limited to start-ups; in a changing world, enterprise is vital for competitiveness. Innovation Innovative businesses are more able to develop new products or better ways of producing them. This helps to enhance competitiveness and strengthen performance by leading the field rather than being a more passive follower. Strategy A business’s strategy is its long-term plan to achieve its objectives. Successful businesses are able to develop and implement effective strategies through analysing the business environment and the opportunities available and making appropriate choices. The structure of the AS- and A-Level examinations There are two examination papers for AS and two for A Level Business. The subject content of AS Business is assumed knowledge for the A-Level papers. AS Level Paper 1: Business Concepts 1 • This paper carries a total of 40 marks and has a duration of 1 hour 15 minutes. • It tests the entire AS element of the syllabus. • It comprises two sections: • Section A contains four short answer questions. The first three questions are split into two parts each. • Section B contains two essay questions, one of which must be answered. The essays are split into two parts each. • Section A and Section B each carry a maximum of 20 marks. AS Level Paper 2: Business Concepts 2 • This paper carries a total of 60 marks and has a duration of 1 hour 30 minutes. • It tests the entire AS element of the syllabus. • It comprises two data response questions which may be based on text and numerical data. Each question is split into six parts. • Each of the two data response questions will carry a maximum of 30 marks. A Level Paper 3: Business Decision-Making • This paper carries a total of 60 marks and has a duration of 1 hour 45 minutes. • It tests the entire A Level syllabus and builds on AS knowledge and understanding. • It is based on a case study which includes prose, tables of data and numerical or diagrammatic appendices. • The case study will normally have five questions attached to it. A Level Paper 4: Business Strategy • This paper carries a total of 40 marks and has a duration of 1 hour 15 minutes. • It tests the entire A Level syllabus, and builds on AS knowledge and understanding. • It comprises two questions, each worth 20 marks, based on a series of numerical and non-numerical data relating to a case study. The information in this section is based on the 9609 syllabus for examination from 2023. You should always refer to the appropriate syllabus document for the year of your examination to confirm the details and for more information. The syllabus document is available on the Cambridge International website at http://www.cambridgeinternational.org. Preparing for Business examinations The Business syllabus requires you to understand the relevant theories and concepts set out in the syllabus and covered in this book. However, you will also need to know how to organise ideas, construct arguments, make decisions, solve problems, conduct calculations and interpret data. Finally, it is important for you to ensure you know how to apply your knowledge to business scenarios, such as those set out in questions that relate to data response materials or case studies. This textbook contains numerous questions throughout, and at the end of, each chapter which have been designed to help you to develop these essential skills. Malcolm Surridge & Andrew Gillespie A note on the exam-style questions Exam-style questions (and sample answers) have been written by the authors. In examinations, the way marks are awarded may be different. References to assessment and/or assessment preparation are the publisher’s interpretation of the syllabus requirements and may not fully reflect the approach of Cambridge Assessment International Education. Cambridge International recommends that teachers consider using a range of teaching and learning resources in preparing learners for assessment, based on their own professional judgement of their students’ needs. Third-party websites and resources referred to in this publication have not been endorsed by Cambridge Assessment International Education. viii 9781398308114.indb 8 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1 Business and its environment AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise 1.1.1 The nature of business activity Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the nature and purpose of business activity; for example, we look at factors of production, the business environment, what businesses do and the concept of adding value ★ the differences between local, national, international and multinational businesses ★ the role of the entrepreneur and intrapreneur; for example, we consider why entrepreneurs are important to the economy, and barriers to entrepreneurship ★ business risk and uncertainty ★ business plans; for example, we consider the purpose of business plans, their key elements and their limitations. 1.1.1 The nature of business activity The purpose of business activity What will you do this weekend? Have you got a part-time job to earn some money? Are you going to go out to a café or go shopping in the town centre? Whatever you do, you will come into contact with many different businesses, either as a consumer buying and using their products or as an employee working to create them. Businesses are everywhere! Just think of the last time you went shopping – the outlet where you shop is a business, it has bought the products from a supplier, they were transported by a delivery business and the firm probably uses another business to help promote itself. In every transaction between a customer and a business, many other businesses will have been involved to bring about that exchange. There are many different definitions of a business, but what they tend to have in common is the idea of someone (or a group of people) working in an organised way to achieve a given target. Notice the key elements of this definition – firstly, the activities of those involved are organised in some way and, secondly, the business is created with a specific purpose in mind: often the business objective is profit but, as we shall see later, there are many other reasons why people set up in business. Using a definition of organised activities and a given target, many organisations such as hospitals and even schools could be classified as businesses. They may not have profit as a target, but they do involve many different people working together, planning and organising what they do in order to achieve targets, such as helping people get better more quickly or improving the quality of students’ education. The transformation process All businesses are involved in the transformation process. They take inputs and transform them in some way to produce outputs that they hope consumers will want. INPUTS • land • labour • capital • enterprise TRANSFORMATION PROCESS CREATES VALUE OUTPUTS • goods • services • by-products FEEDBACK ▲ Figure 1.1 The transformation process Inputs The inputs into a business are also called the factors of production. These are: » land » labour » capital » enterprise. GLOSSARY TERMS Business objectives are measurable targets set by the business, such as sales or profits that have to be achieved within a given time period. The factors of production are the inputs into the transformation process of a business; namely land, labour, capital and enterprise. The transformation process involves converting inputs into outputs. 1 9781398308114.indb 1 05/03/21 11:06 AM Land AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise 1.1 This involves choosing the location of the business. This is critically important for businesses such as shops and cafés. For other businesses such as farming, what will matter is the quality of the land in terms of the ability to grow different crops or rear livestock. The success of a farming business will be directly affected by changes to the quality of the land and the weather. For some businesses, what will matter is access to resources; for example, oil drilling and mining businesses need to be near the natural resources. The significance of land as an input will be particularly high in the primary sector. Under the heading of land we also include premises. The amount of space available to a business can affect how much can be produced or how many customers can physically fit in the restaurant or store. The nature of the premises can also affect the working environment and people’s motivation. For example, working in a modern office with a good canteen, parking spaces and a central location might be appealing to employees. GLOSSARY TERM The primary sector is the first stage of production and includes extracting or growing resources. Farming, mining and fishing are all part of the primary sector. Labour Organisations will need staff. The quality of employees in terms of their skills, their attitudes (for example, to customers), their willingness to work and their natural abilities will have an influence on the success of any business. What makes a film a great success? The quality of the writing, the acting and the production – people play a key role in the success of any film. Many films therefore promote themselves on the basis of who the actors are or who the director is. Similarly, universities promote their professors. Music labels promote their bands. Publishers promote their author list. So people can be a crucial element of the transformation process. Capital The word ‘capital’ has many meanings. In this instance, we mean the equipment used by businesses. The coffee machines in the coffee shop, the ovens in the fast-food restaurants, and the scanning equipment in shops are all examples of capital equipment. The amount and quality of the capital equipment in a business can affect the service it provides. For example, the online retailer Amazon is admired for the efficiency with which it processes an order and is able to make suggestions to customers of what else they might like to buy. These rely on the quality of Amazon’s warehousing facilities and computer programs. Enterprise Enterprise refers to a set of skills that develops new ways of doing things or new things to do. Enterprise refers to the ability to be creative and innovative, to come up with new ideas, to combine resources in different ways and to be willing to take risks. Enterprise brings together the other factors of production to create and make a business idea competitive. The choice of inputs The choice of inputs into the business and who supplies them can affect: » the costs of a business » the quality of the final product (and therefore sales). In recent years, customers have become increasingly interested in what resources are used in a production process and where they have come from. Firms may highlight the fact that they use recycled materials, that their supplies come from local businesses or that their ingredients are ‘natural’ or ‘organic’. Firms will also face the choice of whether to buy in some materials or produce them themselves. Tyrrells uses the fact that it grows its own potatoes when it promotes its potato crisp products. Most other crisp manufacturers buy in their potatoes. Outputs The output of a business is a product. A product may be a good or a service, or a combination of the two. » A good (or a product) is a tangible physical item, such as a car or a laptop computer. Businesses can produce and stock them. This means that they can produce or purchase the goods that they sell in advance of demand; for example, a store may stockpile new electrical goods before a busy selling period. » A service is intangible. Examples of services are education, creating music, hairdressing and physiotherapy. Most businesses in more developed economies are in the service sector. Services cannot be stored; they have to be produced for customers as they are needed. This can create problems, because if there is a rush of customers, there are no products stockpiled and so queues form or waiting lists have to be introduced. In many cases, a business provides a combination of goods and services. For example, you may choose a restaurant because of the food you can eat there (the goods) but also because of the waiters, the environment and the way you are treated (the service). Most outputs are intended for sale. A firm produces goods and services to sell to customers. However, there may also be by-products from the transformation process; for example, a firm’s production may create waste and pollution. Many customers pay attention to these issues and, increasingly, firms are considering the effects of their production on other groups, such as the local community. Some by-products may also form the inputs to other industries. For most products there is a series of stages in the transformation process which are involved in taking the initial materials and ending up with the final product. The author JK Rowling took her imagination and a computer and turned her ideas into magical manuscripts for her Harry Potter books. The publishing company worked with the author, designers, editors, a marketing team, a printing business and a distribution business and turned the 2 9781398308114.indb 2 05/03/21 11:06 AM CASE STUDY 1.1 Dabbawalla 1.1.1 The nature of business activity a ‘doer of something’ and a ‘dabba’ is a stainless steel lunchbox. The lunchbox is picked up from the customer’s home and taken to a sorting station. The lunchboxes are then divided up according to destination and delivered on bike, on foot or taken on the train. After lunch, the box is collected and taken back to the customer’s home. This is an incredibly efficient but very labour-intensive and low-technology process, with almost no boxes going missing or to the wrong address. The price is so low that it is easier to pay for the delivery than to take your lunchbox with you on your journey to and from work. Questions 1 ▲ Figure 1.2 A busy dabbawalla delivery in Mumbai Every day in Mumbai, India, around 250 000 people get their lunches delivered by ‘dabbawallas’. A ‘walla’ means manuscripts into a series of books. Bookstores take a range of books and transform them into a retail experience for the customer. A series of transformations has gone on to get the idea from the author’s mind into a book and into the hands of the reader. Managing the inputs Managing the transformation process Managing the outputs TRANSFORMATION INPUTS OUTPUTS PROCESS FEEDBACK ▲ Figure 1.3 Chain of operations Businesses need to identify exactly what they want to provide in terms of the range and quality of products they offer. For example, do they want to specialise in a few types of items or provide a wide range of goods and services? Businesses also need to decide on the resources they will need in order to provide the product to the standard they want for their customers. There are a number of questions involved here: How many people are needed? What skills are needed? Will they be trained? What materials will be used? What equipment? And so on. Businesses need to find a way of generating a product that customers value so much that they will pay more for it than it costs the business to produce. Adding value Adding value occurs in a transformation process when outputs are produced that are worth more than the inputs brought in to provide them. 2 Explain one way in which the dabbawallas transform [3] inputs into outputs. Evaluate how you would measure the success of [12] this transformation process. For example, artists such as Andy Warhol, Vincent van Gogh, David Hockney and Rembrandt took their imagination, paint and canvas and produced amazing works of art that now sell for millions of dollars: far more than the cost of the items used up in their production. They added value via the transformation process. Jamie Oliver, a famous chef, takes standard ingredients such as meat, herbs and vegetables, puts them together in a unique way and comes up with a fantastic meal. He takes ingredients that many others may use but transforms them in a way that appeals to customers, sells books and attracts viewers for his TV series. Clearly, he has added value by using his talent, creativity and personality. GLOSSARY TERM Adding value occurs in a transformation process when outputs are produced that are worth more than the inputs brought in to provide them. Adding value can be done in ways that may seem odd to some. Here are some examples: » Some companies buy new jeans and then stretch them, batter them and fray them to make them look distressed while, at the same time, more than doubling their price. » Bottled water that sells for $10 a bottle comes from King Island, near Tasmania. It is called ‘Cloud Juice’ and is claimed to be the purest in the world. It is rainwater that has been collected from a plastic roof and then bottled. It is supposed to be so pure because it comes from rain clouds that travel 7000 miles from South America without passing over any land, and therefore not encountering pollution. » One of the most expensive coffees in the world is Luwak Coffee. This is made from coffee cherries that 3 9781398308114.indb 3 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.1 the brand or developing a unique selling proposition (USP). A USP is a feature of the product that makes it different from competitors’ products for the customer; for example, a product may be perceived as better quality, better designed, more reliable or more user-friendly than competitors’ products. have been eaten and digested by common palm civets (a type of animal). The civets use their keen sense of smell to select the choicest and ripest beans. The beans are supposed to be much sweeter as a result of the digestion process and, having passed through the animal, they are hand-collected from the jungle floor. To increase the value it adds, a business might aim to: STUDY TIP cutting back on waste, ensuring the best price for the supplies and making sure that mistakes are not made. All activities that do not create value need to be examined to see if they are truly necessary. » increase the perceived benefit of the product in the eyes of the customer. This could be through building When answering questions, you may need to think about how different firms create value. What can businesses do to add more value? Should they focus on the benefits they are providing, or try to control costs more effectively? AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise » reduce the costs of producing the product. This means CASE STUDY FedEx FedEx connects people with goods, services, ideas and technologies. By doing this, FedEx says it creates opportunities that drive innovation, energise businesses and help communities improve their standard of living. FedEx says it does far more than deliver packages. It says it delivers joy in the holidays, provides hope to survivors of natural disasters and solves business problems. Its network extends to over 220 countries and territories. Its 490 000 team members are united behind the FedEx promise to ‘make every FedEx experience outstanding’. FedEx has over 180 000 vehicles and nearly 680 planes. It delivers over 15 million packages on an average day and deals with over 250 requests linked to package tracking each day. Source: www.fedex.com/en-us/about/company-structure.html Question 1 Explain one way in which FedEx can add value in its transformation process. [3] CASE STUDY IKEA IKEA is a furniture producer and retailer. The value chain of a product describes all the stages of operations, from the initial raw materials through to the sale of the actual goods. In IKEA’s case, it owns and manages nearly all the stages of its value chain. IKEA says that the starting point for any value chain is the product itself, and the idea for this starts with ‘listening to people’s needs and dreams, so we understand how we can make a difference’. Typically, IKEA turns this initial idea based on customers’ needs into a sketch of how the product might look. This sketch is then discussed with its suppliers, who consider how it might be made, transported and stored in-store. IKEA will be looking for ways of producing a product with a high-quality design and finish while keeping costs low. IKEA is always trying to improve the product at each stage of discussion and review. Improvements are welcomed from the various people involved in production; for example, designers and technicians. One such suggestion might be using a more sustainable material. Listen to customers Sell Package and distribute to stores Design and create the product Manufacture the product ▲ Figure 1.4 The value chain of a product 4 9781398308114.indb 4 05/03/21 11:06 AM Much of IKEA’s furniture is produced and packaged in the form of a flat-pack, which lowers transport costs because it is easy to put large quantities on lorries and on shelves in-store. This helps keep prices low for IKEA’s customers, who then take the products home and build the products themselves. Collaboration between customers, partners and co-workers aids IKEA’s pursuit ‘to add value to people’s everyday lives’ by producing good-quality furniture at low prices. Questions 1 2 Analyse one way in which IKEA adds value in its transformation process. [4] Evaluate the importance of the customer in IKEA’s value chain. [12] 1.1 GLOSSARY TERMS A brand is a name, design, logo, symbol or indeed anything that makes a product recognisable and distinguishes it from the competition in the eyes of the customer. Market forces are the forces of supply and demand which determine the price of a product and the quantity bought and sold in a market. Opportunity cost measures the sacrifice made by choosing one option in terms of the next best alternative foregone. Businesses and economic activity Businesses make up an important part of any economy. They are important because they employ people, they pay employees’ wages and salaries and they provide goods and services. Businesses provide the products we buy and give us the jobs and earnings we need to buy them. When businesses are doing well and expanding they employ more people and generate more income for the economy. Businesses innovate to win more customers: they create new goods and services and this can improve the quality of our lives, by providing better food, better clothes and better electronic goods. Businesses therefore drive economies forward, and this is why governments are eager to help new firms start up and compete, and why they often try to help businesses grow. Choice and opportunity cost In any economy there is a fixed amount of resources at any moment and therefore decisions have to be made about how these resources are used. Given the scarcity of resources, choices are inevitable in terms of what should be produced in the economy, how these products should be produced and who should receive them. Some of these decisions will be made by market forces of supply and demand: it will be the result of bargaining between consumers and businesses. If, for example, demand for a particular product increases, this will encourage businesses to use their resources to produce this instead of something else. Imagine you were a farmer and had limited land. You have to decide what to grow on it. This will depend in part on demand: if the demand for a particular crop increases, you may switch to this and away from something less in demand. Some decisions about what to produce and how to produce may be made by the government. For example, the 1.1.1 The nature of business activity Source: https://about.ikea.com/en/about-us/the-ikea-value-chain government may provide some or all of the health services, the transport system, the police or the education system in a country. Governments tend to take control of goods and services they think are vital to their economy and where they want to ensure access for most people. However, whenever decisions are made about what to produce – whether it be the free market or the government – it will involve an opportunity cost. Given that resources are limited, if they are used to produce more of one item, then this is at the expense of something else. Opportunity cost measures the sacrifice you make if you choose one course of action in terms of the next best alternative. For example, if a business decides to use its labour force to increase output of soft drinks, then the opportunity cost is what could have been produced if the labour force had been used to produce something different. Whenever a business makes a decision it should consider the opportunity cost. A project that earns a profit of $100 000 may seem attractive, but if the resources could have been used to earn $250 000 it is not so appealing. When judging the success of a business you should also consider the opportunity cost. If Walmart, the huge US retailer, made a profit of $10 million, this would not be that impressive given the people, stores and equipment it has; these resources could be used elsewhere to earn more than that. Walmart’s profit before tax in 2020 was actually over $20 billion, so you can see why its investors wouldn’t be very happy it if only made $10 million! The dynamic business environment Businesses do not operate in isolation. Whatever they do is linked to what other businesses do; for example, their suppliers, the firms that distribute and promote their products, the banks that lend them money. They are also affected by many other external factors such as: » Political and legal issues For example, new laws by a government can prevent the way some products are promoted (such as cigarettes) and can affect the way employees must be treated and the way a business produces (perhaps to reduce its environmental impact). » Economic issues For example, the amount of income in an economy can change over a period of time, affecting demand; the value of one currency in terms of another can alter, affecting the cost of importing supplies; and the cost of borrowing can go up, increasing costs. 5 9781398308114.indb 5 05/03/21 11:06 AM » Social issues For example, an increase in the size of the 1.1 population or the average age of the population in a country can affect the level of demand and the types of products people buy. » Technological issues For example, changes in the availability and speed of the internet can make it easier to find suppliers and sell across the world. AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise These external factors (known as PEST – political, economic, social and technological) will continually be changing and this will affect what businesses produce and the resources they use. These factors can all have an impact on a business, as shown in Figure 1.5. External factors can affect: » the demand for products » the costs and availability of inputs » the nature of the transformation process. and, if necessary, managers will need to change some of their decisions about inputs, the transformation process or the outputs they produce accordingly. Economic Social Political Technological Business ▲ Figure 1.5 External influences on a business STUDY TIP If labour costs in one country become more expensive, for example, businesses might switch production to another country or start to use more machinery instead. If a government signs a treaty with another country to make trade easier, its businesses might start to sell more to customers in the new partner country. New laws may make certain products or production techniques impossible. Businesses therefore need to monitor their external business environment because it is dynamic (ever-changing) Remember that the key external factors in the environment of a business will vary between industries. In the health sector, demographics may be very significant; in the computer sector, technological changes may be critical. You need to assess the key issues for any given industry. CASE STUDY Lockdown In 2020, the Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic affected countries all over the world. Governments reacted in different ways, but in many countries shops were forced to close and people were ‘locked down’ at home for several weeks. Many businesses such as restaurants simply could not operate at all. Others such as food shops were forced to change the way they operated to ensure that people kept a suitable distance from each other. A limited number of people would be allowed in shops and, once inside, they could not get too close to each other. Staff were often serving behind screens. In the first few What does a business need to do to succeed? To succeed, a business needs to be more competitive than its rivals. This means it needs to provide better value for money. Its ability to achieve this depends on: » the benefits it offers. For example, what does its product do relative to those of its competitors? Is it faster? Easier to use? Smaller? Bigger? Longer lasting? » what price is being charged relative to the competition. Businesses will aim to outperform their rivals by offering the same benefits for less, or more benefits for the same price. The difficult part is deciding what it is that customers actually regard as a benefit, working out how to provide them and somehow doing this more cheaply than competitors, or finding additional benefits without increasing the price. How businesses try to do this is weeks of lockdown, there was often panic-buying, with products such as hand sanitiser, toilet rolls and some food products in high demand. When lockdown was over there were concerns over how well economies would recover. Businesses had closed down and people had lost their jobs. Questions 1 Evaluate the possible effects of the COVID-19 pandemic on the transformation process of retail stores. [12] examined in the rest of this book. Even if a business does manage to become competitive, it cannot afford to be complacent because competitors will soon follow its lead; this means it needs to keep improving and seeking ways of becoming more competitive. Many once-famous businesses have now disappeared and those that are still successful can only stay that way by constantly improving. STUDY TIP Remember that businesses often compete in different ways. Some may offer premium products and be able to justify high prices. Others may offer more basic products at low prices. An important thing to think about is how sustainable this approach is in the long term – will others be able to imitate the idea easily or can the business protect its success? 6 9781398308114.indb 6 05/03/21 11:06 AM Why do businesses fail? In fact, many businesses fail early on in their life. This is because: » the people managing them may not have had much experience of business. Often people who start up a business have an interest in a product but have not necessarily run a business before. They may be good at making things, for example, but not so good at dealing with customers or managing money. It may also be difficult to recruit experienced staff to join the business because they may want the security of a bigger business that has been around for longer and has a track record of success. This means that those making the business decisions may not be very good at it. » new businesses do not have much market power, which can make it difficult to survive. For example, suppliers may be worried whether they will be paid and demand payment in advance, which can cause cash-flow problems. Meanwhile, buyers may have a lot of power. Imagine being a new small supplier trying to sell to a big supermarket. The buyer (the supermarket) may push the price down and be slow to pay, causing further financial problems for the new business. Given its lack of power, it may have to pay more for supplies and advertising than more established businesses, making it difficult to compete on price. HANDLING DATA Imagine 60 per cent of new businesses in a country fail in the first two years. Of those that survive, another 40 per cent fail in the next three years. Imagine 400 000 businesses start up in one year; how many would you expect to be left after five years? Local, national, international and multinational businesses 1.1 The scope of business activity can vary significantly. Some businesses operate very much within a local market; for example, a local hairdresser or local café. Their customers will come from the local area. The success of these businesses will be affected by the number of potential customers in the local area and their spending power. A shop in a rural area, for example, may struggle to attract enough customers. Local laws introduced by the city or town will affect what the business can do. 1.1.1 The nature of business activity Businesses fail when they stop being competitive. This means that they stop providing good value for money relative to their competitors. This can be due to external reasons (perhaps they have a high level of borrowing and so their costs are hit badly when the cost of borrowing rises) or internal reasons (such as poor training of staff leading to poor customer service). Businesses fail when they end up providing relatively low benefits given the price they charge. This can be because of their choice of inputs, their choice of outputs or the way they manage the transformation process. We hope that reading this book will help you avoid some of these problems if you decide to manage a business. Having said that, while many of the problems of business are avoidable, some – such as an earthquake – may be more difficult to plan for! Other businesses may have more of a national market. There may be a national bus company offering routes within the country or a national energy business. In this case, the business has a wider customer base that may be based all over the country. These businesses will be affected by national laws and by decisions of the national government. For example, changes in national government spending may affect demand for products. In other instances, businesses may operate around the world. These businesses are international – they export products to other countries. These businesses will be affected by changes in the value of their currency compared to other currency (this is known as the exchange rate) and by trading agreements between countries. For example, national governments may sign a treaty making it easier to sell products in each other’s countries. By becoming an international business, an organisation may have more places to find the best suppliers and resources; this can allow it to access better quality supplies are a lower price. Going international means a business may also have more markets to sell to; this can lead to faster growth and reduce the risk of being dependent on one market. In recent years there has tended to be more co-operation between countries, making it easier to be an international business. This has also been helped by better communications and better transport systems. If businesses have bases abroad (for example, they have shops or factories in other countries) they are known as a multinational. Whereas international businesses trade with or buy from other countries, multinationals actually have production bases or offices in these other countries. This means multinationals can benefit from incentives (such as subsidies) provided by other governments to locate there. It also means the business is closer to its market, which may mean it understands it better. In some cases, there are limits to the products coming from abroad into a country, or a tax is placed on them which makes them more expensive; by being based within a country these restrictions can be overcome. Another benefit of being multinational is that it spreads risk by having bases in different countries. If there is a problem with production in one country – for example, due to a natural disaster – production may be switched to the other location. 7 9781398308114.indb 7 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.1 1.1.2 The role of entrepreneurs and intrapreneurs Entrepreneurs AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise An entrepreneur is someone who is willing to take a risk to start a new project or a new business. Enterprise refers to the skills needed to do this, such as creativity. An entrepreneur has an idea and then tries to make it work. Entrepreneurs see the resources that are available and the possibilities of combining them in a particular way to provide a product or service. Entrepreneurs create new businesses and in so doing provide new products and services. Some entrepreneurs, such as Sir Richard Branson of Virgin and Stelios Haji-Ioannou of easyGroup, continually have ideas for new businesses and set up many different ones during their careers. Such people are called ‘serial entrepreneurs’. GLOSSARY TERMS Entrepreneurs are individuals who take the risk to create or start a new business or project. According to the Royal Bank of Scotland (RBS) a successful entrepreneur is usually: » well-rounded Someone who can make the product, promote it, sell it and count the money » able to bounce back A person who can cope with mistakes and have the confidence to try again » innovative Not an ‘inventor’ in the traditional sense, but a person who is able to carve out a new niche in the market, often a niche that is invisible to others » results-oriented To make a business successful requires a drive that only comes from setting goals and targets and getting pleasure from achieving them » a professional risk-taker To succeed means taking measured risks. Often, successful entrepreneurs use a step-by-step approach to risk-taking, at each stage exposing themselves to only a measured amount of personal risk and moving from one stage to the next only as each decision is proved » totally committed Hard work, energy and singlemindedness are essential elements in the entrepreneurial profile. CASE STUDY Enterprise is the skill needed to make a new idea work. What qualities is an entrepreneur likely to need for success? There is no single set of qualities that has been identified that will definitely make someone a successful entrepreneur. Entrepreneurs can differ enormously in terms of their backgrounds, skills, interests and personalities. However, it is likely that a successful entrepreneur is someone who: » is prepared to work very hard, especially in the initial stages of setting up the business. This means you need determination and the ability to cope with stress and setbacks » has a vision. Many entrepreneurs have stories about the various problems they encountered when they first started up. Problems with money, suppliers, equipment and so on are all fairly common. It is also quite usual for others around you to be more cautious and less certain that your project will work than you are. To be successful, you need faith in your idea and a belief in your own vision, even when there are initial problems » is willing to take a risk. It takes a lot of nerve to give up your existing job and start out on your own and yet this is what many people do. You may have to give up the salary, the company car, the support from head office and the pension just to pursue your dream. You may also have to go through quite a long period of time with relatively low rewards before you make it a success (if you ever do!). Hirka In 2017, an entrepreneur in Indonesia started a business that turned scraps of skin from chicken feet into leather, which is then made into shoes. These ‘chicken’ shoes are marketed as alternatives to ones made from reptile skin, such as snake and crocodile, as ‘reptile’ shoes have been increasingly criticised by customers and animal rights supporters. The ‘chicken’ shoes do not rely on breeding animals for purpose, as they are made from scraps and waste material that comes from dimsum and fast-food restaurants. The transformation process that turns these inputs into shoes begins by dyeing the chicken skins and then sewing pieces together. It takes about 10 days and up to 45 chicken feet to make a single pair of shoes. The business employs six people. Hirka’s most popular style of shoes are sneakers, and the company makes only 70 pairs per month to ensure quality is kept high. These sell for Rp500 000 ($31) and above. Questions 1 2 Explain one reason why someone might set up in business for themselves. [3] Evaluate the factors that might determine the success of this shoe business. [12] 8 9781398308114.indb 8 05/03/21 11:06 AM Why become an entrepreneur? someone else then the rewards belong to them. You may work very hard and very successfully and get a bonus, but the major rewards will usually go to the owners. If you are an entrepreneur, you are the owner and so any rewards belong to you. The downside is that if anything goes wrong, the losses are yours as well. » You have more control of what you do and when you do it compared to working for someone else. Many people become self-employed because of a desire for more flexible working and an improved balance between work and their social lives. 1.1 1.1.2 The role of entrepreneurs and intrapreneurs There are many attractions to being an entrepreneur: » You will experience a great feeling of satisfaction if your idea is successful. Imagine being able to look at a large business and know that you created it and helped it to grow. » You will be your own boss. Fed up with being told what to do? Dislike orders? Then being an entrepreneur may be the way forward. Setting up on your own means it is your business, to do with as you wish. This can be challenging and demanding but it does mean you are more in control of your own destiny. Some people prefer this to working for others: they like their independence. » You keep the rewards. If you work in a business for CASE STUDY Awfully Chocolate year. As people not from the baking industry, they tried innovative methods to create a recipe they loved – and Awfully Chocolate was born. The first Awfully Chocolate store opened in 1998 in Katong in Singapore, in an old side street. It offered only one type of chocolate cake for sale. It was also unconventional in that the cake was not displayed, so the store did not look like a typical cake shop. This enhanced the quirky character of how Awfully Chocolate made its mark. Friends and family thought the business would not last three months and even her supplier warned her about over-ordering boxes. But Awfully Chocolate gained a reputation for delicious handmade chocolate cakes and quirky design, and demand proved high. Cakes sold out every day and its reputation grew beyond Singapore. But Lyn wanted Awfully Chocolate to grow on its own slowly, so she only opened her second store in 2004, using the profits from her first shop. Awfully Chocolate’s products now include more cakes, tarts, ice cream and truffles. It also owns the brands Everything with Fries, Sinpopo and Ninethirty by Awfully Chocolate, and now has 17 stores across Asia. Lyn says that ‘every city has got its own bit of character, bit of personality, its own quirks’, so you need to understand these to make it work. ▲ Figure 1.6 Lyn Lee Living in Singapore – a very cosmopolitan city – Lyn Lee was amazed that she could not find a simple dark chocolate cake! Most chocolate cakes in the market were either too sweet and creamy or not chocolatey enough. So she decided to set up a business to make the perfect everyday chocolate cake – soft, moist, very chocolatey but not too sweet or creamy. With some friends, she tried different recipes and techniques every weekend for a According to Lyn, although people say the success is due to luck, it’s actually due mainly to hard work! Source: www.bbc.co.uk/news/business-11701575 Questions 1 2 Analyse one reason why demand for Awfully Chocolate’s products may have been high. [4] Evaluate whether the success of a new product is likely to be mainly due to luck. [12] 9 9781398308114.indb 9 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise 1.1 CASE STUDY Government regulations Governments regulate businesses to protect different groups. For example, laws may be introduced to prevent employees from being exploited, to protect customers from unsafe products and to protect businesses from other businesses using unfair tactics. However, regulations can make it more difficult to set up and run a business, which can deter entrepreneurs or make it difficult to do business. This can lead to entrepreneurs not starting up a business or doing so in another country. In Uruguay, for example, entrepreneurs have to deposit a significant sum of money in the bank and a new business has to pay many taxes. Questions 1 2 Explain one reason why people want to set up in [3] business. Evaluate the problems that regulations can play in determining the success of a new business. [12] The role of intrapreneurs An intrapreneur is an entrepreneur within an existing business. As businesses get bigger, they often worry that they lose some of the creativity and risk-taking that they had when they first started. The danger is that to control a larger business, the managers introduce many rules and policies which potentially limit innovation. Intrapreneurship occurs when the business encourages people within the organisation to think and act like entrepreneurs. The business wants existing staff to challenge the way things are done, to question whether there are better ways of doing what they do and to take business risks; they want intrapreneurs. The aim is to keep established businesses moving forwards, being flexible and keeping ahead of competitors. To help people be intrapreneurs, the business needs to empower them to make decisions and give them the resources they need to try things out. The business needs to encourage an approach where it is perfectly acceptable to try and fail in order to ensure that employees are willing to take risks. Intrapreneurship can be critical to the ongoing success of a business. Entrepreneurs and intrapreneurs create change and challenge the way things are done. They find and create new markets, generate income and employment and bring about innovation. They are extremely important to the growth of an economy and to improving the quality and range of goods and services on offer. GLOSSARY TERM Intrapreneurs are people within an established business who think and act like entrepreneurs. Barriers to entrepreneurship Entrepreneurship may be limited in a country because of a number of factors: » The financial system may not be good at supporting start-up businesses. Banks, for example, might think starts-ups are too risky and avoid them, or make it difficult and expensive for them to borrow. » There may be many different regulations involved in setting up a business, which discourage people from doing this or make it complex and slow to do. » The culture in the country may not favour entrepreneurs; failure may not be accepted socially and those who do fail may find it difficult to find financial backers when they want to start a second venture. » The government may prefer state provision and not want to encourage entrepreneurs; there might be some goods or services that have to be provided by the government. CASE STUDY Ease of starting up The Doing Business Index produced by the World Bank measures the number of procedures, such as the time and cost, involved for a small to medium-sized company to start up and formally operate in each economy’s largest business city. The table below shows the data for the top five and bottom five countries identified in May 2019. The top five are the countries where it is easiest to do business and the bottom five are the countries where it is most difficult to do business. 10 9781398308114.indb 10 05/03/21 11:06 AM ▼ Table 1.1 Ease of doing business by country Location Starting a business rank Starting a business score New Zealand 1 Georgia 2 99.6 Canada 3 98.2 Singapore 4 98.2 Hong Kong, China 100 98.2 186 52.5 Cambodia 187 52.4 Somalia 188 46.0 Haiti 189 36.4 Venezuela 190 25.0 Source: www.doingbusiness.org/en/rankings Questions Explain one factor that might influence the ease of doing business in a country. [3] Business risk and uncertainty Uncertainty is a feature of business life. Businesses have to make decisions based on what they know and, in many cases, their best estimate of a situation. Decision-making is often focused on preparing for the future and, obviously, we do not know exactly what is going to happen then. Businesses can look at what is happening now, what has happened in the past and they can research what different scenarios might look like in the future, but they will not know with 100 per cent certainty. This means decisions will involve a risk. Risk occurs when there is a danger that the outcomes will be unfavourable. Businesses will want to assess the risk and, where they can, take actions to reduce the risk. Entrepreneurs are people who are prepared to take risks to start up and develop a business. They are investing time, money and effort into a new project that may or may not work. The danger is that it will not work and all their investment will be lost. Many new businesses fail. Look at the main shopping street in your nearest village or town. How long have the shops been there? Have some opened up recently? Have some closed down in the last year? The landscape of the centre of most towns is changing all the time as some business ideas fail and others rise to take their place. The real risk to entrepreneurs is that they will lose much or even everything they have put into a project because the business idea eventually fails. Some of the causes of risk are external. For example, there could be a change in the economy, meaning people have less money to spend than entrepreneurs had expected (and so demand for their products is lower than they hoped), or competitors may have changed their behaviour, making it more difficult for similar businesses to survive. Alternatively, the causes of risk could be internal. It may be that an entrepreneur’s understanding of the market is not as good as they had thought and they make some bad pricing decisions. It may be that their judgement of people is poor 2 Evaluate the implications of the data above if you were going to set up a business abroad. [12] and they hire the wrong people, with the result that the quality of service is not as good as hoped. Entrepreneurs may sometimes undertake a project ‘because it is there to be done’. They may be driven by a desire to do something new. This in itself may be a reward in terms of self-satisfaction or a sense of self-achievement: they can hopefully look back on their career and be proud of what they have achieved. However, entrepreneurs may also be interested in other rewards from setting up, such as the financial gain from owning their own business. These rewards can be high! For example, YouTube was set up in February 2005 by Chad Hurley, Steve Chen and Jawed Karim. The website includes music videos, movie and TV clips, as well as material posted by the general public. In 2006, the founders of YouTube sold their business to Google for $1.65 billion! Not a bad return in less than two years. 1.1.2 The role of entrepreneurs and intrapreneurs 5 Chad 1 1.1 To go ahead with any venture, the expected rewards must justify the risk involved. In an ideal world, a project would have a high reward and low risk, but typically new ventures are very risky because there are so many things that can go wrong. In fact, many ideas do not even get launched. Entrepreneurs hit so many setbacks or face so many difficulties that the project does not go ahead. ▼ Table 1.2 Risks and rewards matrix: analysing projects Risk Reward Low High Low These are safe projects but do not generate high returns. These projects are not of interest because of the high risk relative to the low rewards. High These projects are ideal: low risk but high rewards. However, it may not be easy to find projects like these! These projects are of interest but risky. To go ahead, entrepreneurs must believe the rewards outweigh the risks. 11 9781398308114.indb 11 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.1 HANDLING DATA If you estimate that a project has a 55 per cent probability of succeeding, what is the probability of failure? AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise CASE STUDY Banyan Tree Historically, a banyan tree gave shelter to weary travellers. Its name is now the brand of a chain of luxury hotels and resorts around the world, founded by multimillionaire Ho Kwon Ping. Ho Kwon Ping attended Stanford University after he left school, and later protested against the Vietnam War. In his time as a journalist for the Far East Economic Review, he wrote controversial articles that resulted in him spending two months in a Singapore jail. He continued working as a journalist after his release and settled with his wife on an island off the shore of Hong Kong. He joined the family business after his father became ill, deciding that it needed to do more than manufacture products for other companies. Producing for others, he realised, limited your profits and eliminated your brand presence. This fuelled his decision to move the company into the hotel industry, but he struggled to generate customer interest in their planned new hotel in Phuket, Thailand. Ho Kwon Ping resolved that the Banyan Tree should offer STUDY TIP Remember that any decision has a risk attached to it, but the key question is whether this risk is worth it. Managers must try to assess the probability of any outcome and decide whether the business should pursue any course of action given the risk involved. Why do governments like entrepreneurs? Governments like entrepreneurs because they set up new businesses in an economy. This means that entrepreneurs: » create jobs and help keep unemployment low in the economy » earn money and pay taxes » create competition for the existing providers in markets and provide new products and services. This is good for customers, who get more choice, and this is likely to lead to better service. Given the benefits of entrepreneurship, many governments are willing to help entrepreneurs to start up and grow their businesses. a different type of hotel, designed to stand out from the competition, with a luxury spa and villa format instead of the typical hotel building with rooms. He insisted on decisions others thought would not work because he was sure they would. For example, the staff at the spa did not wear shoes because being barefoot in Asia is a sign of respect, and they wore Asian clothes rather than the white uniforms that staff in Europe tended to wear. Banyan Tree Hotels & Resorts has now grown into one of the leading providers of resorts and spas, operating in 28 countries with 47 resorts and hotels around the world, 64 spas, 72 retail centres and three championship golf courses. Questions 1 2 Analyse one external factor that might have helped the success of Banyan Tree. [4] Evaluate the features you think make a successful [12] entrepreneur. The role of business enterprise in the development of a country Enterprise involves taking risks to develop new ideas. This is important to businesses and the country as a whole because a business enterprise finds solutions to problems, and new and better ways of doing things. This can help the business reduce costs and offer more benefits at a lower price than competitors. For the country as a whole, enterprise leads to innovation, which creates new products and economic growth. Enterprise challenges established ways of doing things and provides competition to existing providers. This can lead to more choice, better quality and lower prices for customers. How can governments help entrepreneurs? There are many ways in which governments can help entrepreneurs. They can provide: » access to advice and useful information to help them get started. For example, a new entrepreneur may have little experience of financial matters and appreciate some advice in this area 12 9781398308114.indb 12 05/03/21 11:06 AM » funding such as grants to help with the initial start-up HANDLING DATA costs » legal protection for new ideas. For example, a patent Imagine you need to raise $250 000 to start your business. The government will provide 3 per cent, and your savings equal 6 per cent. How much money do you still need to raise? provides legal protection for an invention. This means that inventors can make profits without their ideas being ‘stolen’ by others. EY World Entrepreneur of the Year In 2020, Dr Kiran Mazumdar-Shaw of Biocon Limited, India, won the award for the EY World Entrepreneur of the Year. Kiran graduated from a brewing school in Australia in 1975 and returned to India to begin her career. However, as a woman in a very male-dominated industry, she struggled to get a job. Instead, she started her own business and founded Biocon in 1978 with a mere $500 from investors. Today, Biocon is a leading biotech company and one of the largest employers in Asia, with a workforce of over 11 000. Kiran has been named on both the Forbes 100 Most Powerful Women list and Time magazine’s 100 Most Influential People in the World list. She is known for her determination and proactive approach. Led by Kiran, Biocon has gone from manufacturing pharmaceuticals, such as immunosuppressants, to discovering, developing and producing medicines for chronic diseases such as diabetes. Biocon has been consistently ranked as one of the highest investors in research and development in India. Kiran is very focused on helping society. Through her business, she aims to develop affordable medicines that can help save millions of lives. Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor that might have contributed to the success of Kiran’s business. [4] Evaluate the importance of spending on research and development of new products to the success of Kiran’s business. [12] 1.1.3 Business plans » a financial section which would include a cash-flow A business plan is a written document that sets out key aspects of a business idea. A business plan is often produced by entrepreneurs when setting up a business to try and anticipate any potential problems and opportunities, and to put in place appropriate actions. A business plan is a useful document to have to show potential business partners, investors or banks. This is because it shows the business is thinking ahead, is researching the risks and has suitable plans. A business plan should have information and data to support the ideas and plans of the business and reduce the risks to those lending money to it. The benefits and limitations of business plans A business plan should be a working document: as conditions change it should be updated to reflect this and the plans changed accordingly. A business plan is not just for when a business starts up; the business should keep it relevant as the business grows. Key elements of business plans A business plan will typically have the following elements: » an outline of the owners and their background and experience » an overview of the business idea and its products » an analysis of market conditions and the positioning of the business and its products within the market » an outline of how the business is to be promoted » an estimate of the sales of the business 1.1.3 Business plans CASE STUDY 1.1 forecast, a profit forecast and a statement of what the business owns and owes » details of the human resource requirements of the business. To produce a business plan, an entrepreneur will undertake market research and make plans for the different functional areas of the business. To produce a business plan, managers must think carefully about what has to be done. This will help the business to identify the degree of risk involved in any aspect of the business and take appropriate actions to manage this risk. The plan is a way of co-ordinating all the different activities of the business so that everyone knows what has to be done when, and how this fits with what is happening elsewhere within the business. The plan sets ‘milestones’ of what is to be achieved by when. It can set targets so everyone in the business knows how to measure success and understands how what they do contributes to the overall success of the business. At any moment, the progress of the plan can be checked and, if necessary, action can be taken. Even if things start to go wrong, having a plan is valuable because managers can assess where they are compared to where they should be and then decide what to do. Without a plan, they may not recognise that things have gone wrong until far too late. 13 9781398308114.indb 13 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.1 Enterprise 1.1 However, a plan is simply a statement of what the business intends to do. How useful it is will depend on how accurate its forecasts are, whether the right actions are planned in the given circumstances and whether they are implemented effectively. Simply having a plan does not guarantee success – it depends how good it is and how well it is carried out. However, for all of these businesses, planning can help prevent mistakes by identifying difficulties early, co-ordinating actions across departments and helping to take action quickly to get back on track. Even so, plans must always be reviewed because external and internal conditions will change, and therefore the plan may need to be flexible to keep relevant and competitive. The nature of the plan will differ for a start-up business compared to an established business (for example, because the start-up will have limited experience compared to a business that has been going for some time). Similarly, it will differ for a small business compared to a big business in that the latter’s plan is likely to be more complex and involve more money, more products and more markets. STUDY TIP Remember that producing a business plan is only part of the challenge of managers. To make it work, it has to be implemented effectively. CASE STUDY TikTok TikTok, the 15-second video app, is a technology start-up that has grown incredibly fast. Within two years, TikTok was rivalling Netflix, YouTube, Snapchat and Facebook with more than 1 billion downloads in 150 markets worldwide and operating in 75 languages. TikTok had a value of nearly $80 billion within two years of starting up. Through the app, users create and share homemade videos on their phones. This content has proved incredibly attractive to young audiences all over the world. Virtually no translation is needed, as TikTok’s content is primarily visual. This allows it to reach larger consumer audiences more easily than other successful Chinese apps, such as Tencent’s messaging app WeChat. WeChat is used extensively within China but is mainly used by Chinese communities outside of China. Within China, TikTok is known as Douyin. Founder Zhang Yiming, who is in his thirties, was inspired by the early success of China’s technology pioneers of the late 1990s, such as Robin Li of Baidu, Jack Ma of Alibaba, and Pony Ma of Tencent. TikTok makes money through adverts and from the sale of virtual goods, such as emojis and stickers, to fans. It is easy to use and is designed to exactly match what users want to see, rather than recommending content based on people’s viewing habits and ‘likes’. Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor that might determine the success of a new app. Evaluate the value of having a business plan to a business such as TikTok. [4] [12] TEST YOUR LEARNING b Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 5 6 Define the term ‘factors of production’. a Explain one possible purpose of business apart from profit. b Explain one reason a business might want to make a profit. a Define the term ‘scarcity and choice’. b Define the term ‘opportunity cost’. a Define the term ‘business plan’. b Explain one reason why producing a business plan is useful for a business. Explain one way in which growth in the economy might affect the costs of a business. a Explain one reason why a business might fail. [2] 7 a b 8 a b 9 a b [3] [3] [2] [2] [2] [3] 10 a [3] [2] b Explain one effect of business failure on an economy. Define the term ‘intrapreneurship’. Explain one reason intrapreneurship is important to business. Define the term ‘adding value’. Explain one way a business might try to add more value. Define the term ‘multinational business’. Explain one reason why a business might become a national rather than a local business. Explain one likely feature of a successful entrepreneur. Explain one reason why entrepreneurs are important to an economy. [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] [3] [3] 14 9781398308114.indb 14 05/03/21 11:06 AM Data response question Me & the Bees Lemonade was set up by Mikaila Ulmer when she was aged four! 1.1 From the very beginning, Mikaila invested some of the profits from the sale of her lemonade to organisations fighting hard to save bees. Me & the Bees encourages everyone to ‘Buy a Bottle ... Save the Bees’. Most recently, Mikaila launched her own non-profit, Healthy Hive Foundation. Through research, education and preservation, the Healthy Hive Foundation is dedicated to increasing bee awareness and the number of safe environments for bees to survive and thrive. Questions 1 2 3 4 Explain one reason why Mikaila set up in business. [3] Explain one factor that influences demand for [3] Mikaila’s products. Analyse one skill that Mikaila would have needed to be such a successful entrepreneur. [4] Evaluate the challenges that Mikaila’s business might face in the future. [12] 1.1.3 Business plans Mikaila’s interest in bees started when she got stung twice within a week. She started to research bees to find out more about them and became fascinated. Around that time, her family had encouraged her to enter some children’s business competitions, and her grandmother had sent her a cookbook which contained a special recipe for flaxseed lemonade. Mikaila decided to adapt the recipe and use honey from the honeybee rather than sugar. That was the start of her business. It was originally going to be known as Be Sweet Lemonade but Mikaila had to change the name as it was already being used by another business. She decided to call her business Me & the Bees Lemonade because a percentage of sales are donated to help save the bees. The company has now been in ‘buzzness’ for more than 10 years! Its products are sold in many different retailers, such as Whole Foods Market across Texas and Kroger stores in Houston. The product range now includes lip balm and different types of lemonade. Bee Fearless, Dream Like a Kid. The business has some high-profile investors, including $800 000 from a group of National Football League players. Mikaila gives many talks about the importance of saving the bee population. She has also written her first book, 15 9781398308114.indb 15 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1 Business and its environment AS LEVEL AS LEVEL 1.2 Business structure 1.2 Business structure Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the different economic sectors in an economy, that is, the difference between primary, secondary, tertiary and quaternary sectors and the private and public sectors, including the concepts of unlimited liability and limited liability ★ the advantages and disadvantages of different forms of legal structure, such as sole traders, partnerships, companies, co-operatives, franchises, joint ventures and social enterprises. 1.2.1 Economic sectors There are many types of businesses and it is useful to be able to categorise them to analyse their performance and the different issues they face. Typical ways of categorising business include by sector and by legal status. Primary, secondary, tertiary and quaternary sector businesses The many businesses that exist in an economy operate in one of three sectors: » Primary sector This is the first stage of production and involves acquiring or extracting raw materials. For example, oil has to be extracted from the under the ground, coal has to be mined, fish have to be caught and crops have to be grown. Oil, mining, fishing and agriculture are all in the primary sector of the economy. Raw materials can be renewable resources, such as fish and wind power; this means they can be replenished. Or raw materials may be non-renewable, such as oil and coal; this means the total stock available is reduced as they are consumed. » Secondary sector This is the part of the economy that manufactures and assembles products using raw materials. For example, cars are manufactured using many different parts and materials, and so car manufacturing is part of the secondary sector. Similarly, the construction industry uses many parts to produce houses and office space. » Tertiary sector This is made up of businesses that provide services. These services are intangible – that is, the service they provide cannot be physically touched (unlike manufactured goods, for example). Examples of businesses in the tertiary sector include retailers, transportation businesses and providers of financial services, such as insurance. This is often the biggest sector in developed economies in terms of both employment and the value of the output. – Quaternary sector This is a subset of the tertiary sector which represents organisations that are based on knowledge and the skills of employees; for example, information service businesses, such as management consultancies, and research and development businesses. The more developed an economy is, the more resources are diverted into the tertiary and quaternary sectors. Economies begin by being very agriculturally based (primary sector). Investment in capital equipment leads to more factories and equipment and the development of the secondary sector. As investment continues, resources tend to move away from the mass-production processes towards higher value-adding sectors based on services and knowledge. For example, developed economies may focus on sectors such as design, programming, creative work, and research and development more than mass production. The public and private sectors We can also distinguish between businesses that are owned by private individuals, which are in the private sector, and those that are owned by governments, which are in the public sector. Local supermarkets, clothes shops and hairdressers are likely to be in the private sector (although not always); the provision of electricity, water and health services is often in the public sector (although, again, this will vary from country to country). Some products may be provided by both the public and private sectors; for example, there may be government-run schools and private schools. If a government takes control of a private sector business, this is called nationalisation. If a government sells one of its organisations to the private sector, this is called privatisation. Typically the government is likely to run organisations: » that have a strategic importance to the country, such as defence, in order to protect the country 16 9781398308114.indb 16 05/03/21 11:06 AM » that provide essential services, such as energy and water, that the government wants to make sure everyone has access to regardless of income » whose benefits may not be fully appreciated by individuals, such as education and health. These are called merit goods. GLOSSARY TERMS Nationalisation occurs when a government takes ownership of a business from the private sector into the public sector (see Chapter 6.1.1). Privatisation occurs when a government transfers ownership of a business from the public sector to the private sector (see Chapter 6.1.1). Merit goods are goods or services, such as education and health, whose benefits individuals may not fully appreciate. For example, when thinking about how much to spend on healthcare, people will think of the benefits to themselves rather than the benefits that being healthy also bring to those around them. Reasons for the changing relative importance of private and public sectors The extent to which a government intervenes and the public sector is involved in an economy will vary from country to country and depends a great deal on political views about the role of the state. In countries such as North Korea, there has been a belief that the government should mostly decide how resources are allocated and so there is a large public sector and small private sector. Cuba is one of the world’s most centrally planned economies, meaning that the government still runs most of the organisations that exist on the island. According to the CIA World Factbook, the Cuban government employed nearly 73 per cent of all Cuban workers in 2017. Although there have been some changes in recent years to encourage more private sector businesses, the number remains very small and the government still controls the majority of business activities. By comparison, countries such as the USA allow market forces to allocate resources to a greater extent, so the public sector is smaller and the private sector is bigger. 1.2 The reasons why there might be less government intervention, and therefore a bigger private sector, include a desire that people own their own businesses. This is because it gives a great focus on running them well. If individuals own all or part of an organisation, they will want it to make a profit because they will benefit from this financially. This encourages people to identify and meet customers’ needs – to provide them with the goods and services and the quality they need and want. It also encourages people to be efficient and not waste resources because they want to generate more profits. By comparison, if an organisation is owned by the government, those working within it may not be concerned with whether their products are in demand or not, and they may not be focused on increasing revenue or reducing costs because they do not benefit directly. 1.2.1 Economic sectors Public sector organisations can have social objectives, not just profit objectives. This means they may provide nonprofit-making services, such as transport to remote areas. A private sector business would probably not be interested if there were not enough passengers, but the government may provide this service for the welfare of its citizens. However, the role of government may change over time; for example, in China the government has been intervening less in the economy and the private sector has been growing in recent years, whereas in Venezuela government intervention has increased in the last 20 years. The reasons why there might be more government intervention, and therefore a bigger public sector, is because people do not trust the private sector. For example: » They may want more provision of healthcare and education for everyone. In the private sector, this will only be provided for those who can pay. » They may want to provide a full range of services, including some that are not profitable; for example, rail or bus links to remote areas or a postal delivery service to distant locations within the country. » They may want to use some businesses to help maintain employment levels in a region or economy, even if it is not as efficient as it could be. » They may worry that the private sector is misleading customers, or selling products which are cheap to make but not safe, in order to make more profits. ▼ Table 1.3 Benefits of the private and public sectors Benefits of private sector Benefits of public sector Focus on profits means Focus on what is beneficial businesses want to provide for society rather than what what is demanded and ensure is profitable quality is good Focus on profits means businesses want to be efficient and not waste resources Will not try to exploit or mislead customers 17 9781398308114.indb 17 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.2 CASE STUDY Cuba AS LEVEL 1.2 Business structure retail services to entrepreneurs. Over half a million Cuban workers are now self-employed. Other changes include the private ownership and sale of property, and private farming and non-agricultural co-operatives. ▲ Figure 1.7 A street in Havana, Cuba Since 1965, Cuba has been governed by the Communist Party. It has been one of the most centrally planned, state-run economies in the world since then. However, although the government in Cuba retains a high level of political control, it is gradually opening up markets to allow competition. For example, Cubans can now set up private businesses to sell electronic devices and mobile phones, run hotels, and buy and sell used cars. The government has reduced the number of state sector jobs as part of its reform process and has opened up some 1.2.2 Business ownership When setting up in business, the founders must consider the most appropriate legal form for their enterprise. There are several different types of business organisation, each of which has its own legal structure. These include sole traders, partnerships, private limited companies and public limited companies, co-operatives, franchises, joint ventures and social enterprises. Sole traders Despite the increasing opportunities for UK companies in Cuba, the market still offers challenges, which include: l very slow decision-making, with most important business decisions being referred to high-level government l all sales in Cuba are public sales, controlled by heavy regulation l commonality of payment delays l the standard practice for the Cuban state to expect to buy on credit terms of 1–2 years l potentially increased market competition due to easing of US sanctions, which will make it easier for Cubans to trade in the USA. Sources: CIA World Factbook; UK government, Department for International Trade Questions 1 2 Analyse one potential benefit of a centrally planned economy. [4] Evaluate the possible impact for businesses in Cuba of having more privately owned businesses. [12] hairdressers are often sole traders. The people running these businesses work for themselves. In some cases, sole traders hire other people to help them out, but they are the owners and remain responsible for the overall business. Sole traders are actively involved in the running of it on a daily basis. What does it take to be a successful sole trader? As a sole trader you need to be someone who is willing to work on your own, who has the confidence to make your own decisions and who can turn your hand to almost any aspect of your business. As a sole trader, you may have to serve customers, decide what equipment to buy, deal with suppliers and keep accurate and up-to-date business records. This requires a wide range of skills and an enormous degree of flexibility. Sole traders have to be used to working hard: running your own business is no easy task. You must also be good at managing stress. All the decisions of the business are yours alone, so if you get it wrong the responsibility is yours. On the other hand, if it is successful, the sense of achievement and the rewards are yours too! ▲ Figure 1.8 Sole traders run their own businesses When individuals run a business on their own, they are known as ‘sole traders’. Plumbers, decorators, window cleaners and Becoming a sole trader requires a high level of selfdiscipline, because you are your own boss: there is no one to tell you what to do. This can be very exciting, because you decide what is going to happen. However, it also means that you have to motivate yourself to get things done. For 18 9781398308114.indb 18 05/03/21 11:06 AM example, you have to organise your day properly and use your time effectively. » receive a more regular income » be able to call on experts to help you solve problems. The advantages of being a sole trader On the other hand, there is not quite the same sense of achievement and satisfaction of having created something for yourself. Many people also enjoy not having to take orders from other people. They like the freedom to make their own decisions, to decide when and where to work, what to do and how to do it. You can also make decisions quickly as you don’t have to check with anyone to get permission to do something. It can be incredibly motivating to be your own boss. Another important advantage of being a sole trader is that you keep all the rewards of the business. You don’t have to share the profits with anyone else. Many entrepreneurs begin as sole traders for these reasons. The challenges of being a sole trader While being a sole trader can be very fulfilling, it also brings with it many challenges. Making all the decisions can be exciting, but you carry all the responsibility if anything goes wrong. If you work for someone else and there is a real problem, you have someone to work with to solve it. Being a sole trader can be quite lonely: some people find it difficult to cope with the pressure. The hours may be quite demanding too. This is particularly likely to be an issue in the early years, when you are trying hard to build up enough business. Also, you may not be able to take much time off for holidays because you may not be able to afford to close the business and risk losing customers. Another difficulty is raising finance to set up the business and expand it. You generally have to rely on your own money or money from friends and family (plus the money from the business itself, once it is up and running). Of course, it is possible to borrow from a bank or other financial institution, but they often charge smaller businesses quite high interest rates because they are worried about the risk of failure and want to cover their losses. Unlimited liability and its importance Being a sole trader is also quite risky if anything goes wrong. This is because sole traders have unlimited liability. The sole trader keeps any rewards the business makes, but is also personally responsible for any losses. If their business has problems, a sole trader can lose their personal possessions. In many ways, working for other people in a large organisation is much easier because you are likely to: » have other people to share ideas with ▼ Table 1.4 Advantages and disadvantages of being a sole trader Advantages Disadvantages • Making your own decisions can be motivating. • You can make decisions quickly and respond rapidly to changes in the market. • You have direct contact with the market. • Setting up is easy. • Sources of finance are limited. • You rely heavily on your own ability to make decisions. • You may work long hours and have limited holidays, leading to stress. • You are subject to unlimited liability. 1.2.2 Business ownership One of the main advantages of being a sole trader is that it is so easy to start up in business. Unlike starting other types of organisation, you do not need to register with anyone or fill in any special forms: you can just start trading (provided you declare your profits to the government tax office at the end of each financial year!). If you suddenly decide you want to be a gardener, a web designer, an artist, an interior decorator or a cleaner, you could start up in business tomorrow. It may be wise, however, to do some planning and get some training first! 1.2 GLOSSARY TERM Unlimited liability occurs when an individual or groups of individuals are personally responsible for all the actions of their business. With sole traders, there is no distinction in law between the individuals and the business, and so they could lose their personal assets if the business has financial problems. Partnerships If you join with other people and set up a business together, this is known as a partnership. This is common in professions such as accountancy, medicine and law. The benefits of forming a partnership over being a sole trader include: » You have other people to share ideas with. » There are more people to invest in the business and help finance it. » You can benefit from each other’s specialist skills; for example, if you have a legal practice, you could have one partner specialising in tax law, another in marital law, another in company law, and so on. This enables you to offer a wide service to customers. » You can cover for each other if someone is ill or on holiday. However, a partnership can present challenges: » You need to consult with others and there may be disagreements between the partners over the policies and direction of the business. » You are dependent on the actions of others. If, for example, one of the partners makes a mistake or brings the partnership into disrepute, it will have an impact on all the partners. Each partner is liable for the actions of the other partners’ actions, which can be risky. » In most partnerships, the partners have unlimited liability, which means that there is no distinction between the individuals and the business. If the business is sued, for example, the individuals may lose their personal possessions. This is a risk that some people may not be prepared to take. 19 9781398308114.indb 19 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.2 Business structure 1.2 To reduce some of the possible problems of a partnership, the individuals involved are advised to write a ‘deed of partnership’. This document sets out the ‘rules’ of the partnership; for example, it sets out: » how the partnership would be dissolved if someone wanted to leave. It would set out how the partnership would be valued and therefore what the person leaving would receive » how to resolve disputes if the number voting for and against is equal » how profits will be divided up; if this is not specified, the profits are divided up equally. ▼ Table 1.5 Advantages and disadvantages of setting up as a partnership Advantages Disadvantages • Share resources, ideas and workload • More sources of finance than a sole trader • Cover if someone is ill or on holiday • Share profits • May disagree over decisions • Unlimited liability HANDLING DATA You have four other partners in your business. You have agreed to share profits. If your profits are $240 000, how much does each partner receive? Companies To avoid some of the problems of being a sole trader or a partnership, you may decide to establish a company instead. To set up a company, the owners have to complete various documents. In the UK these documents are kept at Companies House. This process is known as incorporation. A company is owned by shareholders. Each share in the business represents a part of the company. The more shares someone owns, the more of the company belongs to them. A company has its own legal identity, separate from that of its owners. The company can own property, equipment and other goods in its own right and is responsible for its own debts. If the company fails, the shareholders can lose the money that they invested in the business when they bought shares, but they cannot lose more than this. This is because shareholders have limited liability. GLOSSARY TERMS A company is a business organisation which has its own legal identity and which has limited liability. Shareholders are persons or organisations that own a part of a company. Limited liability means that investors can lose the money they have invested into the business but their personal possessions are safe. There is a limit to their risk. A franchise occurs when a franchisor sells the rights to use or sell their products to a franchisee. Limited liability and its importance Limited liability means that a company is responsible for the money it owes but that the personal possessions of its owners are safe. This is different from a sole trader, who has unlimited liability and could lose everything if the business has financial problems. Having limited liability is essential for companies to be able to raise money by selling shares. Without it, investors would be far less likely to buy shares because of the risk to their personal possessions. If you invested in a business with unlimited liability, it would mean giving money to others to use and risking everything you owned. With limited liability, you know what the maximum amount is that you could lose; this means that the risk is limited. Having company status means that: » the business must pay to have its accounts checked annually by independent accountants (called auditors) » the company accounts must be made public, so that outsiders can see the revenue and profits of the business, as well as what it owns. This means that there is less privacy of affairs than if you are a sole trader. Private limited companies Private limited companies have ‘ltd’ after their names. They are owned by shareholders and the owners can place restrictions on who the shares are sold to in the future. For example, many (but not all) private limited companies are owned by families who limit the sale of shares to other members of the family: this makes sure that outsiders do not become involved. Owners of shares in private limited companies cannot advertise their shares for sale; they have to sell them privately. Public limited companies Public limited companies have ‘plc’ after their names. Once again, they are owned by shareholders but, unlike private companies, restrictions cannot be placed on the sale of these shares. Shareholders in public companies can sell their shares to whoever wants to buy them. This can cause problems if another firm starts to buy up shares in the business in an attempt to gain control of it. Some of the shareholders may want to resist this takeover, but they cannot stop fellow shareholders from selling their shares. Another difference between plcs and ltd companies is that shares in plcs can be advertised in the media. This is why you can see the share prices of public companies listed in the newspapers, but not those of private companies. Most companies become public because they want to advertise their shares to the general public and raise relatively large sums of money. Most public companies (but not all) are bigger than most private companies. If the owners of a private company do not need to raise large sums via the sale of shares and want to maintain control over their company then they probably would not want to make it a public company. 20 9781398308114.indb 20 05/03/21 11:06 AM HANDLING DATA 1.2 There are 250 000 shares in a company. You have 400 shares. What percentage of the company do you own? CASE STUDY In 2020, there was a massive drop in the amount of dividends paid by companies in the UK – and indeed around the world – amid the Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic. UK dividends were more than 60 per cent lower in 2020 than in 2019. To give a context, dividend payments globally fell by only 20 per cent during the financial crisis in 2008. Banks cancelled their dividend payments indefinitely to hold on to their cash. Retailers, hotel groups, airlines, travel groups and many manufacturers did the same. The oil giants BP and Shell – which according to Citywire accounted for nearly 30 per cent of UK dividends in 2020 between them – faced severe pressure to reduce dividends because the oil price collapsed with less demand for energy from businesses because they had shut down. Shell announced it would stop dividends for the first time since 1945. began, businesses such as high street stores were already under pressure from e-commerce. Oil companies were trying to survive given the long-term decline in hydrocarbon consumption. Car makers and airlines were generally struggling in highly competitive industries for decades, making little, if any, profit. Even the industries which typically offered relatively high dividends, such as utilities and telecommunications, now face increasing regulation and weak long-term growth. 1.2.2 Business ownership UK dividends However, even amidst such difficult times there were some business sectors that offered opportunities, such as insurance businesses and delivery companies. Questions 1 2 The ability of many companies to pay dividends may be affected for years to come. Even before the pandemic Explain one factor that might influence the amount of dividends paid by a business. [3] An investor wants to know what shares to buy. Advise her on an industry you think is likely to do well in your country in the next few years. [12] CASE STUDY Tesla and Toyota In 2020, the share price of Tesla, the electric car maker, went so high that the company became the world’s most valuable car maker, overtaking Japan’s Toyota. Tesla’s share price went to over $1100, which gave the company a market capitalisation of $209.47 billion (£165 billion). This meant that Tesla was worth approximately $4 billion more than Toyota, even though the Japanese producer sold around 30 times more cars in 2019 and its revenues were more than ten times higher. The price of shares in Tesla increased as investors began to feel more confident about the future of electric vehicles. Many analysts believe that Tesla is significantly ahead of its rivals in terms of its product range, capacity and technology. The value of Tesla in 2020 was approximately three times the combined value of General Motors and Ford. Franchises If you do not have an idea for your own business or do not want to risk setting up completely on your own, you might want to buy a franchise. A franchise occurs when one business (the franchisor) sells the right to use and sell its products and/or services to another business (the franchisee). Imagine you were interested in setting up a ▼ Table 1.6 A comparison of Tesla and Toyota Sales volume 2019 Sales revenue 2019 ($bn) Toyota 10.46 million Tesla 367 000 281.20 24.6 Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor that may determine the demand for electric cars. [4] Evaluate the factors that affect the price of Tesla shares. [12] fast-food business. You could sit down and develop your own idea from scratch. However, it could prove to be difficult to come up with something that would capture demand and then decide on a brand image, a way of producing the food, a menu and decor for your stores. An alternative would be to buy the rights to sell, for example, McDonald’s products in a given area. In this case, you would be buying a McDonald’s franchise. 21 9781398308114.indb 21 05/03/21 11:06 AM How do franchises work? AS LEVEL 1.2 Business structure 1.2 There are many different forms of franchise, but the basic elements of a franchise agreement are: » The franchisor sells the right to the product in return for an initial fee and a percentage of the franchisee’s turnover. » The franchisee receives the right to the name and the systems used by the franchisor. This may include access to materials and training methods. In the case of the McDonald’s example, the company will want to keep close control over its brand name, products and reputation. Therefore, if you buy a McDonald’s franchise, you have to follow very close rules in terms of what you sell, how you sell it, the pricing, the way the food is cooked, where it is bought, how you use the logo, and so on. Well-known franchises include: » Ben and Jerry’s ice cream » Domino’s Pizza » McDonald’s fast-food restaurants. ▲ Figure 1.9 An example of a well-known franchise Buying a franchise If you buy a franchise, you are buying a product that has already been on sale and therefore has a track record. This means you can see whether or not it works. You can also learn from other franchisees who are already established and benefit from their experience. The advantages of buying a franchise The advantages of buying a franchise include: » Because you are joining other franchisees, as a group you may have more bargaining power than you would have on your own. This may mean you get better deals with suppliers or when buying advertising space. Franchisees will often pool money to promote the brand on a regional or national scale. Any advertisement for the brand helps all the franchisees. » You have the support of the franchisor and this can help you with decisions such as pricing, choosing suppliers and planning ahead. This should reduce the risk of something going wrong because there is more experience, joint power and support than if you were setting up alone. » Buying a franchise may be less risky than setting up completely on your own. This is because there is past data for you to analyse before deciding whether or not to go ahead with the idea. At the same time, it will be your own business and so there is still the incentive to make it successful, as you will benefit directly. The problems of buying a franchise The most obvious problem with buying a franchise is that it costs you money! This reduces the profits you make. However, you hope that by buying a franchise you will do better than you would have done on your own. Whether you are better off with a franchise therefore depends on its success and the terms and conditions of the contract. Although one of the main benefits of buying a franchise is that you are linked to other franchisees, this can also be a problem. If, for example, the quality of service in other franchises falls, it may damage the overall brand and hit your sales as well. You become dependent on others and vulnerable if there are problems elsewhere. How much should you pay for a franchise? Usually, there are several different types of payments involved in buying a franchise. For example, there may be an initial purchase fee plus a percentage of turnover each year. On top of this there may be money you have to invest each year to cover marketing and management expenses. The amount you pay for a franchise will depend on: » the likely turnover of the business » the typical profits » whether you have the exclusive rights to a particular geographical area and, if so, how big and attractive this area is » the amount of training and support provided. HANDLING DATA A franchisor asks for a $12 000 fixed fee each year plus 2 per cent of profits after this fee and other costs are paid. Your revenue this year is $650 000. Your costs (not including any costs associated with the franchise) are $420 000. What are the profits this year? Selling a franchise One advantage of being a franchisor is that you benefit from the income generated from the franchisees. They will pay a fee to buy the franchise and a percentage of turnover. This generates earnings for the franchisor. Franchising is also a way of growing fast. If you were trying to grow a business on your own, you would have to fund it all yourself; for example, you would have to find the funds to buy more premises and refurbish more shops. If you sell franchises then the costs of opening a particular outlet falls to the franchisee. This may make fast growth much more feasible because individual franchisees are all funding their own enterprises. Domino’s Pizza, for example, was founded in 1960 by Tom Monaghan. His ambition was to grow the business to three stores – that’s why there are three dots on the company logo. However, through franchising, the business has grown to become the world leader in pizza delivery. 22 9781398308114.indb 22 05/03/21 11:06 AM Another benefit of being a franchisor is that it may lead to more motivated managers because they are running their ‘own’ stores or businesses, rather than just being employees of a bigger business. This may help the business as a whole to be more successful. STUDY TIP When studying franchises, you need to compare this way of starting up your own business with the alternatives. What are its advantages and disadvantages compared to other ways of starting up? What would determine whether an individual did this, rather than ‘going it alone’? Toni&Guy Together, Toni and Guy (whose real name was Gaetano) continued to open more salons, and established the TIGI brand in 1979. Under this brand name they launched gel, rollers, scissors and many more products and sold franchises to grow the business. The TONI&GUY video library supports teaching in their salons, emphasising the dedication of Toni and Guy to the development and further education of their employees. ▲ Figure 1.10 Toni&Guy hairdressers, UK Toni&Guy started in 1963, when Toni Mascolo opened a salon with his brother in Clapham, London. Today, the company has over 475 salons in 48 different countries, many of which are franchises. Toni grew up in Italy. When he was a boy, he would walk past his father’s hair salon every day on his way home from school. ‘I had a stool where I would sit and would wash hair, which made my father very proud. By the age of 12, 13, I was doing perms. It was a hobby. It’s always been a hobby.’ Toni (whose real name was Giuseppe) had wanted to become a lawyer, but that changed when the family migrated to London when he was 14. Although he had excelled at school in Italy, he couldn’t speak English, so his only option was to work for his father. 1.2.2 Business ownership CASE STUDY 1.2 Toni&Guy’s business interests, apart from the salons themselves, include: l the production and distribution of products used and sold in the salons l the Toni&Guy branded products, which have been developed with Alliance Boots l another hairdressing chain called essensuals l hairdressing training academies l a business that supplies the salons with fixtures and fittings l an IT business l an in-house media agency. The company has developed other brands which now include TONI&GUY, label.m and essensuals. Source: www.independent.co.uk/news/people/profiles/ toni-mascolo-wash-and-grow-6230921.html Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor you think is important to make a hairdressing business a success. [4] A hairdresser has asked you whether they should adopt the same model as Toni&Guy. Advise them [12] on whether to do this. 23 9781398308114.indb 23 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.2 Business structure 1.2 CASE STUDY 7-Eleven 7-Eleven is the world’s largest convenience retailer. Its business model is that of franchising its name and way of operating; it is one of the biggest franchises in the world. The company has grown fast and says its success is based around the saying of its founder Joe C Thompson Junior, which was: ‘Give the customers what they want, when and where they want it’. the initial franchise fee the expenses to train staff according to the 7-Eleven way cost of inventory to open the store spending on business supplies purchases of business licences and permits insurance costs. l l l l l l Source: https://corp.7-eleven.com/corp/about#corp_about_intro; https://franchise.7-eleven.com/franchise/the-financials 7-Eleven says that it is ‘customer-obsessed. We always poll customers to ensure we are bringing them solutions they can’t even imagine.’ Questions If you want to be a franchisee for 7-Eleven, the investment required will include: 2 1 Analyse one reason why 7-Eleven might franchise [4] its business. A friend has asked you whether they should buy a franchise in 7-Eleven. Advise them on whether to do this. [12] Co-operatives Another form of business is known as a co-operative. Co-operative businesses are owned and run by and for their members, whether they are customers, employees or residents. The members of a co-operative have one vote each and so it is a democracy. Members, such as farmers or freelancers, tenants or taxi drivers, can often do better by working together. Sharing the profit is a way to keep it fair and make it worthwhile. Rather than rewarding outside investors, a co-operative shares its profits among the members. When someone leaves the co-operative they give up their shares. According to the International Co-operative Alliance, nearly 300 million people around the world are employed by co-operatives, while over 1 billion are members. There are different forms of co-operative, such as: » Employee co-operatives These occur when the business is owned equally by all the employees who work there. Each employee has a vote in the business decisions and shares in the profits. The advantage of this is that employees may be more motivated to make the business a success because they are part-owners. One of the problems, however, is that decision-making may be difficult if everyone has an equal vote but disagrees. Also, you cannot sell shares to those outside the business to raise finance, which might limit access to funds. » Community co-operatives These are owned by members of a community to provide a local service, such as a post office. » Retail co-operatives These occur when independent retailers join together. A group of independent stores may come together and operate under one brand name. This means they can get better deals from suppliers by buying in bulk and can share marketing costs. CASE STUDY Co-operative facts and figures ‘At least 12 per cent of people on Earth [belong to one] of the 3 million co-operatives on Earth. Co-operatives provide jobs or work opportunities to 10 per cent of the employed population, and the 300 largest co-operatives or mutuals generate $2034.98 billion in turnover ...’ Source: https://ica.coop/en/co-operatives/facts-and-figures Questions 1 2 Explain one benefit of being part of a co-operative. [3] Evaluate the reasons why the co-operative [12] approach is so popular around the world. Joint ventures A joint venture occurs when businesses collaborate on a project but do not formally join together all their activities. For example, in the car industry a number of manufacturers might share the research costs of developing an electric car but they would still compete with their other models. In the pharmaceutical industry, two businesses may share their research skills for a new medicine. When entering a new market overseas, a company may set up a venture with a local business to help make the contacts and develop the networks it needs to distribute its products. The benefits of a joint venture are that: » businesses can share skills, resources, expertise and experience; this can benefit both parties » businesses can collaborate on projects that are mutually beneficial without having to merge all their operations. This makes the process easier, less difficult to manage and less expensive than a full joining together (called a merger). 24 9781398308114.indb 24 05/03/21 11:06 AM However, there may still be difficulties, such as: » agreeing on the division of the profits; there may be disagreements over the relative contribution of each business » different views on how decisions should be made and what the priorities are » different views on whether and how to end the venture. CASE STUDY 1.2 Wikipedia Social enterprises Not all enterprises are set up to make a profit. Local sports clubs, government organisations and charities, for example, do not have profit as the main objective. They are set up for other purposes. ‘The Wikimedia Foundation provides the essential infrastructure for free knowledge. We host Wikipedia, the free online encyclopedia, created, edited, and verified by volunteers around the world, as well as many other vital community projects. All of which is made possible thanks to donations from individuals.’ Social enterprises are businesses that have social aims and which trade in order to benefit the community or society in general. Examples of social aims are job creation and training, providing community services and ‘fair trade’ with developing countries. Well-known social enterprises in the UK include Cafédirect, The Big Issue, The Co-operative Group and the Eden Project, but there are many others (more than 55 000) operating in a wide range of industries, from farmers’ markets and recycling companies to transport providers and childcare. The number of social enterprises is increasing as people become more concerned about issues such as the environment and inequality. Source: https://wikimediafoundation.org 1.2.2 Business ownership Wikipedia was created in 2001. It is a multilingual, webbased, free-content encyclopedia project and is now one of the largest online encyclopedias. It is written by volunteers all over the world. Its articles can be edited by anyone with internet access. Articles are continually updated and improved by online contributors. The website was created by the not-for-profit Wikimedia Foundation, who says: Questions 1 2 Explain one way in which Wikipedia transforms inputs into outputs. [3] Evaluate the ways in which the success of Wikipedia might be measured. [12] CASE STUDY The Big Issue The Big Issue Group is a social enterprise in the UK aimed at reducing poverty by creating opportunities for people. The group has grown over the years and now includes: l a magazine which offers employment opportunities to people living in poverty l a fund that invests millions of pounds to support enterprises that bring about social change l a charity shop that sells social enterprise products. In 1991, The Big Issue magazine launched with the aim of providing homeless people with an opportunity to earn money by selling copies to the public. The magazine’s sellers are from a wide range of backgrounds, but all of them struggle with poverty. Sellers buy The Big Issue magazine for £1.50 and then sell it on to their customers for £3. This means the seller is earning money and is not begging for it. Not only that, but the act of having to organise themselves and manage their money as well as interacting with the public to sell the magazine all help individuals to build up their self-confidence and self-reliance. The magazine has won numerous awards and led to the creation of over 120 similar magazines in 35 different countries. Key facts about The Big Issue include: l over 200 million copies of the magazine have been sold l 92 000 people have sold The Big Issue. Source: www.bigissue.com/about Questions 1 2 Analyse one way in which The Big Issue helps society. Discuss the ways in which The Big Issue would measure its success. [3] [12] Changing legal structure » publish details of its accounts such as revenue and It is relatively common for someone to set up in business as a sole trader and then to change the business into a private limited company (ltd) later on, when they want to raise funds from selling shares or want the benefits of limited liability. » publish administrative details, such the address of the To operate as a ltd company, a business must: » have its accounts checked by an independent accountant (called an auditor) each year profits each year company and names of its directors. This means the business affairs of a private company are more open than those of a sole trader. If you want to keep your earnings private, you would want to remain as a sole trader. 25 9781398308114.indb 25 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.2 Business structure 1.2 It may be that the owners of a private company want to make it public, as did Facebook in 2012. This gives the company access to more potential investors. To do this, the business must make more information available to the public and there is greater regulation of the way it operates and the information it provides. Becoming a public company opens a business to even greater scrutiny and even bigger legal and accountancy bills. However, it does enable its shares to be sold more easily on the stock exchange and this makes the shares more attractive to more investors, because they know they should be able to sell them, if needs be, to someone else (this means the shares of a plc are relatively easy to sell). TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Define the terms ‘primary sector’, ‘secondary sector’, ‘tertiary sector’ and ‘quaternary sector’. [8] Define the term ‘public sector’. [2] Explain one advantage of a partnership compared with a sole trader. [3] a Define the term ‘limited liability’. [2] b Explain one way that limited liability can benefit a company. [3] Explain one advantage of creating a company rather than operating as a sole trader. [3] a Define the term ‘franchise’. [2] b Explain one reason for buying a franchise. [3] Explain one benefit of being part of a co-operative compared with a company. [3] Explain one advantage of being a sole trader compared with a partnership. [3] Explain one way a company can raise finance. [3] with over 1.4 million copyrights, is one of the world’s largest. Publishing is more secure and profitable than recorded music, although the majority of Warner Music’s income is generated by the latter. Warner Music had previously been bought by billionaire Sir Len Blavatnik for $3.3 billion (£2.5 billion) in 2011, when the industry was not doing well. The value of music companies rose after that, aided by the fast emergence and growth of paid streaming services such as Spotify. In 2019, its profit was $256 million and its revenue was $4.5 billion. By 2020, Warner Music was worth around $6 billion. Warner had initially intended to sell its shares in February 2020, but when the Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic took hold, it delayed the sale. It then intended to sell the shares on 3 June 2020, but delayed this for a few days because it did not want to distract attention away from the Black Lives Matter movement that was in the news. Questions 1 Data response question In 2020, Warner Music Group decided to sell shares to the general public. Warner Music included some of the world’s biggest record labels including Warner, Atlantic, Elektra and Parlophone. The company had many major recording artists signed to it, including Ed Sheeran and Katy Perry, representing over 80 000 songwriters and composers, from Beethoven to Madonna. The company also owns the music publisher Warner Chappell which, 2 3 4 Define the terms: a ‘company’ b ‘private sector’. Calculate Warner Music’s profit as a percentage of its revenue in 2019. Analyse one reason why investors would buy shares in Warner Music. Evaluate the extent to which the price of a share in Warner Music depends on when it is sold. [2] [2] [2] [4] [12] 26 9781398308114.indb 26 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1 Business and its environment AS LEVEL 1.3 Size of business In this chapter we examine: ★ how the size of a business can be measured ★ the significance of small and family businesses for the economy ★ business growth. 1.3.1 Measurements of business size The size of a business can be measured in many ways such as: » the turnover (revenue) of the business » the number of employees » the value of the assets of the business shown on its statement of financial position » the market value of the business (for example, the value of all of its shares) » other indicators such as the number of stores or even the number of vehicles (for example, for a bus company). The best measure will depend on the sector you are considering. For example, public sector organisations might not generate revenue (for example, if the health service is provided for free) so it may be more appropriate to measure the number of employees. It is also important when considering the size of a business to think about its ownership. What seems like a ‘small’ business may actually be part of a much bigger ‘parent’ organisation and therefore have access to its funds and expertise. When governments are considering policies, such as subsidies and tax allowances, they will examine the ownership of a business and whether it is part of a bigger parent organisation. HANDLING DATA Your company has 30 000 shares. The share price increases from $2.50 to $2.80. a Calculate the old and new market values. b Calculate the percentage change in the market value of the company. 1.3.2 Significance of small businesses Chapter overview 1.3.2 Significance of small businesses Advantages and disadvantages of being a small business The advantages of small businesses are that: » they are relatively easy to set up » they are flexible because decisions can be made quickly (without having to consult lots of other people) » they are often run by very motivated individuals because they probably set up and own the business, and so they want it to succeed because they personally gain the rewards » they are often very creative because it is easy for those involved to communicate with each other and share ideas. STUDY TIP Note that profit measures the success of the activities of a business. It is not in itself a measure of the size of a business. 27 9781398308114.indb 27 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.3 CASE STUDY Businesses in the EU AS LEVEL 1.3 Size of business Shown below is the way in which the size of businesses is categorised within the European Union (a grouping of 27 European countries). This is important because it can affect the government support that is available and which regulations apply to them. When determining a business’ size, the number of employees is always taken into account and either the annual turnover or the annual statement of financial position total. Micro, small and medium-sized businesses account for 99 per cent of businesses in the European Union. Question 1 Analyse two benefits these businesses bring to the [8] EU economy. ▼ Table 1.7 Measuring the size of businesses within the European Union Enterprise category Number of employees Medium-sized Annual turnover (€m) OR Annual statement of financial position total (€m) < 250 ≤ 50 OR ≤ 43 Small < 50 ≤ 10 OR ≤ 10 Micro < 10 ≤2 OR ≤2 However, small businesses do have disadvantages: » They lack power in the market (for example, with suppliers and customers) and so can find it difficult to survive. » They may lack much experience compared to more established firms. » They may find it difficult to raise finance because of the high risk involved as so many small businesses fail. This is why governments sometimes try to help small businesses by providing advice, lower taxes and less regulation to help them survive. CASE STUDY Small business finance Small and medium-sized enterprises (SMEs) face challenges getting finance, said the Vietnam Chamber of Commerce and Industry (VCCI). It said that finance was expensive because the banks themselves are paying high interest rates of more than 13 per cent to get savers to provide them with funds. The banks also prefer to offer loans to large companies and state-run enterprises as they are a safer investment. Family businesses have some strengths: » The family members may share values, leading to fewer disagreements. » Those involved may work hard so that the family as a whole prospers; their ties to the business will be emotional as well as financial, which may make them more committed to the survival and success of the business. This may mean they will work harder and for longer than outsiders. » Individuals may be very supportive of each other because they are family members. » Family members may be willing to plan for the long term because they will be looking for the benefits they can bring for future generations. » A number of family members may be involved in providing finance and expertise. » There may be decreased costs as family members may be willing to work for less than outside employees, at least in the short term. The Vietnamese government has ordered the banks to lend more to SMEs. Questions 1 2 Analyse two ways that high interest rates might make it difficult for SMEs to survive. [8] Evaluate why the Vietnamese government might beeager to lend more to SMEs. [12] Strengths and weaknesses of family businesses A number of businesses in an economy will be run by families. This is especially true in countries such as India, where the culture tends to encourage families to work together. ▲ Figure 1.11 Family businesses are common in some countries, such as India. 28 9781398308114.indb 28 05/03/21 11:06 AM However, there may also be weaknesses: » Sometimes in a family business, decisions may be made for emotional reasons rather than rational ones. It may be that the correct thing is to do ‘A’ but because we don’t want to upset a family member we do ‘B’ instead. » The family members may lack the right experience but there may be reluctance to bring in outsiders. Sometimes the wrong people may be doing jobs but family ties keep them in that role. » It may be difficult to manage your relationship with others in the business easily because you will be influenced by emotional issues as well as business factors. » The biggest difficulty for any family-run business is handing over power to the next generation when the current head of the family retires. A family business Nelson Assemany and his four brothers opened a shop together in Rio de Janeiro in 1967. Now employing their sons, today they have two shops: one selling fabrics, the other selling imported consumer goods. Family businesses are also more likely to be focused on long-term growth, because the aim is to pass them on to the next generation, while large companies are often too concerned with short-term results and shareholder profits. While outsiders often think Brazilian business is dominated by big companies such as the mining business Vale and oil group Petrobras, in reality 85 per cent of the country’s companies are much smaller, family-run operations. These businesses can adapt easily in a crisis compared to a company managed by a board of directors, where you have to consult other people and get approval for everything. Questions The importance of small businesses and their role in the economy In most economies, the majority of businesses are quite small, often one-person businesses. For example, plumbers, hairdressers, restaurateurs, lawyers and photographers are often sole traders. Although these small businesses are the most significant in terms of number, the larger businesses tend to dominate in terms of the total number of people they employ and the value of the output they produce. There may only be one Google or one Ford, for example, but they each employ a lot of people and have a very high turnover! Nevertheless, the small business sector is very important to any economy. This is because small businesses: » create jobs, reducing unemployment » provide competition for established businesses to ensure they remain competitive » provide new sources of ideas. Small businesses are often very creative and many innovations start in smaller organisations » can go on to grow in the future. Small businesses and the economy Small businesses are important to economies because they help create jobs and are often sources of innovation. Many new products or new ideas come from small businesses, so they are a source of entrepreneurial thinking. Small businesses create competition and provide momentum to an economy to promote economic growth. However, the founders and owners often need support. Governments may provide this support through: 1 2 Define what is meant by the term ‘company’. [2] Evaluate the advantages and disadvantages of family businesses. [12] 1.3.2 Significance of small businesses CASE STUDY 1.3 » better business and enterprise training at school and university » access to support and advice » access to finance » making it easier to start up and run a business; for example, by removing regulations that add to costs and make it difficult to operate. The role of small businesses as part of the industrial structure in some industries Small businesses are often very innovative. In industries such as pharmaceuticals and computers, many of the breakthroughs are made by small businesses; bigger businesses then often take over or work with the smaller organisations to develop the ideas further. Bigger, more established businesses often provide the finance and capacity to produce and sell the product on a large scale. Small businesses can also provide specialist services that bigger organisations might not be interested in providing for themselves; for example, while the larger firm concentrates on its core business, the small firm might specialise in, say, digital marketing, specialist legal advice or provide expertise on a new market overseas. Small businesses can concentrate on small segments of the market (called niches) and sell their services to bigger organisations who buy in this expertise. GLOSSARY TERM A niche is a small segment of a market. 29 9781398308114.indb 29 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.3 CASE STUDY Businesses in the UK private sector The data below shows the composition of the UK economy in 2019 in terms of the size of businesses. ▼ Table 1.8 Estimated number and size of businesses in the UK, 2019 AS LEVEL 1.3 Size of business Business Employment (thousands) Turnover (£ millions) All businesses 5 867 770 SMEs (0–249 employees) 5 860 085 16 630 2 168 005 Small businesses (0–49 employees) 5 824 500 13 157 1 528 684 With no employees 4 457 820 4 835 304 508 All businesses with employees 1 409 950 22 663 3 845 465 1 155 385 4 206 595 013 10–49 employees 211 295 4 116 629 163 50–249 employees 35 585 3 473 639 321 7 685 10 868 1 981 968 27 498 4 149 973 of which: 1–9 employees 250+ employees Source: UK government, Department for Business, Energy & Industrial Strategy Question 1 Evaluate the contribution of small businesses to the UK economy in 2019. HANDLING DATA The market as a whole is worth $960 000. Your niche is worth $60 000. What percentage of the market is this? 1.3.3 Business growth Business growth is a common objective of any business. By growing: » a business can get more power over suppliers and customers, which might help it to make more profits » a business can reach more customers and there is the possibility of more profit through more sales » the owners can eventually own something that is worth more » the owners can have a sense of achievement because they can look back and be proud of having grown the business » a business can raise its profile. Why and how a business might grow internally (organic growth) The size of a business is not fixed – it can change over time. One way to grow is to expand your existing operations. This is called internal or organic growth. To do this a business may: » try to grow sales of its existing products in its existing markets [12] » develop new products for its customers » find new markets where it can sell its existing products. External growth External growth occurs when a business expands by buying up another business or joining with another business. This is known as integration. The process of integration is sometimes called a merger and sometimes a takeover. In a merger, two or more businesses mutually agree to join together to form one new one. Alternatively, one business may unilaterally decide to acquire another; this is known as a takeover. In the case of a takeover, one business buys control of another one by gaining the majority of its shares. It can do this by offering shares in its business (which is called a paper offer) or by paying to buy the shares (which is a cash offer) or a combination of the two. The directors of the company being targeted may welcome the bid and advise their shareholders to sell; this is a friendly takeover, which could be called a merger. However, the directors of the target company may resist the bid and advise their shareholders not to sell; this then becomes a hostile takeover. There are different forms of integration: » Horizontal This occurs when one business joins with another at the same stage of the same production process; for example, a car manufacturer acquires another car manufacturer. 30 9781398308114.indb 30 05/03/21 11:06 AM » Vertical This occurs when a business acquires another The motives for these different types of integration may vary; likely reasons for them are shown in Table 1.9. ▼ Table 1.9 Motives for different forms of integration Type of integration Likely motives Horizontal Greater market power; economies of scale Forward vertical Gaining access to the market, for example, by joining with retailer Backward vertical Gaining control over supplies – this may improve co-ordination, improve quality and reduce costs Conglomerate Spreading risks by operating in different markets; less vulnerable to a change in conditions in one market Integration and stakeholders The coming together of businesses will have an impact on stakeholders. The precise effect will depend on the nature of and success of the deal. However, some of the potential implications are: » Investors The deal is likely to cost money initially but, if it works, bring higher returns in the long term. If investors generally approve of the deal, the share price of the bidder will rise and, if profits do increase, dividends may as well. However, in reality many mergers and takeovers do not do as well as expected, in which case the shareholders of the bidding company may be disappointed. » Managers The effect on managers will depend on the deal, but in some cases it will mean there is a duplication of roles. Company A may have a marketing manager and so might company B. With integration there may be an opportunity to save money by only having one marketing manager. » Suppliers They may benefit if the combined business does well and grows. However, the new, bigger business may have more power to push down prices from suppliers. Why a merger/takeover may or may not achieve objectives 1.3 Many businesses like the idea of external growth. This is because it is a way of growing rapidly. By joining with an existing business, it is possible to quickly enter a new market or to achieve a much bigger presence in a market. However, often these deals are not as successful as expected. Problems of mergers and takeovers include: » the costs of doing the deal itself. Integration may involve legal costs, finance costs and reorganisation costs » the clashes that may occur when the businesses start to try and work together. There can often be significant differences in the way that people work, what they prioritise and how they make decisions, and this can lead to friction, higher costs and mistakes being made » inefficiency because the business is too big. This can cause problems co-ordinating it, communicating to staff and building a common sense of purpose. 1.3.3 Business growth business at a different stage of the same production process. Backward vertical integration occurs when the business joins with a supplier; forward vertical integration occurs when a business joins with a business closer to the customer, such as a distributor or retailer. » Conglomerate diversification This occurs when a business joins with another business operating in a different sector; for example, a car manufacturer joins with a confectionery business. Joint ventures and strategic alliances Another form of external growth occurs when a business forms a joint venture or establishes a strategic alliance with another business. This means they agree to co-operate in specific areas but do not fully join together in all aspects of their operations. In the case of a joint venture, the businesses create a new legal entity to collaborate together. The joint venture agreement will specify all the details of the contract, including the rights of the partner businesses, the objective of the venture, how day-to-day operations will be carried out and how profits will be distributed. In the case of a strategic alliance, they remain completely independent businesses but collaborate on a given project. The advantage of joint ventures and strategic alliances is that businesses share their expertise and assets in areas where they feel this will bring benefits. However, they can avoid some of the problems that come with trying to integrate whole businesses together. Strategic alliances will often be used when co-operating on a project allows the businesses involved to benefit from each other’s resources and expertise and to make more profits. Joint ventures are often used when businesses enter new markets. The ‘outside’ business can join with a local business and use its expertise and contacts. In this situation, a joint venture can reduce risks by making use of the local business’ inside knowledge, contacts and awareness of the country’s culture and business environment. In some countries, foreign businesses can only operate in conjunction with local ones and so joint ventures are a common way of entering the market. 31 9781398308114.indb 31 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.3 TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions AS LEVEL 1.3 Size of business 1 a State two ways of measuring the size of a business. [2] b Explain one possible advantage of being a big business compared with being a small business.[3] 2 Explain one problem of being a small business. [3] 3 Explain one reason why a government might want [3] to support small businesses. [2] 4 Define the term ‘internal growth’. 5 State two ways in which a business might try to grow. [2] 6 Explain one advantage of being a family business. [3] 7 a Explain one reason why a business might want to grow internally. [3] [3] b Explain one problem of internal growth. 8 a Explain one reason why a business might want [3] to grow externally. b Explain one benefit of horizontal integration. [3] 9 Explain one reason why a merger or takeover may not achieve its objective. [3] 10 Explain one benefit of a using a joint venture to enter an overseas market. [3] Data response question Family businesses in Asia From Samsung in South Korea, Reliance Industries in India, to Hon Hai, the Taiwanese maker of the iPad, family businesses dominate Asia’s (and increasingly the world’s) business environment. They make up half of Asia’s public limited companies and a third of the market capitalisation value of all companies on the stock exchange, and they employ millions of people. However, many of these businesses are failing to plan for the transition to a public limited company with external shareholders. This can lead to uncertainty, at best, and potentially ruinous family disputes. For example: l Lee Kun-hee, the 70-year-old chairman of electronics giant Samsung, was sued by both his brother and sister over company shares left by their late father. l India’s richest man, Mukesh Ambani, was involved in a five-year dispute with his brother Anil over their father’s vast Reliance empire. l In Hong Kong, a row emerged over the future of billionaire Stanley Ho’s Macau casino business, which led to Mr Ho arguing against some of his own children. l Winston Wong, eldest son of the late Taiwanese tycoon Wang Yung-ching, sued to recover $4 billion worth of disputed assets that he claimed were taken by members of his father’s third family. Wang founded Formosa Plastics, one of Taiwan’s biggest companies. Given that many of Asia’s most successful businesspeople are now in their eighties and nineties, the next decade will probably see a number of contentious leadership successions. Asia’s biggest family businesses l l l l l l l l l l Samsung Electronics (South Korea) Reliance Industries (India) Hon Hai Precision Industries/Foxconn (Taiwan) Sun Hung Kai Properties (Hong Kong) Tata Consulting (India) Cheung Kong (Hong Kong) Hutchison Whampoa (Hong Kong) Wilmar International (Singapore) Bharti Airtel (India) Formosa Petrochemical (Taiwan) A recent study tracked the market performance of 250 family companies that underwent a succession. It found that, on average, these companies’ market values declined by almost 60 per cent during the period starting five years before the succession and up to three years afterwards. The performance of a family firm is often down to the skills, charisma and connections of the founder, something that subsequent generations may find hard to replicate. Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘public limited company’ [2] b ‘market capitalisation’. [2] Explain two reasons why family businesses are so important to the economy. [6] Evaluate whether family businesses are ‘ultimately [12] doomed to fail; it is just a question of time’. 32 9781398308114.indb 32 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1 Business and its environment AS LEVEL 1.4 Business objectives 1.4.1 Business objectives in the private sector and public sector Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ business objectives in the private and public sectors ★ objectives and business decisions. 1.4.1 Business objectives in the private sector and public sector GLOSSARY TERMS An objective is a target. A good objective will state what is to be achieved (for example, an increase in profit), how much the business wants it to be (for example, $25 000) and when it wants this to be done by (for example, in three years). This means a good objective should be: » specific in terms of what the target is » quantifiable (measurable) » time-specific in terms of when it should be completed. Labour productivity measures the output per time period of an employee. A business will have an overall objective, such as a target of doubling its profits within five years. This will then give the business’ managers the opportunity and information to set departmental targets. For example: » The marketing department may have to increase sales by 40 per cent over an agreed period. » The operations management department may need to reduce costs by 20 per cent over the next three years. » The human resources department may have a target to increase labour productivity by 8 per cent over the same time period. Within each department every individual should also have their own objective. For example, to reduce costs by 20 per cent, the person responsible for ordering supplies for the business may be set a target of finding a supplier that is 5 per cent cheaper. The manager in charge of sales for the southeast of the country may be asked to increase sales in their area by 30 per cent to help overall sales rise by 40 per cent. Those objectives which relate to the entire business, such as growth, are also termed corporate objectives. The setting and pursuit of objectives of a business helps it to co-ordinate its activities, whether it operates within the private sector or the public sector. It provides goals for employees at all levels within the organisation and helps managers to co-ordinate the activities of all employees. The Starbucks case study on page 34 emphasises the importance of objectives within large and growing organisations. Corporate objectives Departmental objectives ▲ Figure 1.12 Business objectives Individual objectives An objective is a target that is measurable and has a given timescale. A corporate objective is a target set for the business as a whole. Business objectives in the private sector We saw in Chapter 1.2 that private sector businesses are owned by individuals. Businesses in the private sector can have a number of objectives, including the following. Profits and profit maximisation Profits are maximised when the difference between sales revenue and total costs is at its greatest. Some firms set objectives which involve achieving a minimum level of profit, allowing the business and its managers to focus on other objectives. This approach, known as satisficing, may be pursued by smaller family-owned organisations. Satisficing allows the owners of these businesses to achieve other targets, such as entering new markets or increasing the size of the business. Other businesses may seek to earn the greatest possible profits to satisfy their shareholders’ desire for high dividends. This might be a shorter-term objective. Others may pursue the longer-term objective of providing acceptable levels of dividends, but they may also look for growth in the value of the company and therefore in its share price. This can provide shareholders with long-term financial benefits. Growth Many businesses have an objective of growth because their managers believe that the organisation will not survive otherwise. If a firm grows, it should be able to exploit its market position and earn higher profits. This benefits business owners (in the long term) by providing greater dividends, as well as offering better salaries and more job security to the employees and managers of the business. 33 9781398308114.indb 33 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.4 The case study on Starbucks shows that the company has set itself the aim of growth. This will have been expressed in quantified objectives, possibly relating to sales figures or market share in other countries. CASE STUDY AS LEVEL 1.4 Business objectives Starbucks’ objectives Starbucks is an American multinational company. In 2019, it operated 30 600 stores in 80 countries selling coffee, other drinks and food. at cafés open for at least a year have increased by 6 per cent globally. In 2019, its sales reached a record figure of $6.8 billion. Starbucks sets out its objectives clearly on its website and one of these is growth. Starbucks has put in place a range of plans to achieve its growth objective. The company has opened new restaurants, improved its use of technology within its stores and developed new products for its customers. Questions These decisions appear to have been successful, as Starbucks has improved its financial performance. Sales 1 2 Explain one reason why making Starbucks’ employees responsible for its marketing might help the company to achieve its objective of growth. [3] Evaluate the benefits that Starbucks might receive from its clearly stated business objectives. [12] Survival Diversification This objective is for the business to continue to trade over a defined period of time, rather than to submit to some form of commercial pressure and be forced to cease trading. This is an important objective, even for the largest of businesses at certain times. However, it is a more common one for small and newly established businesses. Survival is likely to become a key objective during: » periods of recession or intense competition » times of crisis, such as during the 2020 Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic. Diversification is an objective where a firm produces an increased range of unrelated goods and services. Adopting this objective allows a business to spread its risk by selling a range of products (rather than one) or through trading in different markets. Thus, if one product becomes obsolete or a market becomes significantly more competitive, then the alternative products or markets will provide a secure source of revenue for the business while it seeks new projects. Diversification allows a business to avoid relying on one or two products and has been the principle behind the creation of conglomerate businesses – those that sell a range of products in different markets. PepsiCo Inc., the multinational soft drink and snack producer, has pursued the objective of diversification to extend its product range beyond soft drinks. This is intended to help it to compete with its powerful rival, The Coca-Cola Company. Cash flow For most businesses, cash flow is a vital element of success as it is essential to be able to pay debts on time. This is especially true of businesses that have long cash cycles. A cash cycle is the time that elapses between the outflow of cash to pay for the resources needed to produce a product and the receipt of cash following the sale of the product. Businesses in industries such as pharmaceuticals and construction may have long cash cycles. Walt Disney, the global entertainment company, has an objective to strengthen its cash-flow position. The failure to set an objective relating to cash flow could have dire consequences for a business if it is unable to pay its debts as they fall due. In the worst case, a shortage of cash could result in a business having to cease trading. GLOSSARY TERMS The market share of a business measures its sales as a percentage of the total market sales. Cash flow is the movement of cash into and out of a business over a time period. Ethics are moral principles that can shape the way a business behaves. Social responsibility is a philosophy under which businesses consider the interests of all groups in society as a central part of their decision-making. Business objectives in the public sector Providing a service to the community Businesses in the public sector are owned by the government. Usually a major objective of businesses in this sector is to provide a service to all of the country’s population. For example, if a transport system is owned by the government, it may operate bus services to remote areas where few people live. Private sector businesses may not be willing to do this as it may not be profitable due to the low number of passengers. In India, the government has set public sector businesses the target of constructing 11 000 kilometres of roads each year to improve transport services. Similarly, it may be necessary for public sector businesses to provide some products that otherwise may not be available. Private sector businesses may not be willing to make the huge investments necessary to develop systems needed to supply utilities such as gas, water and electricity. In many countries these services are supplied by the public sector. For example, in Pakistan there are publicly owned businesses supplying electricity in many localities including Lahore, Faisalabad and Multan. 34 9781398308114.indb 34 05/03/21 11:06 AM Social objectives Businesses in the public sector do not seek to maximise profits, unlike many of those in the private sector. In many countries, public sector organisations are expected to at least cover their operating costs, to avoid needing financial support from the government. Public sector businesses in some countries have an objective to generate a financial surplus which is reinvested to improve the service offered by the business. In 2020, businesses in the public sector in Indonesia were reviewed by the government, and some were merged with others or closed due to very weak financial performance. Social objectives include targets that relate to matters such as providing employment for people or improving facilities for local people (for example, building a play park for local children). Social enterprises frequently reinvest their profits to help to meet their social objectives. A study by the University of Pennsylvania showed that many social enterprises have ambitious goals of having more clients and expanding their operations but that few set quantifiable targets. Development of relatively poor regions Many countries operate public sector businesses in regions with low incomes. This can help to raise standards of living in less affluent parts of the nation. In New Zealand, the government is making changes to ensure that public sector organisations meet the needs of the country’s indigenous Maori population. Private sector business (e.g. Lenovo, Tata Group) Profits and profit maximisation Growth Survival Cash flow Diversification Public sector businesses (e.g. electricity supply) Providing a service Financial objectives Regional development Social enterprises (e.g. Wikipedia) Social objectives Ethical objectives ▲ Figure 1.13 Objectives for different business sectors The objectives of social enterprises Social enterprises are businesses which operate to benefit the community or society in general. As a result, they normally set themselves social and ethical objectives. Social and ethical objectives have received much attention recently. In part, this is the result of widespread access to the internet, making it easier for the public to discover information about the behaviour of businesses. Some investors will only invest in companies that trade with ethical or social objectives. Importantly, a significant proportion of customers seek to purchase products from businesses with social and ethical objectives. Pursuing such objectives, and publicising the fact, can offer a business a distinctive and attractive image. 1.4 1.4.1 Business objectives in the private sector and public sector Financial objectives Ethical objectives Ethical objectives are those that are based on moral principles. Examples of ethical objectives include protecting the environment through the use of sustainable production techniques and ensuring that suppliers receive fair and prompt payment. The importance of business objectives Business objectives set out what the business wants to achieve. This provides a focus for all decisions. Employees know what they are supposed to achieve and can then make suitable decisions. Without objectives, employees do not know the priorities and do not know how success will be measured. This can lead to a loss of focus and a wasteful use of resources. Objectives can: » motivate employees by providing targets » provide a measure of control, as progress can be reviewed against these targets. Corporate social responsibility as a business objective A business may have many objectives relating to different areas. For example, it may want to boost profits but, at the same time, may be aware of its impact on society as a whole and the environment in particular. Any business will have certain responsibilities to other groups by law. For example, there are laws in many countries determining the minimum an employee can be paid, the information businesses have to provide about their products, and the procedures to be taken to make the working environment safe. All businesses should have an objective of acting legally. However, some may accept obligations to society over and above the legal minimum; this type of behaviour is known as corporate social responsibility (CSR). For example, a business may believe: » it should ensure that work is interesting and that employees have a good career path within the organisation » it has a responsibility to keep people in work as much as possible and therefore be reluctant to force anyone to leave the business » it is important to pay suppliers quickly rather than taking as long as possible and holding on to money » it should invest in its local community to improve the area and quality of life of the community where it is based. 35 9781398308114.indb 35 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.4 Business objectives 1.4 CASE STUDY The Good Hotel The Good Hotel is part of the Good Group, set up by Marten Dresen. The Good Group is a social enterprise, offering customers luxury accommodation in wonderful locations. In 2020, the business operated hotels in London and Antigua de Guatemala. By 2021, it plans to open hotels in five new locations. The Good Hotel operates in an environmentally conscious way. It sources its food locally and treats suppliers fairly. It offers vegetarian and vegan meals and does not use plastic straws in any of its hotels. It does not put TVs in its hotel rooms, opting to instead provide spaces that facilitate connection and conversation. The Good Hotel believes that ‘conversation is the key to community’. All the business’ profits are invested into educational projects in Guatemala to provide skills and training to those A business that acts responsibly believes it is a corporate citizen with obligations to society. This type of business will set targets to do more for society than it is obliged to by law. who really need it. According to its website, a one-night stay can finance one week’s education for a child in Guatemala. In its first year of trading, Good Group donated approximately $80 000 to its causes in Guatemala, and is on target to donate more than $500 000 per year. This has financed the building of three schools, providing quality education for over 500 students in impoverished Guatemalan communities. Source: www.good.community Questions 1 2 Explain one way in which operating as a social enterprise has shaped The Good Hotel’s objectives. [3] Evaluate whether The Good Hotel can be expected to compete successfully with other hotels operated by businesses in the private sector. [12] of people and its impact on the planet. This is known as the triple bottom line (profit, planet, people) and it encourages sustainable production, allowing it to continue in the long term without damaging the environment. CSR and the triple bottom line While many organisations see profit as important, they may also be concerned about how this profit is made and the impact of the business on others. This means that businesses often have social and environmental objectives relating to how they treat suppliers, how they treat staff and the impact of their activities on the environment and other groups, such as the local community. A business may be willing to accept lower profits if it significantly reduces pollution, if it ensures only recycled resources are used and if it helps the local community, for example. This increasing interest in social and environmental issues may be because there is more information available about such things and so managers are making betterinformed decisions. It may also be a response to the fact that consumers, employees and investors are increasingly interested in such issues. Not only that, if competitors are demonstrating their environmental and social awareness, then other businesses may have to follow in order to retain their competitiveness. John Elkington, a business author and advisor, suggested a business’ performance should be measured by examining three Ps: its profits, its treatment Profit Planet Sustainable production People ▲ Figure 1.14 Elkington’s triple bottom line 36 9781398308114.indb 36 05/03/21 11:06 AM CASE STUDY 1.4 Social objectives at Intel Intel’s 2018 corporate social report states: ‘In celebration of Intel’s 50th anniversary, we set a goal to engage 50 000 of our employees to volunteer more than 1 million hours in 2018. We exceeded that goal, with more than 68 000 employees (or 64 per cent of our employees) volunteering approximately 1.5 million hours of service throughout the year. To support our goal, each business group achieved a participation rate of over 50 per cent. Over the past 10 years, our employees have generously donated their skills, technology expertise and more than 10 million hours of service to tackle environmental challenges, improve education and help meet community needs around the world.’ Intel’s volunteer groups have worked in many countries including Malaysia, Japan, Namibia and Puerto Rico. Source: Corporate Social Responsibility at Intel, 2018–19 Report Questions 1 ▲ Figure 1.15 The Intel organisation believes in corporate social responsibility Mission statement, aims, objectives, strategy and tactics The mission of a business is the fundamental reason why it exists. A mission statement sets out the purpose of the business. For example, an airline may exist to be the ‘best airline in the world’; a computer manufacturer may aim ‘to help people work more effectively’, and a cosmetics business may intend ‘to bring beauty to everyone’. The mission will be determined by the owners of the business. A business’ aims are its long-term goals and are often referred to as its corporate aims, meaning that they relate to the whole business. Businesses do not normally state aims as numerical targets but rather in qualitative terms. For example, a housebuilder might set itself an aim of building environmentally friendly homes. Both corporate aims and mission statements are set by senior managers within the business. They are designed to provide guidance for setting objectives and to assist junior managers in decision-making. The mission and aims are rather general statements and, unlike objectives, whether or not they have been achieved cannot easily be measured. What exactly does a business measure to decide if it is the best airline? It could be the number of planes it operates, or the number of passengers, or perhaps the level of customer satisfaction. This is why corporate objectives exist, to turn the mission and aims into measurable, specific and time-related targets. 2 Define the terms: a ‘mission’ b ‘objectives’. Evaluate the extent to which Intel benefits from having a widely publicised mission statement. [2] [2] [12] Once these targets have been set, the business has to decide how to achieve them most effectively. The longterm plan to achieve an objective is known as a strategy. For example, if a business wanted to increase profits by 30 per cent in three years, the strategy might be to target overseas markets. However, this strategy has to be put into action; in this example, a decision has to be taken on which countries will be targeted. However, other decisions have to be made too: In what order will the new markets be entered? What products will be offered in each? The shorter-term action plans that combine to make up the strategy are known as tactics. Mission statement Aims Objectives Target Strategy 1.4.1 Business objectives in the private sector and public sector Intel is one of the world’s largest manufacturers of semiconductors, a component used in many electrical products including telephones and computers. In 2019, it employed more than 110 200 people across the world. The company’s mission statement is ‘to bring smart, connected devices to every person on Earth.’ It believes that technology can help to improve living standards. Tactics ▲ Figure 1.16 From mission to tactics GLOSSARY TERMS A mission statement sets out the overall purpose of a business. An aim is a long-term goal that determines the objectives that an organisation sets itself. Strategy is the long-term plan to achieve the objective of a business. Tactics are the short-term actions needed to implement the strategy. 37 9781398308114.indb 37 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1.4 1.4.2 Objectives and business decisions AS LEVEL 1.4 Business objectives The role of objectives in the stages of business decision-making Managing a business involves many different decisions; for example, deciding on the objectives, deciding the best way of achieving these (which is set out in the company’s strategy), and deciding how to bring the strategy about on time and at an acceptable cost through use of appropriate tactics. Making the right decisions is therefore an important part of good management. Decision-making involves: » Setting the objectives This is essential because the success of a plan can only be judged against the objectives that were set. Making a profit of $100 000 may be disappointing if the objective was $300 000, but not if the target was $80 000! It is important to set realistic and achievable targets. » Gathering information Before you decide what to do, you need information on where you are at the moment, what else is happening and what your options are in order to analyse the situation. » Selecting a suitable strategy Having analysed the information, you can decide on the best strategy; for example, targeting domestic or overseas markets. » Implementing the strategy This is where the tactics come in to make sure the plan works well. » Reviewing This is essential to see how you have got on and what, if anything, needs to be changed. After the review you can consider whether the objectives are still appropriate or not; you may need to set higher or different targets, for example. Implementing the strategy Decision-making is a continuous process in which decisions are being taken and reviewed and new objectives are set. Translating objectives into targets and budgets The overall objectives of a business need to be cascaded down into departmental and then individual targets for people. Using objectives throughout the organisation helps to ensure everyone is working towards the same aim. With each objective there should be a strategy of how it is to be achieved and specific tactical targets showing the details of the activities that need to be undertaken. A plan will show: » who is in charge of what » what they have to do » when it must be done » how much they have to spend; that is, what budget has been agreed. A budget is a financial target that might set out expected revenues and also anticipated expenditure. This helps with financial planning. The size of the budget will depend on what the objective is and what has to be done to achieve it. GLOSSARY TERMS A target is a goal pursued by a business, such as achieving a particular market share or rate of growth of sales. Budgets are financial plans setting out a business’ future revenues and expenditure. Setting objectives Reviewing want the business to grow faster, for example, or are more concerned about the environmental record of the business than the previous owners. » External Perhaps the economy has gone into decline and so the organisation needs to reduce its growth target. Perhaps competitors have entered the market, which means the profit target was too ambitious and needs to be amended downwards. Ethical behaviour is behaviour that is thought to be morally correct and not necessarily the most profitable. Gathering information Selecting a suitable strategy ▲ Figure 1.17 The process of decision-making How objectives might change over time Over time, the objectives of a business may change. This can be for many reasons, both internal (inside the business) and external (outside the business): » Internal A business may have new owners or managers who want to achieve different things. Perhaps they The communication of objectives and their likely impact on the workforce When setting objectives, this should be done in discussion with the people who will be responsible for achieving them. This should help make sure the objectives are realistic and that the people involved are committed to achieving them. If a target is forced on an employee, they may not try very hard to achieve it because they may not think it is feasible or even possible to hit. Having an objective can be very motivating because it provides a sense of direction, so that employees know what they are doing and why, and how this fits in with the overall strategy of the business. It can also motivate because it sets workers a target, so they have something to aim for and something that can be reviewed. However, objectives may be demotivating if the person who is set them does not believe in them and has no sense of ownership. If an employee feels they have been set a target 38 9781398308114.indb 38 05/03/21 11:06 AM that cannot be reached, or they do not have the budget to make it possible, they will probably feel demotivated. This means that how an objective is set and what resources are allocated to it are very important. STUDY TIP SMART objectives To be effective, objectives should be SMART. SMART objectives must be: » Specific They must define exactly what the firm is measuring, such as sales or profits. » Measurable They must include a quantifiable target; for example, a 10 per cent increase in sales revenues. » Agreed If targets are simply imposed on people, they are likely to resent them. If, however, the targets are discussed and mutually agreed, people are more likely to be committed to them. » Realistic If the objectives are unrealistic (for example, they are too ambitious), people may not even bother to try and achieve them. To motivate people, the targets must be seen as attainable. » Time-specific Employees need to know how long they have to achieve the target; for example, is it two or three years? 1.4 How ethics may influence business objectives and activities Business ethics refers to what is considered to be right or wrong in terms of business behaviour. For example, is it ethical behaviour to sell cigarettes if you know they can damage people’s health? Is it ethical to produce a good or service if the process of producing it damages the environment? Is it ethical to show advertisements for children’s toys between children’s television programmes to get the children to pester their parents to buy them? Managers face ethical issues all the time, in all areas of business. Sometimes the objectives of the business can encourage unethical behaviour. If employees are set extremely high sales targets, they might decide to sell products to people who don’t really need them or to avoid telling people some of the problems that might occur with the product if they don’t ask. The drive to boost sales can lead a business’ employees to behave badly. In recent years there have been many sales scandals; for example, insurance companies have sold people policies that were unlikely to ever pay out and banks have not told people they could be earning higher returns if they changed to a different type of bank account. This behaviour is usually driven by a desire to hit high targets, in order either to keep a job or to earn bonuses. 1.4.2 Objectives and business decisions Remember that some of the businesses you will encounter in question papers may be large ones, and this can pose a challenge for the business to communicate corporate objectives clearly. This problem can be more serious if the business operates in different countries with different languages and time zones. An example of a good objective might be ‘to increase profits by 25 per cent over the next four years’. By comparison, a bad objective would be ‘to do much better’ – it is not clear what ‘doing better’ actually means, how it will be measured or how long you have to achieve it. CASE STUDY Ethics at Texas Instruments Texas Instruments (TI) is based in Dallas, Texas, and makes a diverse range of electrical products including military equipment and calculators. In 2020, it employed 30 000 people in 30 countries. TI’s board of directors adopted ethical principles very early. The company established an ethics office in 1987 and appointed the company’s first ethics director. Its ethics director and staff have three primary functions: l to ensure that business policies and practices are continuously aligned with ethical principles l to clearly communicate ethical expectations l to provide multiple channels for feedback, through which stakeholders may ask questions, voice concerns and seek resolution of ethical issues. Of course, unethical behaviour does not have to be the case, but businesses must be clear on the behaviour they expect from employees in terms of how they reach their targets. The company’s website makes its ethical position clear. ‘Our challenge ... is to provide the tools employees may need to make tough but appropriate decisions quickly. We work to ensure they have a clear understanding of the global rules and regulations that govern our operations, as well as our own values, principles and ethical expectations.’ Source: Adapted from www.ti.com Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why Texas Instruments sets out its ethical objectives on its website. [6] Evaluate the case for and against Texas Instruments operating with ethical behaviour as a key objective at all levels in the business. [12] This is why some businesses have a ‘code of ethics’ or a ‘code of conduct’ to make it clear to employees what is and what is not regarded as acceptable behaviour. 39 9781398308114.indb 39 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.4 Business objectives 1.4 TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions Data response question 1 A different bank a b a b Define the term ‘business objective’. [2] Explain one feature of a good objective. [3] Define the term ‘mission statement’. [2] 2 Explain one benefit to a multinational business of [3] having a mission statement. [2] 3 a Define the term ‘corporate responsibility’. b Explain one reason why corporate responsibility is important to an oil company such as BP. [3] 4 Explain two differences between strategy and tactics. [6] 5 Explain one type of strategy a business that is entering new markets overseas might adopt. [3] 6 a Explain one stage of decision-making. [3] b Explain one reason why it is important to review [3] decisions. 7 a Define the term ‘ethics’. [2] b Explain one reason why businesses try to take ethical decisions. [3] 8 Explain one reason why a marketing manager might consider ethics when making a decision. [3] 9 a Define the term ‘budget’. [2] b Explain one advantage to a business of setting a budget. [3] 10 Explain two reasons why a growing business’ objectives might change over time. [6] New Zealand has four major banks which dominate its banking market, holding a market share of around 80 per cent. Two years ago, Provident Bank opened its first branches in Auckland and Wellington amid great publicity. The new bank’s corporate objectives include achieving high rates of growth and establishing 20 branches through the country within its first three years of trading. The bank has a mission statement which sets out its commitment to a high standard of customer service. This figures prominently on its website and is used in much of its publicity, including its recruitment materials. Provident Bank has set out to differentiate itself from its rivals by adopting strongly ethical corporate objectives which influence its strategy and tactics. It does not invest in businesses whose actions damage the environment or those that supply armaments. It is a carbon-neutral business. Its charges are higher than the large, established banks, but its marketing is distinctive and research suggests that it is appealing to wealthy New Zealanders. Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘corporate objectives’ b ‘tactics’. Analyse one reason why Provident Bank considers its mission statement to be important. Evaluate the case for and against Provident Bank adopting ethical corporate objectives. [2] [2] [4] [12] 40 9781398308114.indb 40 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1 Business and its environment AS LEVEL 1.5 Stakeholders in a business In this chapter we examine: ★ the different groups affected by business behaviour ★ the relative importance and influence of stakeholders on a business. 1.5.1 Business stakeholders Individuals or groups with an interest in the activities of a business All businesses involve and affect many other people and groups by their activities. These individuals and groups are called stakeholders. Stakeholders include: » the owners of a business, such as the shareholders of a company » the business’ employees » the business’ managers, who take tactical and strategic decisions » the suppliers of goods and services » the banks and other organisations that provide finance » customers, who buy the products » the local community, which may be concerned about issues such as employment and pollution » the government, which collects tax revenues and hopes for high employment levels. Stakeholders may not have formal authority over a business, but it may be in the business’ best interests to take their needs into account when making decisions. It has become more common for businesses to attempt to meet the needs of as many of their stakeholders as possible in order to generate a positive image. STUDY TIP When responding to questions about stakeholders, do not be too ambitious and write about too many stakeholders. This will make it difficult to develop arguments fully and to write analytically. Instead, you should select the two or three stakeholder groups that are most relevant in the circumstances and focus exclusively upon these. Internal and external stakeholders 1.5.1 Business stakeholders Chapter overview The stakeholders of any business can be divided into two categories: those who are part of the business and those who operate outside it. Internal stakeholders include: » the owners of the business – this covers sole traders, partners and shareholders » the business’ employees, such as managers and shopfloor workers. External stakeholders include: » suppliers. These are the individuals and other » » » » organisations that provide businesses with the goods and services that are needed to carry out production customers who purchase the goods and services that are sold by the business the government, both local and national banks who provide businesses with a range of financial services, such as giving loans the community, including people who live near to any of the business’ facilities. Internal stakeholders (e.g. owners, managers, other employees) Stakeholders External stakeholders (e.g. suppliers, customers, the government, the bank, the community) ▲ Figure 1.18 Internal and external stakeholders GLOSSARY TERMS Stakeholders are groups or individuals who have an interest in a business. Internal stakeholders are individuals and groups within a business; for example, employees. Authority is the power or ability to carry through a task or action. External stakeholders are groups outside a business; for example, people who live near to the business’ premises. 41 9781398308114.indb 41 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.5 Stakeholders in a business 1.5 Roles, rights and responsibilities of the stakeholders Each of the stakeholder groups above will have their own objectives. Some examples are: » Employees may want good rewards for the work done, job security, a safe working environment and some opportunities for promotion. » Shareholders will want financial rewards in return for the risk of their investment. » Suppliers will want to be paid on time and to be kept well-informed of any changes in orders. » The government will want the business to act legally; for example, to pay its taxes on time. Each stakeholder will have certain legal rights. Employees may have an employment contract that the business must adhere to, while the owners or shareholders are entitled to be kept informed of the business’ activities. These stakeholders may also have responsibilities to the business. In return for their wages, employees are expected to complete their tasks competently; in return for payment for their products, suppliers should supply goods and services of an appropriate quality and quantity. Businesses are therefore in a two-way relationship with their stakeholders. ▼ Table 1.10 Summary of stakeholders’ roles, rights and responsibilities Stakeholders Possible rights include Possible responsibilities include Employees • To be treated fairly • To be paid fairly • To be kept informed • To work effectively • To turn up for work on time Suppliers • To be paid on time • To be informed of any potential changes in orders in the future • To provide good quality products meeting the set specifications at the time set Owners/ shareholders • To receive a share of profits • To be kept informed by management • To treat management fairly Customers • To be supplied the right quality products on time • To pay on time Government • To be paid taxes • To have businesses obey the law • To protect businesses, customers, employees and the environment Managers • To be rewarded appropriately for responsibilities • To have duties commensurate with seniority • To carry out duties to best of ability • To be discrete in handling sensitive business data Banks and other lenders • To be repaid promptly and on time • Not to charge excessive interest rates or to withdraw loans without a reasonable period of notice The local community • To live in an area that is free from excessive noise or other forms of pollution • To have a say in decisions which impact the local community • To benefit from employment • To co-operate with the business in its daily activities CASE STUDY Gold Fields Limited engages stakeholders Gold Fields Limited operates eight mines in Australia, Chile, South Africa, Peru and Ghana. The business’ mining operations in Ghana make it the country’s largest producer of gold and the largest private sector employer with approximately 5200 direct and 83 000 indirect employees. It uses a forum to discuss issues and listen to its stakeholders. The aim is to engage with and update key stakeholders on its operations and activities. Those invited include government ministers, members of the community, financial institutions, investors and the media. The company is committed to sustainable development and has invested in socio-economic development projects in the community where it operates. Its investment focuses on education, health, water and sanitation, and development. A world-class water treatment plant has recently been constructed at Tarkwa and this provides communities with access to clean water. The company has also tried to employ locals wherever it can – a high proportion of the company’s workforce in Ghana are locals. Questions 1 2 Explain one reason why employees and customers might be Gold Fields’ major stakeholders in Ghana. [3] Evaluate the extent to which Gold Fields Ghana may have benefited from holding its ‘stakeholder forum’. [12] 42 9781398308114.indb 42 05/03/21 11:06 AM Why become a shareholder? Shareholders can also influence the policy of the business. Most types of shares grant their owners voting rights. Each share is worth one vote. By buying more shares, people can get more votes and have a greater influence over what the firm actually does. If someone owns more than 51 per cent of the shares, they control the business and, therefore, can decide company policy. All companies must have an annual general meeting (AGM) to which the shareholders are invited and every shareholder must receive a copy of the company’s annual report. The annual report reviews the performance of the business over the last year. At the AGM, the directors and managers give an overview of the company’s position and respond to any questions that shareholders might have. In the UK, financial institutions such as banks, pension funds and insurance companies own most company shares. These organisations buy shares to make a profit through the dividends they receive and by selling the shares at a higher price later on. They can then pass their profits on to their own investors. GLOSSARY TERM Dividends are money that is paid out of profits to shareholders. It is a reward to the owners of the business. 1.5.2 The relative importance and influence of stakeholders on business activities The interaction between a business’ decisions and its stakeholders’ responses Any business decision can impact on stakeholders. Examples include: » Employees may be affected by a decision to reduce the size of the business. » Shareholders will be affected if the profits of the business are low. » Suppliers may be affected by an increase in orders and be able to grow their businesses. » The community may benefit from the expansion of the business and greater income being earned and spent in the area. jobs and more taxes being paid. 1.5 The impact of business activity can be positive or negative. Sometimes one group may benefit and another may suffer. For example, a decision to cut wages would not be popular with staff but may enable higher rewards for the investors. A decision to shift production abroad would not benefit the government of the original country but may benefit the community where production now occurs. If stakeholders do not welcome changes, they can take various actions to avoid the effects of them. The following are examples of possible responses from stakeholders: » Shareholders can sell their shares and invest elsewhere. » Banks can refuse to lend more or charge more for businesses to borrow. » Employees can leave and work elsewhere or, as a group, they may take strike action, which means they withdraw their labour, hoping to get the business to change its policy. » Suppliers can refuse to supply the business or demand better payment terms, such as payment on delivery. The impact of stakeholder aims on business decisions Most stakeholder groups have aims in their relationship with the business. We shall consider some examples. 1 Employees This stakeholder group is likely to have aims such as improving working conditions, maximising pay and other benefits, and seeking secure employment. Businesses have to take these aims into account when making decisions. For example, Google employs many highly skilled people. When taking decisions on investing in expansion, the company would ensure that it budgets for attractive pay rates, provides working conditions that encourage and promote creativity and that it offers job security. If Google failed to take these decisions, it would experience difficulties in recruiting the most talented and productive employees. 2 Customers Arguably this stakeholder group has the greatest impact on business decisions, particularly when the customer has a wide choice of suppliers of a product. If, for example, a supermarket takes a decision to raise prices, it may find that many of its customers buy their groceries elsewhere. The decisions taken by many managers in businesses will be intended to provide the best possible value and service to their customers. In this way, customers are a major force shaping business decisions. 3 Suppliers Businesses depend on suppliers to deliver raw materials, components and other services. Without receiving the correct supplies at the right time, a business may not be able to continue trading. Businesses would normally seek to take decisions which do not impact adversely on suppliers, such as delaying payments or changing orders at short notice. A supplier is more likely to have a significant impact on business decisions if it is a major supplier and if there are few or no alternative sources of supply. 1.5.2 The relative importance and influence of stakeholders on business activities By investing in a company, shareholders become the owners of the business. This means that, if the business is successful, the value of their shares should increase. Shareholders should also receive some of the profits that the company makes each year. The part of the profits paid out to shareholders is called the dividends. The more profit a firm makes, the bigger the dividends are likely to be. Each year the shareholders will decide on the amount of dividends to be paid per share; the more shares a person has, the more dividends they receive in total. » The government may be affected by the creation of more 43 9781398308114.indb 43 05/03/21 11:06 AM AS LEVEL 1.5 Stakeholders in a business 1.5 4 Owners and shareholders Shareholders can be a very influential group on business decisions taken by companies. Shareholders in the UK can vote to remove directors of a company if the directors take decisions of which the shareholders disapprove. The owners of small businesses (sole traders and partners) are more likely to be the people who are taking the business decisions. Thus, there is less chance of any disagreement occurring. How and why a business needs to be accountable to its stakeholders The shareholder concept Businesses have certain legal responsibilities to their stakeholders. For example, there are laws controlling the ways in which businesses can promote their products and, for food manufacturers, the ingredients that can be used. Some businesses simply do what they have to by law and no more. They focus mainly on rewarding their owners. They will pay employees what they need to get the job done but do not think they have any more responsibilities other than this. They will try to get the lowest price for supplies, perhaps by threatening to use different suppliers. They will pay governments the taxes they have to but will not think they have any obligation to invest more in their region or country. This is known as the shareholder concept, where rewarding owners is the key business objective. The stakeholder concept However, increasingly, organisations are trying to work with their stakeholders and regard them much more as partners. This co-operative approach is known as the stakeholder concept. This view believes that it is better in the long term to treat stakeholders well. For example, working closely with suppliers and paying them a fair reward for their work (even if this is more than the business would have to pay) will lead to better quality suppliers and much greater flexibility by suppliers to help out when needed. Focusing on employees’ careers and showing concern about their welfare could lead to greater loyalty and commitment and, as a result, a better quality of work. Being interested in the environment could help save costs through initiatives such as recycling, but it could also make the business more attractive to employees, customers and investors. The stakeholder concept fits in with corporate social responsibility in that it stresses the benefits of accepting obligations to stakeholders over and above what the law requires. CASE STUDY Hitachi: contributing to a sustainable society as a good corporate citizen Hitachi is a multinational company, based in Japan, that produces a range of products including trains, construction equipment and power tools. was due to its stakeholders. The company has a good relationship with its different stakeholder groups such as customers, suppliers and national governments. Climate change is a priority for Hitachi, and we are striving to reduce CO2 [carbon dioxide] emissions ... We announced our long-term environmental targets, called Hitachi Environmental Innovation 2050, which include a CO2 reduction target of 80 per cent ... by 2050 (compared to 2010). To achieve a resource efficient society, we are responding to the issue of water scarcity and promoting the efficient use of water and other resources. We are also promoting the effective use of plastic and other resources to minimise our impact on [the] natural [environment] ... Hitachi believes it is important to be a good corporate citizen. For example, it says that environmental issues such as climate change are becoming a priority, and there is increasing awareness of the relationship between businesses and human rights. The United Nations has asked companies to make broad contributions to society, mainly through corporate activities, with an eye on the environment but also alleviating poverty and protecting human rights. Hitachi is eager to do just this. Hitachi has faced a range of natural disasters, such as an earthquake in Japan in 2011. Hitachi City in north Tokyo, which is the headquarters of the company, was particularly badly affected by the disaster. These problems did disrupt the company’s supply chain but the business continued to achieve good results. The managers believe its ability to survive such disasters A business is made up of people with different opinions and, sometimes, very different views on what they want to achieve and how they think it should be achieved. Any major decision is likely to make some better off and others worse off; it is therefore likely to meet with opposition from some stakeholders. Every decision will involve different stakeholders and will consider their objectives and their relative power. Do Source: Hitachi Sustainability Report 2019, www.hitachi.com/ sustainability/download/pdf/en_sustainability2019.pdf Questions 1 2 Explain two ways in which Hitachi could claim to be a good corporate citizen. [6] ‘Working with stakeholders helps Hitachi.’ Evaluate this statement. [12] managers want to listen to them? Do managers need to listen to them? What will happen if managers ignore them? This means the managers of a business need to think about their relative power. A well-organised workforce that is unionised, for example, may be able to negotiate for more consultation and participation in decision-making than individual employees could on their own. Managers may want to pay more attention to an investor who owns 65 per cent of the company compared with one who owns 44 9781398308114.indb 44 05/03/21 11:06 AM 1 per cent. A key supplier of a business’ major component will have more influence than the supplier of a component that can be bought in thousands of different stores. So, the more well-organised a stakeholder group is, the more managers need that particular stakeholder, and the more that managers like or agree with the stakeholders and their objectives, the more likely the stakeholders are to influence a manager’s decision. Level of interest How conflict might arise from stakeholders having different aims and objectives ▲ Figure 1.19 A stakeholder map and how a business may view different stakeholders One of the issues when dealing with stakeholders is that their aims might conflict; it might not be possible to please all of the groups all of the time. For example: » Investors may push for lower costs to increase their profits and rewards and this may lead to fewer or lower pay increases for employees. » In order to meet customer demands for cheaper products, the business may relocate to cheaper production facilities overseas, thus upsetting the local community. » In order to meet government demands for more environmentally friendly operations processes, the business may change its production system, leading to higher costs and higher prices for customers. Groups in quadrant D are likely to influence decisions a lot. They are interested in what is going on in the business and A business may have to juggle different demands and compromise on occasion. High Low A Minimal effort B Keep informed High C Keep satisfied D Key players Power Low CASE STUDY Foxconn and Amazon The Foxconn Technology Group manufactures technology products for well-known multinational companies such as Apple and Amazon. The company has been criticised for reducing wages and not operating according to local labour laws. In response, Foxconn dismissed two senior managers at one of its factories where work is carried out to fulfil orders from Amazon. Foxconn has received a lot of criticism in the past for its poor working conditions. Amazon and Foxconn have previously attracted attention for allegations of poor treatment of Chinese workers. The pressure group China Labor Watch (CLW) published allegations in 2018 that Foxconn had forced employees to engage in long – and illegal – periods of overtime working. In response the company announced that it had taken disciplinary action against the managers responsible for mistreating employees. ‘Amazon and Foxconn responded that they would make improvements to the factory’s working conditions,’ CLW stated. ‘However, CLW’s 2019 investigation found that How changing business objectives might affect stakeholders As the objectives of a business change, this may well affect the way it treats its stakeholders. For example, Foxconn’s working conditions did not improve, and instead deteriorated.’ CLW also reported that Foxconn’s wages, which were already very low, had been cut by a further 16 per cent. This, the pressure group reported, had led to such low rates of pay that the company experienced significant labour shortages. These labour shortages resulted in the company recruiting very young employees, a number of whom had to work overtime. 1.5 1.5.2 The relative importance and influence of stakeholders on business activities The role of different stakeholders can be shown using a stakeholder map, as in Figure 1.19. are very powerful (for example, major investors); managers will need to keep this group happy. By comparison, stakeholders in quadrant A are not very interested and are not powerful (for example, your milk delivery service or local newsagent); you do not need to worry much about this group. Source: www.digitalcommerce360.com/2019/08/09/amazon-isunder-fire-for-factory-hiring-practicesand-treatment-of-workers Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why some of Foxconn’s stakeholders might not have approved of the actions that the company has taken. [6] Evaluate whether Foxconn has done the right thing by taking these actions. [12] a greater emphasis on environmental issues may lead to more concern for society as a whole and future generations, in addition to a focus on recycling, reusing and less waste and pollution. A focus on better quality might lead to better treatment of suppliers. On the other 45 9781398308114.indb 45 05/03/21 11:07 AM 1.5 hand, greater pressure for profits may mean managers start to cut back on training, career development and wage increases in order to reduce costs; they might also bargain hard to push down suppliers’ prices. It is very difficult for managers to take decisions to satisfy all stakeholders simultaneously, especially at a time of change when major strategic decisions may be forced upon them. It may be that the best they can do is to satisfy as many stakeholders as possible. AS LEVEL 1.5 Stakeholders in a business TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions Data response question 1 A change of approach a b Define the term ‘stakeholder’. [2] Explain one reason why the Malaysian government might be a stakeholder of a Malaysian retailer. [3] 2 Explain one way in which businesses and employees have responsibilities to one another. [3] 3 Explain two possible responsibilities that a business that manufactures chemicals might have to its local community. [6] 4 a Explain one responsibility that a business may have to its suppliers. [3] b Explain one likely reaction of a retailer’s stakeholders to a decision to close 10 per cent of its shops to increase profitability. [3] 5 a Explain one responsibility of the Indian government to its businesses. [3] b Explain one way in which the adoption of an objective of growth might affect an airline’s customers. [3] 6 a Define the term ‘social responsibility’. [2] b Explain one reason why a business might wish to be accountable to its bank. [3] 7 Explain two reasons why a large manufacturer might experience difficulty in meeting the objectives of its shareholders and its customers simultaneously. [6] 8 a Explain one reason why a business might wish to be accountable to its employees. [3] b Explain one way in which a retailer could be accountable to its employees. [3] 9 Define the term ‘internal stakeholder’. [2] 10 Explain the possible effect of a hotel’s decision to increase its prices significantly on two of its stakeholder groups. [6] Multan Textiles Ltd has had a change of heart. Its new management team has decided to implement a range of policies intended to meet the needs of all of its stakeholders, rather than solely its shareholders. The adoption of policies based on the stakeholder concept has significant implications for all of the company’s stakeholders. The company has agreed to raise its employees’ wages over the next few years, at a rate in excess of the current rate of inflation, and to improve working conditions. It also has offered its suppliers more favourable credit terms to encourage a long-term relationship. It is also reviewing its manufacturing processes to minimise the impact of the chemicals on its employees and the local community. The company has a long tradition of manufacturing textiles in the region and a good reputation. It is profitable, although its shareholders have expressed some dissatisfaction at declining profit levels over the last few years. Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘shareholder’ b ‘stakeholder concept’. Analyse one benefit to Multan Textiles Ltd of implementing policies based on the stakeholder concept. Evaluate the case for and against Multan Textiles Ltd retaining its original approach based on the shareholder concept. [2] [2] [4] [12] 46 9781398308114.indb 46 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2 Human resource management AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management In this chapter we examine: ★ the purpose and roles of human resource management (HRM) ★ why and how businesses prepare workforce plans and the importance of labour turnover ★ how businesses recruit employees, including the process and key documents ★ how businesses select employees ★ the nature and use of employment contracts ★ the ways in which businesses make employees redundant and dismiss them ★ issues affecting staff morale and welfare ★ the purpose, methods and importance of training and developing employees ★ key elements of management and workforce relations. What is human resource management? Human resource management (HRM) comprises the acquisition, training, motivation and reward of human resources within the business. Over recent years, the influence of Japanese management techniques, and their evident success in managing people, has encouraged the adoption of human resource management by companies across the globe. GLOSSARY TERM Human resource management (HRM) is the process of making the most efficient use of an organisation’s employees. 2.1.1 Purpose and roles of human resource management Human resource management can help businesses to generate a significant competitive advantage over rivals and to achieve organisational objectives, such as growth and increased profitability. Many companies use HRM to enhance organisational performance. If implemented fully and operated properly, HRM recognises the individual rather than producing personnel policies for the whole workforce. All the elements of HRM (such as recruitment and selection, training and development, redundancy and dismissal) are geared to fulfilling the needs of the individual as well as those of the organisation. All aspects of the HRM ‘package’ should be co-ordinated to ensure coherence and to assist the attainment of strategic targets. If an organisation is successful in operating its HRM policy, one outcome could be motivated and creative employees who are committed to the firm and who do not seek to leave. Such employees should be aware of the goals of the organisation and understand how they can contribute towards the attainment of organisational targets, such as growth in market share. Under this scenario, a business should incur lower recruitment costs and enjoy higher levels of productivity and a reduction in faulty products. It may attract top-class applicants to vacancies because of its reputation as a caring and enlightened employer. All of these factors should make the organisation more competitive and better able to cope with the rigours of operating in international markets. 2.1.1 Purpose and roles of human resource management Chapter overview However, in reality the case for HRM is not so clear-cut. Many businesses in the UK differ in their interpretation of HRM. Some see it as a confirmation of the value of employees who have to be developed to meet the needs of the organisation. Others take a ‘harder’ attitude, viewing employees as simply another resource to be used as effectively as possible. The latter approach has a much more short-term focus and may help a business to meet objectives, such as becoming the lowest-cost producer in the market. The fact that different interpretations of the policy exist make it more difficult to assess its contribution to achieving objectives and overall competitiveness. We will look at these two approaches to HRM more fully in Chapter 7.4 later in this book. The role of HRM in meeting organisational objectives We saw in Chapter 1.4 that an organisational or business objective is a target that is normally specific in terms of what the target is, how it is measured and the time by which it must be completed. A business might set itself targets such as: » achieving a certain growth rate in terms of sales (for example, 10 per cent per year) 47 9781398308114.indb 47 05/03/21 11:07 AM » becoming the lowest-cost producer in a market, enabling AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management 2.1 rewarding employees are, it is argued, best done by managers and colleagues close to the employee in question. Empowered teams can play a role in recruiting employees and identifying training needs. This approach to HRM embodies a philosophy entirely in harmony with modern management techniques such as delayering and teamworking. This approach to HRM can help a business to meet challenges through possessing workforces which are more efficient and responsive to customers’ needs than those of competitors. it to charge low prices » attaining social objectives, including protecting the natural environment or maintaining employment levels in low-income communities. Two key arguments exist which mean that the use of HRM within businesses is vital to meet organisational objectives. 1 The nature of the workforce has changed over recent years. Greater use of part-time and peripheral workers, for example, has encouraged human resource managers to view people as a resource to be deployed as effectively as possible. Simultaneously, the existence of a better-educated workforce, along with the expectation that workers should carry out more complex tasks and duties, has led managers to view employees as valuable assets to be developed to make the organisation more competitive and able to outperform rivals. 2 Changes in organisational structure have led to many managers taking on responsibility for managing people within the organisation. Techniques such as delayering and the development of empowered teams have been an integral part of the implementation of human resource management. Acquiring, developing, motivating and GLOSSARY TERMS Delayering is a reduction in the number of levels of hierarchy within an organisational structure. Teamworking is the process of breaking down production into large units and using groups of employees to complete these tasks. A workforce (or human resource) plan assesses the current workforce and actions necessary to meet the business’ future labour needs. Labour turnover is the percentage of a business’ workforce that leaves a business over a given period of time (usually one year). CASE STUDY The First State Bank In 2020, the First State Bank announced that it was to introduce a human resource management package to improve the productivity of its 44 000 employees. This programme is intended to develop employees’ skills and to ensure suitable candidates are available for future promotions. The Bank will use technology to automate many of the functions of its HR department, including paying employees, booking holidays and repayment of some expenses. Senior managers at the Bank estimate that this will save approximately 5000 employee days of work each month, resulting in a substantial cost reduction for the publicly owned Bank. 2.1.2 Workforce planning The reasons for and role of a workforce plan Before a business recruits, selects or trains employees, it must establish future labour needs. This is not simply a matter of recruiting sufficient employees. Those recruited must have the right skills and experience to help the organisation achieve its corporate objectives. Managers will draw up a workforce plan or human resource plan to detail the number and type of workers the business needs to recruit, as well as the location where they will be employed. The automation of the HR function offers other benefits to senior managers. The new HR system gives managers instant access to all employees’ qualifications, experience, performance appraisals and positions held. This will help the Bank’s managers to manage the talent available more effectively and will ease the process of planning its future workforces. Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why HRM might be an important issue within the First State Bank. [6] Evaluate whether the advantages of the introduction of new technology into the Bank’s HR department will outweigh the disadvantages. [12] Workforce plans plays an important role in making businesses competitive and enabling them to meet their organisational objectives. For example: » They help businesses to deal with changes (such as the impact of new technology or changes in consumers’ tastes) by ensuring that they have the right employees in terms of numbers, work locations and skills. » Workforce plans help businesses to prepare for changes in the workforce, such as the introduction of new production-line machinery or a significant proportion of employees leaving through retirement. Workforce plans are designed to help businesses to prepare for changes in their environments and not simply to respond to them. 48 9781398308114.indb 48 05/03/21 11:07 AM Labour turnover turnover = number of staff leaving during the year × 100 average number of staff This ratio measures the proportion of a workforce leaving their employment at a business over some period of time, usually one year. Low wages and inadequate training leading to poor morale among employees may cause high levels of labour turnover. Another cause is ineffective recruitment procedures, resulting in the appointment of inappropriate staff. Other reasons include redundancy and retirement. HANDLING DATA Last year, 45 employees at Kenya Fuels Ltd left the company. The company had an average of 900 employees during the year. The company’s HR manager had forecast that the company’s labour turnover figure would be 4 per cent. 1 Calculate the labour turnover figure for this company. 2 How many employees would have left if the HR manager’s forecast had been accurate? Some level of labour turnover is inevitable. Managers seek some labour turnover to bring new ideas into a business, but not so much as to impose excessive recruitment costs. A survey in the UK in 2017 by the Chartered Institute of Personnel and Development (CIPD) revealed that labour turnover in the UK was 16.5 per cent and that it has risen steadily for some years. Businesses attempt to manage labour turnover to achieve a balance between the costs of recruitment and the potential for disruption to production on the one hand, and bringing new employees with enthusiasm and ideas into the business on the other. The implications of different rates of labour turnover Surveys in the UK have shown that labour turnover for most businesses surveyed has a negative impact on performance and their ability to achieve organisational objectives. This suggests that most businesses face a higher labour turnover than desired or that they face unexpected recruitment costs. If the rate of labour turnover continues to rise in the UK, this may result in businesses incurring significant additional costs to recruit and train new employees. They may also face additional wage costs if they have to increase pay to reduce the level of labour turnover. However, it may be that a business suffers a rate of labour turnover that is too low. For example, in creative industries such as marketing, it is often helpful for a business to have a stable and steady rate of turnover. This can help to develop ideas for new products and more effective ways of working. The implications of different labour turnover rates depend on the industry in which the business operates and the type of labour in question. For example, a seasonal business that hires a high proportion of unskilled employees may not be concerned by high rates of labour turnover. It can recruit during the off-season and its expenditure on training is likely to be low. The same would not be true of an organisation that employs highly skilled employees who are difficult to replace. A hospital might be an example of this type of organisation. 2.1 2.1.2 Workforce planning Businesses require a range of information when developing human resource plans: » They need to research to provide sales forecasts for the next year or two. This will help identify the quantity and type of labour required. » Data will be needed to show the number of employees likely to be leaving the labour force in general (labour turnover). Information will also be required on potential entrants to the labour force. » If wages are expected to rise then businesses may reduce their demand for labour and seek to make greater use of technology. » The plan will reflect any anticipated changes in the output of the workforce due to changes in productivity or the length of the working week. » Technological developments will impact on planning the workforce. Developments in this field may reduce the need for unskilled employees while creating employment for those with technical skills. CASE STUDY Labour turnover and restaurants in the USA Hotels and restaurants across the world face very high rates of labour turnover. Restaurants in the USA experienced rates of nearly 75 per cent in 2018, meaning that around three-quarters of business employees are leaving each year. The equivalent figure for 2010 was 57 per cent. The restaurant industry is the US economy’s largest employer of teenagers, as one-third of all working teenagers in the USA are employed in a restaurant. The industry also employs a high proportion of students, who may only work part of the year and tend to leave employment once they finish studying. This helps to reduce costs and to allow restaurants to charge competitive prices for meals. Restaurant guests also develop a comfort level with an employee with whom they regularly interact. Appointing new employees can affect regular operations which are vital to the smooth running of any restaurant, especially in the kitchen. Having skilled and experienced staff is vital in the American restaurant industry, where competitiveness is based heavily upon employee performance. Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why labour turnover rates of ‘nearly 75 per cent’ might cause problems for managers in restaurants in the USA. [6] Evaluate the possible actions the managers of restaurants in the USA might take to reduce rates of labour turnover. [12] 49 9781398308114.indb 49 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2.1 2.1.3 Recruitment and selection The process of recruitment AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management The process of workforce planning, in which a business analyses its expected future labour needs and compares this to its current workforce, may identify the need for recruiting new employees. Alternatively, the need for recruitment may arise because an existing employee opts to leave. The recruitment process is summarised in Figure 2.1. Use HR plan to decide number and type of employees needed Prepare: 1 Job adverts 2 Job descriptions 3 Person specifications Advertise outside the business (external recruitment) Advertise inside the business (internal recruitment) recruitment difficulties. The key reason cited was a lack of suitable candidates. Recruiting is expensive. The average recruitment cost of filling a vacancy in the UK in 2020 was £3000 and took nearly 28 days, during which output and sales may have been lost. However, many managers would argue that these figures are less costly than appointing the wrong employee and perhaps having to repeat the process. Two very important documents used in the process of recruitment are job descriptions and person (or job) specifications. GLOSSARY TERMS Recruitment and selection is the process of filling an organisation’s job vacancies by appointing new staff. Job descriptions list the duties and responsibilities associated with a particular job. Person (or job) specifications outline the skills, knowledge and experience necessary to fill a given position successfully. An employment contract is a legal agreement between an employer and an employee setting forth the terms and conditions of the employment arrangement. Job descriptions Receive job applications Prepare shortlist for selection, matching applications and person specifications Select employees using interviews, etc. ▲ Figure 2.1 The process of recruitment and selection Source: CIPD Resources and Talent Planning Survey Recruitment is likely to be a more important activity in a business that is expanding or one which is developing new products or entering new markets. In such cases, the business may require a substantial number of new employees and these may come from inside the business (existing employees) but are more likely to be recruited from outside it. STUDY TIP It is easy to get bogged down in the detail of recruitment and selection procedures. While such knowledge is fundamental, it is vital to think about how successful different approaches to recruitment and selection might be in helping the business to achieve its organisational objectives. In 2018, more than 70 per cent of businesses taking part in a UK survey said that they were experiencing Once managers know the type and number of employees required, job descriptions can be prepared. These relate to the position rather than the person. Typically, job descriptions might contain the following information: » the title of the post » employment conditions » some idea of tasks and duties » the key aims and responsibilities of the job » where the job fits into the organisation. A job description is likely to form the basis of the employment contract, which we consider below. It also offers other important information to employers and employees. » It helps employers by allowing them to consider exactly what should make up the job and how this job relates to others within the organisation. It can also be used to judge performance of an employee at some point following their appointment. Employees can be set targets based on the information included in the job description. During an interview, the job description might form the basis for the interviewer’s questions. » It provides potential employees with essential information to help them to decide whether or not to apply for a job. For example, the descriptions of tasks and duties will help them to decide whether they would enjoy the role. Person specifications Person or job specifications set out the qualifications and qualities required in an employee. They relate to the employee, whereas job descriptions relate to the job. They include: 50 9781398308114.indb 50 05/03/21 11:07 AM » educational and professional qualifications required » character and personality needed » skills and experience wanted. Candidates’ applications should be compared against the person specification and those applicants with the ‘best fit’ should be invited to interview or other selection procedure. This document, therefore, plays a vital role in helping an organisation decide which of the applicants for a post should progress to the next stage of selection. Once managers have prepared job descriptions and person specifications, a decision has to be made as to how to recruit the necessary employees. A number of options are available. Job advertisements The start of recruitment is often drawing up an advert for the vacant position. This advert could be placed in newspapers, magazines or on the internet. The advert needs to be targeted so as to attract suitable applicants while dissuading unsuitable candidates from applying. For example, if an international airline such as Pakistan International Airlines was recruiting a senior manager, it may advertise the vacancy globally. In contrast, a retailer seeking to advertise a vacancy for a shop assistant would be more likely to advertise the job in a local newspaper. In part, the choice of where to advertise a job will also be determined by cost; generally, businesses are willing to spend more heavily on recruiting senior employees. 2.1 Online recruitment Online recruitment allows businesses and other organisations to use their websites to recruit potential employees cheaply and from any part of the world. This method of recruitment can increase the number of applicants and the quality of employees who are eventually employed. Online advertising can reach much larger audiences, increasing the number of applicants. Equally, this form of advertising can be targeted, as relevant groups help to improve the quality of applicants. Websites operated by both businesses and governments bring together those seeking work and businesses intending to recruit. Examples include the privately owned Rozee website (www.rozee.pk) in Pakistan and the New Zealand government’s jobs website (www.jobs.govt.nz). 2.1.3 Recruitment and selection Methods of recruitment together employers and potential candidates. Businesses may use employment agencies to recruit highly specialist employees or those with skills that are scarce. Although this is a costly method of recruitment, agencies often have skills and contacts that many businesses do not possess. CASE STUDY Job advertisement An effective job advertisement should contain sufficient information to attract and engage potential employees but not too much so as to discourage them from applying. Figure 2.2 contains a checklist of possible information to include in a job advertisement. BUILDING A BETTER WORLD OSEEC provides a platform for social, economic and environmental communication and collaboration, with the aim of creating and supporting policies that increase development in these sectors, enriching quality of life for people across the globe. Our platform enables global organisations, charities and governments to share information, co-ordinate resources and collaborate efforts to tackle shared social, economic and environmental problems. Director – Environment Directorate Job title www.oseec.org/ed A Berlin-based position with a competitive salary and benefits The Environment Directorate (ED) oversees global communication on environmental objectives, including design, collaboration and implementation of multinational policies to combine economic efficiency with sustainable environmental practice. The ED also provides information, analysis and advice to support emerging and transition economies currently engaged in development, promoting inclusivity and environmental sustainability. Location of job Brief description of business, its products and markets Outline of job role This position provides intellectual and strategic leadership in the areas of biodiversity and biosafety, natural resource management, climate change and environmental indicators, resource efficiency and waste reduction, and sustainable environmental practice. This position is responsible for ensuring that current and future policies fully reflect the aims of OSEEC in this Directorate and for providing effective support for OSEEC members. Any special features of the job such as part-time or flexible hours Some indication of qualifications and experience required The successful candidate will have significant knowledge and experience in the aforementioned policy areas, with attestable powers of analysis, communication, planning and organisation. They will be expected to promote the intrinsic value of OSEEC in bringing together world partners to multiple audiences, obtaining wide-reaching media coverage. Salary or salary guide Other reward details such as a company car Explanation of how to apply and the recruitment process This position requires fluency in either English or German and a partial knowledge of, or willingness to learn, the other. Full details of the position can be found at www.oseec.org/careers/vacancies (ref. 93752). Applications must be submitted online by 23 March 2020. Contact details for the business ▲ Figure 2.2 A checklist for writing job advertisements ▲ Figure 2.3 An example job advertisement Employment agencies Question Employment agencies provide employers with details of suitable applicants for posts they may have vacant. Agencies usually charge considerable fees for bringing 1 Evaluate whether or not this is an effective job advert. [12] 51 9781398308114.indb 51 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management 2.1 Other methods of recruitment Internal and external recruitment Firms headhunt employees who are currently working for other organisations in order to offer them employment. Those employees who are headhunted are usually either senior managers or people with specialist skills, perhaps in short supply. Specialist executive recruitment agencies exist which can target precisely the right type of candidates, but they normally charge high fees. Firms may recruit internally through promotion or redeployment of existing employees. Internal recruitment offers a number of benefits: » Candidates will have experience of the business and its culture and will be familiar with the firm’s procedures. » Internal candidates may not require induction training. » Internal recruitment provides employees with opportunities for promotion. » It avoids the need for expensive external advertising. » Selection may be easier as more is known about the candidates. Governments operate a number of training schemes to improve the skills and knowledge of the workforce. In the USA, the Department of Labor’s Employment and Training Administration funds job-training programmes to improve the employment prospects of adults, youths and workers who have lost their jobs. Its training is designed to boost workers’ employability and earnings. This provides a source of employees for American businesses that are seeking to recruit workers. However, internal candidates are drawn from a limited pool of employees and the skills and experience of this group of people may be insufficient to meet the business’ needs. This limitation is more likely in the case of smaller businesses and with senior appointments or for rapidly growing businesses. CASE STUDY IHG uses online recruitment in Dubai The InterContinental Hotels Group (IHG) is about to open a new hotel in Dubai. Many of the guests at this new hotel will be from countries other than the United Arab Emirates (UAE), as Dubai is a major tourist destination and its airport is a hub for flights from a large number of countries. The Indigo Dubai Downtown has launched a recruitment campaign to attract employees with a range of skills and experience. The intention is to appoint people in a range of roles within the hotel including finance, reception, cleaning, as well as bar and restaurant staff. The company has a reputation for providing accommodation within a relaxed setting. It has designed a number of eye-catching adverts intended to attract candidates with the skills and personalities that match its needs. Managers may be keen to have a wider choice of candidates and may seek to recruit externally. This can result in applications from higher-quality candidates, especially if recruitment is through national media or nationally based recruitment agencies. External recruits may bring fresh ideas and enthusiasm into the business. This can be a vital factor in an organisation with a low level of labour turnover. However, external recruitment is likely to be very expensive. It also carries a greater risk as candidates are not known to the business. GLOSSARY TERM A business culture is the attitudes, values and beliefs that normally exist within an organisation. Selection A number of selection techniques exist. Because of the high costs resulting from recruiting the wrong people, firms are IHG has used online recruitment to enable it to recruit employees from any part of the world. This could provide the company’s managers with a large number of applicants from which to choose. One requirement from any selected applicants will be to record a video describing the place in which they live. Source: Adapted from www.hoteliermiddleeast.com/ business/115326-hotel-indigo-dubai-downtown-launchesrecruitment-campaign Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why some potential applicants may not apply for jobs using the IHG’s website. [6] Evaluate the case for and against companies based in the UAE relying increasingly on their websites to recruit new employees. [12] investing more resources and time in the recruitment and selection process. ▼ Table 2.1 Methods of selection used by a sample of UK businesses in 2015 and 2017 2015 survey (%) 2017 survey (%) Competency-based interviews 77 78 Interview following contents of CV/application form 83 74 Online tests 24 23 Personality/attitude questionnaires 36 35 Assessment centres 38 39 Group exercises (e.g. roleplaying) 27 24 Method of selection Source: Resourcing and Talent Planning Survey, 2017 (CIPD) 52 9781398308114.indb 52 05/03/21 11:07 AM Question 1 Evaluate whether the data in Table 2.1 suggests that UK businesses are attempting to minimise costs of selection. [12] and provide potential employers with a further indication of the applicant’s suitability for the post. References are not always accurate. For instance, an employer may give an employee an undeservedly good reference if they want to get rid of them. 2.1 Testing Methods of selection Curriculum vitae (CVs) take various forms but are all designed to record key information about potential employees, such as their education, professional qualifications and experience in previous employment. This is designed to help managers to match employees to person specifications which detail the requirements of the job. Thus, they can form an important element of the early stages of the selection process. Résumés are very similar. A résumé normally summarises the applicant’s relevant job experience, education and training. The résumé is usually sent to employers with a covering letter which may contain additional information. Some businesses supply application forms for prospective employees to complete. These are normally used in place of CVs and résumés. They offer the advantage that businesses can ensure that all applicants have the chance to supply the information that is required to make the selection decision. Also, because the application forms are in a standard format, it can be easier to compare candidates’ applications. CVs, résumés and application forms all tend to be used early in the selection process, and they can be a useful means of screening candidates and deciding which to invite to interview or other method of selection. They are particularly valuable if a business receives a large number of applications for a position. Interviews These remain a popular form of selection technique and are the most common in the UK, as shown in Table 2.1. Interviews can involve one or two interviewers or even a panel. Candidates can be asked a series of questions designed to test their knowledge of, and suitability for, the job. Some interviews (sometimes called competency-based interviews) may require candidates to undertake specific job-related tasks to assess their skills. They are relatively cheap and allow the two-way exchange of information, but are unreliable as a method of selection. Some people perform well at interview, but that does not necessarily mean they will perform well at work. References Many employers ask candidates to supply references at some stage in the recruitment and selection process. These are written by former employers or by other people in a position of authority who may know the candidate well. They will set out the candidate’s strengths and possibly their weaknesses Assessment centres 2.1.3 Recruitment and selection Curriculum vitae, résumés and application forms Testing as part of the selection process can take a variety of forms. Psychometric tests are very common; these can take two forms. An aptitude test provides candidates with opportunities to demonstrate their skills and abilities in relation to the job. For example, an aptitude test for a sales role might involve the candidate making a sales presentation. Personality tests examine the likely behaviour of potential employees and how they might respond to certain situations in the workplace. They involve numerical and written questions and can help to assess how well the applicant might fit in with existing employees. Managers are aware of the high costs of poor selection decisions and this has led to the heavy use of assessment centres. Many managers believe that this is a more reliable method of selection. In such centres, a number of candidates are subjected to a variety of selection techniques over a period of between two and four days. These might include some or all of the following: » simulations of circumstances that might occur within the job » a variety of interviews » group exercises, such as role-plays involving a number of the candidates and assessment centre staff » tests of candidates’ personalities. Employment contracts An employment contract is a legal agreement between an employer and an employee, setting forth the terms and conditions of the employment arrangement. It is a legally binding agreement designed to protect the rights of employers and employees. In the UK, the Employment Rights Act requires employers hiring workers for more than a month to issue an employment contract. A contract does not have to be issued immediately upon an employee starting work, but its conditions are in force from the time an employee commences employment. Employees’ contracts may be verbal, implied (for example, through previous practice) or written, though the latter is more common and preferable in many ways. The laws relating to employment contracts vary between countries. Here we refer to those that apply within the UK. An employment contract in the UK should contain the following information: 1 the employee’s and employer’s names 2 date when employment began 3 the scale (and rate) at which the employee will be paid and the frequency of payment 4 the employee’s usual hours of work 53 9781398308114.indb 53 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management 2.1 5 the employee’s entitlement to holidays – how many days and whether they can only be taken at certain times of the year 6 rules relating to absences due to sickness or injury, including sick-pay conditions 7 the employee’s right to a pension (if any) and employer’s and employee’s contributions 8 the notice from either side to terminate the employment contract. This states the period of time that must elapse between the employee stating their intention to leave the job and doing so. Similarly, it may record the time period to be given to employees before making them redundant or dismissing them 9 the job title and a summary of duties 10 the location or locations of the work 11 details of any trade union agreements relating to the job 12 disciplinary procedures – this sets out the rules establishing standards of conduct at work and how the employer may respond to any breach of these rules 13 grievance procedures – this will state how an employee can make a complaint against other staff or their treatment at work. shall examine each of these situations in turn and explain the difference between the two. An employment contract may include implied terms which are not directly stated. Examples of implied terms include: » employees not stealing from employers » employers providing a safe and healthy working environment » employers meeting legal requirements, such as giving a minimum of a certain number of days of paid holidays » employees should have essential qualities and qualifications to carry out the job; for example, lorry drivers should have a relevant category of driving licence. Voluntary and involuntary redundancies If either the employer or the employee suffers financial loss because the other party has breached the contract, they can claim compensation in a court of law. For example, an employee who leaves before the end of a fixed-term contract and thereby causes disruption to the employer may be sued for damages. In many cases in the UK, an employee may take an employer to an employment tribunal to settle a certain range of disputes relating to employment. Employment tribunals Employment tribunals in the UK hear claims about matters to do with employment. These may include unfair dismissal, redundancy payments and discrimination. Employment tribunals are similar to law courts, but they are less formal. No one in an employment tribunal wears a wig or gown. Almost all hearings are open to the public, and evidence is given under oath or affirmation. 2.1.4 Redundancy and dismissal It is only possible for an employer to legally terminate the employment of a worker for specific reasons and having followed certain procedures. It may be that the employer takes disciplinary action against an employee; this may result in the employee being dismissed. Similarly, employment may be ended as a result of redundancy. We GLOSSARY TERMS A dismissal occurs when an employer terminates the employee’s contract. Redundancies take place when an employee is dismissed because a job no longer exists. Redundancy Redundancy is a legal reason for an employer to dismiss an employee, but it can only occur if a job no longer exists. Redundancies can take place for a variety of reasons, including: » A business closes down and all its employees are made redundant. » The jobs of some employees are replaced by new technology. » A business moves some of its operations overseas and some jobs are lost as a consequence. Voluntary redundancy occurs when an employer, wishing to make redundancies, invites employees to apply for redundancy in return for a financial compensation package. This is often the first choice for a business wishing to make redundancies. This form of redundancy can help to maintain the morale of a workforce at what can be a very difficult time for a business. Offering voluntary redundancies means that employees choose to leave. Some employees, for example, those near to retirement or those who might find it easy to obtain alternative employment, might find the offer of financial compensation very attractive. By contrast, involuntary (or compulsory) redundancy is where employees are selected for redundancy. They have no choice in the matter. This is likely to occur when a large number of employees are to be made redundant and insufficient people are willing to take voluntary redundancy. Involuntary redundancies often damage the morale and performance of the workforce. We shall see in the next chapter that job security is an important factor affecting motivation at work. Customers may also be less willing to purchase products from businesses that are using involuntary redundancies. The law requires that use of involuntary redundancy must follow set procedures. These are explained below. Procedures for redundancy If a business in the UK intends to make 20 or more employees redundant, it is obliged to consult with any relevant trade union or other employee organisation at least 30 days before any redundancies occur. The employer must also consult with individual employees. If 100 or more employees are to be made redundant, consultations must take place at least 90 days before the process of making people redundant can commence. 54 9781398308114.indb 54 05/03/21 11:07 AM Part of this consultation may involve agreeing a procedure by which those employees who are to be made redundant are to be selected. It is likely to be beneficial to involve employees and their representatives in making such decisions. Businesses commonly seek to reduce the number of employees who have to be made redundant by: » asking for volunteers for redundancy » banning any overtime to maximise the number of jobs that are retained » not replacing employees who leave for other reasons. If, despite these measures, employees have to be made redundant, there must be clear and agreed criteria for selecting them. The criteria for redundancy could be based upon employees’ skills and experience (that is, the business would retain the most skilled and experienced) or on absence and disciplinary performance (those with the best records keeping their jobs). Employees who are selected for redundancy must be given between one and twelve weeks’ notice of their impending redundancy, depending on how long they have been employed by the business. Airline makes redundancies Philippine Airlines (PA) announced that it has cut 300 jobs as a result of continued financial losses. The airline said that this will help the company to reduce its costs, adding that it was offering voluntary redundancy packages to long-serving employees. Those who accept will receive benefits including flight pass privileges and career counselling assistance. The company’s workforce currently totals 6087 employees. causing the cancellation of flights to mainland China, Hong Kong and Macau. Other cost-reducing initiatives include: ● increasing revenues from flights and other products ● a vigorous cost-management approach ● investment in digital technology. Questions The announcement was made after Philippine Airlines posted its biggest ever loss ($208 million) in 2019. The company blamed these losses on high levels of interest payments on debts and on unexpected global crises, Redundancy pay Employees in the UK who have been continuously employed by the business for two years and who are made redundant due to the closure of the business or reduced need for employees are entitled to compensation in the form of redundancy payments. The calculation for statutory redundancy pay is: » half a week’s pay for each full year of service where the employee is aged under 22 » one week’s pay for each full year of service where the employee is aged between 22 and 41 » one and a half week’s pay for each full year of service where the employee is 41 or over. The maximum number of years that can be taken into account in calculating redundancy pay is 20 years. Some employers may choose to pay higher levels of redundancy pay. Many employers will have a set of redundancy guidelines with which they will comply to ensure that they do not break any employment laws relating to the process of redundancy. Dismissal Dismissal takes place when an employer terminates an employee’s employment contract. We saw above that redundancy is one reason for dismissal. Thus, dismissal is a more general term than redundancy, which is a specific form of dismissal. As part of its statement on the redundancies, the airline said that it would be acquiring new aircraft and launching new routes between Cebu and Los Angeles, as well as routes to Perth, Pagadian, Kota Kinabalu and Manado. 2.1.4 Redundancy and dismissal CASE STUDY 2.1 Source: Adapted from www.ch-aviation.com/portal/news/86974 1 2 Explain two reasons why Philippine Airlines might prefer to use voluntary redundancies, rather than involuntary redundancies, to achieve the desired [6] reduction in its workforce. Evaluate the case for and against Philippine Airlines [12] making 300 employees redundant. Apart from redundancy, there are a number of reasons why employees may be dismissed legally in the UK. The reasons for ‘fair’ dismissal include: » when employees are unable to do their jobs properly, perhaps because they do not have the necessary skills or qualifications to be competent » as a result of persistent or long-term illness (but not because of a person’s disability) » for ‘gross misconduct’ – theft or violence towards colleagues or customers may be considered gross misconduct » a ‘substantial reason’ such as not agreeing to reasonable changes in employment terms or if an employee is given a prison sentence. Employees should receive an explanation in writing of the reason for their dismissal within 14 days of it happening. Employees may also be entitled to receive up to 12 weeks’ notice of dismissal, depending upon how long they have been employed by the business. If employees in the UK are dismissed for other reasons, this can be classed as ‘unfair dismissal’. Dismissals are classed as ‘automatically unfair’ if the reason for dismissal is connected with an employee exercising rights relating to factors such as the following: 55 9781398308114.indb 55 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2.1 » pregnancy: including all reasons relating to maternity » family reasons: including parental leave, paternity leave (birth and adoption), adoption leave or time off to care for dependants, such as children who are ill » trade union membership: including being a member of a union and union recognition. AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management STUDY TIP Do make sure that you distinguish between redundancy and dismissal. Redundancy is just one of the reasons why a business can dismiss employees fairly and legally. Dismissal is a more general term. 2.1.5 Morale and welfare At its most basic, every employer is required by law to provide essential amenities such as toilets, sinks and clean drinking water for employees. Most employees also hope to find additional facilities, such as a cloakroom and a clean and hygienic seating area for workers to use during meal breaks. There should be facilities nearby for heating food or water for hot drinks. A ‘good’ employer who is concerned about employee welfare may also consider other issues besides the physical working environment. For example, such employers will seek to develop their employees as fully as possible to improve their performance at work. Employee morale is the level of satisfaction, as well as the overall sense of well-being, of a business’ employees. An employee who is satisfied and content at work usually tends to co-operate with colleagues and managers and to perform well. GLOSSARY TERMS Employee welfare is a broad term covering a wide range of facilities that are essential for the well-being of a business’ employees. Employee morale is the satisfaction felt by employees within the workplace. Work–life balance refers to the obligations placed on employees by employers that determine the amount of time that employees spend on work-related activities. HRM, welfare and employee morale Human resource management can play a central role in developing and improving the morale and welfare of employees. Recruiting people with the intention of developing their skills and improving their performance throughout a long-term relationship is at the heart of what is called ‘soft’ human resource management. Such an approach to HRM may well seek to develop the skills of employees and to encourage them to work with the business for long periods of time. Using this ‘soft’ approach to HRM also offers benefits to the business of providing good facilities for employees. CASE STUDY Working at Google Here’s a taste of what Google offer their employees: ● On-site physicians and nurses, convenient medical services, and comprehensive health care coverage help keep you healthy and happy. (Varies by location.) ● Googlers and their families have travel insurance and emergency assistance, even on personal vacations. ● New parents get time off and some extra spending money to help them welcome their new bundle of joy. ● We’ll reimburse you for classes or degree courses that help you with what you do. Google is committed to continuous learning among its employees. ● Googlers get legal advice at no cost and, in the USA, also get common legal services at a generous group discount. ▲ Figure 2.4 More time with your baby (image for illustration purposes only) Source: www.google.com Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why Google’s employees might benefit from the company’s commitment to continuous learning. [6] Evaluate the benefits Google might receive from treating its employees in this way. [12] ▲ Figure 2.5 Travel without worries (image for illustration purposes only) 56 9781398308114.indb 56 05/03/21 11:07 AM Work–life balance is a topic of increasing importance for employers as well as employees. The term work–life balance refers to the time an employee spends on work-related duties compared with time spent on non-work activities. Non-work activities include leisure interests and time spent with family and friends. Some governments have become concerned about the possible adverse implications for the health of employees and for rates of labour productivity of excessive working hours. The European Union has implemented a working time directive intended to limit working hours to a maximum of 48 per week, although exceptions can be made. 2.1 CASE STUDY 2.1.5 Morale and welfare International working hours Despite concerns about the work–life balance of many employees, average working hours in many countries have declined since 2012, as shown in Table 2.2 (below). Many countries have laws to restrict the number of hours people may work, though these are not always enforced. For example, China has legislation imposing a 44-hour maximum normal working week with overtime payments for hours beyond this. However, surveys suggest that this limit is ignored by many employers. Foxconn is a major company in China which manufactures large numbers of mobile phones for Apple and other businesses. A report released in September 2019, by China Labor Watch, alleged that Foxconn did not always follow Chinese labour laws. This investigation found that its Apple 11 factory ‘routinely’ and ‘repeatedly’ ignored laws that were put in place to regulate the employment of temporary workers. Research has shown that long working hours can damage the health of employees, endanger their safety at work and increase levels of stress. A few countries have long average working weeks. In Columbia, the average working week is 47.7 hours, reportedly the longest in the world. However, long working weeks do not always lead to high levels of productivity. ▼ Table 2.2 Weekly working hours in a selection of OECD countries, 2012 and 2019 Country 2012 2019 Australia 33.2 32.9 Chile 39.0 36.8 Mexico 42.8 41.1 Spain 32.4 32.4 Turkey 35.7 35.2* Average of OECD members 33.9 33.2 * 2018 data It also reported that Foxconn failed to follow laws concerning its permanent staff, including claims that employees were not permitted to resign during peak season, needed to provide three days’ notice if they wished to quit during their probationary period, and needed permission to not work overtime. Source: www.theregister.com/2019/09/09/ foxconns_apple_11_ factory_clw_report/ Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why many governments have passed laws to impose limits on the number of hours employees may work each week. [6] Evaluate the case for and against Foxconn requiring its employees to work very long hours each week. [12] Many employers are concerned about long working hours and their impact on the work–life balance of the people who work for them. Long working hours can harm the performance of employees, which may have a significant impact on the performance of the business itself. Some major businesses have implemented policies designed to relieve the pressure on employees and to help them to achieve a sensible balance between work and non-work activities. The Colgate-Palmolive company is an American multinational manufacturer of consumer products such as soaps and detergents. It has acquired a reputation for employment practices that set realistic expectations for employees, and it encourages the development of time-management skills. Colgate-Palmolive also offers its employees the chance to work flexible hours and to telecommute. It provides nearby back-up childcare facilities to assist parents who work at home. As a result, ColgatePalmolive has a low rate of labour turnover, which offers it a range of benefits. Source: OECD data, https://data.oecd.org/emp/hours-worked.htm 57 9781398308114.indb 57 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management 2.1 The impact of diversity and equality in the workplace Although the terms ‘diversity’ and ‘equality’ are frequently used together, and sometimes interchangeably, they have different meanings. Diversity, in a workplace context, refers to recognising the differences between individual employees and also the differences that may exist between different groups of employees. Businesses that operate diversity policies will treat people as individuals and will value the benefits that diverse individuals and groups in a workplace may offer to a business. Employee diversity could be based upon gender, race and ethnicity, disability, religion, sexuality, class and age. In contrast, policies related to equality are intended to create a fairer society where all employees can contribute and fulfil their potential. One key aspect of this is to operate policies that allow all employees the opportunity to reach senior positions in a business, irrespective of their age, gender, ethnicity or sexual orientation. This is considered necessary as many groups, such as women and minority ethnic groups, are under-represented in senior positions in businesses. This can mean that the skills and abilities of such employees are wasted. By including such groups, businesses can become more competitive and successful. A number of governments have enacted employment legislation to ensure that businesses design and implement policies to encourage diversity and to promote equality. For example, the UK government passed the Equalities Act in 2010. This offered protection to employees on the grounds of: » direct and indirect discrimination » harassment » victimisation. The Act identifies a number of ‘protected characteristics’. These are: » age » disability » gender reassignment » marriage and civil partnership » pregnancy and maternity » race » religion or belief » gender » sexual orientation. Operating an effective policy for equality offers benefits to businesses. Drawing on all people within the local community when recruiting offers the best opportunity to employ the most talented employees, which will enhance the performance of the business. Similarly, promoting the most able employee, regardless of personal characteristics, secures the greatest level of talent for the business. Any other approach is likely to harm the business. The elements of a policy designed to promote diversity can also bring benefit to the business. A diverse workforce may allow the business to understand the needs of a market which may comprise diverse consumers. This will assist the organisation in meeting the needs of its consumers more effectively. A business that acquires a reputation for operating an effective diversity and equality policy may become an attractive employer to potential employees. This process is called employer branding and can help businesses to attract highly talented and skilled employees, whatever their personal characteristics. CASE STUDY Equality and diversity at the University of Cambridge The University of Cambridge, in the UK, is one of the bestknown universities in the world. It was founded in 1209. In 2020, it had over 11 000 staff and 23 000 students from countries throughout the world. The University of Cambridge is committed in its pursuit of academic excellence to equality of opportunity and to a proactive and inclusive approach to equality, which supports and encourages all under-represented groups, promotes an inclusive culture, and values diversity. The commitment applies to all protected groups and is underpinned by the University’s Equal Opportunities Policy and Combined Equality Scheme (CES). It is managed by the University’s Equality & Diversity Committee. The University’s Equality & Diversity essential online training module: Firms take positive decisions on welfare and training because they have the potential to improve the morale and motivation of employees. We shall see in Chapter 2.2 that there are different views on what motivates employees. Some writers on motivation argue that physical faculties aims to help staff understand the main principles of equality and diversity, their impacts on the University and how members of staff and students can access support and other resources. The module, which can be accessed on a variety of platforms, including tablets and laptops, is Cambridge-specific and takes about 30 minutes to complete. Source: www.equality.admin.cam.ac.uk Questions 1 2 Explain two ways in which training might assist Cambridge University to implement its equality and diversity policy. [6] Evaluate the extent to which the benefits of the University of Cambridge’s equality and diversity policy outweigh its costs. [12] are important. Other writers on motivational theory would argue that providing training and allowing employees to develop themselves and to fulfil their potential are powerful motivators. 58 9781398308114.indb 58 05/03/21 11:07 AM GLOSSARY TERMS Diversity, in an employment context, refers to recognising the differences between individual employees and also the differences that may exist between groups of employees. Equality is the circumstance in which all people are equal, particularly in relation to rights and opportunities in the workplace. Training is a process whereby an individual acquires jobrelated skills and knowledge. 2.1.6 Training and development Training and development can help employees to improve their performance at work. Employees who are offered opportunities for training and development are often more motivated. In the next chapter we will look at some of the motivational theories that explain this relationship. Businesses that offer good-quality training and development often have very loyal workforces, and it can help to develop a reputation as a ‘good’ employer. Improvements in the performance of a business’ labour force can assist the organisation in achieving its objectives. Training and other development activities can result in higher levels of productivity or fewer faulty Development is a broader term than training and refers to a wider range of activities intended to improve employee performance at work. It includes attendance on courses studied at colleges and universities, performance tracking and improvement, coaching and mentoring, as well as training. Types of training Almost all employees receive training at some point during their working lives and this training comes in different forms. Induction training Employees may receive training when commencing a new job. This is known as induction training and is intended to introduce an employee to the business. Induction training may provide employees with information on the following: » important policies such as health and safety, and disciplinary procedures » the layout of the factory or office » their new colleagues » the basic duties of the job. 2.1 2.1.6 Training and development Development refers to activities designed to increase employees’ skills, education, knowledge and abilities in the workplace. products. Both factors can help businesses to reduce their costs. Induction training enables a new recruit to become more productive quickly. It can prevent costly errors resulting from employee ignorance and can make a new employee feel welcome, thereby reducing labour turnover. CASE STUDY Center Parcs apartments and lodges. Each village offers an extensive range of sports and leisure activities, plus numerous restaurants, bars and retail outlets and an Aqua Sana Spa facility. Woodland, water and a natural healthy environment are the essential elements of a Center Parcs break. The company employs about 9500 people and values its staff. It has the following statement on its UK website: ▲ Figure 2.6 Center Parcs is a business that offers its employees regular opportunities for training. Center Parcs opened its first UK village at Sherwood Forest in July 1987, offering short-break holidays at any time of year. Since then it has expanded its operations and currently operates six villages across the UK and Ireland. Each UK holiday village is set in a forest environment, typically 400 acres (162 hectares) in size, and provides high-quality accommodation in fully equipped villas, ... we encourage our employees to develop their skills and reward them when they are successful. Our training and development programme offers our employees the opportunity to develop their technical and professional skills as well as their leadership potential, from entry level through to managers. Source: www.centerparcs.co.uk/company-information/ourresponsibilities/our-people.html Questions 1 2 Explain two possible reasons why Center Parcs might have such a clear and highly prominent statement on its website. Evaluate the benefits of effective systems of training to Center Parcs, which is expanding. [6] [12] 59 9781398308114.indb 59 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2.1 Off-the-job training The impact of training and development This involves training outside the workplace, at a college, university or some other training agency. Off-the-job training can take the form of a range of activities in which job-related skills and knowledge are acquired. These activities can include external courses such as lectures and seminars, self-study or open learning. Some businesses, for example, Center Parcs, invest heavily in training and development, often regarding it as a core element of their human resource management. Some managers value it highly because they believe it improves employee attitude, motivation and performance. Others are less eager to spend money in this way, taking the view that ‘if they cannot do the job already, why are we paying them?’ Managers may be especially suspicious of off-the-job training, which can be very expensive. AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management On-the-job training This form of training does not require the employee to leave the workplace. They learn from experienced employees through observation and work shadowing. The trainee may work through instruction manuals or receive guidance from senior employees. Training and development activities offer benefits and drawbacks to businesses. These activities can be expensive and disruptive but can improve employee performance. The possible impact, in terms of benefits and drawbacks, is summarised in Table 2.3. ▼ Table 2.3 The impact of training and development Drawbacks Benefits • Training and development activities use up valuable resources that could be utilised elsewhere in the organisation. • Attendance at training and development activities may mean that employees are unavailable to the organisation for a period of time. Production may suffer as a consequence. • Employees, once trained, may leave for other, possibly betterpaid jobs. • The beneficial effects of these activities may vary because some managers might seek to avoid training and developing their staff as it can lessen the degree of control they have over their subordinates. • It can improve employee performance, and hence the competitive position of the business, by developing new skills and knowledge. • Training and development should improve employee morale and productivity. • Training and development are core components of HRM and assist organisations in having the right workforce to achieve strategic objectives. • A reputation for training and developing employees will assist businesses in attracting and retaining highquality, creative and productive employees. The impact of training and development of employees is potentially greater if the market in which the firm operates is subject to fierce competition. For example, firms may operate extensive development activities in an attempt to improve rates of creativity and/or productivity to gain an advantage over competitors. Businesses manufacturing motor vehicles have tended to invest more heavily in such activities over recent years for these reasons. When products are similar, price is often a very important factor influencing consumers’ buying decisions. In such circumstances, minimising costs (and prices) is vital. A key part of this is making sure that labour is as productive as possible. An emphasis on training and development may have an impact on the management style used in the business. Managers who engage in large-scale development and training activities will be more likely to value techniques such as delegation and teamworking. Partly, this is a question of philosophy: democratic and communicative managers are more likely to value employees and therefore will aim to develop them as much as possible. However, there are practical reasons why training and development will be needed in these circumstances. Businesses cannot expect to benefit from granting employees greater authority without preparing them for such roles. GLOSSARY TERMS Delegation means passing authority down the organisational hierarchy. This is only genuine if the manager relinquishes some control to the subordinate. Intrapreneurship occurs when individuals within organisations are being entrepreneurial – taking risks and generating new ideas. Employee development to encourage intrapreneurship, multi-skilling and flexibility Intrapreneurship We saw in Chapter 1.1 that entrepreneurs are individuals who take risks to develop business ideas and start their own businesses. Some larger organisations attempt to encourage entrepreneurial approaches among their employees to improve the organisation’s performance. This is termed intrapreneurship. Such organisations encourage individuals to develop ideas for new products or ways of producing goods and services within their own departments or sections of the business. In effect, employees are supported 60 9781398308114.indb 60 05/03/21 11:07 AM to behave as entrepreneurs within a large business. One well-known example of successful intrapreneurship is Spencer Silver, who developed the Post-It note while working at 3M, an American multinational company. He was a chemist who developed the glue used in Post-It notes. His innovative type of glue was strong enough to hold papers together, but easily pulled apart without tearing the documents. It could also be used repeatedly. The need for learning and development activities in an intrapreneurial organisation will be continuous as markets, products, technology and consumer needs change over time. In addition, labour turnover will mean that new employees are recruited who lack the necessary skills to operate as effective intrapreneurs. Learning and development activities will be needed throughout the careers of intrapreneurs. 2.1 2.1.6 Training and development Employees cannot simply be expected to become intrapreneurs overnight. A range of learning and development activities are required to prepare employees to fulfil the role of an intrapreneur successfully. » Personal skills Intrapreneurs need many of the strengths associated with entrepreneurs. They should be creative, confident and pursue their ideas with persistence. They should be good at solving problems and willing to take calculated risks. Thus, they need to be able to analyse risk to avoid making damaging decisions. Ongoing training and development activities can help to develop and improve such knowledge and skills. » Technical skills Successful intrapreneurs must be able to analyse markets, organisations and consumer behaviour to uncover problems. These may take the form of unfulfilled or unrecognised needs or production bottlenecks. Intrapreneurs then apply a range of skills to solve these ‘problems’. Developing the knowledge and skills to undertake this analysis and subsequent problem-solving are central to success as an intrapreneur. These skills may need to be supported by relevant technical skills such as engineering or, as in the case of Spencer Silver, those of a chemist. » Senior employees The learning and development activities are not limited just to employees engaged in intrapreneurial activities. It is important that managers and leaders also have the intrapreneurial spirit and that this exists throughout the organisation. They should encourage risk-taking, innovative activities and ensure sufficient resources (human and non-human) are provided. They may require training and development to fulfil such roles effectively. Simply recruiting some very talented individuals and hoping this will be sufficient to promote intrapreneurship within the organisation will not be enough. Businesses need to develop a learning and development plan to build innovation throughout the organisation. CASE STUDY Facebook Facebook has over 2 billion users worldwide and nearly 45 000 employees. It is expanding and recently recruited 800 employees in the UK. It is an important company in the global technology industry. The company describes itself as constantly solving problems. It hires people with different backgrounds and viewpoints to help it make better products. The company supports its employees to become bold and confident and to seek to solve the problems they care most about. Its employees work together in small teams to develop new products quickly. The company offers high-quality training and operates its own university. Over time, Facebook has extended its product range, sometimes by buying other businesses; for example, Multi-skilling and flexibility Multi-skilled workers have the skills to perform roles in more than one area of a business’ activities. For example, in a manufacturing business, multi-skilled workers may receive training in all aspects of constructing the product, as well as the ability to perform inspections to ensure products are of suitable quality. Having multi-skilled employees allows a business to switch workers to where they are needed over time. WhatsApp in 2014. The company’s range now includes: ● Instagram ● WhatsApp ● Messenger ● Augmented Reality ● Virtual Reality ● Facebook Connectivity. Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why Facebook encourages its employees to be intrapreneurs. [6] Evaluate the extent to which training and development at Facebook is essential to encourage [12] intrapreneurship among its workforce. A company with multi-skilled employees has the potential to have a flexible workforce. This enables managers to use workers where needed to match the business’ needs. This flexibility assists businesses in: » meeting unexpected increases in demand for their products » covering for employees who are absent » dealing with crises, such as delays in production. 61 9781398308114.indb 61 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management 2.1 Labour flexibility arising from multi-skilling allows the business owner to maintain production levels under circumstances that would otherwise leave workers idle and reduce profits. Training and development play critical roles in creating a multi-skilled workforce and the flexibility that arises from this. Without enhanced skills and knowledge, employees will be unable to carry out a variety of roles. Training and development activities will be required on a long-term basis in industries where the skills required change and develop over time. GLOSSARY TERMS Multi-skilling exists when employees have the skills to carry out several roles within an organisation. A trade union is an organisation of workers established to protect and improve the economic position and working conditions of its members. Collective bargaining is negotiation between employers and representatives of employees, normally trade union officials. 2.1.7 Management and workforce relations The benefits of co-operation between management and the workforce Co-operation between management and the workforce can reduce the number of disputes that may occur between the two sides. Disputes can result in strikes (where workers withdraw their labour) or other measures, such as banning overtime working. One way of considering how co-operation between management and the workforce benefits both parties is to consider the costs that may arise from any sort of dispute (see Table 2.4). ▼ Table 2.4 The costs of industrial disputes Employers • The business may lose revenue from selling its products if the dispute results in industrial action, such as a strike, and production is halted. • The business may lose future sales if its customers believe that it is an unreliable supplier. • The business’ relationship with its employees may be damaged in the long term, with negative implications for morale and productivity. • The business may be regarded as a more risky investment and may encounter more difficulty in raising finance, or it may be expected to pay higher interest rates for loans • The business’ image may be damaged if it is involved in a dispute with its employees and this may result in the loss of some of its customers. The benefits to employers Employers benefit in a range of ways from co-operation with employees. » Helping to develop a strong employer brand Employers who avoid disputes with employees and who have effective mechanisms to resolve any disputes quickly will be viewed more favourably by potential employees. This will assist them in attracting more able and productive employees. » Enhancing employee morale Having a workforce with high morale is a valuable asset for any business. Poor employer relations are likely to lead to employees believing they are not valued and will reduce their sense of well-being and morale. Such factors can damage employee performance severely. » Improving the business’ corporate image Avoiding disputes or settling them quickly helps a business to develop or maintain a reputation as a fair and reasonable employer. This can have positive effects on a range of stakeholders, including customers and investors. » Strengthening competitiveness Good employer– employee relations can be a powerful competitive weapon. They can reduce costs by eliminating lost Employees • Employees may lose pay if the industrial dispute takes the form of a strike. • The dispute may weaken the employer’s finances, putting employees’ job security at risk. • A financially weakened employer may not be able or willing to pay for training and development for employees, denying them the chance to improve and update their skills and knowledge. • The employer may respond to the threat of, or actual, industrial action by replacing people with technology in the production process or by moving overseas. production, adding to a business’ reliability as a supplier as its production is not interrupted, and can enhance labour productivity (thereby lowering labour costs), as workers are motivated by what they regard as fair pay and working conditions. The benefits to employees Equally there are a number of advantages to employees from the maintenance of good relations with their employers. » Financial benefits Employees avoid loss of pay during periods of industrial disputes if good relations are maintained. However, because the employer may also be financially stronger as a result of avoiding wasteful disputes, there is a greater possibility of future improvements in pay and conditions. » Job security An employer is less likely to consider replacing employees with technology or moving overseas to locations where industrial action rarely or never occurs. » The possibility of greater participation in decisionmaking Involving employees in decision-making is one way of helping to maintain good relations, but it is also a possible benefit to employees from doing their part 62 9781398308114.indb 62 05/03/21 11:07 AM in maintaining a positive relationship. Where amicable relationships exist, employers may be more willing to offer opportunities for employee involvement in decision-making. The impact on employers and employees of trade union involvement in the workplace Trade unions Trade union membership has declined in many countries around the world. Figure 2.10 shows that the percentage of national workforces belonging to a trade union varies significantly. OECD – the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development – has 32 member countries. In 1985, average trade union membership in OECD countries was 30 per cent. By 2019, that had fallen to just 16 per cent. Iceland Sweden Belgium Italy Canada Ireland United Kingdom Japan Germany Australia Mexico South Korea United States Turkey France 25.9 24.2 23.2 17.1 16.7 13.7 12.0 10.5 10.1 8.6 7.9 34.3 54.2 66.1 90.4 Source: Forbes, https://bit.ly/3n5cncW ▲ Figure 2.7 Trade union membership as a percentage of the total workforce in a selection of countries Most OECD countries have seen a decline in trade union membership. The only ones that have seen increases since 1985 are Iceland, Belgium, Spain and Italy. Iceland remains the most unionised country in the OECD, with 90.4 per cent of its workers being members of a trade union. Trade unions are normally organised on a regional basis. For example, in the UK, Unite operates in ten regions throughout the UK and Eire and is the UK’s largest trade union. Each region has a regional office staffed Most trade unions across the world have similar objectives. These focus on improving the economic position of their members by fulfilling the following objectives. » Maximising pay Trade unions engage in collective bargaining to provide their members with the highest possible rates of pay. » Achieving safe and secure working conditions Unions often provide training for safety representatives who can advise employers on health and safety issues. Creating a workplace in which there is a focus on health and well-being can be an important factor in creating employee engagement. » Attaining job security Arguably this is the most important objective of a modern trade union, and it is one that is difficult to fulfil in the light of pressures resulting from globalisation and the increasing use of technology in the workplace. » Participating in and influencing decisions in the workplace Trade unions may achieve this through collective bargaining or through having representatives on any employer–employee committees. Trade unions may play a role in decisions ranging from a change in fringe benefits, such as free lunches, to the closure of one or more parts of the business. 2.1 2.1.7 Management and workforce relations The value of co-operation between employers and employees is probably greatest where the costs of industrial disputes are most significant. This might be where the business is in a weak competitive or financial position, and it is vulnerable to losing its customers to rivals or at risk of financial failure. Similarly, industrial disputes might be risky for employees in areas of high unemployment and for those who are relatively unskilled. If a prolonged dispute results in a loss of jobs, they may experience difficulty in finding alternative employment. by full-time union employees (called organisers or officers). The region is made up of a number of branches (more than 6000 in the case of Unite) and each branch has an elected shop steward. The shop steward communicates with employers on behalf of the union’s members and reports back to members regarding management decisions. The union head office has administrative, statistical and legal staff, as well as the senior officials of the union. Other trade unions operate similar structures. Collective bargaining Collective bargaining between employers and trade unions usually covers issues such as wages and salaries, holidays, the length of the working week and employee pensions. Because the negotiation is collective, any agreement that is reached applies to all those represented by the trade union. The rules for collective bargaining are usually agreed between the trade unions and each individual firm. Trade unions are in a better position to negotiate than individuals as they have better collective negotiating skills. Furthermore, the threat of taking industrial action (such as strikes) gives them increased power in negotiations, helping them to achieve higher rates of pay. STUDY TIP Do not assume that trade unions do not offer any benefits to employers. The case study below outlines some of the benefits that they can offer and you should be able to argue the positive and negative impact of trade unions on employers. 63 9781398308114.indb 63 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.1 Human resource management 2.1 CASE STUDY Airbus and European works councils European Union laws relating to European works councils affect any organisation with at least 1000 employees, of which least 150 employees are located in two or more member states of the EU. European works councils (which operate on behalf of employees) bring together employee representatives in a multinational company from across Europe. The works councils inform and consult employees on the group’s activities and future prospects. European works councils help trade union members to respond to the decisions that employers take on a global basis. A European works council is made up of at least one elected employee from each country in which the multinational operates, along with representatives from senior management. They normally meet annually and discuss issues affecting employees throughout the organisation. These include health and safety, merger proposals, the closure of plants and the implementation of new working practices, such as teamworking. company operates factories in the UK, Germany, France and Spain. In 2020, it announced plans to consult its European works council over plans to cut 2362 jobs in its factories. The jobs are under threat due to reduced levels of demand for its aircraft. The company said it wanted to manage the implications of the job losses for its workforce ‘in a responsible manner’. The company said it hoped to consult on opportunities for those employees who are affected. The matters to be discussed include transferring affected employees to work in other locations within the company. Questions 1 2 Airbus, the multinational plane manufacturer, has its headquarters in Toulouse in Southern France. The Employees can receive significant benefits from being represented by trade unions. In the UK in 2018, those employees who were represented by trade unions earned approximately 7.9 per cent more than people carrying out similar work who were not members of a trade union. Trade unions bring other benefits for employees. For example, they can play a major part in monitoring health and safety issues to protect the workforce. This can help to provide a more secure working environment and reduce the number of accidents. It may appear that trade unions only offer disadvantages to employers. They are able to use collective bargaining to negotiate higher wages than would be paid in a Explain two reasons why Airbus might prefer to transfer employees in Europe rather than make them [6] redundant. Evaluate whether or not Airbus’ employees benefit overall from the existence of the company’s European [12] works council. non-unionised workplace. This wage differential is known as the trade union premium. This can increase the business’ costs of production. As a consequence, profits may be lower or prices may have to be higher, reducing the business’ competitiveness. This can be a serious disadvantage in an industry where competition is based on low prices, such as the airline industry. Despite this, employers can also benefit from the existence of trade unions for the following reasons: » They act as a communications link between management and employees and can reduce the chance of industrial action occurring. » Professional negotiation on behalf of a large number of employees can save time and lessen the likelihood of disputes occurring. TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 5 a b Define the term ‘human resource management’. [2] Explain one activity that forms part of human resource management. [3] Explain two possible benefits to a business of an effective system of human resource management. [6] a Define the term ‘workforce plan’. [2] b Explain one factor that might influence the workforce plan of an international retailer. [3] a Explain one possible effect of a high level of labour turnover in a business. [3] b A business has 9500 employees. During the year, 190 leave its employment. Calculate its rate of labour turnover. [3] a Explain one difference between recruitment and selection. [3] Explain one method of selection. Explain one difference between internal and external recruitment. b Define the term ‘job description’. 7 a State three items that might be included in an employment contract. b Define the term ‘person specification’. 8 Explain one benefit a business might receive from preparing and using a person specification. 9 a Explain one difference between redundancy and dismissal. b Explain one reason why an employee may be made redundant. 10 Explain two reasons why businesses invest in training and development despite the high costs. 6 b a [3] [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] [3] [3] [6] 64 9781398308114.indb 64 05/03/21 11:07 AM Data response question The company behind the soaps and shampoos in hotel bathrooms 2.1 Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘induction training’ [2] b ‘redundancy’. [2] Analyse one reason why Cannell Ltd should be [4] concerned about its rate of labour turnover. Evaluate whether or not the managing director is correct to argue that the company should double its spending on training and development. [12] 2.1.7 Management and workforce relations Cannell Ltd manufactures soaps, shampoos and other complimentary toiletries that are available in hotel bathrooms. The company operates two factories with acombined workforce of 380, and labour costs are 47 percent of its total costs. The company is relatively small and, selling throughout Europe, faces intense price competition from larger rivals. Recently the company has had to reduce its prices to retain some major customers. Profitability has declined in recent years – last year it fell by 14.5 per cent. The company has a highly skilled workforce, although its labour turnover figure rose to 23.4 per cent last year from 14.9 per cent the previous year. Cannell Ltd’s managing director believes strongly in the importance of training and development, including induction training. He has proposed doubling the company’s expenditure on training. Employees work in teams and the company updates its production-line technology whenever it can afford to do so. The company has never had to use redundancy to manage its workforce. 65 9781398308114.indb 65 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2 Human resource management 2.2 AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation AS LEVEL Motivation Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the nature and importance of motivation as a management and leadership tool ★ the needs of employees while at work ★ some of the theories of motivation that can be applied in the workplace ★ the practical methods of motivation used by businesses, both financial and non-financial. 2.2.1 Motivation as a tool for management and leadership There are two ways we can think about motivation at work and what causes it: » Motivation can be the will to work due to enjoyment of the work itself. This implies that motivation comes from within an individual employee. » An alternative view is that it is the will or desire to achieve a given target or goal that is the result of external factors, such as the promise of a reward, or to avoid the threat of punishment. The first of these views assumes that motivation lies within the individual employee and the second assumes that it is the result of some external factor. People in the workplace have differing views on the sources of motivation. A survey revealed that nearly 90 per cent of employers believe that money is the main motivator, while employees rank pay fourth, behind an interesting job, security and achievement. This distinction is an important one, and you should remember it when considering theories of motivation and how, in practice, leaders and managers can motivate other people. Whatever causes it, motivation is an important factor for all businesses. Having a well-motivated workforce is vital to assist all businesses in achieving their objectives. Organisations whose workforces possess high levels of motivation tend to show the following characteristics: » a low level of absenteeism by employees at all levels within the business » relatively few employees deciding to leave the organisation, giving a low level of labour turnover » good relations between managers and other employees » high levels of labour productivity from the workforce. A business that enjoys the benefits of a highly motivated workforce is also likely to have a productive workforce. Low production costs offer firms two opportunities: » to sell their products more cheaply » to maintain price levels and enjoy greater profits. Thus, well-motivated workforces offer managers and leaders the means to achieve a range of common business objectives, including those below. » Growth High levels of labour productivity and low labour turnover will support businesses in increasing the volume of sales by providing increased output cost-effectively. » Higher profits Having well-motivated and very productive employees assists businesses in producing products more cheaply per unit. This is an important means of increasing profits. GLOSSARY TERMS Motivation describes the factors that arouse, maintain and channel behaviour towards a goal. Absenteeism describes a situation in which an employee is absent from work without a good reason. Human needs can be defined as the elements required for survival and good mental and physical health. 2.2.2 Human needs Fundamental human needs are relatively few and finite. They are likely to be similar – or the same – for all countries and cultures and to change little over time. A list of human needs is likely to include the following: » physical needs. For example, having enough income to meet essential needs e.g. food, drink and shelter » safety needs e.g. job security, contract of employment, reduced uncertainty, health and safety policies, and good working conditions » social needs e.g. team or group working, good communication and involvement » esteem needs e.g. recognition, status, responsibility, respect and feedback on performance » self-actualisation needs e.g. fulfilment of potential, challenging work, sense of achievement and development of new skills. 66 9781398308114.indb 66 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 2.2 Al Rashed International Shipping Company on the quality of its staff. The company aims to have an effective workforce and has carefully thought-through systems of recruitment and selection, as well as training. The company has strict policies to avoid any discrimination and encourages teamworking. The company was established in 1911 and is currently a major player in shipping markets in the Persian Gulf. It supplies a range of services including ocean freight, international air freight and land transport both domestically and internationally. Training is organised by each department within the business. Training focuses heavily on communication and customer service. The company responds quickly and positively to any customer complaints. In its vision statement, the company says that it is ‘committed to consistently deliver extraordinary value to our customers and stakeholders through the building of passionate, empowered teams [of employees]’. Ravi Varrier is Al Rashed’s chief executive officer (CEO). He has worked for the company for more than 30 years and believes that the company’s success has been based How human needs may or may not be satisfied at work Employment does offer the possibility of satisfying some, but possibly not all, of these human needs. The following needs could be met through employment, but this may not always be the case. » Subsistence Employment can provide an income sufficient to allow people to have shelter, food and clothes so that their lives are not threatened by the lack of these basic items. However, this need is only met if employees have an employment contract that offers them regular and sufficient hours of work to meet their basic needs. » Protection Work can satisfy this need in a number of ways. A permanent employment contract may provide the security of knowing that the income from employment will be received for the foreseeable future. Some forms of employment also provide health care and pensions to give employees an income in old age. However, many forms of employment do not offer much in the way of protection. Some employees have no guaranteed hours of work and no pensions. » Participation This can be achieved through working in teams, from teams of shop assistants through to membership of the board of directors of a large public company. Participation can also take the form of responsibilities within an organisation. 2.2.2 Human needs The Kuwait-based Al Rashed International Shipping Company trades in international markets and has benefited from high rates of recent sales growth and is planning further growth. The company depends on highly motivated staff to achieve its ambitious expansion plans. Source: https://al-rashedgroup.com/handbook/ Questions 1 2 Explain two ways in which having highly motivated employees might offer advantages to the shareholders of the Al Rashed International Shipping Company. [6] Evaluate the benefits that you think this company might gain from having a well-motivated workforce. [12] » Creation Many working environments offer opportunities for creativity and some may require this as an integral part of employment. Others may offer few opportunities. Working in advertising or architecture requires creativity but this can also be an important part of manual work, such as constructing houses. Creativity can take other forms, including developing teams and building brands. » Freedom Working in an organisation does offer surprising numbers of opportunities for freedom. In a democratically managed business, managers may empower employees. This gives them control over their working lives and a high degree of freedom not only to take decisions but to decide which decisions to take. It is important to remember that the extent to which this need may be met at work depends on the way that the business is managed. Some managers may opt to retain control and offer little freedom to more junior employees. Some other human needs may also be met through working. For example, many businesses provide leisure facilities for their employees, and it is not unusual for people to engage in leisure activities with their colleagues from work. However, this may not be the case for people such as farmers or lorry drivers who often work alone. 67 9781398308114.indb 67 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2.2 CASE STUDY Working at Google AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation Though Google has grown a lot since it opened in 1998, we still maintain a small-company feel. At lunchtime, almost everyone eats in the office café, sitting at whatever table has an opening and enjoying conversations with Googlers from different teams. Our commitment to innovation depends on everyone being comfortable with sharing ideas and opinions. Every employee is a hands-on contributor and everyone wears several hats. Because we believe that each Googler is an equally important part of our success, no one hesitates to pose questions directly to Larry or Sergey in our weekly all-hands (‘TGIF’) meetings – or throw a volleyball across the net at a corporate officer. Our corporate headquarters, fondly nicknamed the Googleplex, are located in Mountain View, California, USA. While our offices are not identical, they tend to share some essential elements. Here are a few things that you might see in a Google workspace: ● bicycles or scooters for efficient travel between meetings, dogs, lava lamps, massage chairs, large inflatable balls 2.2.3 Motivation theories Many different views exist on motivation, and they differ because it is not clear why people work. Is it to gain money, to enjoy social interaction with other humans, or to fulfil personal needs such as achievement and recognition? Or is it a combination of some or all of these? ● Googlers sharing cubes, yurts and huddle rooms – and very few single offices ● laptops everywhere – standard issue for mobile coding, emails on the go and note-taking ● foosball, pool tables, volleyball courts, assorted video games, pianos, ping-pong tables and gyms that offer yoga and dance classes ● grassroots employee groups for all interests, such as meditation, film, wine-tasting and salsa-dancing ● healthy lunches and dinners for all staff at a variety of cafés ● staff-rooms packed with a variety of snacks and drinks to keep Googlers going. Source: Adapted from www.google.co.uk Questions 1 2 Explain two ways in which the human needs of participation and creation may be met by working at Google. [6] Evaluate the extent to which human needs are met by working at Google. [12] examine the process of motivation and are concerned with ‘how’ motivation occurs. Vroom studied motivation from a process perspective. Motivation theories can be classified broadly into two different perspectives: content theories and process theories. Content theories consider ‘what’ motivates people and are concerned with individual needs and goals. Taylor, Mayo, Maslow, Herzberg and McClelland studied motivation from a content perspective. In contrast, process theories GLOSSARY TERMS Schools of thought are individuals and groups who hold similar views on a particular matter – in this case on what motivates employees. Piece-rate is a system whereby employees are paid according to the quantity of a product they produce. Division of labour is the breaking down of production into a series of small tasks, carried out repetitively by relatively unskilled employees. ▼ Table 2.5 Schools of thought for content theories of motivation School of thought Key writers Essential ideas Scientific school Frederick Winslow Taylor (1856–1917) Motivation is an external factor achieved through money. Employees should be closely supervised and paid piece-rate. Time and motion studies determine efficient means of production and workers are trained and told how to operate. Human relations school Elton Mayo (1880–1949) This brought sociological theory into management and accepted that employees could be motivated by meeting their social needs. More attention was given to the social dimension of work (e.g. communication, working as groups and consultation between managers and employees). The neo-human relations school of management Abraham Maslow (1908–70), Frederick Herzberg (1923– 2000) and David McClelland (1917–1998) This school highlighted the importance of fulfilling psychological needs to improve employee performance. Motivation, according to Maslow and Herzberg, depended upon designing jobs to fulfil psychological needs. 68 9781398308114.indb 68 05/03/21 11:07 AM Content theories of motivation The content theories of motivation can be divided into three schools of thought. These are set out in Table 2.5. The school of scientific management 1 Study the work process to determine the most efficient production methods 2 Observe and time the best workers in these methods Against this background, managers began to investigate ways of increasing employee motivation to improve competitiveness and employee satisfaction. Frederick Winslow Taylor was the most notable of these early writers on motivation and became known as ‘the father of scientific management’. 3 Train the remaining workers to the same standard Taylor’s theories were based on a simple interpretation of human behaviour, that people were motivated solely by money – his term was ‘rational man’. He combined this principle with a simple interpretation of the role of the manager: to operate the business with maximum efficiency. The key elements of Taylorism » The starting point of Taylor’s approach was work study. » » » » He measured and analysed the tasks necessary to complete the production process. He used a stopwatch to measure how long various activities took and sought the most efficient methods of completing tasks. He encouraged the use of the division of labour, breaking down production into small tasks. From this he identified the most efficient employees and the approaches they adopted. Using these as a basis, he then detailed ‘normal’ times in which duties should be completed and assessed individual performance against these norms. Employees were provided with the equipment necessary to carry out their tasks. This principle extended to giving stokers (men shovelling coal) a shovel of a size appropriate to their physique to maximise their efficiency. They were also given elementary training and clear instructions on their duties. Because, according to Taylor, employees were only motivated by money, the final stage of the system was to design and implement a piece-rate pay system. Under a piece-rate system, employees are paid according to the amount they produce. Taylor, however, developed differential piece-rate systems to encourage efficiency among employees. Taylor also believed in close supervision of the workforce to ensure that they continued to make the maximum effort possible, motivated by pay. Taylor’s views were unpopular with shop-floor employees. Shop-floor employees are those who work on production 2.2 2.2.3 Motivation theories Motivating workers became an important issue as the size of businesses increased in the late-nineteenth century. Managers developed the division of labour to its fullest extent in an attempt to increase efficiency and improve competitiveness. The introduction of mass-production methods, along with the use of division of labour, increased the numbers of people working in factories. At the same time, their tasks became monotonous. lines in factories and do not have any management or supervisory role. His systems forced them to work hard and, by raising productivity levels, placed the jobs of the less efficient workers under threat. Taylor’s approach raised efficiency and productivity, so businesses did not need as many employees. His ideas resulted in strikes and other forms of industrial action by dissatisfied workers. 4 Implement differential pay rates and close supervision to increase productivity ▲ Figure 2.8 The essential features of Taylorism Taylor’s legacy It is easy to dismiss Taylor and his ideas. His entire philosophy was based on the belief that employees were motivated only by money. He ignored any social dimension of employment and made employees work very hard for what was a meagre wage. His ideas resulted in workers endlessly completing monotonous tasks. There was considerable hostility towards his ideas and opposition from politicians and the business community. However, Taylor made a significant and enduring contribution to the management of business organisations. He established management as a scientific subject worthy of research and study. His approach was adopted by many premier figures in the business community in the early decades of the twentieth century, including Henry Ford. His techniques encouraged the use of mass production and the conveyor-belt system. Furthermore, his work provided a starting point for a later and more people-centred approach to management. STUDY TIP Avoid considering Taylor simply in negative terms. Certainly, many of his ideas would not be acceptable in modern businesses, but others (for example, simple piece-rate pay and work study) have endured. A balanced assessment of Taylor should take into account the lasting elements of his approach, as well as the shortcomings. 69 9781398308114.indb 69 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation 2.2 CASE STUDY Salary packages important for Indian employees A survey carried out by TJinsite, research division of TimesJobs.com, revealed that 77 per cent of employees in India judge salaries to be more important than the location of the job. However, the respondents rated salary and job status to be of equal importance, although financial rewards are considered important by most people taking part in the survey. The importance of pay varies between older and younger employees. Younger employees consider pay to be more important, while older workers tend to rate job status more highly. Employees in most industries in India rate salaries as important – there was minimal variation between different industries. Respondents said that factors such as job titles, location and status are significant, but an attractive salary is always a critical factor in persuading employees to apply for jobs. Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why salaries are an important [6] element for younger people in choosing jobs. Evaluate other possible situations in which salary might be considered very important by employees. [12] The human relations school The implications of the ‘Hawthorne effect’ A fundamental weakness of the scientific school was that it ignored the social needs of employees. This, and the obvious unpopularity of the ideas of Taylor, led to the development of the human relations school. This school of thought concentrated on the sociological aspects of work, and its foremost member was an Australian-born psychologist, Elton Mayo (1880–1949). Initially, Mayo was one of Taylor’s disciples, believing in the importance of scientific management to business efficiency. Following the publication of Mayo’s findings, managers gradually became more aware of the importance of meeting the social needs of individuals at work. Social environments at work and informal working groups were recognised as having positive influences upon productivity. The acceptance of Mayo’s views led to a number of developments in businesses during the 1940s and 1950s, many of which remain today. » Personnel departments were established to ensure that employees’ social needs were met at work wherever possible. » Employees were provided with a range of sporting and social facilities to foster the development of informal groups among employees. » Works outings and trips became a familiar part of an employee’s year (for example, multinational retailer Marks and Spencer organises short-break weekends for its employees). » Managers gave more attention to teams and teamworking. The Hawthorne effect Mayo’s views altered as a result of research he conducted at the Western Electric Company in Chicago. The research was to examine the effects of changes in lighting on the productivity of workers at the company’s Hawthorne plant. Previous experiments on lighting and productivity had produced unexpected results. Researchers had anticipated that improving lighting would increase productivity because giving workers better working conditions would allow them to work harder and earn more money. They were astonished when productivity increased not only in the group who were given improved lighting but also among a group whose lighting had not changed. It became apparent that the employees were responding to the level of attention they were receiving as part of the investigations and because they were working together as a group. This became known as the ‘Hawthorne effect’. As a result of this and similar experiments, Mayo stressed the importance of ‘social man’ within the workplace. From these experiments, Mayo concluded that motivation was dependent upon: » the type of job being carried out and the type of supervision given to the employee » group relationships, group morale and the sense of worth experienced by individuals. Mayo’s recognition of the importance of teamworking is perhaps his most enduring testimony. Many firms have organised their workforce into teams; for example, the Japanese electronics manufacturer, Toshiba. Mayo’s work took management forward in general and motivation in particular. He moved the focus onto the needs of employees, rather than just on the needs of the organisation. STUDY TIP Don’t just think of Mayo in terms of communicating with bosses, and his emphasis on social and sporting facilities. This is only part of his work. He advocated the benefits to employers and employees of working in teams: this aspect of his work is an important issue within many businesses today. 70 9781398308114.indb 70 05/03/21 11:07 AM The neo-human relations school This could also be called the new human relations school. Abraham Maslow, Frederick Herzberg and David McClelland are key members of this particular school and began to put forward their views in the 1950s. The neo-human relations school considered the psychological aspects of employment and argued that motivation lies within each individual employee; managers merely need the key to unlock the motivational force. By focusing on the psychological needs of employees, Maslow, Herzberg and McClelland encouraged managers to treat their employees as individuals, with different needs and aspirations. Their work emphasised that, because people are different, the techniques required to motivate individuals will also differ. Motivating accountancy graduates Respondents to an internet survey have judged training and development of skills to be more important than salary, according to a survey by accountants Ernst and Young. Most of the 1051 respondents were accountancy graduates with additional experience in the industry. The key elements of the survey were: ● Approximately 44 per cent rated training as the most important factor attracting them to a job. ● A mere 18 per cent of respondents placed salary and benefits as the most important factor. ● The reputation of the business was judged most important by 12 per cent and 8 per cent identified the business’ culture as the vital factor. Questions 1 Explain two ways in which employees may be motivated by pay. [6] Evaluate whether the results of this survey show that pay as a motivator is outdated and irrelevant for today’s employees. [12] 2 2.2.3 Motivation theories CASE STUDY 2.2 Maslow’s hierarchy of needs In 1954, Maslow published his ‘hierarchy of needs’, setting out the various needs that, he argued, everyone attempted to meet through working. Maslow presented his hierarchy of needs as a triangle with basic needs shown at the bottom and his so-called higher needs towards the top (see Figure 2.9). GLOSSARY TERM The hierarchy of needs is a theory that employees have successive requirements that can be fulfilled through work. 5 Selfactualisation e.g. fulfilling potential 4 Esteem needs e.g. recognition and achievement Higher needs 3 Social needs e.g. relationships with fellow employees 2 Security needs e.g. employment contract, safe working conditions Basic needs 1 Physiological needs e.g. food, drink, shelter ▲ Figure 2.9 Maslow’s hierarchy of needs 71 9781398308114.indb 71 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2.2 Abraham Maslow established five levels of human needs that can be satisfied through work. Maslow’s argument was a relatively simple one. Employees, he argued, have a series of needs they seek to fulfil at work. These are in a hierarchy – once a lower level need is satisfied, individuals strive to satisfy needs further up the hierarchy. AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation The key point of Maslow’s argument was that a business could motivate its employees by offering them the chance to fulfil a higher level of need once a lower one was satisfied (see Table 2.6). So once an employee’s basic needs had been met, perhaps through a system of fair pay, they could be motivated further by the offer of secure and continuing employment. Similarly, a worker whose social needs were met through employment could next be motivated by the opportunity to satisfy self-esteem needs. This could be achieved by taking responsibility for a major project, offering the chance of achievement and recognition. ▼ Table 2.6 An explanation of Maslow’s hierarchy of needs Maslow’s level of need 1 Physiological needs 2 Security needs 3 Social needs 4 Esteem needs 5 Self-actualisation Examples Means of satisfying needs Food, water, shelter, clothing Through pay and a warm and dry working environment A safe and secure working environment for employees Implementing a proper health and safety policy, providing employees with employment contracts Contact and friendships with other employees Social and sporting facilities, opportunities to work in groups Achievement, recognition and self-respect Delegating authority to junior employees, offering promotion opportunities To fulfil one’s potential completely Providing opportunities to take new responsibilities and to develop new skills Maslow’s theory was attractive to managers from the outset. It offered a more individualistic approach to motivating employees, recognising that not all people are the same. Managers had long realised that what motivated one person would not necessarily motivate another. Maslow’s theory offered an explanation and an alternative approach for managers. Frederick Herzberg’s two-factor theory Herzberg’s two-factor theory was the result of a study designed to test the view that people face two major sets of influences at work. Herzberg’s resulting theory was based on the results to questions asked of 200 accountants and engineers in the USA. Herzberg’s motivators – these satisfiers relate to the job itself and can create positive motivation Personal achievement Potential to satisfy Recognition Interest in the work itself MOST IMPORTANT Responsibility Growth and advancement LEAST IMPORTANT Relationship with fellow workers Company policy and administration Working conditions Salary Supervision Potential to dissatisfy Herzberg’s hygiene factors – these relate to the job environment and have the potential to dissatisfy ▲ Figure 2.10 Herzberg’s hygiene and motivational factors 72 9781398308114.indb 72 05/03/21 11:07 AM Herzberg’s crucial finding was that hygiene factors do not lead to motivation, but without them employees may become dissatisfied. So, according to Herzberg, an employee cannot be motivated by pay, but they might be dissatisfied by inadequate financial rewards. Hygiene factors were so named because Herzberg believed attention to them would prevent hygiene problems. It is important to note that Herzberg’s research classified pay as a hygiene factor and, therefore, as unable to motivate. The second finding of Herzberg’s research established those factors with the ability to motivate – the motivators. These factors relate to the job itself and can be used to positively motivate employees. He identified the following factors as motivators: » personal achievement of goals and targets » recognition for achievement » interest in the work itself » responsibility for greater and more complex duties » personal growth and advancement. Herzberg believed that these approaches (hygiene and motivation) must be used simultaneously. Employees should be managed so they have a minimum of dissatisfaction. They should get achievement, recognition for achievement, take interest in their work and be given responsibility to allow them to grow and develop within their work. GLOSSARY TERMS 2.2 2.2.3 Motivation theories The first part of Herzberg’s motivation theory is related to the environment of the job. He identified a range of factors that shaped the environment in which people work; he called these influences hygiene or maintenance factors. These factors are all around the job but are not a part of the job itself. Herzberg’s research identified a number of hygiene factors, including the following: » company policy and administration » supervision of employees » working conditions » salary » relationship with fellow workers (at the same level). Hygiene factors (also called maintenance factors) are a group of influences that may result in employee dissatisfaction at work. Motivators are a series of factors, such as promotion, that may have positive influences on employee performance at work. CASE STUDY Frederick Herzberg Frederick Herzberg was born in Massachusetts in the USA in 1923. He attended City College, New York, before enlisting in the army. During his military service, he witnessed the survivors at Dachau concentration camp. Herzberg gained a PhD in Psychology at the University of Pittsburg and began to turn his attention to business management. He became Professor of Management at Case Western Reserve University, where he established the Department of Mental Health. In 1972 he joined the University of Utah’s College of Business. Herzberg developed a reputation as one of the most influential thinkers on people at work and employee motivation. He combined his deep knowledge of employee psychology with a series of practical experiments in the workplace. His book Work and the Nature of Man (1966) was voted one of the ten most important books on management theory and practice in the twentieth century. He died in January 2000. Questions 1 2 Using examples, explain two differences between Herzberg’s motivators and hygiene factors. [6] Evaluate the possible reasons why a book on employee motivation was voted one the twentieth century’s most important management books. [12] ▲ Figure 2.11 Frederick Herzberg 73 9781398308114.indb 73 05/03/21 11:07 AM ▼ Table 2.7 Herzberg and Maslow compared AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation 2.2 Maslow Herzberg Motivation factors (higher needs) • Self-actualisation needs • Esteem needs (higher needs) Maintenance factors (lower needs) • Social needs • Security needs • Physiological needs (mainly lower needs) • • • • • • • • • Both Maslow’s and Herzberg’s theories have the major advantage in that they were not simply theoretical writings – practical implications for management were within the theories. Both authors encouraged managers to utilise their employees’ abilities by giving them challenging tasks. Weaknesses do exist within these theories, of course. Herzberg’s assertion that pay cannot be used to motivate might be true of many employees in wealthy, developed economies. However, this may not be the case with workers in poorer, developing countries. Equally, Maslow’s theory is based upon a hierarchy and the assumption that individuals move from one level to the next. His work has been criticised on the grounds that people do not move through these needs in the same order. It also assumes that, once a need is fulfilled, it loses its power to motivate. This may not be the case, especially with the higher needs. STUDY TIP Many answers to questions on motivation receive low grades because students do not apply their knowledge to the scenario in the question. Ensure that you do not simply explain relevant theories – you must apply them to the scenario. David McClelland’s theory of needs The American writer David McClelland was also a part of the neo-human relations school of thought. He is perhaps best known for his work on achievement motivation. In his acquired needs theory, McClelland argued that an individual’s motivation depends upon their needs and that these needs are determined by the individual’s experience. McClelland identified three types of motivational need: » achievement motivation (n-ach) » authority/power motivation (n-pow) » affiliation motivation (n-affil). McClelland believed that these three needs exist, to differing extents, in all employees, irrespective of their role or status within the business. McClelland’s work emphasised that the combination of these three needs determines: Achievement Recognition Responsibility Interest in work Personal growth Company policy and administration Supervision Working conditions Relationship with fellow workers » each employee’s behaviour in terms of what motivates them » how they manage and motivate other employees. The need for achievement People who have a high need for achievement (n-ach) aim for excellence. This means that they are likely to avoid low-risk situations as they derive little satisfaction from meeting targets that are not challenging. Equally, they tend to avoid high-risk situations as they fear not achieving. Therefore, this type of person aims to attain realistic but challenging goals – ideally those in which they have a 50 per cent chance of success. This type of employee has a strong need for feedback on achievement and progress, and they have a need for a sense of accomplishment. The need for authority and power A need for power (n-pow) can fall into one of two categories: » a need for personal power and to direct or control other employees – this is a need which may be considered undesirable » a need for institutional power – this is a need to organise other employees to attain the organisation’s objectives. Managers and leaders with a need for institutional power are likely to contribute more to a business enterprise than someone whose need for power is a personal one. The employee with a need for authority and power wants to have an effect on an organisation and to have some degree of control. They may also want to have more status within the organisation. The need for affiliation Employees who have a need for affiliation (n-aff) generally seek harmonious relationships with other people in the organisation. They need to feel accepted and are motivated to work with other people. This type of employee works well as a member of a team and enjoys social interaction. Employees who are motivated by the need for affiliation often work successfully and effectively in marketing, sales and customer service. 74 9781398308114.indb 74 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 2.2 Motivating generation Y employees The Bank’s executive vice-president for HR management, Latifa Pini, commented: ‘This bank is very serious about management of our generation Y employees (those born after about 1983) since they are certainly going to be our future senior managers. If we don’t understand them then it will be difficult to make the bank as successful as it might be.’ She continued to argue that generation Y employees dislike being forced or ordered to do something, while employees born between 1946 and 1964 (called baby boomers) prefer to be in control and want others to follow them. The implications of McClelland’s work McClelland’s work has clear implications for leaders and managers. The principle is that employees with different needs require different roles and tasks if they are to be motivated effectively. » An employee with a high need for achievement Such employees should be given tasks which are demanding but which can be reasonably expected to be achieved. Such employees require regular feedback, especially of a positive nature. » An employee with a high need for authority and power This type of employee is most likely to flourish and perform well when controlling others. For a junior employee this could be a supervisory role, while more senior employees may fulfil this need by managing large teams of employees. » An employee with a high need for affiliation Working as part of a team, especially a co-operative one, is likely to allow employees to meet their needs for affiliation. Equally, this type of employee is likely to perform best when interacting with other employees, and they should be provided with opportunities to do this whenever possible. Process theories of motivation Process theories of motivation look at what people are thinking about when they decide whether or not to put effort into a particular activity. Examples of such theories include expectancy and equity theories. They try to capture the process that employees go through when making choices with goals in mind. Unlike the other theories of motivation we have considered, they see the individual as an active decisionmaker, rather than trying (in the case of the neo-human relations school) to meet certain needs. Process theories emphasise the actual process (or method) of motivation. There are a number of process theories of motivation, but we shall just consider the one developed by Victor Vroom. Latifa Pini argued that generation Y employees perform most effectively if given challenging work, rewards related to performance and direct instructions. ‘Give them challenging work, and if they achieve something, then recognise them for that achievement. It does not have to be a financial reward but something that will make them feel proud to be part of the team and organisation,’ Pini concluded. 2.2.3 Motivation theories The Moresby Bank Ltd is based in Papua New Guinea and provides a range of banking services. It is relatively small with only 2850 employees. Despite this it experiences problems with its labour turnover rates, particularly among junior employees. In 2020, the Bank suffered an average labour turnover rate of 23 per cent, while the figure for junior employees reached 34 per cent. Questions 1 2 Explain two differences between the need for power and the need for achievement in McClelland’s [6] theory. Evaluate the extent to which McClelland’s explanation of the differing behaviour of the older and younger employees at Moresby Bank Ltd is the only valid one. [12] Victor Vroom’s expectancy theory This theory, developed by Vroom in the early 1960s, argues that motivation depends on employees’ expectations of the results of their efforts. If employees know what they want from an outcome and believe they can achieve that particular outcome, they will be motivated. In brief, Vroom’s theory argues that the behaviour of individuals is such as to maximise pleasure and to minimise pain in whatever form it may occur. Vroom’s model consists of three major elements, as illustrated in Figure 2.12. Expectancy Expectancy leads to Performance Instrumentality leads to Outcome (reward) Valence Personal objectives ▲ Figure 2.12 Victor Vroom’s expectancy theory » Expectancy This refers to the confidence that employees may have in their ability to complete a particular activity or task to an acceptable standard. Demotivation will result if an employee believes that they are not capable of completing the task in question satisfactorily. » Instrumentality This is the belief of employees that the completion of a particular activity will lead to a desired outcome. In a situation of high instrumentality, the employee has confidence that specific activities 75 9781398308114.indb 75 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation 2.2 will result in the achievement of a valued reward. Instrumentality will be greater if employees recognise a clear link between actions and rewards and have confidence that they will receive the promised rewards for achieving their targets. » Valence This represents the strength of a person’s desire to achieve a specific outcome. Valence is positive if a person prefers the outcome to not achieving it. If the person is indifferent to the outcome then the valence will be zero. High values of valence mean that an outcome is highly attractive to employees and has great potential to motivate. In such circumstances, managers can use the possibility of attaining this outcome as a means of motivation. For example, a salesperson may find the prospect of a monetary bonus for achieving an agreed sales target very desirable. The salesperson must have confidence in their ability to achieve the number of sales necessary to receive the bonus. 2.2.4 Motivation methods in practice The theories in practical situations Reading the various theories of motivation, it can appear that there are a number of straightforward methods of motivating employees. However, in practice this is not necessarily the case. Managers may lack the resources or knowledge to be able to apply these theories in the workplace. For example, a business may not have sufficient financial resources to be able to increase pay or offer promotions as a means of motivating workers. Furthermore, workforces are increasingly likely to contain diverse employees who may be motivated by different factors. This can make the task of improving levels of motivation more difficult for a manager in a modern business. Energage (a research and consulting firm based in Philadelphia) has conducted research into employee motivation in the USA. It surveyed more than 20 million employees working for 60 000 businesses between 2004 and 2020. Across all sectors and populations within the USA, appreciation of employees’ efforts is ranked among the most important drivers of motivation, according to this survey. Appreciation can take many forms, such as financial rewards or praise, and is part of many of the theories we have studied. This research suggests that in the workplace, elements of many of the theories we have covered can be very effective in increasing levels of motivation. It also suggests that there are relatively simple ways to improve employee motivation. Financial motivators Managers and organisations use a variety of pay systems in an attempt to improve the performance of their workforce. Despite attention given to the views of Herzberg, which suggest that monetary methods of motivation are of limited value, pay remains a major incentive. ▼ Table 2.8 Opinions on the motivational powers of pay Writer Opinions on the motivational power of pay Frederick Taylor Taylor saw pay as the primary motivating factor for all workers. He referred to workers as ‘economic animals’ and supported the use of piece-rate. Abraham Maslow He saw pay as a reward which permitted employees to meet the lower needs on their hierarchy. Frederick Herzberg Herzberg saw pay as a hygiene factor and a possible cause of dissatisfaction. In a few circumstances pay might be a motivator if, for example, it is used as a recognition for merit. Time-based pay Some employees receive payments based on the number of hours that they work each week or month. Their income is based on an hourly rate of pay. Thus an employee may be paid $11 an hour. If the employee works 36 hours in a particular week, they will receive gross pay amounting to $396 ($11 × 36 hours). This payment system has the advantages of being simple to understand and transparent. Many countries across the world have minimum-wage laws based on specific hourly rates of pay which can be increased over time to compensate for inflation. However, time-based pay can result in employees becoming clock-watchers and not being prepared to carry out any duties outside the hours for which they are paid. Salaries and wages Most employees receive their payment in the form of salaries or wages. Salaries are expressed in annual terms (for example, a production manager might be paid a salary of $30 000 per year) and are normally paid monthly. Salaried employees are not normally required to work a set number of hours per week, though their employment contract may state a minimum number of hours. On the other hand, wages are usually paid weekly and employees are required to be at work for a specified number of hours. Employees on wages are normally paid a higher rate (known as overtime) for any additional hours worked. Piece-rate Under this pay system, employees are paid according to the quantity they produce – a form of payment by results. Thus, an employee on a production line might receive an agreed amount for each unit of production they manufacture. Piece-rate is common in a number of industries including textiles, electronics and agriculture. 76 9781398308114.indb 76 05/03/21 11:07 AM Piece-rate offers businesses a number of advantages and disadvantages. The introduction of piece-rate pay can increase the productivity levels achieved by many employees within a business. This can effectively reduce the business’ labour costs for each unit of output that is produced. However, this rise in productivity may be at the expense of quality and customer complaints may increase. A business using piece-rate may lose customers as a consequence of its introduction, especially if quality is an important factor in customers’ buying decisions. Bonuses are additions to pay that are linked to individual or team performance measured against targets or objective criteria. Employers introduce bonus payments to reward individuals for doing well. By definition, a bonus payment is an extra and not part of basic pay. Bonuses can be paid to employees in different industries and at different levels in an organisation. Some examples are: » profit-related bonus, for example, to a manager in a retail organisation » performance bonus payments to senior managers or directors or investment bankers » bonus payments for reaching production targets in manufacturing. Commission, like piece-rate, is the payment for the quantity (or value) that is produced by an individual employee. In some industries, such as telesales, an employee’s entire income may be made up of commission, although it may have to meet any conditions imposed by minimum-pay laws. Employees can be paid a percentage of the value of any products they sell as commission. This form of payment has similar advantages and disadvantages to piece-rate. However, in many countries it has become less common. One explanation for this may be that its disadvantages outweigh its advantages. Profit sharing Profit sharing is a reward system under which employees receive some part of the business’ profits. This is a type of performance-related pay (see opposite) but not one which discriminates between the performances of individual employees. Such payments, which may vary according to the employee’s seniority within the organisation, are separate from, and additional to, regular earnings. Profits are paid to employees in the form of cash or company shares. Profit-sharing schemes can improve an employee’s loyalty to the business by breaking down the ‘us and them’ attitude. Under profit-sharing schemes, a greater level of profit is regarded as being of benefit to all employees, not just to senior managers. Employees may be more willing to accept changes designed to improve the business’ profitability. The danger with profit-sharing schemes is that they can provide rewards that are too small to represent a worthwhile payment for employees. On the other hand, if they are too generous, the business may lack sufficient funds for capital investment. 2.2 Performance-related pay (PRP) exists where some part of an employee’s pay is linked to the achievement of targets at work. These targets might include sales figures or achieving certain grades in an annual appraisal. Variable pay is a reward for working that is based on employee performance or results judged against some targets. Performance-related pay Performance-related pay (or PRP) has become more widely used over recent years and has developed along with employee appraisal systems. PRP is only paid to those employees who meet or exceed some agreed targets. Under PRP, employees are paid for their contribution to the organisation, rather than their status within it. Businesses of all sizes throughout the world have introduced PRP. It is widely used in Hong Kong and Japan, with Nissan as a prime example. Despite criticisms, PRP remains popular, and many employees support linking some element of pay to performance. However, there have been criticisms of the huge rewards paid to some senior managers and directors of moderately successful companies. 2.2.4 Motivation methods in practice Bonuses and commission GLOSSARY TERMS Criticisms of PRP A number of other criticisms of performance-related pay have been put forward: » Many employees perceive PRP as fundamentally unfair. This is particularly true of those working in the services sector, where individual employee performance is difficult to measure. » Employees fear that they might be discriminated against because they do not get on with the manager who makes a decision on their performance. This can result in their performance worsening, not improving. » A majority of businesses operating PRP systems do not put sufficient funds into the scheme. Typically, the operation of a PRP scheme adds 3–4 per cent to a business’ wage bill. This only allows employees to enjoy relatively small performance awards, which may be inadequate to change employee performance. Developments in PRP Increasing numbers of businesses are implementing a system known as variable pay. Some managers argue that a business’ performance often depends upon the achievements of the few. Variable pay is really a development of PRP. It is similar in that it rewards employee performance, but there are differences. PRP operates according to a formula used throughout the company. Variable pay is far more flexible and the potential rewards for star employees are greater. If the business performs well, employees benefit under variable pay, but they can suffer financial penalties in a less successful period. 77 9781398308114.indb 77 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation 2.2 Some managers remain unconvinced of the value of PRP, no matter how sophisticated the scheme. The widespread use of PRP may, in part, be an attempt by managers to keep pay rates down for the majority of employees. PRP, or variable pay, treats employees as individuals, limiting the ability of trade unions to bargain collectively. Targets set. These are agreed between employee and line manager. May take the form of sales targets, level of customer satisfaction, etc. Pay decision made. Those meeting all performance targets fully might receive 5% extra. Least effective performers may receive 0%. Fringe benefits Fringe benefits (sometimes referred to as perks) are those extras that an employee receives as part of their reward package. Examples include: » a company car (or a mileage allowance for an employee’s own car) » private health insurance » employers’ contributions to pension schemes » discounts for company products. Firms tend to use fringe benefits to encourage employee loyalty and to reduce the number of employees leaving the firm. A danger of the widespread use of fringe benefits is that costs can increase quickly, reducing profitability. STUDY TIP Evidence collected on employee performance through, for example, observation of employee at work. Remember that PRP remains a highly topical and controversial issue. While there are a number of arguments in favour of it, a central weakness remains. This can be explained in terms of the theory we covered earlier. Writers such as Maslow and Herzberg argued that money has limited power to motivate employees. PRP, no matter how it is implemented, has more in common with Frederick Taylor’s views of motivating employees. ▲ Figure 2.13 The operation of a typical performancerelated pay system CASE STUDY Profit-sharing at Ford Ford is one of the world’s best-known manufacturers of cars and other vehicles. In 2019, the company’s profits were just $47 million, a very heavy fall compared with 2018. The company said that the decline was due to a range of operational reasons including unexpected costs associated with the launch of Explorer, a new model of car. The fall in profits led to a reduction in the company’s profit-sharing payments to its employees. The company revealed that these would be 13 per cent lower: $6600 per employee, compared to $7600 in the previous year. Ford does not pay profit shares to all of its hourly paid employees. Some other vehicle manufacturers will pay their employees larger sums as profit-sharing bonuses. Employees at GM will be paid $8000 and employees at the lorry manufacturer FCA will receive $7280. Tim Stone, Ford’s chief financial officer, expressed optimism about the company’s prospects for 2020, while acknowledging that ‘results were not OK in 2019’. Source: https://eu.freep.com/story/money/cars/ford/2020/02/04/ ford-profit-sharing-2020-checks-bonus/4644019002/ Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why Ford might expect its profitsharing scheme to improve the performance of its workforce. [6] Evaluate the possible problems Ford faces in operating its profit-sharing scheme. [12] GLOSSARY TERMS Fringe benefits (or perks) are those extras an employee receives as part of their reward package. Job enlargement is giving employees more duties of a similar level of complexity. Also called horizontal loading. Job redesign means changing the group of tasks or duties which make up a specific job. Job rotation is the regular switching of employees between tasks of a similar degree of complexity. Job enrichment occurs when employees’ jobs are redesigned to provide them with more challenging and complex tasks. Also called vertical loading. Empowerment is a series of actions designed to give employees greater control over their working lives. 78 9781398308114.indb 78 05/03/21 11:07 AM The main methods of non-monetary motivation attempt to incorporate some of these features into the working lives of employees. Job redesign Employers can change the design of employees’ jobs to encompass more or different duties, or duties that are more challenging. Job enrichment occurs when employees’ jobs are redesigned to provide them with more challenging and complex tasks. This process, also called vertical loading, is designed to use all employees’ abilities. The intention is to enrich the employee’s experience of work. Frederick Herzberg was a strong supporter of job enrichment. He believed that enrichment provided employees with motivators that increased the satisfaction they might get from working. Job enrichment normally involves a number of elements: » redesigning jobs so as to increase not just the range of tasks but the complexity of them » giving employees greater responsibility for managing themselves » offering employees the authority to identify and solve problems relating to their work » providing employees with the training and skills essential to allow them to carry out their enriched jobs effectively. Job enrichment involves a high degree of skill on the part of the managers overseeing it. They must ensure that they do not ask employees to carry out duties of which they are not capable. Job enlargement does not increase the complexity of tasks carried out by an employee; instead it increases the number of similar duties. It is also termed horizontal loading. A number of firms operating a policy of job enlargement simply require employees to carry out a number of similar tasks. Thus, a receptionist might be asked to carry out a number of duties in addition to dealing with telephone and personal enquiries from customers. The receptionist may also be asked to maintain records of petty cash and update customer records, for example. Job enlargement offers benefits to the employee in that carrying out a range of duties, rather than a single one repeatedly, may stimulate their interest. The business gains Job rotation is a particular type of job enlargement. Under this system employees switch regularly from one duty to another. Thus, a supermarket may require employees to spend one week on the checkout, one week stacking shelves and one week dealing with customer enquiries. Job rotation may reduce the level of monotony, but it does not increase the challenge of the job. Job enrichment Increasing the complexity of tasks carried out by an employee or a group of employees Job enlargement Increasing the number of tasks of a similar level of complexity Extent of tasks 2.2 2.2.4 Motivation methods in practice Many non-monetary methods of motivation tend to focus upon the design of employees’ jobs. Employees can be motivated by asking them to do a job that is challenging and interesting. A good job should have at least a number of the features listed below. » Employees carry out duties that result in a definite end product. » Clear and challenging goals give employees something to aim at. Goals should be demanding but not unattainable. » Employees should be able to identify easily their contributions to the organisation. » Jobs should be designed so that employees are involved in planning their own schedules of work, choosing their work methods and coping with problems as they arise. an advantage from having an employee able to carry out a wider range of duties, possibly reducing its labour costs. Complexity of tasks Non-financial motivators ▲ Figure 2.14 Job redesign: job enrichment and job enlargement Employee empowerment Empowerment involves redesigning employees’ jobs to allow them greater control over their working lives. Empowerment gives employees the opportunity to decide how to carry out their duties and how to organise their work. Empowerment can make work more interesting as it offers opportunities to meet a number of individual needs. Empowered workers can propose and implement new methods of working as they bring a new perspective to decision-making. They may spend a part of their working lives considering the problems they face and proposing solutions. Empowerment would receive the approval of Maslow and Herzberg. It provides motivators, as well as offering employees the opportunity to fulfil higher needs. Employees require training if they are to be empowered. They are unlikely to have the skills necessary to schedule tasks, solve problems, recruit new employees and introduce new working practices. It takes time to implement empowerment and teething problems are common. Teamworking Teamworking exists when an organisation breaks down its production processes into large units instead of relying upon the use of the division of labour. Teams are then given responsibility for completing the large units of work. Team members carry out a variety of duties including planning, problem-solving and target-setting. A number of different team types operate within businesses: 79 9781398308114.indb 79 05/03/21 11:07 AM » Production teams Many production lines have been AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation 2.2 organised into distinct elements called ‘cells’. Each of these cells is staffed by teams whose members are multiskilled. They monitor product quality and ensure that production targets are met. » Quality circle teams These are small teams designed to propose solutions to existing problems and to suggest improvements in production methods. The teams contain members drawn from all levels within the organisation. » Management teams Increasingly, managers see themselves as complementary teams, establishing the organisation’s objectives and overseeing their achievement. There has been a major trend in businesses towards teamworking over recent years. Teamworking is a major part of the so-called Japanese approach to production and its benefits have been extolled by major companies, such as Honda. Teamworking offers employees the opportunity to meet their social needs, as identified by Maslow; Herzberg identified relationships with fellow workers as a hygiene factor and McClelland noted that some employees have a high need for affiliation. However, much of the motivational force arising from teamworking comes with the change in job design that usually accompanies it. Teamworking requires jobs to be redesigned, offering employees the chance to fulfil some of the higher needs identified by Maslow, such as esteem needs. Similarly, teamworking offers some of the motivators; for example, achievement. Training and development Some businesses invest heavily in training and development, often regarding it as a core element of managing their workforces successfully. Managers value training because they believe it improves employee motivation and performance. They believe that training helps to motivate employees because they feel valued by the business and this fulfils what Maslow would have called their esteem needs. However, training has drawbacks as a technique of motivation. It can be very expensive, especially if it takes place away from the workplace, and it may not be the most cost-effective method of motivating employees. A further danger is that employees may leave once they have acquired new skills and higher levels of motivation, attracted by higher pay elsewhere. Employees may receive induction training when starting a new job. This type of training is intended to introduce a new employee to their job and working environment. Induction training can give employees confidence in their ability to do a job from the outset and this confidence may boost their motivation and performance in the workplace. Employee participation Employee participation is the involvement of employees in the process of decision-making within a business, possibly through the appointment of worker directors. Many businesses recognise the motivational and other benefits of involving employees in decision-making within an organisation. We consider employee participation more fully below. GLOSSARY TERMS Job design is the process of grouping together individual tasks to form complete jobs. Employee participation is the involvement of employees in the process of decision-making within a business. Promotion and status Promoting an employee to a more senior position within the business is likely to prove motivational. Organisations that offer clear paths for promotion are likely to have more motivated employees, as promotion brings a number of benefits including financial rewards, more opportunities for taking responsibility, and recognition. Employees in such organisations will be more able to identify a career path and would be expected to be more motivated and committed to achieving advancement. Herzberg recognised that many employees needed opportunities for advancement. McClelland identified a group of employees with high needs for authority and power. Both writers acknowledged that having clearly defined routes for progression up the organisational structure can be an effective means of meeting these needs and can motivate employees and improve their performance at work. If employees believe that their employer offers no prospects for advancement, they may seek alternative employment. This can reduce a business’ retention rates and increase its costs, including those for recruitment and training. Businesses can gain a competitive advantage by establishing and publicising clear promotion paths for employees. This approach can assist managers in attracting the most talented employees and in developing a strong employer brand. Similarly, granting someone higher status within an organisation, perhaps through giving them their own office or parking space, may motivate them by fulfilling their need for self-esteem. However, some businesses have opted for a policy of single status in recent years. Single status means that businesses end discrimination between different grades of employees within the organisation, by providing the same facilities and benefits for all. Methods of employee participation As we have seen, employee participation is the involvement of employees in the process of decision-making within a business. Trade unions can be opposed to the use of employee participation because techniques such as quality circles can replace unions in the workplace. Employee participation can take numerous forms, including: 80 9781398308114.indb 80 05/03/21 11:07 AM » Quality circles These are groups of workers who meet Elton MAYO emphasised the importance of social contact and human interaction in motivation encouraged use of teamworking in business » Employee shareholders Firms across the world operate schemes whereby their employees can buy shares in the company, often at discounted rates. Because employee shareholders have a financial interest in the business’ performance, it may be that their motivation levels and performance will improve as a consequence. If the business performs well, its share prices should increase, giving financial benefits to the employee. » Autonomous work groups These are teams of employees who are given a high level of control over their working lives – in effect, another form of empowerment. Some such groups elect their own leaders and can appoint new staff, as well as having considerable authority over what tasks to complete and in what sequence. Abraham MASLOW argued that businesses should offer employees the opportunity to fulfil their ‘higher needs’ such as status and recognition Maslow’s theory supports the use of quality circles Frederick HERZBERG identified factors (which he called ‘motivators’) which are central in improving employee performance at work 2.2 2.2.4 Motivation methods in practice regularly to identify methods of improving all aspects of the quality of their work. Quality circles normally involve four to ten employees, drawn from all levels within the organisation, and focus on supplying imaginative ideas. » Works councils Managers and employees meet within works councils to discuss issues such as working conditions, pay and training. They are popular in many countries, especially Germany. Employee representatives on works councils are normally elected by the workforce and works council representatives may also be appointed to a company’s board of directors. the use of autonomous work groups generate ‘motivators’ for those involved EMPLOYEE PARTICIPATION ▲ Figure 2.15 Employee participation and motivational theory CASE STUDY Primark in Bangladesh Primark is one of Europe’s largest retailers of clothes and operates more than 230 shops. The company has a wellpublicised commitment to improve working conditions in its suppliers’ factories in Bangladesh. It has established committees to allow employees to participate in decisionmaking in a number of its factories, allowing employees to make proposals to improve their working conditions. The programme covered factories in Dhaka, Savar Gazipur and Narayanganj. In preparation, Primark provided training to 500 managers in the factories and more than 1000 employees to ensure they had the necessary skills to implement decisions to enhance working conditions in diverse environments. Equipped with new skills, including those related to bargaining, the factory workers have reduced working hours and increased holiday entitlements, while increasing hourly pay rates. The negotiations have also led to a number of administrative changes, including transparent pay rates and accurate and detailed pay slips. Primark has also supported the creation and publication of a range of posters setting out workers’ rights. The whole scheme is designed to ensure that workers are empowered, educated and effective communicators dedicated to improving working conditions in one of the world’s poorer economies. Questions 1 2 Explain two difficulties that Primark might face in establishing its worker-participation committees. [6] Evaluate whether or not Herzberg’s theories of motivation offer the best explanation of the benefits that Primark might receive from setting up workerparticipation committees. [12] 81 9781398308114.indb 81 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2.2 TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions AS LEVEL 2.2 Motivation 1 a b Define the term ‘motivation’. [2] Explain one characteristic of a highly motivated workforce. [3] 2 Explain one way in which a business may benefit from having a highly motivated workforce. [3] 3 a Identify two human needs. [2] b Explain two key elements of FW Taylor’s theory of motivation. [6] 4 Explain one difference between Frederick Herzberg’s motivators and his hygiene factors. [3] 5 a Define the term ‘process theory of motivation’. [2] b Explain one difference between the need for achievement and the need for affiliation. [3] 6 a Explain one difference between piece-rate pay and hourly pay. [3] b Explain one possible benefit to a business of profit-sharing. [3] 7 Explain two features that an employer should include in the design of a job if it is to motivate employees. [6] 8 a Explain one difference between job enrichment and job enlargement. [3] b Define the term ‘job design’. [2] 9 Explain two different types of teams that may be used within a business. [6] 10 a Define the term ‘employee participation’. [2] b Explain two techniques that businesses may use to encourage employee participation. [6] Data response question A traditional business Gibble Ltd is a long-established manufacturer of luxury pens. It is a traditional business with a clear hierarchy and many long-serving managers. Its products are recognised as being of the highest quality and it charges premium prices for them. Its most expensive pen sells for $1250. Despite the company’s profits reaching record levels, its managers are seeking ways to improve the performance of its workforce. Some managers believe that pay is the best way to improve motivation and employee performance. Others would prefer more employee participation allowing greater use of teams and techniques, such as empowerment and job enrichment. Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘empowerment’ b ‘job enrichment’. Analyse one way in which Gibble Ltd might use monetary methods of motivation to improve the performance of its workforce. Evaluate whether it is inevitable that Gibble Ltd will use non-financial methods to motivate its workforce. [2] [2] [4] [12] 82 9781398308114.indb 82 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2 Human resource management 2.3 AS LEVEL Management In this chapter we examine: ★ the functions of management ★ the role of managers using the theories of Fayol and Mintzberg ★ the contribution of managers to business performance ★ a range of management styles ★ McGregor’s theory X and theory Y managers. Di ct re g in The Manager ng isi an rg O Leaders, by comparison, are people who are followed, who have a vision of the future and a clear sense of where they are taking the business. A leader decides what needs to be done and is prepared to shake things up to get it done. According to a significant writer in this area, John Adair, ‘leadership is the process of motivating others to act in particular ways’. We look at leadership in much more detail in Chapter 7.3. pany objectives Com g Many business writers draw a distinction between a leader and a manager. A manager is someone who gets things done. Managers tend to focus on the present and the short term and are responsible for implementing the decisions of others. They manage but they also follow. Their role, in many ways, is to maintain things the way they are. The theorist Mary Parker Follett believed that management was ‘the art of getting things done through other people’. From Fayol onwards, various writers over the years have argued that this involves different functions. However, those set out in Figure 2.16 would be considered the key functions that are carried out by most managers. nt ro llin We will consider both of these classifications in more detail in this chapter. The functions of management Co Describing management is a complex task, and there have been a number of attempts by writers to classify what managers do within an organisation. For example: » Henri Fayol, writing in the early twentieth century, set out the functions of management. » In contrast, Henry Mintzberg identified ten roles carried out by managers. Do make sure that you distinguish between management and leadership in your answers and avoid using these two terms interchangeably. If the question is about management, make sure that is what you write about! an ni ng What is management? STUDY TIP Pl 2.3.1 Management and managers 2.3.1 Management and managers Chapter overview GLOSSARY TERM Leadership includes the functions of ruling, guiding and inspiring other people within an organisation in pursuit of agreed objectives. Management is planning, organising, directing and controlling all or part of a business enterprise. Com p a n y o bje cti v e s ▲ Figure 2.16 The functions of management 83 9781398308114.indb 83 05/03/21 11:07 AM 2.3 All businesses operate in different ways and may require managers to undertake varying tasks and duties. However, these various management duties and tasks can be categorised into four basic functions – the functions of management. The four principal functions of management are: » » » » planning organising directing controlling. CASE STUDY AS LEVEL 2.3 Management Saudi Arabian company wins airport car park contract Sharjah Airport is one of the busiest in the United Arab Emirates. In the past, the managers at Sharjah Airport Authority have managed parking by passengers and staff. However, it was decided recently that another company should be employed to take on this role. The contract was won by Mawgif, a business based in Saudi Arabia. Mawgif has promised to use technology to support its management of parking at the airport in the hope of improving the travel experience of passengers passing through Sharjah Airport. It has significant experience in this area as it already operates parking in more than ten cities and has operations in Saudi Arabia and Jordan. It also plans to offer drivers parking at Sharjah Airport new, and more convenient, methods of paying parking charges. Source: www.moodiedavittreport.com/national-parking-companymawgif-wins-15-year-sharjah-airport-parking-contract/ Questions 1 2 Explain two functions of the managers at Sharjah Airport Authority. [6] Evaluate which of the functions of management will be most important if Mawgif’s managers are to respond effectively to winning this contract. [12] Planning Organising Planning is the first of the functions of management and involves looking to the future. It is the foundation upon which the other three functions of management should be based. Planning requires management to evaluate where the company is currently and where it would like to be in the future. This allows managers to take decisions so that the company moves forward in an organised and coherent manner to give managers something against which to judge their decisions. Planning may involve a variety of tasks, including: » establishing objectives or targets for the business » gathering together forecasts of key data, such as costs and revenues » drawing up plans for functional areas within the business such as finance, human resources or marketing – these plans should fit together to help the business achieve its objectives » estimating the likely resource needs for any proposed plans. Management must assemble the resources that they need to carry out the actions set out in the plan. Through the process of getting organised, management will determine the internal organisational structure, establish and maintain relationships, as well as allocate necessary resources. The planning process is continual because external factors (such as licences to operate telecommunications services in many countries, for example) change all the time. These changes may cause a company to adjust its course of action to ensure that it achieves its objectives. Planning helps managers to reduce the chance of projects failing in the future. A plan can highlight problems and encourage managers to develop solutions. It can help to make sure that managers have the resources they need. A plan can also be extended to help managers to overcome emergencies or crises – these are called contingency plans. For example, a company might draw up a contingency plan to cover the consequences if a bid made to operate mobile phone services is unsuccessful. Global demand for palm oil is rising quickly. Worldwide production of palm oil has been climbing steadily for five decades. Between 1995 and 2015, annual production quadrupled, from 15.2 million tonnes to 62.6 million tonnes. By 2050, it is expected to quadruple again, reaching 240 million tonnes. Plantations have been established in Africa and South America. In order to organise this expansion, the managers will need a range of resources: » land for palm oil plantations and oil mills » labour to plant the trees, build the mills and, eventually, harvest the fruit of the trees and process it » capital to finance the plan. The companies may also need to restructure their workforce to operate plantations in Africa and South America to ensure that their planned operations run efficiently. A wellmanaged business will use minimal resources to achieve its objectives. (The palm-oil industry has a high environmental impact which companies must also take into account – see pages 233 and 257.) Directing The third function of management is directing. Through directing, management is able to influence and oversee the behaviour of the staff in achieving the company’s goals, as well as assisting them by providing the necessary resources. Directing employees effectively entails motivation and communication. 84 9781398308114.indb 84 05/03/21 11:07 AM » Motivation is the willingness to achieve a target or Controlling Controlling involves setting standards using the company’s objectives and then evaluating and reporting performance. Once management has done both of these things, it should compare the two to determine any necessary corrective or preventive action. Managers can report on business performance in a number of ways: » Financial reports Many companies publish details of their financial performance each year. This gives interested parties information on their sales, revenues and profits. In many countries there is a legal requirement for companies to report on profits or losses to assist governments in assessing whether the correct amount of tax has been paid. » Employee performance Such reports may provide information on productivity (the quantity produced per employee per week, for example), levels of absenteeism or training costs. For many service businesses, these can be vital measures of performance. » Social performance Managers can measure a business’ performance in terms of behaving ethically, minimising pollution and creating jobs. Palm-oil producers may need information on each of the above areas to assess whether their planned expansion of palm-oil production in countries throughout the world is progressing according to their plans. The control process is a constant task for managers. Through the process of control, a manager is able to identify potential problems and take the necessary decisions to overcome them. ▲ Figure 2.17 A newly established palm-oil plantation Question 1 2.3 Evaluate why it might be necessary for palm-oil producers to report on their social performance in Africa to ensure that their activities are controlled [12] effectively. Henri Fayol’s theories of management Henri Fayol (1841–1925) was a French mining engineer. He developed a theory of business administration and published his ideas in his book, Industrial and General Administration, originally published in France in 1916. Fayol created his theory at roughly the same time as Frederick Winslow Taylor developed his ideas about scientific management. 2.3.1 Management and managers goal. Employees that are highly motivated generally perform better, which assists businesses in achieving objectives. For this reason, managers tend to put a lot of focus on motivating their employees. For example, they provide financial-incentive programmes to encourage employees and may also grant them authority to take decisions to help improve motivation and performance. » Communication is the exchange of information between one or more people. Effective communication can take a number of forms. It may simply be praise or clear guidance; alternatively, it could be detailed instructions. Whatever form it takes it can help to achieve high levels of productivity and encourages employees to use their initiative as well as to solve problems. As a director in a mining company, Henry Fayol established what he thought were the fourteen key principles of management. His work set out how managers should organise and interact with employees. He also identified five primary functions of management which supported his fourteen principles. Fayol was one of the earliest writers on management theory and remains a very strong influence on management theory and practice. Fayol’s fourteen principles 1 Division of work Output can be increased if employees are specialised in different areas of production. This occurs because employees become increasingly skilled and productive. 2 Authority Fayol believed that managers need authority to give orders to subordinates. However, it is important to remember that responsibility comes with authority. 3 Discipline This refers to obedience and is a core value in an effective organisation. 4 Unity of command This means that an individual employee should receive orders from one manager and that the employee is answerable to that manager. 5 Unity of direction In a well-co-ordinated organisation, teams with the same objective should be working under the direction of one manager and following a single plan. 6 Subordination of individual interests to the general interest The interests of any one employee or group of employees (including managers) should not be more important than the interests of the organisation as a whole. 7 Remuneration Employee satisfaction occurs when all employees are paid fairly. This covers financial and nonfinancial rewards. 8 Centralisation This refers to how close employees are to the decision-making process. It is important to achieve a balance between senior managers (at the centre) and more junior employees being involved in decisionmaking. 9 Scalar chain Employees must know where they are in the organisation’s structure. They should know who is their manager and those people over whom they have authority. 85 9781398308114.indb 85 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.3 Management 2.3 10 Order Employees must have the right resources to carry out their jobs effectively. In addition, the workplace should be clean, tidy and safe. 11 Equity Fayol believed that managers should be kind and treat all employees fairly at all times. 12 Stability of tenure of personnel Managers should aim to have the right staff in the right place and to minimise the rate of labour turnover within the business. 13 Initiative Employees should be given the necessary freedom to be creative and to develop new ideas. This helps to encourage employees to be engaged and motivated. 14 Esprit de corps Organisations should strive to promote team spirit and unity and create good morale within the workplace. Interpersonal management Fayol’s fourteen principles may have been written more than one hundred years ago, but many of these principles are now adopted by almost all managers, although they were considered revolutionary when first published. Informational management Fayol’s functions of management Fayol set out five functions of management. These are: » planning » co-ordinating » organising » controlling. » commanding You will see that Fayol’s functions of management are very similar to the generic managers’ roles described earlier (on pages 84–85). Analysing the functions and principles of management gives some insight into what managers have to do to be effective and efficient. Some management writers have argued that when Fayol’s writing on good management was accepted, productivity and living standards in America increased. However, this may have been the result of other factors too. Mintzberg’s roles of management Henry Mintzberg is Professor of Management Studies at McGill University in Montreal, Canada, and a renowned author on management. One of his most famous pieces of writing, in 1990, set out the ten roles performed by managers within businesses. He argued that management is not about functions but about what managers do. Mintzberg argued that managers performed ten roles and that these fall into three categories, as shown in Table 2.9. ▼ Table 2.9 Mintzberg’s management roles and categories Role Category 1 Figurehead 2 Leader 3 Liaison Interpersonal management 4 Monitor 5 Disseminator 6 Spokesperson Informational management 7 8 9 10 Entrepreneur Disturbance handler Resource allocator Negotiator This category entails managing through other people. » Figureheads represent their colleagues. They carry out social, ceremonial and legal responsibilities and are expected to be a source of inspiration. Figureheads are considered to have authority. » Leaders create and maintain an effective working environment and motivate and develop more junior employees. In this role, employees manage the performance and responsibilities of everyone in their team. » Liaisons must communicate with internal and external contacts. They need to network effectively to gather information. The roles in this category involve processing information. » Monitors search for internal and external information relevant to the business, looking for relevant changes in the environment. Monitors also look after their teams in terms of performance and welfare. » Disseminators pass on valuable information to others in the organisation. This is a central communication role. » A spokesperson represents and speaks for their organisation. In this role, they are responsible for transmitting information about their organisation and its goals to the people outside it. Decisional management This category of management role uses information to take decisions. » Entrepreneurs plan and initiate change as a manager within a business organisation. » Disturbance handlers deal with the unexpected and also with crises. Managers should take control in such circumstances and attempt to solve disputes. » Resource allocators take decisions on the most effective use of an organisation’s resources including finance, staff and capital equipment. » Negotiators engage in important negotiations within and outside the business. Mintzberg reached a number of conclusions from his studies. » Senior managers are very busy and have heavy workloads! There is little free time and trying to get away from work is difficult. » The work is fragmented; managers are moving from one task to another. They need to focus on what really matters and what really makes a difference (80 per cent of results usually come from 20 per cent of the effort, so they try to work out what that 20 per cent is). » Managers focus on short-term, immediate problems. They are often firefighting, dealing with the problem in front of them; this pushes them away from long-term planning and thinking. Decisional management This category of management role uses information to take decisions. 86 9781398308114.indb 86 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 2.3 SF Airlines plans to enlarge fleet Each week, SF Airlines operates an average of 959 flights to 65 airports. The airline plans to double its fleet to 118 aircraft and to expand its network of routes to 70 destinations during 2020. SF Airlines has also expanded its fleet of aircraft by 16 per cent during 2019 and now operates 58 planes. In December 2019, it was given approval by the US Department for Transportation » Verbal contact is preferred to written as, with the latter, lots of information is received but it takes longer to get a response. Managers seldom get out and about; walking around is useful because it makes you visible and more aware of the issues within the business. » Managers actually control little of what they do day to day – things happen to them! Mintzberg’s work on management roles was based on observing senior managers, and this is both a weakness and a strength of his theory. He did analyse what managers really do, but he did not consider the working lives of middle or junior managers, so, in this respect, his analysis may be considered incomplete. The contribution of managers to business performance Managers play a critical role in business activities and can have a significant influence on their performance. There are many elements of the work of managers which can impact on the performance of the business. We will consider some of these below (these are also summarised in Figure 2.18). » Setting suitable objectives Managers play an important role in setting objectives and monitoring the actions taken to achieve these. Setting objectives which are appropriate and achievable is an important part of business success. If they are too challenging, employees may be demotivated by failure; if too easy to achieve, the business may underperform. Effective managers also monitor the progress of the business towards its objectives, ensuring, for example, that sufficient resources are available to employees. Managers at Volkswagen, the German car manufacturer, plan to switch production from cars powered by internal combustion engines to those with electric motors. By 2028, Volkswagen will sell 70 different electric vehicles and the company will be carbon-neutral by 2050. Its future success will depend on how effective managers are in guiding the business to achieve these objectives. to operate flights from China to any point in the USA. In response to this, the airline will introduce flights from Hangzhou to New York three times each week. Source: www.ch-aviation.com/portal/news/85299-chinassf-airlines-fleet-to-top-60-aircraft-in-2020 Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why planning will be an important function for SF Airlines’ managers in the future. [6] This expansion represents a major challenge for SF Airlines’ managers. Evaluate which of Mintzberg’s roles would be most important in the management of the company’s growth. [12] » Allowing subordinates to work to their full potential Managers who can recognise and respond appropriately to the needs and abilities of their workforce are more likely to achieve success. Some employees will flourish if managers relax control and empower employees to make decisions and take greater control of their working lives. In other situations, managers may need to use more authority. If managers achieve the right balance between the use of authority and freedom for employees, the workforce, and hence the organisation, is likely to perform better. » Making good-quality decisions Managers tend to make a lot of decisions. Some of these can have significant implications for the performance of the business. Effective managers will use their experience and skills, as well as data, to make good-quality decisions. Modern managers frequently have access to enormous amounts of data on, for example, market trends and consumer behaviour. This can be used to support and inform decision-making and can help to reduce the risk in major decisions, such as that taken by Volkswagen above. Use workforce and other resources as efficiently as possible 2.3.1 Management and managers SF Airlines is based in Shenzen, China, and was founded in December 2009. It provides a service transporting cargo and has transported around 2.5 million tonnes of cargo to destinations in central and south-east Asia and Europe. It only commenced flights between Frankfurt (Germany) and Wuxi (China) in September 2019. Increased sales and profits Achieve objectives on time, enhancing business’ performance Set challenging but achievable objectives Take informed decisions using experience and data Protecting and/or increasing market share ▲ Figure 2.18 Some ways in which managers can contribute to business performance 87 9781398308114.indb 87 05/03/21 11:07 AM Styles of management AS LEVEL 2.3 Management 2.3 There have been many studies looking at styles of management and evaluating the extent to which they have been successful. There is no simple answer to which style is most effective, as it depends on the circumstances. Here, we will consider a range of styles of management. One classification of styles is to consider the extent to which managers ‘tell’ or ‘listen to’ their staff. Using this approach, managers have been classified as being autocratic, paternalistic, democratic or laissez-faire (literally meaning ‘leave alone’). However, there are many more different styles of management that can be identified using this approach. The Tannenbaum and Schmidt continuum, shown in Figure 2.19, emphasises that there is a range of management styles depending upon the extent to which managers take decisions or whether subordinates contribute significantly to decision-making. A key factor in differentiating between these styles is communication. At the autocratic end of the spectrum, communication is likely to be downward only as the manager ‘instructs’ their subordinates as to their duties. Paternalistic management is a ‘softer’ version of this, as we shall see. Democratic management is more likely to result in two-way communication, as consultation and ‘selling’ of the final idea take place. Laissez-faire management may result in relatively little communication, as the problem or task may be outlined with subordinates having considerable freedom thereafter. Manager-centred management Subordinate-centred management Area of freedom for subordinates Use of authority by the manager Manager makes decision and announces it Manager sells decision to subordinates i.e. convinces them Manager presents ideas and invites questions Manager presents tentative decision subject to change Manager presents problem, gets suggestions and makes decision Manager defines limits and asks group to make decision Range of behaviour Manager pemits group to function independently within defined limits ▲ Figure 2.19 The Tannenbaum and Schmidt continuum GLOSSARY TERMS Autocratic management exists when managers keep control of information and make major decisions alone. Sometimes known as authoritarian management. Paternalistic management is a style in which managers take decisions in what they believe are the best interests of their subordinates. Democratic management occurs when information is shared and team members participate in decision-making. Sometimes known as participative management. Laissez-faire management takes place when managers allow subordinates freedom to make their own decisions. Autocratic management This is also sometimes termed authoritarian management. It refers to a management or leadership style which assumes that information and decision-making are best kept at the top of the organisation. It is also characterised by: » one-way communication (downward) » minimal delegation or decentralisation » close supervision of employees. Martha Stewart, an American entrepreneur, built up a vast global business venture including publishing, television broadcasting and online commerce, despite (or perhaps because of) her reputation as an autocratic manager. Under this style, the manager determines objectives, allocates tasks and expects obedience from subordinates. In these circumstances, employees become very dependent upon their managers, as they do not have the necessary information (or confidence) to act on their own initiative. Organisations managed in an authoritarian style can face difficulties. People avoid making decisions, so that matters to be decided are either passed up for the decisions to be made at a higher level or decisions are made by committees – as it is more difficult to dismiss all the members of a committee for jointly making a wrong decision. Senior management tends to be overworked and staff turnover tends to be high. 88 9781398308114.indb 88 05/03/21 11:07 AM This style of management becomes more difficult to operate successfully as an organisation grows. As with all of these management classifications, the term ‘autocratic manager’ covers a spectrum of actual styles. Extreme autocratic management will result in subordinates having no freedom of action. More benevolent autocratic leadership will allow for the possibility of some discussion or persuasion. This implies that limited two-way communication may occur. 2.3 ▼ Table 2.10 Autocratic management – circumstances in which it may be applicable Inappropriate • When a rapid decision is needed – perhaps in an emergency • When it is important that the same message is given out by everyone in the organisation – maybe as part of crisis management • When managers are responsible for a large number of (possibly unskilled) subordinates • When taking highly complex decisions requiring diverse knowledge and skills • When leading a talented, self-motivated and creative group of employees • In circumstances in which junior managers are expected to develop a full range of managerial skills Paternalistic management » the manager acts upon advice and explains the reasons Paternalistic management is broadly autocratic, but this type of manager takes into account the interests of the workforce when making decisions. Paternalistic managers consult with junior employees over decisions and may take some notice of the views expressed by subordinates. However, paternalistic managers retain control over most decision-making and only delegate minor decisions (and little freedom) to subordinates. » subordinates have some control over their own working A paternalistic manager regards their staff as an extended family. Businesses using this style of management consider it important to meet the social and leisure needs of their staff. This approach was common in the UK in the past, and Cadbury’s (a manufacturer of chocolate and similar products) was a well-known example. Paternalistic managers often develop very loyal subordinates because subordinates feel protected and cared for. It is not unusual for paternalistically managed businesses to have a low rate of labour turnover. This can help to reduce recruitment costs and improve competitiveness. However, paternalistic managers do not encourage their employees to use their creative and imaginative skills, nor do they encourage the use of initiative. This can mean that the business does not make the most effective use of the human resources that it has available. Democratic management Democratic management (sometimes called participative management) entails operating a business according to decisions agreed by the majority. Decisions may be agreed formally through a voting system, but they are more likely to be the result of informal discussions. Typically, democratic management encourages some or all of the following: » the manager delegates a great deal and encourages decentralisation » the manager and subordinates discuss issues and employee participation is actively encouraged for decisions lives. The successful operation of this style requires excellent communication skills on the part of the manager and the ability to generate effective two-way communication. A considerable amount of management time may be spent on communicating in one form or another. This approach helps to develop the skills of subordinates and generally results in a more satisfied workforce. 2.3.1 Management and managers Appropriate Democratically led groups usually have low dependency on their manager, offer constructive ideas and suggestions and derive great satisfaction from their employment. As a consequence, such groups have high levels of selfmotivation and may require relatively little supervision. There is evidence of a trend towards more democratic styles of management, though this depends on many factors, including the size of a business and its culture. The trend towards democratic management has a number of possible causes: » Management theory has developed and provided substantial evidence that people are more likely to be motivated (and productive) through the use of a democratic management style. » Management has become more complex. Globalisation means that businesses are larger and more complicated organisations, and the environment in which they operate is dynamic and subject to rapid change. Individuals are more likely to need the support that democratic management provides to succeed in these circumstances. STUDY TIP Do learn the glossary terms in this chapter (and the other chapters as well!), as understanding the terms that may be used in questions is essential and you may be asked to provide definitions. 89 9781398308114.indb 89 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 2.3 Management 2.3 CASE STUDY Steve Jobs Steve Jobs was an unconventional manager. His management style was not the stuff of textbooks – he wasn’t known for his democratic style or consensusbuilding approach. Jobs founded the American technology company Apple with school friend Steve Wozniak in 1976, and was effectively fired from it in 1985. However, he returned to the company in 1997 and achieved greatness. Under his control, the market value of Apple’s shares increased from about $5 billion in 2000 to $351 billion in 2011, when ill-health forced his retirement. It remains one of the most valuable companies globally; he also created one of the world’s most valuable brands. Sir Richard Branson, the founder of the Virgin Group of companies, was a fan of Steve Jobs. He has described Jobs as an autocratic manager with a ‘meticulous eye’ for detail. Branson considered Jobs to be someone who wanted to work with people who were like-minded and who would follow his instructions. Jobs was not thought to be a good delegator and tried to become involved in too many aspects of the business. He was very demanding as a manager, expecting a great deal from the people who worked for him. Laissez-faire management This approach is sometimes described as ‘mild anarchy’. Under this approach, the manager has a minimal input into the operation of the business. Employees take the majority of the decisions with little reference to the manager. As a consequence, the organisation can lack a sense of direction as well as co-ordination and planning. A laissez-faire style of management may occur because of the personal shortcomings of the manager or a lack of the essential skills needed to carry out the manager’s role successfully. Alternatively, it may be a conscious and brave policy decision to give staff the maximum scope for showing their capabilities. It may be an appropriate style to adopt in certain circumstances. For example, the manager of a highly creative team may deliberately adopt this Some analysts do not consider Jobs to have been the best manager of people. There are times when clear and decisive management is essential and a strength, especially in times of crisis. However, it may be that Jobs should have delegated more and listened more, as subordinates often have great ideas. Despite the criticisms of Jobs as a manager, he is considered to have been an excellent communicator and he was the public face of Apple for many years. He was also passionate about his work. He loved finding gaps in the market and developing products that people really wanted. Jobs’ legacy lives on in Apple. Questions 1 2 Explain two differences between autocratic and democratic management styles. [6] Evaluate whether being passionate about your business and a good communicator is more important than the management style that is used. [12] style in the expectation of bringing out the best in their subordinates. Laissez-faire management may be successful in the following circumstances: » The manager is one among a number of equals in terms of experience and qualifications. » The workforce is self-motivated and understands the role of the manager. » The workforce understands and agrees with the organisation’s objectives. Laissez-faire management tends to result in highly independent employees who are willing to voice their opinions. Staff may be satisfied or dissatisfied with this style of management, depending on their skills, the complexity of the tasks to be completed and their own personality. ▼ Table 2.11 The key features of a selection of management styles Autocratic Paternalistic Democratic Laissez-faire Description Keeps information and decision-making among the senior managers Dictatorial, but decisions are intended to be in the best interests of the employees Entails managing a business on the basis of decisions agreed by the majority Manager has a peripheral role, leaving staff to manage the business Decision-making Sets objectives and allocates tasks. Manager retains control throughout Manager explains decisions and ensures social and leisure needs are met Encourages participation and makes use of delegation Manager evades duties and unco-ordinated delegation occurs 90 9781398308114.indb 90 05/03/21 11:07 AM Paternalistic Democratic Laissez-faire One-way communication downwards from manager to subordinate Mainly downwards, though feedback will take place Extensive, twoway. Encourages contributions from subordinates Communication is mainly between people at the same level in the organisation, though little occurs Uses Useful when quick decisions are required Can appear democratic, but is really ‘soft’ autocracy When complex decisions are made requiring a range of specialist skills Can encourage production of highly creative work by subordinates Advantages Decisions and direction of business will be consistent. May project image of confident, well-managed business Can engender loyalty, and frequently enjoys low labour turnover due to emphasis on social needs Commitment to May bring the best out business, satisfaction of highly professional and quality of work may or creative groups all improve Disadvantages Lack of information, so subordinates are highly dependent on managers; supervision needed An autocratic style can result in groups becoming highly dependent. They may become dissatisfied with manager Slow decision-making and need for consensus may avoid taking ‘best’ decisions Communication Style versatility Building on the contention that there is not a single perfect style of management, it is possible to argue that the best managers are those who adopt a style suitable to the circumstances. Thus, the most talented managers might be the most versatile, able to call on one or more of the styles we have discussed in order to assess the demands of the situation. Therefore, a versatile manager might adopt a democratic approach when reaching a decision on a proposed marketing campaign with a small group of writers and artists but they may demonstrate a more autocratic style when dealing with a crisis. Douglas McGregor’s Theory X and Theory Y Douglas McGregor was an American social psychologist who researched into leadership and management in large companies. His writing developed understanding of how the attitude of a manager might shape their behaviour. His book, The Human Side of Enterprise, was published in 1960 and has received much acclaim, particularly his celebrated comparison of two types of manager as set out in Theory X and Theory Y. McGregor’s theories were based on research he had conducted into the attitudes of managers towards their employees. His research revealed that many managers assumed their workers were motivated solely by money and had no real desire to work. McGregor referred to this type of manager as Theory X. He also discovered an alternative, and less common, type of manager, which he termed a Theory Y manager. Such managers, according to McGregor, believed workers sought more than financial gain from employment. Staff are likely to lack focus and sense of direction. Much dissatisfaction among subordinates is common 2.3 2.3.1 Management and managers Autocratic Thus, a poor performance by a group of workers may be the result of a work environment lacking stimulation and challenge for employees. The behaviour of employees, argued McGregor, is often the result of the way they are treated. McGregor did not believe in the views expressed by Theory X managers. He set the theory only to disprove it as part of his support for the views expressed by Theory Y managers. A Theory Y manager is more likely to be one who believes the following to be true: » Workers seek satisfaction from employment and not just a pay cheque. » Workers possess knowledge, creativity and imagination. » Workers willingly commit themselves to organisational objectives. » Poor performance by employees is due to repetitive and monotonous work or poor management. » Employees wish to contribute to decision-making. Theory X is derived from the work of FW Taylor and the scientific school of management, who contended that workers were ‘economic animals’ motivated solely by money. Theory X managers seek to get the best from their employees by use of techniques such as piece-rate pay and close supervision. Alternatively, Theory Y stems clearly from Mayo’s human relations approach and Maslow’s work on human needs (see pages 70–72 on motivation). It focuses on meeting the social and psychological needs of individuals within the workplace. McGregor’s work is, however, a theory of management and not one of motivation. If managers adopt a Theory Y style, the implications can be significant for a business. These might include: 91 9781398308114.indb 91 05/03/21 11:07 AM » greater delegation within the organisation, allowing those 2.3 further down the hierarchy to have greater authority » training for managers to encourage delegation and to improve two-way communication » reviewing the business’ culture to discourage managers from retaining what they might see as their ‘authority’ » considering the organisation’s structure and approaches, such as thinking about delayering. Businesses moving towards a Theory Y approach to management require planning, the support of managers and shop-floor workers, and considerable training for all the employees involved. AS LEVEL 2.3 Management TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 a Define the term ‘authority’. b Explain one function of management. Explain two ways in which good communication might help a manager to carry out the functions involved in their job. a Explain one reason why organising is an important function of management. b Explain one way in which managers can report on business performance. Explain one reason why most managers normally focus on short-term problems. a Explain one difference between autocratic and laissez-faire styles of management. b Explain one advantage of the use of democratic management. a Explain Henri Fayol’s fourth management principle: unity of command. b Explain one other management principle identified by Fayol. Explain one reason why managers who allow employees to work to their full abilities may help to improve a business’ performance. a Explain one difference between McGregor’s Theory X and Theory Y managers. b Explain one way in which FW Taylor’s theory of motivation might have influenced McGregor’s Theory X management style. Data response question [2] [3] [6] [3] [3] [3] [3] [3] [3] [3] [3] [3] A growing business Gadfly is a small, private limited company that designs and manufactures bicycles. It competes with a number of large multinationals and its unusual designs have proved popular. The business is growing quickly (sales are rising by an average of 19 per cent each year) and it now has two factories, each with its own manager who is responsible for production at their site. A major extension to one of the factories is expected next year. The number of employees is rising rapidly and last year reached 397, most of whom are relatively unskilled. The business was established by Ali ten years ago and he hopes that it will continue to grow quickly. Ali is a natural autocrat and likes to take all of the decisions using little delegation. He is a good communicator, has 30 years’ experience as an entrepreneur and also understands the bicycle manufacturing industry. The business is changing as it grows. The company is having to produce a larger range of bicycles, and it needs more skilled employees to design new products and to sell the bicycles in new markets – the company made its first sales in Australia and Argentina earlier this year. Ali is beginning to wonder whether his management style is suitable for this changing company. Questions [3] 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘delegation’ b ‘management’. Analyse one reason why planning is an important part of the managers’ role at Gadfly. Evaluate whether Ali’s use of an autocratic ­management style is suitable in these circumstances. [2] [2] [4] [12] 92 9781398308114.indb 92 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3 Marketing AS LEVEL 3.1 The nature of marketing In this chapter we examine: ★ the role of marketing and its relationship with other business activities ★ marketing objectives ★ the factors influencing supply and demand, and how supply and demand interact ★ the features of different markets ★ market share and market growth ★ the difference between consumer and industrial markets ★ the differences between B2C and B2B marketing ★ the difference between mass and niche markets ★ different methods of market segmentation ★ the costs and benefits of customer-relationship marketing. 3.1.1 Role of marketing and its relationship with other business activities All organisations need customers. The purpose of all businesses is to understand and provide the goods and services that customers want. Indeed, according to Peter Drucker, a very influential management writer, there is only one valid purpose for a business, which is ‘to create a customer’. Marketing is the function of the business that is responsible for understanding customer needs and developing the right products, setting the right price and promoting and distributing products in the right way. Marketing provides the link between the customer and the production function of the business. Marketing ensures that what is being provided is actually wanted and needed (that is, it is something of value), communicates this and makes the product available to customers. Operations Human resources Finance Marketing ▲ Figure 3.1 Integrated business functions; for the business to succeed, the activities of the different business functions must be integrated effectively GLOSSARY TERM Marketing is the process of identifying, anticipating and satisfying the needs of customers in a mutually beneficial exchange process. The importance of marketing Effective marketing occurs when a firm fully understands the requirements of its customers and is able to meet these needs successfully. The marketing function helps the organisation to provide a product that the customer wants, is affordable, is perceived as good value and that leaves the customer and the organisation itself satisfied with the transaction. Marketing is an ongoing process because: » customers’ needs change over time (for example, the developing interest in health issues has increased demand for health clubs and reduced demand for highfat foods) » the business environment can change (for example, with new laws, changes in technology, the economic climate or the 2020 Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic) » competitors enter the market with their own offerings, and so businesses must respond to this » a firm’s own strengths change and develop. 3.1.1 Role of marketing and its relationship with other business activities Chapter overview Effective marketing will, therefore, change over time to ensure there remains a good match between customers’ needs and the business’ own strengths. Effective marketing will lead to high levels of customer satisfaction, which means that customers: » are more likely to come back and buy more » are more likely to tell their friends to try the products » may be more willing to try new products by the business » may become loyal to the product and less likely to switch to competitors. 93 9781398308114.indb 93 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.1 CASE STUDY Hugh Davidson AS LEVEL 3.1 The nature of marketing Offensive marketing can be defined as: ‘An openly competitive marketing strategy involving one company exposing and attacking the weaker points of another company in order to take market share directly away from the competition.’ Hugh Davidson is a marketing writer who has advised many large companies around the world. One of his books is called Offensive Marketing. According to Davidson, ‘Offensive marketing involves every employee in building superior customer value very efficiently for above average profits.’ This is an interesting definition of marketing in that it highlights that: ● everyone is involved in marketing, because everyone affects the quality of the service and the customer’s impression of the product Defining marketing A formal definition of marketing should include the features below. » It is an exchange process – that is, it is two-way. The business offers the customer a good or service and in return receives something, usually payment. » It is mutually beneficial because both sides should gain from the exchange. Customers should be satisfied with the product and firms should make a profit (assuming that the firm is a profit-making organisation). Firms are unlikely to give away products for nothing. » It aims to identify and anticipate customer needs. Entrepreneurs need to understand their customers to know what to offer them. However, it is not always enough just to identify customers’ needs: in fact, sometimes the customers may not know themselves what their needs and wants are. In some markets, such as fashion and film, firms have to anticipate what customers will want in the future. They have to predict trends even before most customers know what these trends will be. » It aims to delight customers. Nowadays satisfying customers may not be enough, as many other firms are also doing this. It’s much better to delight the customer, so that they are more than satisfied and more likely to buy from you. The purpose of marketing is to match the abilities and strengths of the business to the needs of the market. Marketing involves a whole range of activities, including finding out what customers want, developing new products, packaging and promoting the products, and setting the price. All these activities are aimed at developing and providing goods and services which will satisfy the customer (so they will buy them), and make a profit for the ● it is important to develop value for money that is better than your competitors’, not just the same ● it is important to use resources efficiently – that is, you must think about how much you spend on marketing and measure the returns from different types of spending ● the aim is not just to do well but to achieve profits that are above average – the mark of a truly successful business. Questions 1 2 Explain one feature of offensive marketing. Evaluate the possible benefits of an offensivemarketing approach. [3] [12] firm. The more effective the marketing, the better the value provided for customers and the greater the rewards the business should be able to make. Marketing and other business functions The purpose of marketing is to ensure that the organisation meets the customers’ needs in the present and in the future. Marketing is therefore a dynamic process. To be effective it must work with the other functions of the business to influence: » what is produced, that is, the precise nature of the firm’s offerings (for example, in terms of design, features and quality) » how many are produced – marketing must estimate likely sales, which in turn will influence the quantity of goods and services the business must be able to provide » the range of products offered (for example, how extensive the menu should be in a restaurant; how many different models should be displayed in a store) » the price at which products are sold – this therefore determines how much can be spent on materials and the transformation process if a profit is to be made. Marketing will discuss and negotiate with: » operations over how much can be produced, what benefits can be offered and what the costs will be » finance over the amount that can be spent on developing, launching and promoting the product or service » human resources over the number and skills of staff required. There may be, for example, occasions when the business does not have the money, skills or capacity to develop a product. 94 9781398308114.indb 94 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 3.1 Amazon Marketing objectives and corporate objectives Marketing objectives are the targets set for the marketing function. Typically, these include: » Sales targets These might be set in terms of sales volume or value. Specific targets may be set for the business as a whole and also for specific products or particular regions. » Market share Increasing sales may not in themselves be particularly impressive if the market as a whole is growing fast and competitors’ sales are increasing faster than yours. This is why a business may set targets in terms of the share of the market. Market share measures the sales of one product or business as a percentage of the total sales in the market. A business may set a target such as its sales being 5 per cent of the market in the next year. » Brand awareness A business may want to increase people’s awareness of its brand relative to the competition. The marketing objectives will be linked to the overall objectives of the business – the corporate objective. For example, if the business has a target of growth, the marketing department may have to increase sales. If the corporate target is to boost the profits of the business, the marketing team might focus on sales of the most profitable products and place less emphasis on others that sell but are not necessarily as profitable. Corporate objective (e.g. increase profits by 5% next year) Marketing objective (e.g. increase market share to 12% next year) ▲ Figure 3.2 Corporate and marketing objectives STUDY TIP An objective should be quantifiable and include a time element. For example, ‘to increase market share to 3 per cent by 2025’. Amazon’s approach is supported by its highly developed systems that collect and analyse data, enabling Amazon to understand customer needs and behaviours. The founder of Amazon, Jeff Bezos, says that the most important thing is to ‘focus obsessively on the customer’. Questions 1 2 3 Analyse one benefit of being a customer-centric company. [4] Analyse one way that Amazon’s focus on providing products at a low price might affect one of the other business functions. [4] Analyse one way that the needs of consumers and sellers might differ. [4] Marketing strategy = how to get there 3.1.2 Demand and supply When Amazon.com was launched in 1995, it set out ‘to be the Earth’s most customer-centric company, where customers can find and discover anything they might want to buy online … and this will be available at the lowest price.’ Being customer-centric means the company starts with what the consumer wants and then works backwards. This goal still drives Amazon, although it is now worldwide not just in the US and has millions of sellers, consumers and content creators (for example, selling their own books). Each of these groups has different needs, and Amazon always works to meet these needs by innovating new solutions to make things easier, faster, better, and to be more cost-effective. Marketing objectives = where are we heading for? ▲ Figure 3.3 Marketing objectives and strategy GLOSSARY TERMS A marketing objective is a marketing target for the business, setting out what it wants to achieve and when. A corporate objective is a target set for the business as a whole. A marketing strategy is a marketing plan to achieve the marketing objective. STUDY TIP Remember that marketing is not just about making customers happy. The business also needs to meet its objectives, so think about issues such as the costs of any marketing action compared to its likely returns. Also, bear in mind what the business can actually deliver given its capacity, employees and other resources. 3.1.2 Demand and supply A market is made up of buyers and sellers. The sellers supply the product and the buyers demand it. If markets are allowed to work without government intervention, and if they are competitive with many different sellers, then the quantity produced and the price in the market will be determined by the forces of supply and demand. This can be shown in a graph. A supply curve shows how much producers are willing and able to supply at each and every price, with all other factors constant. It is usually upward-sloping because as the price 95 9781398308114.indb 95 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.1 The nature of marketing 3.1 increases, producers are more willing and able to supply more. They are more willing because of the higher price, and they are more able because the higher price means they can produce more even if their costs are slightly higher. The supply of a product will depend on: » the number of firms producing. With more firms producing, the supply in the industry should increase » the time period. Over time, more firms can move into this market if it is attractive, which could increase supply » technology. Technological developments will increase the quantity supplied » costs. If a business can reduce its costs (for example, by using cheaper supplies or being more efficient in its operations) this means it can produce more at each price and supply can increase. A demand curve shows how much customers are willing and able to buy at each and every price with all other factors unchanged. It is downward-sloping because as the price falls, customers can afford to buy more with the same income. The demand for a product will depend on factors such as: » the income of buyers, as this will affect how much they can afford » the price of rivals’ products. If these are cheaper, this is likely to reduce demand for your product » the price of complementary products (for example, if you buy a printer and print cartridges together, these are complementary products). If a complement is cheaper, customers might buy more of it and more of the associated product as well » marketing activities. Effective marketing by a business should help increase demand for the product. Look at Figure 3.5a. If the price was originally at P1 then, at this price, the quantity supplied is greater than the quantity demanded – because the price is high, producers want to sell more than customers want to buy. This leads to excess supply, or a surplus. In a free market with no intervention, the price will fall. As it does, the quantity demanded increases, the quantity supplied falls until P0 is reached. P0Q0 is the equilibrium price and quantity; at this price the quantity demanded and supplied is equal and there is no incentive to change. If the price was P2 then at this low price the quantity demanded is greater than the quantity supplied and there is excess demand. This is known as a shortage. In a free market, the price will increase; this increases the quantity supplied and reduces the quantity demanded until equilibrium at P0Q0 is reached. Price Supply P1 P0 P2 Demand Q0 ▲ Figure 3.5a Promotional activities Competitors (substitutes) Changes in demand conditions Population Influences on demand Complements Price Income Quantity A demand curve shows the quantity of a product demanded at each and every price, with all other things unchanged. The demand curve can shift if, at each price, the quantity demanded changes. This may be because of: » a change in consumer incomes » a change in the price of rivals’ products » a change in the price of complementary products » a change in customers’ tastes and social values » a change in the marketing activities of the business. A change in price leads to a movement along a demand curve. A change in one of these other factors changes the quantity demanded at each and every price and shifts the demand curve. Changes in supply conditions ▲ Figure 3.4 Influences on demand A supply curve shows the quantity that businesses are willing and able to supply at each price, with all other 96 9781398308114.indb 96 05/03/21 11:07 AM factors unchanged. The supply curve will shift if, at each price, there is a change in the quantity supplied. This may be because of: » an improvement in technology. This might increase the quantity supplied at each price » a reduction in costs. Again this would allow a business to supply more at a given price » government subsidies or taxes on producers. Supply S2 Price Supply S1 P4 P0 The effect on equilibrium of a decrease in demand Price Supply Demand Q4 Q0 Quantity ▲ Figure 3.5c ▼ Table 3.1 Effects of shifts in supply and demand Change Equilibrium price Equilibrium quantity Increase in demand Increases Increases Decrease in demand Decreases Decreases Increase in supply Decreases Increases Decrease in supply Increases Decreases 3.1.2 Demand and supply A change in price leads to a movement along a supply curve. A change in one of these other factors changes the quantity demanded at each and every price and shifts the supply curve. If demand conditions change and there is a decrease, the quantity demanded at each price will shift demand inwards. This is shown in Figure 3.5b as the demand curve moves to D2. At the old price there is now excess supply and this leads to a fall in the price. As the price decreases, this decreases the quantity businesses will supply and increases the quantity demanded until a new equilibrium is reached. The equilibrium is now P3Q3; less demand leads to lower prices and output. 3.1 HANDLING DATA P0 1 P3 D1 2 Demand D2 Q3 Q0 Quantity ▲ Figure 3.5b The effect on equilibrium of a decrease in supply If there is less supply in a market, perhaps because of a bad crop, the supply curve would move to S2 and equilibrium would be at P4Q4 – as shown in Figure 3.5c. Less supply in the market means that at the original price there is excess demand (that is, a shortage) and this leads to higher prices. As the price rises, there is a decrease in the quantity demanded and a rise in the quantity supplied until the new equilibrium is reached. This has a higher price and lower output. The effects of shifts in supply and demand on the equilibrium price and quantity are shown in Table 3.1. Draw a diagram of supply and demand for cars for a given year, showing the equilibrium price and quantity. Now show an increase in demand. What happens to the equilibrium price and quantity? CASE STUDY Supply and demand The Pacifica Super Penthouse apartment is located on the top two floors of New Zealand’s tallest residential building. It is for sale at a price of $40 million. This makes it the most expensive single-family home in New Zealand. The building is not yet completed, and so buyers have the option to design the penthouse themselves or leave the interior design to the tower’s developers. The developer’s plans include a conservatory, an open-plan area, a luxury kitchen and dining area, and a wine cellar. The top floor (the 54th) includes a spa and sauna, five guest bedrooms and a master bedroom. Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor that might influence the supply of apartments in the development. [4] Evaluate how an increase in demand for apartments might affect the equilibrium price and quantity in the short and long term. [12] 97 9781398308114.indb 97 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.1 3.1.3 Markets Consumer and industrial markets AS LEVEL 3.1 The nature of marketing There are different types of markets. In consumer markets, the customer buys the product and it is consumed. For example, you buy food, music and clothes and then use (consume) these. If a business is selling products direct to the consumers who will consume them, this will involve businessto-consumer marketing, often abbreviated as B2C. These consumer items will have had to be produced and that will have involved machinery, transport and technology. When you are selling products to be used in the production process for other products (for example, a production line or raw materials), this is known as a producer (or an industrial) market. When one business is marketing its products to another business to buy, this is known as business-tobusiness marketing, or B2B. ▼ Table 3.2 Industrial and consumer markets Industrial markets Consumer markets Number of buyers Relatively small Large Nature of buyer Professional Individuals level of competition then firms need to be market-oriented to survive; if they are not, rivals will meet customer needs more effectively and reduce their sales. Any entrepreneur wanting to succeed should make sure there is demand for their product. This will usually be done via market research to try to identify the likely level of sales. By comparison, a product-oriented (or product-led) business focuses more on what it can produce and hopes that this will fit with customer requirements. This is a very risky approach because the firm may produce something the customer does not want. If an entrepreneur assumes that because they like the idea, everyone else will also like it, this is being product-oriented. Not everyone thinks or behaves in the same way, so entrepreneurs must check that there is demand before starting out. Although being product-oriented is less likely to succeed than being market-oriented, it can work if the customer has limited choice; for example, in some countries, governments only allow a few firms to produce particular products and so customers have to buy what is available. If it is lucky, the business may produce a product that people want, or in some cases people invent products that customers did not know they wanted until the product arrived. However, over time, as customers find alternatives, product-oriented firms are likely to suffer. Local, national and international markets Some products, such as oil, are sold on worldwide markets. There are international producers and the products are demanded all over the world. Other products tend to be more national; this means they are sold mainly or exclusively in the domestic country, such as a chain of clothes stores. Others may be traded only in the local area, such as a local taxi business or hairdresser. The markets in which a firm operates affect the likely sales, the nature of the competition and the complexity of the marketing challenge. ▼ Table 3.3 Examples of local, national and international markets Type of market Possible examples Local Taxis, hairdressers, local food markets National National energy, national rail, national water International Tobacco products, mobile phones, pharmaceuticals Customer (market) orientation versus product orientation A customer-oriented (or market-led) business is one that bases its decisions on customers’ needs. It continually monitors its environment to find out what customers want, what competitors are offering and what changes are occurring in the market. By being market-oriented, a firm should be able to ensure that the product or service it provides matches its customers’ needs. If there is a high CASE STUDY Amazon Founded: Incorporated July 1994. Mission: To be Earth’s most customer-centric company where people can find and discover anything they want to buy online. Headquarters: Seattle, Washington, USA. Websites: Amazon serves its consumers through its retail websites. It operates websites in the USA, the UK, Germany, Japan, France, Canada, China, Italy and Spain. Selection: Amazon and more than 2 million third-party sellers offer millions of unique, new, refurbished and used items in categories such as: ● Kids & Baby ● Books ● Grocery ● Movies ● Health & Beauty ● Music ● Clothing, Shoes & ● Video Games Jewellery ● Electronics & ● Health & Beauty Computers ● Sports & Outdoors ● Home & Garden ● Automotive & ● Tools Industrial. ● Toys Questions 1 2 Define the term ‘customer-centric business’. [2] Visit the Amazon website (www.amazon.com). Evaluate the ways in which Amazon tries to be the world’s most customer-centric business. [12] 98 9781398308114.indb 98 05/03/21 11:07 AM Measuring market share and growth GLOSSARY TERMS Business-to-consumer marketing (B2C) occurs when one business is marketing its products to the final consumers. Business-to-business marketing (B2B) occurs when one business is marketing its products to other businesses. The market size is the total number of items sold (this is measuring volume) or the total value of sales. Market growth measures the rate at which the market as a whole is growing over a given time period. Market share is measured by the sales of a business (or a particular product) relative to the total market sales. Its equation is: market share = sales of a business (or product) × 100 total market sales For example, if product A sells $40 000 and the total market sales are $160 000, the market share of product A is: $40 000 × 100 = 25% $160 000 Measuring market share is not always easy. This is because the data you have on the sales in general may not be easy to collect; competitors, for example, may not want to share information. It will certainly take time and, at best, estimates of the market are likely to be a year or so out of date. While you will know your sales this month, it may not 3.1 STUDY TIP In some cases you may be asked to calculate the market share as shown above. In other cases you may be asked to calculate the size of the market given the market share. For example: Product A has sales of $20 000; this represents a market share of 40 per cent. 3.1.3 Markets Markets will differ in nature. For example, this could be in terms of: » Market size The size of a market can be measured in terms of the volume of sales or the value of sales. For example, there may be 20 000 products sold (volume) or $100 000 sold (value). If the volume of sales increases, the value will also usually increase, but this depends on what is happening to the price. If the price falls, it is possible that more units are sold but the value of sales declines. » The number of competitors Some markets have many thousands of competitors – just think of how many hairdressers and cafés there are. In other markets there are relatively few providers – how many electricity or train companies are there, for example? » Market growth Some markets do not change in size very much, while others grow fast and some shrink. The growth of a market is measured by the percentage change in its size over a given period. Generally, businesses will prefer fast-growing markets because they can all sell more. If the market is static then one firm can only sell more at the expense of another; this can lead to aggressive, competitive behaviour. be easy to compare this with other firms’ sales accurately; market share data is therefore most likely to be accurate when looking backwards. We now calculate 1 per cent of the market. If $20 000 = 40 per cent of the market, we can divide by 40 to get 1 per cent. 1 per cent market share = $20 000 = $500 40 Total sales in the whole market (which is 100 per cent) will equal $500 × 100 = $50 000. Market growth measures the rate at which the market as a whole is growing over a given time period. If, for example, the growth rate is 2 per cent this year, it means that the market is 2 per cent bigger than one year before. The growth may be measured in terms of the growth in sales volume or value. Its equation is: this year’s market sales – last year’s market sales market growth = × 100 last year’s market sales For example, if the market sales last year were $200 000 and are now $220 000, then: market growth = $220 000 – $200 000 × 100 = 10% $200 000 If the growth rate is positive, it means the market is getting bigger. If the growth rate is negative, it means the market has become smaller. Similarly, data on market growth is difficult to estimate at any given moment because of the problems in gathering data from all outlets and all producers. Again, it is most likely to be accurate when looking backwards. A further problem with calculating market share and market growth is actually defining the market in which a business operates. What is the market for your local bus company? Is it bus transport in your area? But how large do you define the area being considered? Or is it bus transport in the whole country? Or is it all forms of transport in your area? It is not always easy to clearly define the market a business operates within. 99 9781398308114.indb 99 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.1 CASE STUDY Ford The data below was produced by Ford, the automobile manufacturer, in its 2019 annual report. AS LEVEL 3.1 The nature of marketing ▼ Table 3.4 Ford retail sales, industry volume and market share, 2018 Retail sales Industry volume Market share (in millions of units) (in millions of units) (%) United States 2.5 17.7 14.1 Canada 0.3 2.0 14.7 Mexico 0.1 1.5 4.8 North America 2.9 21.5 13.4 Brazil 0.2 2.6 9.2 Argentina 0.1 0.8 12.1 South America 0.4 4.5 8.3 United Kingdom 0.4 2.8 13.7 Germany 0.3 3.8 7.9 EU21 1.4 19.6 7.2 Russia 0.1 1.8 2.9 Turkey 0.1 0.6 10.9 Europe 1.5 20.9 7.2 Middle East and Africa 0.1 3.8 3.0 China 0.8 26.2 2.9 Australia 0.1 1.2 6.0 India 0.1 4.4 2.2 ASEAN 0.1 1.7 6.6 Asia Pacific 1.1 43.5 2.5 Global N/A 94.2 6.3 Total company 6.0 N/A N/A Source: https://annualreport.ford.com/Y2019/default.aspx Questions 1 2 Calculate the proportion of Ford’s sales in 2018 that were made in North America compared to the total company sales. Calculate the total size of the market for vehicles in North America in 2018. [2] [3] STUDY TIP In some cases you may be asked to calculate growth. In other cases you may be asked to calculate the sales given a certain growth rate. For example: A market had sales of $500 000. This grows by 20 per cent. What are the sales now? 20 × $500 000 = $100 000 100 This means the new sales are $500 000 + $100 000 = $600 000. To calculate this you must work out 20 per cent of $500 000 and add it to the original sales. To calculate 20 per cent you use: 100 9781398308114.indb 100 05/03/21 11:07 AM Implications of changes in market share and growth When considering market share, it is important to bear in mind the total market size. A small percentage of the global confectionery market is still a lot of sales! The growth of a market shows the rate at which sales are increasing. In general, businesses might prefer faster growth to slower growth because it creates more sales opportunities. However, it is again important to bear in mind the size of the sales involved. A 1 per cent growth in the market for laptops is still a large number of sales because the market is so big, whereas a 10 per cent growth of a very small local market might only mean additional sales of a few thousand. In well-established, bigger markets growth may be slow but the numbers involved can still be huge. HANDLING DATA 1 2 3 4 A business sells $20 000 in a market worth $800 000. Calculate its market share. A business has a market share of 8 per cent in a market worth $400 000. Calculate its sales. A market was worth $300 000 and increases in size to $360 000. Calculate the market growth rate. If a market was worth $500 000 but grows by 2 per cent, calculate the size of the market now. 3.1.4 Consumer and industrial marketing STUDY TIP It is very important when answering marketing questions to think about the specific market the business operates in. It is important to adapt your understanding for the particular market. Selling bars of chocolate may require heavy advertising, while selling aeroplanes may require a very experienced sales team. Attractive packaging may help sell perfume, but it is less significant for selling tractors! GLOSSARY TERM A unique selling point (USP) is something about your product which is perceived by your customers as unique. There are many different types of products and these can be classified as: » Consumer products, which are items bought by the final user. These can be subdivided into: – Convenience items These are usually relatively cheap items and distribution is the key to marketing here; for example, newspapers and milk. Customers will not spend much time searching for them in different stores; they pick up what is convenient in the nearest shop. This means producers have to get them distributed in many different places and displayed in a way that attracts attention. This is important because some convenience items are bought on impulse (for example, chewing gum) when they are seen in the store. – Shopping items These are products such as clothes or electrical goods which are more expensive than convenience items. When customers go to buy them, they shop around, comparing prices and features; they may go and look several times before actually buying. Customers may go to a retail area where they can quickly move from one store to another to compare. The producer has to clearly demonstrate value for money; for example, by stressing a unique selling point (USP) to show why its product is better than the competition’s. – Specialist products are products that customers have probably thought about for a long time and for which they are willing to travel to find the right item; for example, Rolex watches or Ferrari cars. Specialist products may be distributed to relatively few locations, but the nature of the outlet is very important to the overall brand image. These products are probably not very price-sensitive because people want them for their status and their uniqueness. » Industrial products These are products which are bought by businesses to use in their production process to produce the consumer goods. They include: – Installations These are big items of expenditure, such as production lines and new office space. Buyers will take a lot of care over the precise features of the item, especially any technical features, because it is a major item of spending. – Materials These are materials used in the production process. There may be several possible suppliers, so buyers will shop around. The quality, reliability and flexibility of supply will be very important when buying these products. – Supplies These are basic items such as paper and light bulbs; there will be many suppliers and the buyer will look for good prices. 3.1 3.1.4 Consumer and industrial marketing A change in market share means that a business’ sales account for a greater proportion of the total sales in the market in the given period. If the market remains the same size or is growing then an increasing market share means higher sales. However, if the market is declining, the market share could be increasing even if sales are falling. Classification of products and how marketing might differ for different types of goods and services 101 9781398308114.indb 101 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.1 Consumer AS LEVEL 3.1 The nature of marketing fewer mistakes? At a lower cost? To win sales, it will be important to convince the customer of the business case for it. The person buying it will need to justify it to their managers and investors. Types of products Industrial Convenience Installations Shopping Materials Specialist Supplies ▲ Figure 3.6 Types of product Business-to-business marketing versus business-to-consumer marketing When one business is targeting other businesses, it will tend to be dealing with relatively small numbers of customers. These customers will want to understand how buying this product will help them in what they do – will it enable them to do their work faster? With Industrial buyers are usually professionals, and therefore will be very interested in the technical specifications of what is being offered and a whole range of issues such as the payment terms, delivery times and your reliability as a supplier. Often business-to-business marketing will involve a sales force approaching the business customers to explain the benefits of what they have to offer. The sales team will usually require specialist technical knowledge and an understanding of how their product helps the other business. Business-to-consumer businesses are dealing with larger numbers of potential buyers. These buyers will not be professional buyers (it’s not their full-time job!) and they may be more interested in the brand, the image of the product and the emotional benefits they get from buying it. In B2C marketing, more use is likely to be made of advertising and other promotional techniques to reach a wider audience. ▼ Table 3.5 Classification of products Industrial products Consumer products Buyers Professionals Amateurs! Number of buyers • Relatively few • Selling to businesses May be millions if a mass-market product May focus on • Technical specifications and how it helps their business • Benefits in terms of consumption do better • May be more influenced, for example, by • When the product can be supplied and in what quantities look or design or packaging • What the payment terms are Promotion Often uses sales force to approach customers 3.1.5 Mass marketing and niche marketing Niche marketing occurs when a firm targets a specific market segment – that is, a particular group of similar customer needs and wants. For example, Aston Martin targets the luxury sports car market and Umbro targets the football market. By focusing on a niche, a firm can understand the specific requirements of its customers and ensure its offering meets these needs precisely. A business can tailor its marketing approach and avoid wasting time and money on activities that are not relevant. Niche marketing is quite common for small businesses. This is because: » It focuses on just one segment of the market and therefore the resources required may be relatively small. This makes it affordable and feasible for a start-up business. May be advertising for mass-market product » By focusing on a small segment of the market, this may not be perceived as a threat by larger, established firms. If a start-up is perceived as a real threat, the established firms may cut prices or try to influence stores to get them to stop distributing the product. However, there are dangers associated with niche marketing: » The total number of customers is likely to be quite low and therefore, if anyone changes their mind and switches to a different product, this can have a significant effect on the total demand. » If the product does prove to be successful then larger businesses may be attracted by this success and enter the market. Small businesses may struggle to match the power and resources of larger firms and so may lose their share of the market. 102 9781398308114.indb 102 05/03/21 11:07 AM By comparison, a mass marketing approach targets the majority of the market. This usually involves high volumes of production and much higher capacity levels than niche marketing. This may make it unrealistic for a start-up business, especially given the high levels of promotion needed to generate the necessary demand to make mass production viable. However, over time, a niche product may become more mainstream and therefore niche products may be moved into the mass market. 3.1 ▼ Table 3.6 Advantages and disadvantages of niche and mass marketing Niche marketing Mass marketing Disadvantages Advantages Disadvantages • Small market segment so marketing activities can be very targeted • Small segment of market so larger firms may not be interested • Can often charge high price for a specialised, targeted product which helps cover cost of provision Small market so overall returns not that high in absolute terms • Large-scale production enables lower unit costs; this enables lower prices, making the product accessible for customers but at the same time still profitable for the business • Large target market means the total sales and profit in absolute terms may be high Products not adjusted for differences in customer needs; specific groups may be targeted more effectively by niche producers GLOSSARY TERMS Niche marketing occurs when a business focuses on a particular (usually small) segment of the market. A market segment exists when there is a group of clearly identifiable customer needs and wants. Mass marketing occurs when a business targets the majority of the market. STUDY TIP When studying this topic, you should be aware of the benefits and problems of a niche-marketing approach. You should also appreciate the importance of understanding and monitoring customers’ needs. To make your business more effective, you have to understand exactly what your customers want and provide them with excellent value for money. 3.1.6 Market segmentation Within any market, different segments may exist. For example, within the market for newspapers there are some readers who are most interested in sport, others who want financial news, and others who want celebrity gossip. Different newspapers have been developed to target these different groups. Within the chocolate market, the demand can be segmented into groups such as: » snacking – you buy the chocolate and eat it there and then (for example, a Mars bar) » sharing – you buy the chocolate and take it home to share with others (for example, Cadbury’s Heroes) » gift – you buy the chocolate to give to others (for example, Thornton’s chocolates). There are various ways in which a market may be segmented, including: » Geographic segmentation This type of segmentation focuses on aspects of consumers such as the location of customers or the climate in different regions. Cars sold to Africa, for example, will have to withstand high levels of heat; cars sold to Scandinavia will need to cope with the cold. Cars targeted at people living in cities may be relatively small so it is easy to get around and park; people living in the countryside may want more rugged vehicles to cope with the terrain. » Demographic segmentation This type of segmentation focuses on aspects of consumers such as age, gender, income, occupation, marital status and stage in the family life cycle. In the toys market, for example, the type of toys 3 year-olds will play with is very different from those wanted by 13 year-olds. When you are single, you may be looking for a city centre, 1-bedroom flat; when you are married with children you may want a 3-bedroomed house with a garden, near a good school and out of the city. » Psychographic segmentation This type of segmentation focuses on aspects of consumers such as personality, lifestyle, values, social class and attitudes. Are you someone who likes belonging to a group? Are you someone who is very ambitious? Do you want material things? Do you care how products have been made and their impact on the environment? These factors might all influence the way a product is promoted and the actual design of the product. Some holidays may be designed for adventurous, outgoing types. Others might target customers wanting a package holiday in Spain. Your job and earnings are likely to influence a whole host of lifestyle factors: the newspaper you read, where you shop, where you go on holiday, the interests you have and what you wear. 3.1.6 Market segmentation Advantages 103 9781398308114.indb 103 05/03/21 11:07 AM STUDY TIP AS LEVEL 3.1 The nature of marketing 3.1 Although targeting specific segments may seem appealing from a marketing perspective, it may make production more complex as it requires different models to be produced. Managers must balance the desire to meet the specific needs of customers with the costs and challenges this may generate. Geographic Types of market segmentation Demographic Psychographic 3.1.7 Customer-relationship marketing Aims of CRM ▲ Figure 3.7 Types of market segmentation For a market segment to appeal to a business, it must be: » measurable, so you can identify it exists and measure its size to decide on the likely earnings » accessible, so you have the resources to offer what would be required and be able to get your products to the customers » profitable, so you can meet customer needs and your own needs at the same time. Advantages and disadvantages of market segmentation By segmenting a market effectively, managers can identify which segments they want to target. By understanding the requirements of a particular segment, they can develop the marketing activities to meet these needs more closely. Hopefully, this should increase sales and boost brand loyalty. Effective segmentation should lead to effective marketing, with businesses providing exactly the right product in the right place at the right time and price. However, the more a market is segmented, the more variations there are to the product and its marketing – imagine producing a different cleaner for the sink, oven, shower, toilet, floor, door handles, carpets, work surfaces, windows, walls, and so on. Each one may meet a very specific need, but co-ordinating and providing such a range of products may be expensive. If possible, it would be easier and cheaper to produce an allin-one cleaner to cover at least some of these functions. The firm may well get cheaper inputs if it buys in bulk and can spread one set of marketing costs over more units. Businesses may therefore have to trade off the appeal of segmenting and meeting specific groups of needs more precisely with the benefits and cost advantages of producing a limited range of products on a larger scale. Customer-relationship marketing (CRM) involves gathering and analysing data about customers. The aim of CRM is to understand customers’ behaviour and take appropriate actions to move them towards a purchase and repeat purchases. A business will interrogate its data on customers to understand where in the buying process they are and to identify actions to make them buy and to retain them. Customer retention is very important to businesses. It is a measure of customer loyalty and can be measured by the proportion of customers who continue to buy from the business over a period of time. If a business sells a product to a customer who does not return to buy again then, to keep sales going, it has to keep finding new customers. This can be expensive and time-consuming. Ideally, a business will develop a relationship with a customer and generate ongoing sales. For example, an online retailer might want to develop a relationship so that it becomes the ‘go-to’ place for a customer to buy from; they become loyal to the business. This loyalty and repeat purchases of a range of products provided by a business can be built up in various ways, such as: » by analysing customers’ buying patterns and making recommendations of what else they may want to buy » analysing customer behaviour to understand what incentives to offer customers to gain their loyalty and repeat purchases. Costs and benefits of CRM By holding on to customers and generating repeat purchases, the business hopes to generate more revenue from its customers while keeping its marketing costs low. The benefits of CRM are that it can lead to more sales from the existing customer base at relatively low cost. The costs of CRM are the investment required in data systems to gather tools and staff skills in order to analyse information on customer enquiries and buying patterns. GLOSSARY TERMS Customer-relationship marketing (CRM) involves gathering and analysing data about customers to understand their behaviours and take appropriate actions to move them towards a purchase. Customer retention measures the proportion of customers who continue to buy from the business over a period of time. 104 9781398308114.indb 104 05/03/21 11:07 AM TEST YOUR LEARNING 10 a Short answer questions 1 2 3 5 6 7 8 9 [2] [2] [3] [3] [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] b 3.1 [2] [3] Data response question The fluctuating price of oil In 2020, US oil prices became negative for the first time in history. This was due to the greatest fall in demand in 25 years. The result was a surplus of oil and a fall in the price of oil to almost –$40. This meant producers were paying buyers to take the oil off them, so they didn’t have to pay for storage costs and because they had no more storage capacity. The fall in demand was due to the negative growth of most economies during the ‘lockdown’ that was necessary amid the Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic. Supply continued to increase even as demand collapsed, and this is likely to cause a fall in petrol prices. Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘market’ b ‘surplus’. Analyse one way in which a fall in the price of oil might affect businesses. Evaluate the factors that might affect the price of oil. 3.1.7 Customer-relationship marketing 4 Define the term ‘marketing objectives’. a Define the term ‘market segmentation’. b Explain one benefit of segmenting a market. a Explain one factor that influences the supply of goods or services in a market. b Explain one factor that might increase demand for a product. a Define the term ‘niche market’. b Explain one possible benefit of operating in a niche rather than a mass market. a Define the term ‘market share’. b Explain one possible benefit to a business of having a high market share. a Define the term ‘market growth’. b Explain one possible benefit to a business of selling in a fast-growing market. Explain one difference between a consumer market and an industrial market. a Define the term ‘business-to-consumer product’. b Explain one possible difference between marketing a business-to-consumer product and a business-to-business product. a Define the term ‘customer orientation’. b Explain one possible benefit of being customeroriented rather than product-oriented. Define the term ‘customer-relationship marketing (CRM)’. Explain one possible benefit to a business of customer-relationship marketing. [2] [2] [4] [12] 105 9781398308114.indb 105 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3 Marketing AS LEVEL AS LEVEL 3.2 Market research 3.2 Market research Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the purposes of market research ★ the main features of a market: size, growth, competitors ★ aspects of customer and consumer characteristics, profiles, wants and needs ★ the difference between primary and secondary research ★ the reliability of data ★ the meaning and value of sampling ★ analysis of quantitative and qualitative data. 3.2.1 Purposes of market research Market research involves the gathering and analysis of data that is relevant to your marketing. The purpose of market research is to understand more about the customers of a business and the main features of the market as a whole to help the business make better marketing decisions. For example, a business might want to use marketing research to identify the main features of a market, such as: » the size of the market. This can be measured in terms of the number of dollars spent in it (the value of the market) or the number of items purchased (the volume of the market) » the growth of a market. This measures the rate at which the market has increased (or potentially decreased) in size. The growth in a market is measured by: market growth = change in market size original market size × 100 For example, if the market size is $200 000 and it changes to $220 000, the growth is: market growth = ($220 000 − $200 000) $200 000 × 100 = 10% Usually the growth of a market will be measured over a year; for example, 10 per cent growth this year. If a market is growing fast, this means that demand is there and may create more opportunities for sales to increase » competitors. Research will give the business an insight into how many competitors there are in a market and what their sales are. A business can identify its own market share and the market share of its competitors. The market share of a business is measured by its sales as a percentage of total sales. market share of a business = sales by the business total market sales × 100 For example, if the sales of a competitor are $40 000 and the total market sales are $160 000, its market share is: market share of a business = $40 000 $160 000 × 100 = 25% A business will be interested in the relative size of these competitors because this might reflect their strength and the threat they might create. In some markets there may be relatively few competitors – usually this is true in the banking and telecommunications industry. In other industries there may be many competitors; for example, this is usually the case with hairdressers and cafés. Market research will also allow a business to identify how it is positioned relative to its competitors; for example, is it regarded as better value for money? Is it seen as a premium product or more basic than its rivals? This might affect some of the marketing actions the business then takes. As well as understanding the market as a whole, managers can also use market research to identify different aspects of customers and consumers, such as their characteristics, profiles, wants and needs. A customer is someone who purchases and pays for a product or service. A consumer is the person who ultimately uses the product or service. If you buy and drink a cup of coffee, you are the customer and consumer. If your parents buy you a present for your birthday, they are the customer and you are the consumer. Businesses need to consider both their customers and consumers when deciding on how best to market their products. Characteristics of consumers and customers might include aspects such as their age, gender, income, where they are located and their lifestyle. This might allow the business to identify patterns within its customers and adjust its marketing accordingly. A customer profile is an outline of the customer base of the business – it outlines the characteristics of the customers. 106 9781398308114.indb 106 05/03/21 11:07 AM Customer and consumer needs refer to what people must have to survive, such as water and food. Customer wants refer to what people desire but are not essential, such as a particular type or brand of food. Market research can identify the fundamental need to buy the product (for example, because customers are thirsty or hungry) and customer wants (which shows which product they would like to buy). Having identified customers’ need, a business will aim to make them want its products as opposed to those of a competitor. By undertaking market research, managers should have a better idea of what people want and how they behave. This should mean that the firm can meet their needs more effectively and avoid wasteful marketing activities. Imagine that you are considering launching a new product. If you can find out who your target market is, what they like, what they read, where they shop, what they watch and listen to, then your marketing can be much more effective. For example, there is no point in spending money on a big Saturday afternoon television campaign if your target audience is out watching a sports match. Market research may be undertaken before the business is set up in order to decide whether or not it is viable. It can also be undertaken once the business is up and running to decide what to do next; for example, whether to change the price of a product or launch a new brand. Identifies market opportunities Market research Assesses the effectiveness of different marketing actions Assesses the alternative options open to the business to meet customer needs ▲ Figure 3.8 Uses of market research Typically, market research is used to: » identify features of a market such as its size, the segments that exist, its growth and what competitors exist the market. This means identifying customer needs and wants, and the profiles of different customer segments. 3.2 Having undertaken this analysis, businesses can use their market research findings to: » assess the alternative options open to the business to meet customer needs » assess the effectiveness of different marketing actions. GLOSSARY TERMS Market research is the process of gathering, analysing and producing data relevant to the marketing process. Primary market research gathers data for the first time for a specific purpose. STUDY TIP Simply gathering data for the sake of it does not make much sense, so managers need to be clear about why it is being gathered, how accurate it has to be, what time there is to gather it in, what the best way of gathering it is and what costs are involved. 3.2.2 Primary research and secondary research Market research provides a manager with information which is important for effective decision-making. Imagine you are wandering around a house at midnight and none of the lights are working. You stumble, move slowly and make mistakes getting around. Market research can provide the lighting in the room that enables you to move quickly, efficiently and effectively, to get to where you want. Market research can provide the light you need in order to view the whole situation. » identify features of the customers and consumers in 3.2.2 Primary research and secondary research Primary market research In some cases, you may have to gather new data for a specific purpose. This is called primary market research. For example, you may want to discover what people in your local area think of your specific idea, whether they are likely to use your particular service or what they think of your business name. This sort of information will not exist already, so you will need to undertake new research. Primary research can be tailored precisely to your own needs, but it can be quite expensive and time-consuming compared with using information already collected. The danger is that because of cost constraints, or because you are inexperienced, you only ask a relatively small number of people or a specific group that does not really represent the population as a whole. This means that your results may be biased and misleading. If you ask your friends, for example, they may tell you it is a great idea even if it isn’t, because they do not want to upset you! If you are going to undertake primary research, you need to make sure that you: » don’t lead people into giving you the answer you want (for example, ‘Why do you think my idea is so good?’ is a leading question) » ask a representative group of people (that is, that you hope will represent your target group) 107 9781398308114.indb 107 05/03/21 11:07 AM » ask enough people for the findings to be significant (one 3.2 person’s opinion may not necessarily reflect the views of the population as a whole). Primary data can be gathered: AS LEVEL 3.2 Market research » by observation. For example, you may watch what is happening in the stores of your possible competitors or count how many people walk by a potential location for your shop on a typical day to calculate the ‘footfall’. In high-street retailing, the footfall is an important indicator of the likely number of customers. The more people that walk past, the more customers you may get » through surveys. You may have been stopped in the street and asked your opinion about something. This is a face-to-face survey and is one way of finding out what people think. Firms also use telephone, mail or online surveys to find out the views of potential customers. Surveys may give you an idea of what people think of your idea and help you decide whether or not to go ahead » by asking a small group of people what they think (a focus group) » by test marketing. Sometimes a business may try a product in a test market, such as a particular region, for a while to see how it sells. If this goes well it might be rolled out to other areas; if sales are poor, changes could be made to the product or the way it is promoted to see what happens then. GLOSSARY TERMS A focus group is a small number of people gathered together to talk about a particular issue in open discussion. Secondary market research uses data that already exists. CASE STUDY Africa Africa is one of the biggest emerging markets in the world. This rapidly expanding, competitive environment creates a growing need for market research. Consumers are the lifeblood of companies, but do companies actually possess sufficient knowledge about their consumers? Are their customers (perfectly) satisfied with their products/ services? What are their opinions and wishes? How could their loyalty be improved? These are important questions for organisations and investors operating in Africa. Africa represents a major market opportunity with a growing population, a growing middle class and relatively fast economic growth. The potential Africa will be the fastest-growing economy in the world in the next five years. For example, Uganda has an economic growth of 6.41 per cent per year, yet only 1 per cent of the total global market research budget is invested in Africa. The basic survivors (people living on or below one dollar a day) is a huge group in African countries (in Uganda, for example, this group is 65 per cent of the population). Given the fact that Africa is the fastest-growing economy in the world, the basic survivors move towards a regular middle class, with comparable incomes and Western consumer behaviour. This means there is a huge potential for doing business, but there is still an unused investment opportunity in African countries. Companies that find new ways to overcome constraints and tap opportunities can gain insights, market share and customer or supplier loyalty, and will secure a strong position in this growing market. Effective market research methods in developing countries More than 500 million Africans use a mobile phone and the market is growing fast each year. Mobiles have penetrated to even those villages that have no electricity and no landlines. The rapid and accelerating penetration of mobile phones through all levels of society in developing countries means that it is possible to communicate with the basic survivors and emerging middle classes. This underlines the massive potential to use mobile phones in order to reach and interact with huge groups of people across the continent. The explosive growth of Africa’s mobile communications industry offers a vast potential to interact with people on a personal level. Market research is conducted by inviting people to participate in surveys and rewarding them with incentives such as mobile phone credits. The mobile phone is particularly well-suited to market research as it is costeffective, reliable and enables clients to obtain results virtually in real time. Furthermore, it allows consumers to participate in surveys when and where it suits them. These advantages have a positive impact on response rates, data quality and validity of results. Source: www.mckinsey.com 108 9781398308114.indb 108 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.2 2 Working Families 3 Rising Strivers 4 Cosmopolitan Professionals 5 The Affluent Basic Survivors are the largest consumer group in Africa and are characteristically low income consumers. They tend to live in urban slum areas or rural areas and make day-to-day decisions based on basic needs. Working Families are the second largest consumer group. They focus their spending on their children’s needs and they value stability and routine in their lives. Rising Strivers are emerging from the first two segments, having built their purchasing power through access to credit or other resources. They value upward mobility and buy based on convenience, quality, or even more ‘expressive’ factors. Cosmopolitan Professionals are typically located in urban areas. They are busy with work but often have active social lives. As a result, these consumers value pragmatic products but are also brand conscious and influenced by the media. The Affluent of Africa have a disproportionately high purchasing power, and are considered wealthy regardless of where they travel across the globe. This group is extremely small and very fickle. ▲ Figure 3.9 Five key sub-Saharan African consumer segments Questions 1 Analyse one benefit of using the mobile phone to undertake market research. 2 [4] Secondary market research Given that the amount of money you have available to spend when starting up a business is likely to be limited, you will probably have to carry out most of your market research yourself rather than using specialist companies to do it for you. The cheapest and quickest way of doing this is to see what information about the market already exists. What data has been collected and published? A tremendous amount of information is available on the internet, in libraries and in newspapers, as well as from other sources. Using data that already exists is called secondary market research. It is particularly useful for Evaluate the potential benefits of using market research for businesses targeting Africa. [12] general information on the economy, the market and on competitors. While secondary data is usually quite quick to get hold of, it is not always in the right format for your needs, or up to date. The research may have been done in the previous year, when what you want is this year’s figure. It may organise sales data according to the sales per country, when what you need is data focusing on a particular city. Nevertheless, secondary research is usually a good starting point. Once you have looked at secondary sources, you can identify what else you need to know and what information needs to be gathered for the first time. 3.2.2 Primary research and secondary research 1 Basic Survivors CASE STUDY Coca-Cola Sparkling soft drinks Hot beverages Packaged food $1.6 trillion Juice, dairy and plant Hydration RTD tea/coffee NRTD cold Energy 4.3% NARTD Household products 4.0% 3.5% 3% 4% 0 1% 2% 5% Note: NARTD = non-alcoholic ready to drink. Industry growth for NARTD excludes white milk and bulk water ▲ Figure 3.11 Industry retail-value growth Note: RTD = ready to drink; NRTD = not ready to drink ▲ Figure 3.10 Hot and cold beverages industry retail value 109 9781398308114.indb 109 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.2 Market research 3.2 According to Coca-Cola, there are significant long-term growth opportunities both for the soft-drinks industry and for Coca-Cola. Coca-Cola has a 20 per cent market share of cold non-alcoholic beverages, with a very small market share in hot non-alcoholic beverages. In the developing and emerging world, only about 30 per cent of beverage consumption is commercialised, and Coca-Cola’s market share within these regions is about half of what it is in the developed world. The developing and emerging world represents 80 per cent of the world’s population; over 6 billion people. Therefore, Coca-Cola believes there is compelling long-term growth potential across the world through growing the overall industry and continuing to gain share. ▼ Table 3.7 Hot and cold beverages: developed and developing/emerging markets Developed markets (% sales volume) Non-commercial Developing and emerging markets (% sales volume) 30 69 Alcohol 11 3 Hot beverages 12 11 Cold beverages 47 17 1.5 billion 6.1 billion Population Source: https://coca-cola.com 3.2.3 Sampling The need for and limitations of sampling If you decide to undertake a survey, the total number of people you are interested in is known as your ‘target population’. For example, if you have an idea for a website dedicated to your favourite football team, your target population would be all the fans of the club around the world. In most cases it will not be possible to interview all of the people in your target group. It may be too expensive or would simply take too long to talk to everyone. Imagine your website was aimed at the fans of a big club like Manchester United FC or FC Barcelona. There are hundreds of thousands of fans all over the world. Even if you managed to identify them somehow, the cost and time involved in trying to talk to them would make it unrealistic, especially if you are a new business and therefore likely to have limited funds. Instead of interviewing everyone in the target population, the business might decide to take a sample. A sample is a group of people that is intended to represent the overall population. By interviewing, say, 500 fans you would hope to get an impression of what all the others think. Obviously, the results will not be 100 per cent reliable, because you have not asked everyone in the population – you have only asked some of them. This means that you cannot be totally confident of the results. So it is important to choose a sample that is big enough to be representative of the whole market. The findings from a sample that is too small may not be very reliable. Question 1 Evaluate the significance of the data in the case study, in Figures 3.10 and 3.11, and in Table 3.7, for Coca-Cola’s marketing. [12] HANDLING DATA 1 2 When deciding on the size and type of sample, you need to think about issues such as the time available, the costs and how accurate the data needs to be. Sampling methods Following market research, Nick estimates the market as a whole is worth $1 500 000. He believes his company can achieve a market share of 50 per cent. What would his sales value be? Nick also thinks the market will grow by 5 per cent next year, but he can retain the same market share. What would his sales value be then? ▼ Table 3.8 Primary and secondary research Primary Secondary • • • • • Existing data • Gathered for another purpose • May be relatively quick • May be relatively cheap New data Specific to your needs May take longer to gather May be expensive STUDY TIP There are three main ways of selecting a sample: » Random sample With a random sample, all the members of the target population have an equal chance of selection. If you wanted a random sample of 30 students at your school, you could take a list of names of all the students and then pick 30 names at random. You would then have to find them to interview. This approach has the advantage that anyone could be asked. However, it can be quite time-consuming, because once the names have been selected you then have to go and find those people. If they were not in school on that day, you would have to wait until they were, slowing up the whole process. » Stratified sample A stratified sample is based on particular proportions (such as 60 per cent males, 40 per cent females; or 20 per cent aged 16–35 and 80 per cent aged over 35). This type of sample is used when 110 9781398308114.indb 110 05/03/21 11:07 AM Types of sample Random Stratified Quota Qualitative research is based on the opinions, values and beliefs of people. It is usually undertaken using a small focus group or in-depth one-to-one interviews. This type of market research aims to understand why customers behave in certain ways, or to find out what people think of a product or what they would do in a particular situation. Qualitative research examines why customers do what they do. For example, a focus group might be used to discuss consumers’ views of a brand to understand their shopping habits. This often helps marketing managers understand what customers think of their product compared to another, and can be a starting point in the research process. Focus groups may highlight particular issues or give a reaction to a business idea that can be examined in more detail. Given that qualitative research involves small groups, it means that the findings are not statistically reliable; this is why more extensive research is often used as a follow up. Qualitative research can be quite expensive and slow to organise because it is so important to get the right group of people to talk to. 3.2 3.2.4 Market research data the target population has particular characteristics that you want reflected in your sample. You reproduce the characteristics of the target population and randomly sample within each category. » Quota sample With a quota sample, the research sets proportions (for example, male/female or different age groups) which may or may not reflect the target population. People who meet these characteristics are found as quickly and easily as possible, which means that a quota is not a random sample. For example, if you want to interview 12 students (5 male and 7 female) you simply approach people and see if they match these criteria and work with the first five male students and first seven female students who agree to take part. A quota sample is easier and quicker to complete than a random sample (as you do not need to know all the members of the population), but it is not random because members of the population do not have an equal chance of selection. To find 30 students, for example, you might simply find one class and ask them. This could lead to very biased results because they would all be a similar age and/or may all study the same subject. With a random sample you would expect a range of ages and interests, which might provide a better insight into the school as a whole. Quantitative market research is based on relatively large samples and is therefore more statistically valid. This sort of research is often used to show what has happened in a market, and its findings can be expressed in numerical terms (for example, sales of brand X have increased by 45 per cent; 12 million people watched a particular television programme last week; the market for soft drinks is worth more than $4 billion). Quantitative market research is used to answer questions such as: how many units might be sold? When are items most likely to sell? Where? What has happened? Quantitative research is usually gathered via surveys such as telephone, face-to-face or email. ▲ Figure 3.12 Types of sample Analysing market research results Choosing a sampling method When analysing the market research results a business needs to consider: » Can the results be trusted to be relatively accurate? In other words, is the research valid? » Would the research give the same results if it were repeated? In other words, is the research reliable? The choice of sampling method will depend on factors such as: » the time available. If time is limited, a quota is likely to be used because it is relatively quick to do » your knowledge of the target population. To select people randomly you must have details of the target population. If you were selecting from a list of cardholders or club members this would be feasible. However, if you were interested in potential buyers of your product, you would not necessarily know who they were and so could not select from this group randomly » the extent to which the target population has clearly differentiated groups of buyers. If the buyers can be differentiated clearly (for example, 70 per cent male, 30 per cent female) then you would want to use a stratified sample. 3.2.4 Market research data Quantitative and qualitative market research Quantitative and qualitative market research are two different approaches to market research. GLOSSARY TERMS A sample is a group of people selected to represent the population as a whole. The validity of market research refers to how accurate the findings of market research are. The reliability of market research refers to the extent to which the same results would be received if the research was conducted again. The accuracy may depend on factors such as how the information was gathered, what the sample size was and how accurate you want the findings to be. Researchers often express their findings in terms of confidence levels based on a statistical analysis of the data. For example, they might say they were 95 per cent confident that sales would 111 9781398308114.indb 111 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.2 be between $20 million and $26 million in two years’ time but only 68 per cent confident they would be between $23 and $25 million. The more precise you want the estimate to be, the less confident the researchers are likely to be. The confidence level of market research findings relates to how reliable the data is. AS LEVEL 3.2 Market research Interpreting marketing data Marketing data may be presented in many forms, often tables, charts and graphs. For example, a pie chart may be used to illustrate market share: Sales (%) When examining line graphs, you may want to consider the trend and how much sales fluctuate around this trend, as this will affect how much capacity is required and is being used. Do check the axes when looking at data. Figure 3.15 and Figure 3.16 show the same sales figures but, by changing the y-axis, the sales look as if they are rising more sharply in the second figure. Sales ($) 120 100 80 Product E: 1, 4% 60 Product D: 2, 8% 40 20 0 Product C: 4, 16% Product B: 5, 20% Product A: 13, 52% 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 2023 2024 ▲ Figure 3.15 Line graph – shallow y-axis Sales ($m) 110 100 90 Product A Product B Product C Product D Product E ▲ Figure 3.13 Example of a pie chart In this pie chart we can see the sales of each product and what proportion of the total market sales this represents (that is, its market share). 80 70 60 50 Sales data over time is often shown using a line graph: Sales ($m) 2017 2018 2020 2021 2022 ▲ Figure 3.16 Line graph – steep y-axis Data may also be presented using a bar chart; for example, the sales of a business in different regions or the sales of competitors. 60 50 40 Sales ($’000s) 45 40 30 20 10 0 2019 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 2023 2024 ▲ Figure 3.14 Example of a line graph In Figure 3.14, we can see there is an upward trend in sales. Sometimes marketing managers want to plot the underlying trend to ‘smooth out’ the data. They do this using moving averages (this is explained in Chapter 8.1). We have assumed this data was produced in 2022. The sales from 2023 onwards are, therefore, forecasts; this is often shown with a dotted line. 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 Competitor A Competitor B Competitor C Competitor D ▲ Figure 3.17 Example of a bar chart Some data may also be in the form of tables. For example, Table 3.9 shows forecasted sales volume and sales value data for a product. 112 9781398308114.indb 112 05/03/21 11:07 AM » » » » ▼ Table 3.9 Example of a table showing index values Index of sales volume (units) Year Index of sales value ($) The sales value in 2022 is 5 per cent more than 2021. The sales value in 2023 is 10 per cent more than 2021. The sales value in 2025 is 15 per cent less than 2021. The sales value in 2026 is 10 per cent more than 2021. 2021 100 100 2022 102 105 2023 105 110 2024 110 120 2025 95 115 Using marketing data 2026 90 110 When examining any marketing research data, in whatever form it is produced: » check the source. Has this been produced internally or by a specialist market research agency, for example? You will want to take a view on the reliability of the data » check the dates. How recent is the data? Markets can change quickly so be wary of old data. At the same time, if you are considering forecasts, you need to find out how it is gathered and how reliable it is likely to be » check the units. Be sure to check whether you are measuring in thousands or millions of dollars, for example. Also check the labelling of the axes – are you measuring sales or profits, for example? 3.2 Notice that in this example the sales volume by 2026 is 10 per cent less than in 2021 and yet the sales value is 10 per cent more; this must be because the price of the product has increased. Notice we can easily see the change in the sales volume; we do not know what the actual level of sales is, only the percentage change. Similarly with sales value: 3.2.4 Market research data Tables often show data as index numbers. An index number shows percentage changes relative to a starting or base point. In the table above, the base is 2021 and changes in sales volumes and values are shown compared to that. For example: » The sales volume in 2022 is 2 per cent more than 2021. » The sales volume in 2023 is 5 per cent more than 2021. » The sales volume in 2025 is 5 per cent less than 2021. » The sales volume in 2026 is 10 per cent less than 2021. CASE STUDY Esports 2000 1790 Revenue in US$ millions 1750 1500 1250 1096 1000 865 750 655 493 500 250 0 325 130 2012 194 2014 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2022 ▲ Figure 3.18 Esports market revenue worldwide, 2012–2022 Esports, or competitive video gaming, has existed for over 20 years. Sponsors like Intel and Red Bull have been hosting events for more than 10 years. However, in the last couple of years there has been a significant increase in interest in esports by major brands. Companies such as Coca-Cola and Mercedes have brought spending on their esports sponsorship into their main marketing budget. One of the appeals of esports is the reach it has with young men and the high levels of engagement. In the USA, in 2020, it is estimated that there were 21 million esports fans; 83 per cent were male and 84 per cent under the age of 35. It is now the third most-popular spectator sport for young men. Source: www.mckinsey.com/industries/technologymedia-and-telecommunications/our-insights/the-keysto-esports-marketing-dont-get-ganked Questions 1 2 3 Calculate the percentage growth in esports market revenue between 2012 and 2018. [3] Explain one factor that might determine the demand for esports. [3] Evaluate the appeal of sponsoring an esports event to a business. [12] 113 9781398308114.indb 113 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.2 TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions AS LEVEL 3.2 Market research 1 a b Define the term ‘market research’. [2] Explain one reason for undertaking market research. [3] 2 a Define the term ‘secondary market research’. [2] b Explain one advantage of secondary research compared to primary research. [3] [2] 3 a Define the term ‘primary market research’. b Explain one advantage of primary research compared to secondary research. [3] 4 Define the term ‘sample’. [2] 5 Explain one reason why a business may use sampling when undertaking market research. [3] 6 Explain one feature of effective market research. [3] 7 Explain one source of information for secondary [3] market research. 8 Explain one limitation of sampling. [3] 9 Explain one factor that might influence how much is spent on market research. [3] 10 Explain one reason why spending more on market research may not lead to higher sales. [3] Data response question Burberry and luxury brands Consumers around the globe have high expectations of luxury brands. They widely research products before purchasing and expect exceptional service in-store. The strong interest in forward-looking fashions and innovative products is partly driven by the younger customers now entering the luxury market. Consumers are increasingly using luxury products to say something about themselves, to express their individuality, their own style or point of view. This means luxury products increasingly have to be fashionable and are often sold in limited-edition ranges. The fastestgrowing segments of the luxury market are young consumers and Chinese consumers, and they expect to buy an increasing number of products they would describe as ‘fashionable’. The market for clothing and accessories is increasingly polarising between the mass market and luxury products. Consumers are increasingly preferring products that are positioned either at the highest or the lowest end of the market rather than mid-market. A huge amount of the growth in the luxury market is driven by generation Z and millennial consumers*. Generation Z consumers are more willing to shop in a physical store – although they also expect an online presence. They prefer heavily logoed products and are not especially brand loyal. Younger consumers are highly socially and environmentally aware. Concern about sustainability and a brand’s social or political stance is a key factor in their purchasing decision process. Findings from market research about the luxury market include: ● market growth has varied by region. China has continued to have very fast growth and is attractive to businesses due to its market size. There are more buyers in China due to fewer restrictions on importing products, more restrictions on buying abroad and more tax-free shops. Spending across the rest of Asia has been strong in recent years, with Hong Kong, Macau and Japan benefiting from travelling Chinese consumers due to the relative strengthening of the Chinese yuan and strong local consumption in Korea. Sales in the Middle East have remained relatively flat due to low oil prices and lower government spending in the economy ● online sales of luxury brands have been rising fast, especially in Asia ● in luxury accessories, the handbag category has done especially well recently ● growth in shoes has been highest in the trainers segment ● growth estimates for the luxury market over the next five years remain in line with 2019 estimates, ranging from 3 per cent to 5 per cent per year. * Generation Z refers to people born between 1997 and the early 2010s. Millennials are people born between 1981 and 1996. Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘market size’ [2] b ‘market growth’. [2] Analyse one way in which Burberry might research the market for its new products. [4] Evaluate how market research can help the success of Burberry’s new products. [12] 114 9781398308114.indb 114 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3 Marketing AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix In this chapter we examine: ★ the elements of the marketing mix (the four Ps) ★ the importance of the product in the marketing mix ★ product portfolio analysis ★ pricing methods ★ promotion methods ★ place (channels of distribution). A customer is influenced by many factors when deciding whether or not to purchase a product. The combination of these factors is known as the marketing mix. By developing an effective marketing mix, a business can meet the needs of its customers successfully. In this chapter we examine the different elements of the marketing mix. GLOSSARY TERM or enhancing the combination of elements that affect the customer’s buying decision. Place (distribution) The marketing mix is the combination of elements that influence a customer’s decision on whether or not to buy a product. 3.3.1 Elements of the marketing mix The marketing mix comprises all the elements associated with a product that affect whether or not the customer decides to buy it. A broad range of factors may affect customers’ purchasing decisions. Consider why a customer might choose to shop in one supermarket rather than another. The list below contains a number of factors affecting this decision. » How far away is it? » How easy is it to park? » What is the range of products like? » Are the prices competitive? » What facilities are there (for example, a coffee shop)? » Are the staff friendly and helpful? » What services are provided (such as carrying shopping to customers’ cars)? » Does the supermarket offer a loyalty card? There are clearly many factors that influence a consumer’s decision to choose one business rather than another, and these are all part of the marketing mix. An effective marketing mix offers the customer the right mix of benefits at the right price. Improving the mix will involve changing 3.3.1 Elements of the marketing mix Chapter overview Price The marketing mix Product Promotion ▲ Figure 3.19 The marketing mix is commonly described as the four Ps The marketing mix is often simplified and is commonly described as ‘the four Ps’. This approach identifies four elements in the mix (all beginning with the letter ‘P’): » Price How much are customers charged for the product and what are the terms of payment? For example, can you put a deposit down and pay in instalments? How does this price compare with that of rivals? » Product This includes the many different aspects of a product such as its design, quality, reliability, features and functions. For example, you may buy something principally because of its style (for example, Bang & Olufsen, Apple), its features, its reliability and durability (for example, JCB, Caterpillar) or the brand (for example, DKNY, Gucci). » Place This refers to the way the product is distributed. Is the product sold direct to the customer or through retail outlets? Can you buy online, or do you have to travel some distance to get to a shop where it is sold? 115 9781398308114.indb 115 05/03/21 11:07 AM » Promotion This is the way the firm communicates AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 information about the product to the customer. For example, it may use advertising or a sales force to highlight its strengths. The promotion of a product will affect the image that customers have of it and their awareness and understanding of the benefits of the product. However, the marketing mix can be extended to also feature other factors, such as a further three Ps: » People A well-trained, well-informed, polite staff can influence people to buy from one shop rather than another. Customer service is an important marketing weapon. » Physical environment This includes factors such as the layout, decor and parking, and can be an important influence on which restaurant, pub or store a person chooses. » Process The ease of ordering and paying can influence a purchase. Many supermarkets have introduced selfscanning to reduce queues and attract customers. Intangible aspects of the product refer to aspects that cannot be touched but can still be important to customers, such as the brand and its key values. It also includes aspects of the product such as a guarantee, after-sales servicing or additional technical support which come with the purchase. Some people stick with their phone service or energy company because they trust them to fix things quickly if ever there is a problem. Some businesses buy their photocopiers or computers from companies that can maintain them effectively. GLOSSARY TERMS The products of a business refer to what it offers to sell to its customers. These may be goods, which are tangible items, or services, which are intangible. The tangible attributes of a product refer to its physical aspects, such as how it looks and feels. 3.3.2 Products The intangible aspects of a product refer to aspects that cannot be touched but can still be important to customers, such as the brand and its key values. The difference between goods and services Product differentiation occurs when the benefits of your product are perceived as clearly different from competitors’ products. Products refer to goods which are tangible products; services are intangible. Businesses will keep reviewing their products to ensure they are relevant and continue to meet customer needs. When reviewing their products, businesses will consider the core benefit that the product provides. For example, a soft drink satisfies thirst, a washing machine provides clean clothes and an aircraft moves people and cargo from A to B. Businesses have to be aware of new substitutes coming along – with more social communication systems such as Zoom, Skype and FaceTime, people may not need to travel as much. With more emailing there may be reduced need for letter-writing paper. The ways of providing a core benefit can change and businesses must be aware of this and prepare accordingly. Tangible and intangible attributes of products The tangible attributes of products refer to the physical aspects of a product. In the case of a washing machine, for example, the business would consider what size, features, capacity and types of wash were needed and what energy usage it had. The features customers require would vary – in the case of a washing machine, some people live in tower blocks and use industrial-size washing machines in the basement areas. In other cities people have apartments with smaller washing machines inside. In some countries people have a utility room with lots of space, and the washing machine is a ‘top loader’ where people put the washing in from the top. In other regions the workspace on the top is needed and so washing machines are ‘front loaders’. Products must be developed according to how people are likely to use them. These attributes of a product include the specifications, features and design of the product. The importance of product development Developing new products is essential to most businesses. This is because: » customers’ tastes change and so a business must change what it offers as well; for example, customers generally want less sugar in their food products than in the past » competitors will constantly be developing their offerings, so a business needs to innovate to keep up and remain competitive » developments in technology will create new opportunities for products (and indeed can create whole new markets) which businesses will want to make use of » new laws and regulations change what can be produced; for example, diesel cars may be banned in the future. Of course, some products seem to have been around for many years – such as Kellogg’s Cornflakes – but even here there will be some developments relating to the ingredients, recipe, packaging, size of the boxes and communications about the benefits of the product. At the same time Kellogg’s will be developing other products to meet emerging customer needs. Product differentiation and unique selling point One possible approach of marketing is to differentiate the products that the business sells relative to its competitors. Product differentiation occurs when the benefits of your product are perceived as clearly different from competitors’ products. Your product may be perceived as easier, safer, better designed or trendier, for example. This differentiation can be achieved by having a unique selling point (USP); this 116 9781398308114.indb 116 05/03/21 11:07 AM is something about your product which is perceived by your customers as unique. For example, you might be selling the only water from Lake X or the best performing car according to a recent survey. By promoting its USP, a business can differentiate its offering and may be able to charge more or offer better value for money. 3.3.3 Product portfolio analysis Sales The product life cycle traces the stages of a product over its life. The typical path for a product can be divided into five stages, as in Figure 3.20. 2 The introduction (launch) stage This is the stage at which the product or service is launched and put on sale. Many product ideas will never actually reach this stage. They are abandoned after prototypes have been produced and tested. In the launch phase, promotion costs will be relatively high to make potential customers aware of the product, therefore a loss is still likely to be made. Producers may also struggle to get firms to stock their products or customers to try their service at this stage if the business is new, with no proven track record. Buyers may be reluctant to risk switching to or trialling a new product, particularly if there are heavy costs involved in doing so. For example, if there is a penalty payment for switching from one credit card, mortgage company, electricity company or gas company to another, customers are more likely to remain with their existing providers. 3 The growth stage Launch Time Research Introduction and development Growth Maturity Decline ▲ Figure 3.20 The product life cycle GLOSSARY TERMS Product portfolio analysis occurs when a business examines the position of all of its products in terms of their relative market share and market growth. The product life cycle shows the stages of a product over its lifetime. If the product becomes known and accepted by customers, sales should grow. At this stage, it should be slightly easier to get distributors to stock the products, as they will be more confident of sales and therefore willing to stock them. The firm should begin to make profits at this stage, as revenues begin to outweigh costs. For example, sales of teeth-whitening formulas, smoothies, men’s cosmetics and laser eye-surgery are at their growth stage in several countries. At this stage, you need to make sure you can meet the demand and manage the growth process. You may be taking on more staff, buying more equipment and expanding your premises; if this is happening rapidly it can be difficult to keep control. Making sure you can meet deadlines and maintaining quality can be major problems at this time. 3.3 3.3.3 Product portfolio analysis Product life cycle such as the size of the paper or whether to switch to colour, are far less frequent). Of course, some products never reach the growth stage: they are launched but are never successful and sales fail to take off. 1 The research and development stage 4 The maturity and saturation stage During this stage, the basic idea for the product is developed and tested. Mock-ups of a design may be made, models of a product may be produced or a new recipe may be taste-tested. This stage can be expensive for a firm and no revenue is being generated during this period. This is a time of high risk because the product may never be developed successfully and the investment at this stage may not be recovered. For example, it took James Dyson 15 years and more than 5000 prototypes of the Dyson vacuum cleaner before he got it right, highlighting the time and money that can be used up in the development phase. At this point in a product’s life, the growth of sales slows down. The product may have been in the market for some time and competitors may have launched similar products. Products such as washing machines and televisions are currently in their maturity stage. The maturity stage can last for years in some cases. There is no rapid expansion and managers must consider what to do next with the product; for example, should funds be invested to try to boost sales or should the product be scrapped? The length of the research and development process will vary from product to product. In the case of new pharmaceuticals, it can take 12–15 years to develop and test products before they can be launched, whereas developing a new design for a greetings card is likely to take months rather than years. Some products, such as newspapers, are modified on a daily basis (although significant changes, Eventually, the sales of any product are likely to fall. The business may find it more difficult to get the product distributed at this stage and may be forced to cut the price to maintain sales. For example, you will have seen reducedprice CDs or books in the bargain areas of shops: the price has been reduced to try to increase sales. Products such as board games, road atlases and bow ties are in their decline stages. 5 Decline 117 9781398308114.indb 117 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 then adjust the marketing mix accordingly. For example, promotion may be used to announce the launch of a product in the introduction phase but to stress the differences with competitors in the maturity phase. The price may be high initially if the product has some unique features but may have to be reduced in later stages as competitors enter the market. Distribution may be difficult to get at first when a product is new, but it may be easier over time when it has begun to prove itself. The business should be able to improve the firm’s performance by recognising or anticipating where the product is in its life cycle and adapting the marketing mix accordingly. STUDY TIP Remember that the shape of the product life cycle will vary from one product to the next. In some cases, a product may sell well for relatively few weeks or months and then fade; for example, a successful film. Other products may sell well for years, such as a popular book. Products may be at different stages in different regions. Using the product life cycle Managers may use the product life cycle model to identify which stage a product is in at any given moment and CASE STUDY Dyson Dyson is a technology company that is well-known for its product innovations, such as its vacuum cleaners and hairdryers. In 2016, it started to develop prototypes of electric cars but, in 2019, Dyson announced it was going to end this project. The company said it had developed a fantastic car but it was not commercially viable to produce it. Dyson had intended to invest more than £2 billion in developing a radical and different type of electric vehicle. It was never intended for the mass market but, even given the premium price Dyson expected to charge, the company did not think it could sell enough to be profitable. The intention had been to produce the car in Singapore, although £200 million was invested in research and development and test-track facilities within the UK. The project employed 523 people, 500 of whom were in UK, and Sir James Dyson said they had achieved a great deal, even if the car was not going to go into production. The company said that work on developing the battery technology could be transferred to its other projects. Source: Charlie Box/Dyson ▲ Figure 3.21 Dyson patent diagram from 2019 Questions 1 Analyse one factor that influences the design of a vacuum cleaner. 2 [4] Evaluate whether Dyson was right to invest in developing an electric car. [12] 118 9781398308114.indb 118 05/03/21 11:07 AM Extending sales in the product life cycle Effect of extension strategy » Sales » ▲ Figure 3.22 Extension strategies A firm may try to prevent the sales of a product going into decline by using extension strategies. Methods to do this might include: » increasing the usage of the product on any given occasion. For example, shampoo products often advise you to wash once, then rinse your hair and wash again, thereby doubling the usage rate » encouraging the use of the product on more occasions. For example, Head & Shoulders shampoo was seen » GLOSSARY TERM An extension strategy occurs when marketing activities are changed to prevent sales from falling. 3.3 3.3.3 Product portfolio analysis » Time by consumers as a product to use when dandruff was already present. The company tried to change this perception to get people to use it all year round to prevent dandruff, as well as cure it reducing the price. As products approach the maturity stage, firms often cut the price to maintain sales. The success of this depends on how sensitive demand is to changes in price adapting the product. Look around a supermarket and you will see endless examples of ‘new, improved’ products or products with added X, extra Y or less Z! These are all ways of trying to keep the consumer interested in the product introducing promotional offers. Another technique often used by firms to try to prevent sales from falling is to have competitions or offers to boost their sales changing the image of the product. Products may be repackaged to make them appear more modern and attractive to consumers. CASE STUDY Command and conquer Command and conquer is a computer game in which there is a war between the Global Defence Initiative and a terrorist group called the Brotherhood of Nod. Command and conquer was originally a video game in 1995, when it was first released on compact discs. Players could compete against others using what was then an emerging technology – the internet. It sold around 3 million copies. More than 30 updated computer games were launched in 2020. Final Fantasy vii Remake is a remake of a PlayStation game from 1997. It sold 3.5 million copies in three days when it was released in April 2020. Re-releasing games appeals to those who remember them from their childhood. It is also cheaper than developing a new game from scratch, which can cost $100 million. In 2020, a new, improved version came out. This was similar to the original in many ways but had better graphics. Revamping products is common in the music industry where music will be remixed, remastered or brought out as a special edition or part of a compilation. Film studies produce the director’s cut or an edition with ‘extras’ or ‘outtakes’. Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor that affects the promotional mix of a new computer game. [4] Evaluate whether computer games companies are [12] right to relaunch past games. ▼ Table 3.10 Examples of how marketing decisions may change at different stages of the product life cycle Introduction Growth Maturity Decline Price May be low to introduce May be able to increase with demand May hold May cut to boost sales Distribution May be limited as stores May increase to gain unsure whether to stock access to the market May hold May focus on bestperforming outlets Promotion May focus on awareness May try to increase awareness May highlight differences with competitors who may have entered May try to reinforce existence and benefits of the product Product May be limited number of models/varieties May stop developing new models/varieties May focus on best performers May widen range with demand 119 9781398308114.indb 119 05/03/21 11:07 AM Segway AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 CASE STUDY ▲ Figure 3.23 Segway products The Segway Personal Transporter (PT) was a selfbalancing electric scooter that was launched in 2001 by Dean Kamen, its American inventor. ‘Our inspiration for the name “Segway” came from the word segue, which is defined as “to transition smoothly from one state to another”. Segway transforms a person into an empowered pedestrian, allowing him/her to go farther, move more quickly and carry more.’ The Segway had a self-righting technology. If you leant forward, a collection of microprocessors and a set of sophisticated tilt sensors and gyroscopic sensors adjusted so you maintained your balance. The Segway could travel up to 12 miles an hour (19 km/h). In 2015, Segway joined with Ninebot, a privately held Chinese company. The combined company focuses on the research and development, design, manufacturing, distribution and sales of short-distance transportation products. According to Segway, more and more people are using Segway-Ninebot products as an eco-friendly alternative for many of the short journeys that are typically made by car.’ Unfortunately, the transportation revolution that inventor Dean Kamen had envisioned when he launched the Segway PT never really took off. The Segway’s original price tag of around $5000 was too high for many customers. The initial difficulties customers often had balancing also caused problems. The number of highprofile accidents – including the death of the company’s owner in 2010 when he drove a Segway off a cliff by mistake – did not help the Segway’s image. Furthermore, some governments declared that the Segway could not be used in any public place. It was too fast to be used on the pavement but not safe enough to be used on the road. In June 2020, the company announced that it would stop production of the Segway PT. The company continues to produce other products and the Segway only accounted for about 1.5 per cent of the company’s revenue by this stage. Source: https://uk-en.segway.com/about-the-brand Questions 1 2 Analyse one reason why the company may have stopped production of the Segway PT. [4] Evaluate the ways in which the marketing of a Segway product might change as it moves from the introduction to the growth phase of the product life cycle. [12] 120 9781398308114.indb 120 05/03/21 11:07 AM HANDLING DATA Over five years the sales of a product are as shown in Table 3.11. of portfolio analysis was developed by the management consultancy Boston Consulting Group and is known as the Boston Matrix. This model analyses the position of a firm’s products in terms of their market share and the growth of the markets they operate in. 3.3 ▼ Table 3.11 Sales of a product over five years 1 $100 000 2 $150 000 3 $200 000 4 $220 000 5 $225 000 What stage of the product life cycle do you think the sales are in? Explain your answer. The value of the product life cycle model The product life cycle model is valuable because it highlights the fact that marketing activities have to be adjusted at different stages in the development of a product. However, it is important to remember that the product life cycle is just a model and its shape will vary considerably between products. In the case of a new single release by a band, for example, the life span may be just a matter of weeks, whereas Marmite was launched in the early twentieth century and is still in its maturity phase. Toys often have short life cycles but some of them, such as Barbie dolls, have been around for many years. So marketing decisions in relation to the product life cycle are not clear-cut; some products in decline have had to be taken off the market because they cannot be made viable while others, such as the drink Tango, have been rebranded and brought back to great success. Often, it will only be clear in retrospect what stage a product was in; what appears to be a slight dip may turn out to be the decline of a product, or what appears to be a decline may only be a slight dip: it only becomes clear later on. Unfortunately, businesses have to make decisions as they go. They do not have the luxury of waiting to see what would have happened if they had not acted. Another limitation of the product life cycle model is that it traces the sales of one product over time. Most businesses have several products and therefore it is important to look at their overall position. Product portfolio analysis Most firms have more than one product; some have hundreds. For example, at the time of writing, Unilever owns a huge number of brands, including Ben & Jerry’s, Cif, Domestos, Lipton, Magnum, Marmite, Omo, Surf, Timotei and Walls, to name but a few. The range of products and services a firm has is known as its product portfolio. As part of its planning process, a business will examine the position of these products in their markets. This is known as product portfolio analysis (PPA). One of the most famous models GLOSSARY TERMS Product portfolio analysis (PPA) examines the market position of a firm’s products. The Boston Matrix is a method of product portfolio analysis that examines the products of a business in terms of their market share and the market growth. Types of product in the Boston Matrix Each circle in the Boston Matrix represents one particular product or service. The size of the circle illustrates the turnover of the product; the bigger the circle, the higher the turnover. The firm’s products can be classified according to their market share and the growth of the market in which they operate. Stars Question marks Cash cows Dogs High Market growth (%) Sales 3.3.3 Product portfolio analysis 1 Year Low High Market share Low ▲ Figure 3.24 The Boston Matrix » Cash cows are products that have a high market share but are selling in a slow-growing market. In some cases, this type of product will be the market leader in a mature market. Although the market may not be growing very fast, this may be because it has grown in the past, leaving little room for further expansion. For example, the market for washing machines in the UK is quite big but is not actually growing very fast; given the size of the market, a brand with a high market share will have sales worth millions of pounds. By comparison, the market for electric cars and organic food is still relatively small but has potential for fast growth. A cash cow already has a large market share, so much of the promotional work will have been done already. The product is likely to have a good distribution system and people will be aware that the product exists. The firm is used to producing the product in relatively large volumes and so the cost per unit should be fairly low. As a result, this type of product is likely to bring in high levels of cash for the firm. This can be used to finance other products. 121 9781398308114.indb 121 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 products that have a small market share of a fast-growing market. These products may go on to be very successful but, equally, they may fail. They are quite vulnerable and their future is uncertain (hence the name). There is a high degree of risk associated with these products, because you cannot be sure they will succeed. They need protecting by the firm and they require extensive marketing. Most new products are question marks because their future is so uncertain, although there are exceptions when a product takes off quickly. » Stars These products enjoy a large share of a market that is growing rapidly. They are highly successful products for the business; however, they are usually expensive in terms of marketing. Money must be spent to ensure they retain their position in a growing market. For example, they may need to be promoted heavily to maintain customer awareness and to increase distribution in the market. » Dogs These products have a low market share and are selling in a slow-growing market. A firm may want to get rid of these products unless it thinks it can improve its sales. However, dogs can sometimes be revived. Lucozade used to be seen as a drink to help sick people get better, until it was very successfully repositioned as a sports and energy drink. The impact of product portfolio analysis on marketing decisions The Boston Matrix provides a snapshot of the position of all of a firm’s products at a particular moment in time, whereas the product life cycle focuses on just one product. This enables managers to see whether or not they have a balanced portfolio – that is, an appropriate mix of products. It can help a business to be more effective by providing an overview so that the manager can take appropriate actions. For example: » If a business has too many dogs, it may have insufficient new products to keep it going in the future. As a result, it may want to invest in new products. » If a business has lots of cash cows, it is generating relatively high levels of cash but, again, needs to think about the future: cash cows tend to be dominant products in markets that have already grown. A business may want and need to be involved in newer markets as well, and it should therefore look to develop some star products. » If a firm has too many question marks, it may be quite vulnerable, as question marks need protective marketing to maintain and grow their position in the market, and this may drain a firm’s resources. With an appropriate mix of products, the cash cows can be used to finance the development of question marks and turn them into stars. This way the firm uses money from established markets to enter new markets and so protects its future. Portfolio analysis, therefore, provides a good basis for effective marketing planning: » Dog products may be sold off or production and sales halted. » Star products may be invested in to maintain their position. » Cash cows may be ‘milked’ to provide funds. » Question marks may be protected. Market growth Low High » Question marks (or ‘problem children’). These are Stars Question marks Cash cows Dogs High Low Relative market share ▲ Figure 3.25 The Boston Matrix (2) CASE STUDY Coca-Cola The Coca-Cola Company is a beverage company. It has over 500 brands which are sold in more than 200 countries and territories. Its portfolio of products come in the following categories: soft drinks; water, enhanced water, and sports drinks; juice, dairy, and plant-based beverages; tea and coffee; and energy drinks. In addition, the company owns four of the world’s top five nonalcoholic sparkling soft drink brands: Coca-Cola, Diet Coke, Fanta and Sprite. underperforming (which it calls ‘zombies’), it eliminates them to make room for newer products. The company believes its success arises from its ability to connect with consumers by providing them with a wide variety of beverage choices to meet their desires, needs and lifestyle choices. The company constantly reviews its portfolio and when it has products that are Questions Just over half of Coca-Cola’s revenue is now from sparkling soft drinks, with tea and coffee and juice, dairy and plant drinks making up about another 20 per cent each, and the remaining sales being from hydration drinks. Source: https://investors.coca-colacompany.com/strategy/ growth-strategy 1 2 Analyse one reason why Coca-Cola sells products in different product categories. [4] Evaluate how product portfolio analysis is useful to Coca-Cola. [12] 122 9781398308114.indb 122 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 3.3 Crocs Since the business started in 2002, over 600 million pairs of Croc shoes have been sold in over 90 countries. The company has over 4000 employees worldwide. Croc says that it designs everything for the people who wear STUDY TIP You need to be able to discuss the value of the product life cycle model and product portfolio analysis. How can these models be used in marketing? What are their limitations? You also need to make sure you can apply them. Can you tell from sales which stage of the life cycle a product is in? Can you identify a cash cow or dog product? To make their businesses more effective, business managers need to monitor and develop suitable product portfolios. They must also adapt their marketing at different stages of the product life cycle. You need to be able to make recommendations, such as how to extend the life cycle of a product or how to improve the portfolio of a business’ products. its footwear. It aims to keep its designs simple and light. The original Crocs products sold very well, but then entered the maturity stage of the product life cycle. At this stage the managers used the original Crocs as cash cows to finance the development of new styles for different types of occasion. Source: https://careers.crocs.com/about-us Questions 1 2 Analyse one feature of Crocs’ products that you would use when promoting the product. Evaluate whether the Crocs brand can last for another 30 years. How price affects purchasing decisions The price of a product plays an important part in our decision about whether or not to buy it. If the price is too high, we simply cannot afford the product even if we want it! Even if we can afford it, we may decide it is not value for money if the price seems too high compared to the benefits the product offers. [12] The price will, therefore, often play a significant role in the purchasing decision. However, the relative importance of price is likely to vary according to the product and the particular circumstances. For example, if two petrol garages opposite each other are charging different prices for petrol, we are likely to choose the cheaper one. We are unlikely to be loyal to a particular brand of petrol. When buying a wedding ring, however, we do not always go for the cheapest! Similarly, when buying clothes and shoes we may be willing to pay more for an item if we think the brand justifies this. Even if you wanted to choose the cheapest price, it can be difficult to compare prices directly – look at how complicated the price structure is for mobile phones or electricity. The structure of special rates, different tariffs and different options can make it difficult for customers to know which is actually the best deal. 3.3.4 Pricing methods The price of a product can have a major influence on its appeal and whether or not customers think it is good value for money. In this section, we examine the factors influencing the price of a product and different pricing strategies. Getting the price right is an important element of effective marketing, because it will determine whether customers believe they are receiving value for money. [4] 3.3.4 Pricing methods Crocs, Inc. is a world-famous shoes manufacturer. The company was established in Colorado, USA, producing simple, comfortable boat shoes. Nowadays, Crocs footwear can be found all over the world and there are over 120 different styles. Crocs are distinctive for their bright colours and their comfort. The company describes its products as the ‘most delightfully comfortable shoes in the world’. It claims that comfort leads to happiness and this makes the world a better place! The footwear is made of very soft, light and flexible material which makes them easy to wear. The shoes are made using the company’s own resin, called Croslite. Cost of producing a unit Type of product Factors influencing price Competitors Demand for a product ▲ Figure 3.26 Factors influencing price Factors determining the price of a product The price of a product will depend on the following range of factors. 123 9781398308114.indb 123 05/03/21 11:07 AM » The type of product Demand for some products is more AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 » » » » » sensitive to price than others. When you are looking to buy a new microwave, for example, you are likely to look online or go to a shop that stocks several models. You may even go to a couple of different outlets to compare what they offer. This type of product is called a ‘shopping good’ because you shop around to find a good deal. These products are very sensitive to price differences so prices need to be competitive. Other products are known as speciality items. These include high-performance cars and luxury watches. Customers are likely to be willing to travel some distance to find these items and are heavily influenced by their design and branding factors. These products are less sensitive to price changes because they are unique. This may lead to higher prices. The cost of producing a unit Although in the short term a firm may sell an item at a loss to get it established in a market, in the long term a product will nearly always have to generate a profit. This means the price has to be greater than the cost per unit. Some organisations (such as museums and hospitals) are non-profit making and so do not necessarily have to cover their costs. However, most firms in the private sector have to make a longterm profit to survive. The price therefore cannot fall below the unit cost for too long. The ability of customers to pay If the economy is doing well and customers have high income levels, a firm may be able to increase prices. If, however, incomes are falling, customers may be more sensitive to the price and look for a better deal (or wait before purchasing); this may delay any price increases by firms. The demand for a product The level of interest in and demand for a product will also affect the price that firms can charge. Holiday companies will often increase their prices in the school holidays, when they know lots of families will want to go away. The holiday companies lower prices when demand is lower during term time. The sensitivity of demand to price changes The sensitivity of demand to price is measured by the price elasticity of demand (which we will examine in Chapter 8.1). Demand for some products is very sensitive to the price, as people shop around for the best deal. Other items may not be so sensitive; for example, if it is an exclusive item. Competitors The price that a business sets for its product must take account of competitors’ prices. If competitors are offering a similar product or service and it is easy to switch from one to the other, firms are likely to set similar prices to each other. This is why businesses will often stress the particular benefits of what they are offering, so they can justify a higher price. If customers believe a product provides better value for money, they may still buy it even if it is more expensive. Stella Artois beer, for example, ran a very » » » » successful ‘reassuringly expensive’ campaign in the UK, stressing that you pay more for high-quality lager. The price was said to reflect the quality. There are now many websites offering price comparisons; this makes demand more sensitive to price as customers are looking around more. Pricing points Some businesses aim to have a given range of products at particular pricing points in the market (for example, the top or bottom end of the market) depending on the brand image and other elements of the marketing mix. Some businesses produce several different brands, priced at different levels. For example, a business may produce several different watches (often under different brand names); some in an exclusive range, some for the mass market and some discounted items. The objectives of the business The price charged by a firm will be influenced by its objectives. If a firm has a particular profit target, this will influence the price that is set per unit. If it wants to achieve $10 000 profit and expects to sell 20 000 units, it must make $0.50 profit per unit, if this is possible. If, however, it is aiming for a high market share (at least in the short term) it may be willing to sell at a lower price if this will help to boost sales. The stage in the product life cycle The price of a product is likely to be changed at different stages in the product life cycle. For example, when the product is in the maturity stage, the price may need to be reduced to avoid losing sales to competitors. The rest of the marketing mix The price a firm charges also depends on the other elements of the marketing mix. A heavily branded consumer product (such as Nike trainers or Coca-Cola) will be expensive compared to a product which does not have a well-known brand, for example. An exclusive four-star restaurant will charge more than a fast-food store. A designer boutique will charge more than Primark. Typically, the price will be higher if the product: – has a unique selling point – is perceived as being exclusive – is in high demand – is sold through exclusive outlets. There are therefore many factors that can influence the price of a product, and setting the price is a complex decision. If managers understand these influences, they can market their products more effectively by setting the right price for the market conditions. Managers can judge, for example, whether a price cut makes sense, given the market conditions. Of course, a price is not fixed forever and there are a number of times when a firm might reconsider the price it is charging for a product. In the following sections, we consider different pricing strategies and approaches. 124 9781398308114.indb 124 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 3.3 Vertu Every Vertu phone was handmade by a single craftsman at the company’s small factory at Church Crookham, England. This is not like any other phone – Vertu used materials such as ruby, sapphire and titanium. Each material used was selected not just for the fact that it looks good, but also for its exceptional strength. Customers could have phones made to order so that the design reflects their personal choices. GLOSSARY TERMS Competitive pricing is when companies set their prices at the same level as, or slightly below, their rivals. Penetration pricing is a pricing strategy aimed at gaining market share via a low entry price. Price skimming occurs when a high initial price is set for a product and this is reduced over time. Price discrimination occurs when different prices are charged for the same product. Pricing methods for new products When a product is first launched into a market, a firm has to decide what price to charge. It has a number of options: » Competitive pricing Some firms set their price at the same level as their competitors or deliberately undercut their rivals. Richer Sounds, a hi-fi, home cinema and TV specialist, guarantees to charge lower prices than rivals. Esso operates a ‘pricewatch’ to monitor competitors’ prices. Several retailers offer to refund the difference if you can find the same product cheaper in another local store. Competitive pricing is common when consumers can easily make a direct comparison between different products. The rise in internet usage has made it easier for customers to compare prices between firms; this puts more pressure on firms to be competitive. » Penetration pricing This strategy uses a low price to enter the market and gain market share. This makes sense if there are cost advantages from producing on a large scale. For example, in some markets a high level of investment is required to set up, such as when investing in premises and equipment. Once this investment has When you owned a Vertu you could also get access to a concierge service. This means you had your own private butler online. This service was available for customers 24 hours a day, every day of the year, and helped customers organise their lives and gain access to the most exclusive events and places. For example, the concierge service could help customers get tickets to watch large-scale sports events around the world, meet globally famous chefs at Michelin-star restaurants or travel to private islands. Questions 1 2 State one group that would be a target market for [3] Vertu. Explain your answer. Evaluate the factors that would have influenced the [12] price set for the Vertu phone. 3.3.4 Pricing methods Vertu‘s aim was simple: to create something extraordinary. Its main products were luxury mobile phones. These began at a price of around $10 000. The company said that its products brought together great craftsmanship, outstanding performance and exceptional customer services. been carried out, a firm may want to generate high levels of demand to spread the costs over many units. A low entry price might help do this. Price penetration is also beneficial if the market is price sensitive (price elastic), in that a lower price will generate significantly higher sales and increase revenue. » Price skimming This strategy uses a high price to enter a market. Even though the price is high, some people may still be eager to try a new product. Once sales from this group of people have been exhausted, the price can be dropped to attract a new group of customers. When this group is exhausted, the price can be cut again. A price skimming strategy is appropriate if the firm can protect its idea or invention so that competitors cannot enter with a cheaper version in the early stages. Price skimming makes sense if the market is not particularly price sensitive (that is, it is price inelastic), so that a price cut would generate a relatively smaller increase in sales. This strategy is often used with new technology; for example, the latest computer or computer accessory enters the market with a high price, which then falls quite rapidly a year or so later. » Price discrimination This occurs when different prices are charged for the same product. You will sometimes find that demand conditions for the same product can vary and the price changes as a result. For example, demand for public transport around 8 a.m. is very heavy, as people want to get to work for 9 a.m. Similarly, demand is busy between 5 p.m. and 6 p.m., as people want to get home. Demand is less heavy at other times of day. If a business can identify different demand conditions, it may want to change the price in the different markets. The demand for transport before 9 a.m. and between 5 p.m and 6 p.m. is likely to be price 125 9781398308114.indb 125 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 inelastic: it is not sensitive to price because people have to get to and from work. At these times, a transport business may increase price to increase revenue. At other times of day, demand may be more price elastic (that is, sensitive to price) because there is not the same pressure on people to travel; they can always delay their journey or not go at all. To raise revenue at these times, the business may decrease price. The result is that customers pay different prices for the same journey at different times of day. Price discrimination may occur when firms charge different prices: – at different times of day; for example, taxi fares may be higher after midnight – to different age groups; for example, lower fares on the bus for children and pensioners – to different customer groups; for example, discounts for members. » Dynamic pricing occurs when prices are changed at different times to reflect demand conditions. Airlines may change prices according to when you book, utility companies may change rates according to demand for their services during a day, theatres, cinemas and sports stadia may change the ticket prices depending on when you are looking. Dynamic pricing is much easier with online ordering, where the business can track in real time the availability of places or products and measure levels of demand by the number of searches and enquiries, and then adjust the price accordingly. For the business, it means it does not have to estimate demand in advance and set what it hopes is the right price – it can adjust continually, increasing it if demand looks high and reducing it if demand is low. This should allow the business to control demand more effectively and ensure, for example, that its planes, hotels and sports arenas are full. The business should be able to maximise revenue (increasing prices if demand is high to ration the products available rather than turning people away) and make full use of the capacity available. From a customer’s perspective, it means be prepared to discover you paid a very different price from the person in the seat next to you! » Cost-based pricing occurs when a business considers the costs of an item and adds on an amount or a percentage to ensure it makes a profit. A shop may buy in a product at $10 and add on $2 to sell at $12. The advantage of this approach is its simplicity and it means the business is certain it makes a profit, assuming the item sells. However, the disadvantage is that it is ignoring demand. It may be that there is such demand that this product could sell for $20 at that moment. » Psychological pricing takes account of the psychological effect of a price on customers. For example, a high price for consultancy work might suggest that the person is an expert; if the price is too low customers may worry about the consultant’s competency. Other examples of psychological pricing are: – charging, say, $49.99 rather than $50. In the customer’s mind, this makes the price ‘$40 something’ rather than ‘$50 something’ and therefore more attractive. – putting ‘was’ and ‘now’ or ‘sale’ to suggest this is a bargain. For example, ‘was $20, now $15’ may be more appealing than just stating ‘$15’. Penetration pricing Psychological pricing Cost-based pricing Price skimming Pricing strategies Dynamic pricing Price discrimination Competitive pricing ▲ Figure 3.27 Pricing strategies GLOSSARY TERMS Dynamic pricing occurs when different prices are changed at different times to reflect demand conditions. Cost-based pricing occurs when a business considers the costs of an item and adds on an amount or a percentage to ensure it makes a profit. Psychological pricing takes account of the psychological effect of a price on customers. The promotional mix refers to the combination of ways in which the business communicates about its products. STUDY TIP You need to understand the many different factors that can influence the price of a product and the different pricing strategies and tactics used by businesses. You need to be able to discuss the factors that determine the right price in any situation. By understanding these pricing methods, managers can decide on the best price to set when launching a new product. To make a business more effective, it needs to select a price that makes customers feel they are receiving excellent value for money. The price must be reviewed and changed as market conditions and external factors change. 126 9781398308114.indb 126 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 3.3 IKEA IKEA is a furniture and home-furnishings business. It seeks ‘to create a better everyday life for people ... by offering a wide range of well-designed, functional homefurnishing products at prices so low that as many people as possible will be able to afford them.’ Source: www.ikea.com/ms/en_JP/about_ikea/the_ikea_way/ our_business_idea/index.html Questions 1 2 Analyse one reason why IKEA is able to keep its prices low. [4] Evaluate the importance of price as a factor in the success of IKEA. [12] 3.3.5 Promotion methods IKEA is, therefore, committed to high-quality design at low prices. To achieve this it: ● designs and manufactures the products itself ● manages its supply chain to be as efficient as possible ● locates its stores away from town centres to benefit from low rents ● stores many of the products ‘flat-packed’ (that is, not assembled) which enables it to store more in any given space. It also avoids the assembly costs as consumers do this for themselves ● stocks many of its products in a warehouse space. Customers find their products and take them to the tills themselves; this saves on staff costs. 3.3.5 Promotion methods In marketing, promotion refers to the ways in which businesses communicate about their products. A business will want to communicate the benefits of its products to its customers. It has to let them know the product exists, what it does and why they should buy it. In this section, we examine the importance of the promotional mix in marketing. This is the combination of activities used to communicate about and promote the business and its products. Managing the way that a business communicates with its customers about its products is vital to its success. Advertising Sales promotion Personal selling Public relations Merchandising What is promotion and what are its objectives? The promotion of a product involves communicating about it to existing or potential customers. The purposes of promotion include: » informing customers (for example, telling them about modifications to the product, promotional offers or new releases) » persuading them (for example, highlighting your product’s benefits compared with competitors’ products) » reassuring buyers they did the right thing by buying the product in the first place. The objectives of promotion are likely to be: » to increase sales of a business » to increase the market share of a product » to position the product relative to competitors in the minds of customers. The promotional mix The promotional mix refers to the combination of ways in which a business can communicate with its customers. The choice of promotional mix influences the effectiveness of the way in which the business is communicating; this, in turn, influences the effectiveness of the firm’s marketing. Direct mail Branding ▲ Figure 3.28 The promotional mix The elements of the promotional mix include the following. Advertising promotion Advertising is a paid-for means of communication which is part of the promotional mix. Advertising is often used as a long-term strategy to build brand loyalty. There are, of course, many different media available in terms of advertising, such as newspapers, radio, television and billboards. Increasingly, nowadays, there are also online advertising media available. Managers must determine the most appropriate media to use. This depends on the resources available, the target group and their lifestyles, the likely sales (which influences how much can be spent) and the nature of the product. Mass-market products such as cars may be able to justify television advertising, for example, whereas a 127 9781398308114.indb 127 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 local decorator may advertise in shop windows or a local magazine. The difficulty with advertising is that many consumers are bombarded by different adverts, and so getting a message through to your target group that they actually pay attention to can be difficult. With the growth of digital television and radio, as well as the internet, the volume of messages aimed at consumers is increasing all the time and this can reduce the effectiveness of some advertising. Advertisers therefore have to think carefully about what messages to deliver, what media to use and when to advertise. Effective advertising will be measured by considering the outcomes achieved (for example, more sales or greater awareness of the product) in relation to the costs of the campaign. Sales promotions Sales promotions are attempts to boost sales using techniques such as promotional offers, competitions and price cuts. Offers can include 10 per cent extra free and ‘buy one, get one free’ (called ‘BOGOF’). Sales promotions may be used as a means of boosting sales in the short term. When undertaking a promotional campaign, a firm must consider: » What will it cost? » What will it do to the brand image? » To what extent will the offer be effective? For example, the type of offer you would give as a sportswear company is different from a wine or perfume business » What is the likely impact on sales? Personal selling often takes place through a sales force. If a product is sold in low volumes, is technical and complex and needs to be explained to customers, then a sales force is likely to be an effective promotional method. The sales team can be absolutely essential in some markets. For example, manufacturers must work to achieve sales through the retailers; the manufacturing companies’ sales teams compete very aggressively to get their products displayed in the best way to get their promotions highlighted in the stores. Direct promotion This promotion involves communications delivered directly to the consumer without any intervening media. Examples of direct promotion are house-to-house selling, such as Avon or Tupperware sales, direct mailings and emailings, and telemarketing (which is where a sales team telephone customers). With increasingly sophisticated database information, these can be carefully targeted – although this is not always the case. Some direct promotion is associated with ‘junk mail’, which means it is not very well targeted. Businesses do need to be careful where they get their mailing lists from and ensure they are not breaking any data protection laws by accessing a list. Databases have to meet data protection requirements (for example, customers must have access to the information held on them) and be kept up to date to be useful. Direct promotion can be relatively cost-effective and the response rate can be measured relatively easily. For example, what proportion of visits or telephone calls lead to action by the customer? What proportion of people who receive an email respond to it? Personal selling is based on face-to-face contact with customers. This may be used by manufacturers to get distributors to take their products, or in industrial markets and the service sector, where the producer often deals directly with the customer. Financial services such as pensions, insurance and mortgages are often sold in this way. Similarly, the sale of products such as photocopiers STUDY TIP Don’t confuse the promotional mix with the marketing mix. Read the question carefully and make sure you are focused on the right ‘mix’! CASE STUDY South Africa According to the market research company Nielsen, South African shoppers are obsessed with sales promotions. According to a report by Nielsen, called The Price of Promoting, 75 per cent of South African shoppers know the prices of their regular grocery items and notice when those prices change. This makes South Africa one of the most price-sensitive countries in the world. In South Africa, consumers face significant financial constraints, especially with the rising price of petrol, taxes and energy bills. This means that customers are searching for special offers. The use of promotions can attract customers in the short term but it can also damage the value of a brand. In 2018, around 30 per cent of the total sales of consumer goods that are bought frequently were sold at a discounted price. There were also more sales promotions. The danger for producers is that consumers are becoming used to looking for deals. This will reduce the profit margins of producers and retailers, as 22 per cent of shoppers say that they regularly switch stores according to where the best promotions are (an increase from 16 per cent in 2017). Question 1 Evaluate the importance of sales promotions as part of the promotional mix in South Africa. [12] 128 9781398308114.indb 128 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY Swatch Questions 1 2 Define the term ‘segmentation’. [2] Evaluate the possible reasons why a firm such as Swatch operates with different brand names. [12] The role of branding In some markets, branding is very important. By building a brand, businesses hope to make customers more loyal. This may allow them to charge more for items, by making the demand price inelastic. It may also make it easier to introduce new products under the same brand name, as customers may feel reassured and be more willing to try them. If customers recognise a brand, they can associate with all of its values and this in itself can provide a benefit – people may feel more secure driving a Volvo than other brands of car, more fashionable using an Apple Mac than other computers, and smarter wearing Prada than other fashion labels. Increasingly, some people want to identify with a brand and the lifestyle that is associated with it. Brand loyalty is very important because it is easier and cheaper for a business to sell more to an existing customer than it is to generate a new customer. However, a brand has to be protected and managers have to be careful that it does not become associated with the wrong things. For example, in 2010, Toyota had to recall millions of cars due to a brake problem which damaged the company’s reputation for quality. At the same time, promotional campaigns will help build the brand. The promotions will convey key messages about the personality of the brand – is it fun? Quirky? Global? Young? The design and messaging of advertisements, of digital campaigns and all other forms of promotion can shape the brand and customers’ attitudes towards it. Imagine you are about to buy a laptop or tablet – will you look at Apple? Microsoft? Lenovo? HP? Google Chrome? Without even thinking about price or technical specifications, you will have a reaction to each of those brand names; this reaction could be due to past experience, but it will also be shaped by the promotional campaigns of the business. At times, promotional campaigns will specifically aim to change your perception of a brand. Burberry, for example, was originally positioned as quite an exclusive brand, but it then became one very wide range of products, which some say damaged its appeal; in recent years it has been trying to re-establish this link with premium fashion design. Amazon has been criticised for the terms and conditions of employees in its warehouses, and it has responded to this by promoting the work of those people working in the warehouses and inviting people to visit. Promotion may, therefore, be used to build, reposition or protect a brand. 3.3 3.3.5 Promotion methods Swatch Group is an international group active in the design, manufacture and sale of finished watches, jewellery, watch movements and components. The Swatch Group owns a number of watch brands. These brands target different groups and have different price points. Brands may form an important part of a promotional campaign. Businesses may promote the brand because it brings with it all the associated values. When a new Apple iPhone is promoted, we expect a super design, a fantastic look to the product and some new technology, because that’s what we associate with Apple. A well-established brand brings with it immediately a collection of messages that feed into any communication. A Tesla product will be innovative, a Gucci product will be luxurious, and a Volvo product will be safe. Promotional campaigns can use the brand as a selling point in itself (think about strong brands such as the University of Cambridge or Harvard University) that immediately conveys something about the product. CASE STUDY Sir Richard Branson and the Virgin brand ▲ Figure 3.29 Sir Richard Branson Sir Richard Branson was born in 1950 and educated at Stowe School, in the UK. He went into business aged 16, publishing Student magazine. As a young entrepreneur, it was clear he had a real flair for publicity. He originally set up the Virgin brand as a mail-order record company, then subsequently opened a physical store in Oxford Street, London. In 1972, he founded the Virgin Records music label and recorded what came to be a best-selling record, Tubular Bells by Mike Oldfield, in 1973. In the punk rock era, Virgin Records signed the Sex Pistols, even though other record labels wouldn’t go near them. This proved to be a marketing success. Over the years, Virgin accumulated many other stars, including Genesis, Peter Gabriel, Simple Minds and The Rolling Stones. This gave Virgin a major international presence in the music industry. Virgin has also diversified into air and rail travel, mobile phones, finance, weddings, wines, retail, drinks, hotels and gymnasiums. It now has around 200 companies in over 30 countries, employing more than 25 000 people. 129 9781398308114.indb 129 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 One of Sir Richard’s strengths has been his ability to get free publicity for the business. He has had his picture taken in a wedding dress, as well as with Pamela Anderson, Diana, Princess of Wales, and Nelson Mandela. In 1985, Sir Richard attempted to beat the record for the fastest crossing of the Atlantic by boat, but his vessel hit driftwood and sank only 100 miles (160 km) from home. In 2004, he achieved the fastest crossing of the English Channel by amphibious vehicle, marking the twentieth anniversary of the Virgin Atlantic brand. vehicles that are designed to give private individuals the opportunity to see the Earth from space. It will operate a regular schedule of space flights from the company’s base at New Mexico’s Spaceport America, the world’s first purpose-built commercial spaceport. Questions 1 2 Explain one key feature of the Virgin brand. Evaluate other products that you think the Virgin brand could extend to. [3] [12] Sir Richard’s latest venture is space travel. Virgin Galactic is a commercial spaceline. It operates modern space CASE STUDY Biggest global brands ▼ Table 3.12 Biggest ten global brands Ranking Company Change in brand value (%) Brand value ($m) 2019 1 Apple +9 234 241 2 Google +8 167 713 3 Amazon +242 125 263 4 Microsoft +17 108 847 5 Coca-Cola –4 63 365 6 Samsung +2 61 098 7 Toyota +5 56 246 8 Mercedes +5 50 832 9 McDonald’s +4 45 362 10 Disney +11 44 352 Source: www.interbrand.com/best-brands/best-global-brands/2019/ranking/ Questions 1 2 Choose one of the brands in Table 3.12 and explain one element of its brand values (that is, what does the brand stand for?). Evaluate the benefits to a business of having a strong brand. The role of packaging Packaging may be needed to: » protect the product; for example, while being transported (think of an egg box!) » preserve the product; for example, tinned food » keep the product secure; for example, razor blades are high-value items and are vulnerable to being stolen from stores. The packaging of these products is sometimes bigger than it needs to be to make them visible in-store » provide information to customers; for example, information on the ingredients. [3] [12] However, packaging can also play a role in the promotion of the product. Packaging helps communicate about the product. The packaging can: » reinforce the positioning and branding. Think about perfumes; the bottle itself and the box it is in often reflect a premium product. The shape, the design and the colours of the packaging will send messages about the product » reinforce a promotional campaign; for example, if a promotional offer is on where there is 10 per cent extra free, this can be shown on the packaging. At the same time, the promotional campaign can focus on features such as new sizes, resealable containers, new shapes of containers or new recyclable materials. 130 9781398308114.indb 130 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY L’Oréal According to L’Oréal, the cosmetic business, packaging is a ‘make or break’ factor in the beauty experience. It has a huge influence on the commercial success of a product, affecting the reviews of beauty bloggers and the responses of their millions of followers. A recent packaging development at L’Oréal is Lip Magnet. L’Oréal’s packaging innovation team designed an applicator capable of applying the right amount of product on the lips with comfort, precision and creating the sensation of a weightless film. The transparent bottle with thick walls highlights the product shade. 1 2 Analyse one factor that might influence the packaging [4] of a cosmetic product. Evaluate the importance of packaging in the marketing mix of cosmetic products. [12] 3.3.5 Promotion methods Questions 3.3 Source: L’Oréal (UK) Limited ▲ Figure 3.30 L’Oréal packaging Digital promotion on what they are searching for or what they have been looking at. Adverts can adjust depending on whether this is a person’s first visit to a website or whether they have been there before. If a business understands its customer profile well and targets them effectively, and if it monitors the actions taken by customers and adapts what it does accordingly, then digital promotion can be very effective and low-cost. Businesses use social media such as Facebook, Twitter and Instagram to develop their brand image and to communicate with their target market. They also use paid-for online advertising such as Google AdWords to target potential customers, or they might pay social influencers such as Kim Kardashian West to endorse their products – this will enable a business to bring its product to the attention of all the followers of the influencer. Businesses also encourage customers to leave reviews online, as this can help to gain customers’ confidence in the product. However, businesses do need to monitor their spending and make sure it is targeted. Paying for millions of clickthroughs by customers who like the online advert but have no intention of buying the product can waste money. The effectiveness of digital promotion is also limited to those who are online; it will not reach those who are offline. The fastest growing element of the promotional mix in recent years has been digital promotion. Digital promotion involves promoting a brand, product or service on digital channels such as search engines, social media, email and mobile apps. Many businesses in recent years have reduced their spend on printed materials and increased their digital spend. Digital promotion can be very cost-effective. You can target customers very carefully based on factors such as their location, age and interests. A business can also track exactly what actions customers take – for example, they can measure the click-through rate (CTR) from an advert to a website; they can also track exactly the movements of the consumer coming to the firm’s website to measure whether it leads to a sale. Adverts can be shown to users depending GLOSSARY TERMS Digital promotion involves promoting a brand, product or service on digital channels such as search engines, social media, email and mobile apps. The click-through rate (CTR) measures the number of visits to a website as a percentage of the number of impressions of a digital advert. For example, a CTR of 20 per cent means 20 per cent of the times an advert is viewed, someone clicks on it to find out more information. 131 9781398308114.indb 131 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 CASE STUDY Dwayne ‘The Rock’ Johnson In 2020, Dwayne ‘The Rock’ Johnson was listed as the highest-paid sponsor for an Instagram post. It was claimed that Johnson charged over $1 million per post last year. Previously, Kylie Jenner was listed as the highest-paid. She has 182 million Instagram followers; Johnson has 187 million. It was estimated that footballer Cristiano Ronaldo was worth $889 000 per post, and Kim Kardashian West could charge $858 000. The rankings of social-media sponsors were produced by Hopper HQ and were estimates, as the precise amounts paid are highly protected. According to Forbes, Johnson was the highest-paid actor in the world, earning nearly $90 million in 2019 before tax. His films include Fast and Furious and Jumanji. Johnson also has a partnership with the US sports brand Under Armour and holds a stake in the Norwegian bottled-water brand Voss. Source: www.bbc.co.uk/news/business-53261043 Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor that influences the amount someone can charge to sponsor a social-media post. [4] Evaluate the importance of social media in affecting consumers’ buying decisions. [12] CASE STUDY Facebook versus Twitter ▼ Table 3.13 Facebook versus Twitter – selected metrics Facebook Twitter Market capitalisation ($bn) 3 June 2020 655.7 27.4 Revenues ($bn) 2019 70.7 3.5 Net profit ($bn) 2019 18.5 1.5 Employees (’000) Q1 2020 48.3 4.9* Daily active users (bn) Q1 2020 1.7 0.2 * Q4 2019 Source: The Economist Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor that might determine how much a social-media business can charge other businesses to advertise on it. Evaluate the importance of social media in the marketing mix of businesses. [4] [12] 132 9781398308114.indb 132 05/03/21 11:07 AM CASE STUDY 3.3 Digital marketing ● 54 per cent of consumers say fashion is the top category where social media has influenced their purchases, while 45 per cent of consumers say the same for technology. Questions 1 2 Analyse one possible objective of a social-media campaign. Evaluate the importance of social media for businesses wanting to promote their products. [4] [12] Each of the different methods of promotion has its own advantages and disadvantages, as shown in Table 3.14. For example, personal selling is obviously quite labour-intensive, and therefore expensive, but the firm gets immediate feedback from its customers. 3.3.5 Promotion methods Recent market research shows: ● Only 17 per cent of consumers have been influenced to buy a product or service following an endorsement from an influencer or celebrity. ● On the other hand, 32 per cent of consumers are influenced to buy a product or service following a positive review on social media. ● 8 in 10 consumers have undertaken at least one or more financial activities via a digital channel in the past year. ▼ Table 3.14 A comparison of promotional methods Method of promotion Advantages Disadvantages Advertising • Wide coverage • Control of the message • Can be used to build brand loyalty • Can be expensive; for example, TV advertising Direct promotion • Relatively cheap • May not get read Sales promotions • Can entertain and interest the consumer • Often short-term effects • Can encourage brand switching Personal selling • Two-way communication • Can answer customer enquiries • Can be expensive • Can only reach a limited number of customers Digital promotion • Can be very targeted • Can track actions taken online • Can use influencers to attract new customers • Need to target effectively • Will not reach those who are not online CASE STUDY Red Bull Red Bull is an ‘energy drink’ that originated in Thailand and is sold to combat mental and physical fatigue. The marketing of the product has been highly successful and includes a number of unusual promotional methods. For example: ● Selected students (students are a key market) are given free cases of Red Bull if they throw a party; others are given a car with a model Red Bull on the top to drive around and be noticed by others. This is known as ‘viral marketing’. It relies on a few key trendsetters spreading the word about a product and leading to others wanting to be associated with it. ● Sales teams identify key bars and clubs and promote heavily via merchandise, such as branded coolers and point-of-purchase (or POP) displays. ● The company heavily invests in brand-building, including promoting the slogan ‘Red Bull gives you wings’. ● Red Bull sponsors many extreme sports events including cliff diving, BMX and skiing. Red Bull also sponsors the Red Bull Flugtag (‘flight day’ in German), a competition where entrants launch themselves off a 30-foot (9-metre) ramp in homemade ‘flying machines’ into a body of water. ● In recent years, mainstream advertising such as television has also been used. Questions 1 2 Analyse one reason why a business might choose to sponsor an event. [4] Evaluate other types of events you think it would make sense for Red Bull to sponsor. Explain your [12] selection. 133 9781398308114.indb 133 05/03/21 11:07 AM Choosing the right promotional mix AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 Businesses use a combination of promotional methods to communicate to potential customers about their products. The composition of the promotional mix depends on numerous factors: » Nature of the product Consumer-durable products, such as televisions and washing machines, are likely to be advertised to the final customer. Firms usually use a sales team to deal with wholesalers and retailers but use advertising to get customers to demand the product in the stores. By raising awareness of the brand, customers will recognise it when they go to buy a product. Similarly, companies producing shampoos and household cleaners often advertise on television. By comparison, sales of heavy construction equipment are usually made direct to the customer and rely on the sales force. There are relatively few customers in this case, the product is expensive and sold in low volumes, and there are many technical details that need to be explained. A sales force is likely to be much more effective than, say, an advert in a brochure. » Marketing expenditure budget Inevitably, the budget acts as a constraint on all firms’ promotional activities because it limits the amount of money available to spend in this area. Faced with a small marketing budget, for example, a firm cannot even consider television advertising and may have to rely on local newspaper advertising instead. » Available options Technological developments are creating new possibilities, such as internet advertising and text advertising. Legal changes also influence what is possible; for instance, what products can be advertised and how they can promote themselves. For example, there are strong restrictions on the promotion of alcohol and tobacco. Improvements in the promotional mix may: » reduce costs, as cheaper ways of communicating are adopted » boost sales, as better ways of communicating are used to communicate more effectively and to more people. STUDY TIP You need to be able to understand the different messages a business might be trying to communicate to different groups, such as investors and consumers. You also need to understand the different elements of the promotional mix and how these will be changed for different products and different situations. Think about whether some methods are more appropriate than others for specific products. Do not assume advertising is always the answer – there are many other ways of communicating that may be more effective for some products. GLOSSARY TERMS The marketing expenditure budget is the amount of money a business allocates to spend on marketing activities such as promotion. The distribution channel describes how the ownership of a product moves from the producer to the customer. To make its promotion more effective, a business might alter the total amount spent on it or review the promotional mix. As customers’ habits change, the mix might need to be altered as well (for example, switching to more internet advertising). 3.3.6 Place (channels of distribution) The distribution of a good or service refers to the way in which the ownership of it passes from the producer to the consumer. In some cases, the product goes directly to the end customer from the producer (business-toconsumer marketing, see page 102). For example, Dell Computers supplies some of its customers direct, without intermediaries, as does Avon Products. Services such as insurance, health care and education tend to be provided directly to the end customers. In other cases, producers use intermediaries. Most producers of electrical goods, such as Sony and Phillips, have intermediaries between the producer and the final seller. These intermediaries include: » retailers (such as Walmart), which are the final stage in the distribution chain. Many goods are sold through retailers rather than direct to the customer » wholesalers. These buy products in bulk from producers and sell them on to retailers, who then sell direct to the final consumer. Retailers use wholesalers because they offer a range of products and it is easier dealing directly with them than with many different individual manufacturers. The different distribution channels can be described in terms of the number of levels involved in the process (see Figure 3.31). Zero-level channel: no intermediaries Producer Consumer One-level channel: one intermediary Manufacturer Retailer Consumer Two-level channel: two intermediaries Manufacturer Wholesaler Retailer Consumer ▲ Figure 3.31 Distribution channels 134 9781398308114.indb 134 05/03/21 11:07 AM » In a zero-level channel, the good or service passes The distribution strategy will vary considerably from product to product. In the case of milk, newspapers and chewing gum, for example, the aim is usually to generate as wide a distribution as possible. These types of goods are called convenience items because consumers are not willing to travel far to buy them – they need them to be easily accessible. In order to get to as broad a market as possible, several intermediaries may be used. With products such as personal computers, vacuum cleaners, microwaves, and so on, consumers usually want to compare the features and prices of different brands. Manufacturers of these products need to get them distributed to certain stores where customers expect to go to find them. These shopping goods do not need to be distributed to as many outlets as convenience items, but the firm may have to fight hard to get intermediaries to stock them. Although with the growth of online shopping manufacturers do sell directly to customers, many sales are still through retailers, including online retailers such as Amazon. More exclusive (or speciality) products such as Rolex, Porsche, Bang & Olufsen and Bose have even fewer outlets, but the nature of these outlets is very important. They must reinforce the nature of the brand, and so a great deal of time is spent ensuring they are well maintained and suitably exclusive. In some cases, the manufacturer owns the outlet to ensure it presents its products in a way that is appropriate to the brand. Products that are sold to other businesses (business-tobusiness marketing, see page 102) rather than the final consumer are called industrial goods (rather than consumer goods). These tend to be distributed directly. This might include machinery, office equipment and specialised computer software. One growing trend in business is for products to be bought directly from the producer. Distribution is increasingly zero-level. Customers can access their products online and buy direct from retailers or even direct from the producer. Distribution at this point is then either direct to the customer or via a pick-up point; if customers are using ‘click and collect’, for example, they order the product online and collect it later in-store. The objectives of distribution 3.3 The management of distribution will focus on ensuring the right products reach the right customers at the right time and at the right cost. It will aim to ensure the distribution process: » gets the products where customers need them; for example, in the right shops and outlets » makes sure the products reach where they need to be in good time and are undamaged » provides good value for money. 3.3.6 Place (channels of distribution) directly from producer to consumer without any intermediaries. For example, dentists, accountants and plumbers have zero-level channels. » A one-level channel has one intermediary. For example, a retailer buys the product from the manufacturer and sells it to the consumer. » A two-level channel has two intermediaries. For example, a wholesaler buys the product from the manufacturer and sells it on to retailers, who sell to the final customers. Choosing a distribution channel The choice of distribution channel will depend on factors such as: » Access to markets If the target number of customers is relatively small (for example, you are targeting a few large companies), then it may be possible to distribute directly. If, however, you have a mass-market consumer product, it is not realistic to try to distribute individually to all your customers – you will want to use intermediaries to help get your products to the market. Heinz could not distribute its baked beans to every individual household in the UK; it has to sell via wholesalers and retailers. » The desired degree of control If a producer sells its products to other intermediaries then it hands over control of the way they are marketed. The new owner can change the price, the way it is described relative to its competitors and where it is displayed in the market. Concern over the impact of such decisions on the brand may mean that a producer decides to sell directly or only via its own outlets. » Costs It may be cheaper to sell a product direct to the customer. If the product goes through various intermediaries, all of whom add on their own profit margin, the final price will probably be higher than if the business sold direct to a customer. Companies such as Amazon.com, Direct Line and lastminute.com have turned the distribution of their services into a major competitive weapon. By distributing directly to the customer, they have cut their own costs (enabling them to offer better value) and provide a more convenient service for customers. You can now order your weekly shopping, buy your books, check your bank account and book your holiday from home. The internet allows many firms (even very small firms) to deal directly with their customers on a global basis. Choosing the right distribution channel is an important (and often under-estimated) part of the marketing mix. It can have a big impact on the success of the business in terms of factors such as: » market coverage » costs » control over the way the product is promoted and marketed in-store. 135 9781398308114.indb 135 05/03/21 11:07 AM Digital distribution AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 One of the growth areas of business is digital distribution, when customers access products directly online. When Netflix began, it physically distributed films on CD to customers’ homes. The films were posted out and posted back. It now produces content which is digitally distributed online. This has transformed the entertainment industry. Music is another example of an industry which has been revolutionised by digital distribution. Many years ago, music companies produced physical records and distributed these physically to stores. Now, via providers such as Spotify, customers can consume music digitally. Other examples of digital distribution are e-books and computer games. The Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic in 2020 forced many businesses to increase their online provision; this is speeding up digital distribution in sectors such as education and health care. Digital distribution is cheap and enables products to be available to customers whenever they wish, wherever they wish, through a variety of devices. However, digital distribution will not be appropriate for markets where customers want a physical product such as clothing. CASE STUDY E-commerce sales in Asia In billion USD 90% 1462 83% 77% 1286 1188 74% 74% North-east South 1077 957 832 707 2017 2018 2019f 2020f 2021f 2022f 2023f Note: f = forecast data Bangkok North ▲ Figure 3.33 Percentage of adults owning mobile phones in Thailand 17% 35% 16% 11% Central 21% By segment (2018) Fashion Food and beverage, and Home and personal care Electronic and media Furniture and appliances E-commerce is a very fast-growing industry in Thailand. According to the Ministry of Digital Economy and Society, Thai e-commerce has grown the fastest of all economies that are part of the Association of Southeast Asian Nations (which is a group of countries that trade together) at 14–18 per cent a year. With a national income of $602 billion, Thailand is the second-largest economy and the second-largest business-to-consumer e-commerce market in Southeast Asia (Indonesia is the largest). The e-commerce market in Thailand is worth $3.5 billion. This is expected to reach $13 billion by 2025, given the higher level of demand for Thai products. Demand is especially high for electronics, but behind this there are high levels of interest in fashion, jewellery, watches, health and beauty products, and car parts. Toys, hobbies and DIY ▲ Figure 3.32 E-commerce sales in Asia 136 9781398308114.indb 136 05/03/21 11:07 AM One reason for the growth of e-commerce is the high number of internet users. Nearly 60 per cent of households have the internet in Thailand; this is one of the highest rates in Southeast Asia. In 2008 there were 16.1 million internet users; by 2018 this had increased to approximately 45 million. There are also currently 124.8 million mobile subscribers, 44 million LINE messenger users and 52 million Facebook users. Getting the right distribution outlet Of course, the nature of the distribution outlet itself can have an impact on the buying experience. The layout of the stores, the decor, the availability of staff and changing rooms, and the in-store displays all leave an impression and influence the customer’s view of a product. This is particularly important for speciality items such as luxury cars, jewellery or sophisticated technology. Visit a Mercedes dealership, a Gucci outlet or an Apple store and you immediately get a sense of the brand values. If producers of such products are selling through stores (theirs or anyone else’s), the store design and the way their products are displayed is very important. IKEA, the Swedish furniture retailer, is renowned for its highly effective store design. Its stores are very large and are placed out of town. This makes it cheaper for the company to offer a large number of parking spaces. The stores are relatively easy to get to for car drivers, which is important because the items bought are often big and bulky. Once customers get there, the stores are designed in such a way that customers have to walk through all the displays to get to the tills – you cannot ‘nip in’ and buy one thing. This may mean that customers buy more than they had planned. In supermarkets, all kinds of techniques are used to make you buy more: » The width of the aisles and the music being played affects the speed that you walk around the store. » You will usually be greeted by the fresh-fruit displays when you walk in; this creates an impression in your mind that all their products are fresh. Unsurprisingly, Thailand is an appealing target for foreign investment, due to its market size and growing e-commerce potential. Already Chinese internet giants like Alibaba and JD.com have invested there. 3.3 Source: www.thailand-business-news.com/tech/ecommerce/75276thailand-ecommerce-market-shooting-for-success.html Questions 1 Analyse one reason why e-commerce is growing fast in Thailand. Evaluate the benefits of e-commerce to producers. 2 [4] [12] » The aroma in the store is likely to be fresh bread (many » » » » now have bakeries on-site, but even if they do not, they can create the smell of fresh bread); this tends to create positive, warm feelings within us. You will usually enter on the left-hand side of a store because we tend to like walking in and turning right. The basic items such as bread and milk will usually be at the back of the store, so that you have to pass many other items to find them and hopefully buy other things along the way. Key items on promotion will be placed in display bins at the end of aisles so you see them when you turn, or by the tills; these are to prompt impulse-buying. Complementary items such as soft drinks and crisps will usually be placed near each other, as buying one may prompt buying the other. 3.3.6 Place (channels of distribution) In Thailand, 52 per cent of online transactions are made on mobile devices, making the country a regional leader in mobile commerce. (Thailand is second only to South Korea, at 58 per cent.) The Thailand Marketing Research Society reported that 71 per cent of smartphone users engage in online shopping twice a month, and 90 per cent plan to shop online in the future. Store designers have become very aware of the effects that the decor and layout can have on customers, and they have therefore become much more sophisticated in their designs. The physical environment is an element of the marketing mix, because it can have an important effect on where we choose to shop and how we behave as shoppers while we are there. GLOSSARY TERM The distribution outlet is where the product is actually sold; for example, the shop. 137 9781398308114.indb 137 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix 3.3 CASE STUDY Hotel Chocolat When Angus Thirlwell and Peter Harris opened the very first Hotel Chocolat shop in north London in 2004, ‘it was the start of a revolution in British chocolate’. The two entrepreneurs were determined ‘to make chocolate exciting again’. Hotel Chocolat now has 103 shops along with cafés and restaurants, three boutiques in Copenhagen and a hotel on its cocoa plantation in the Caribbean. Thirlwell and Harris started an online chocolate business, investing £5000 each, but found greater success with a conventional high-street presence. The stores were carefully designed to reflect the premium chocolate sold there. The company chose dark-walnut wood interiors and porcelain tiles. It used long counters like a hotel reception desk, and made the stores spacious so that people could wander around, like in a hotel lobby. Whereas fast delivery was the sales pitch of the internet website, quality was the selling point of the stores. The company prides itself on doing things differently. It says that right from the beginning it ignored what it was told. When it began and was told to make the shells of its Easter eggs as thin as possible, it did the opposite and made them incredibly thick! When it was told it must make chocolate bars with bite-sized pieces, it decided on giant slabs! The company is unusual in that it grows its own cocoa. This is grown on its Rabot Estate plantation in Saint Lucia. Unlike most chocolate, Hotel Chocolat focuses on more cocoa and less sugar. Often, 40–50 per cent of its ingredients are cocoa; much more than is typical in the industry. ▲ Figure 3.34 Questions 1 2 Source: https://us.hotelchocolat.com/our-story Analyse one factor that Hotel Chocolat might take into account when deciding a location for a new store. [4] Evaluate the possible reasons why Hotel Chocolat was more successful when it opened stores than when it was just operating online. [12] CASE STUDY L’Oréal and distribution L’Oréal produces beauty products, hair products and fragrances. It uses seven distribution channels, shown in Figure 3.35. 7 distribution channels Pharmacies and medispas Hair salons Branded retail Mass retail Travel retail Department stores and perfumeries E-commerce ▲ Figure 3.35 L’Oréal distribution channels Questions 1 2 Analyse one factor L’Oréal will consider when choosing a distribution channel. Evaluate the advantages and disadvantages of the different channels of distribution used by L’Oréal. [4] [12] 138 9781398308114.indb 138 05/03/21 11:07 AM STUDY TIP You need to think about the factors that influence a company’s choice of distribution channel and its outlets, and the effect this has on its costs and the quality of service it provides. » The internet and marketing The growth of the internet is an important external change which has, of course, had a big impact on marketing activities. For example, businesses can now: » trade globally 24 hours a day, seven days a week, relatively easily » use very targeted marketing; for example, using Google AdWords so that your advert only shows when some key words are used » monitor consumer behaviour very accurately; for example, tracking how visitors to the website move around the site » charge different prices depending on where people are searching from and when they search. This is known as dynamic pricing (see page 126) and is used a lot by airlines and hotels. The price you are offered depends on when you enquire and what the demand is at that stage; if there are still lots of vacancies, the prices tend to be lower » use direct distribution from the producer to the consumer without the need for wholesalers and retailers. It also enables electronic distribution (for example, of music and books) without a physical product being distributed (for example, to e-readers and MP3 players). The impact of the internet on market research and the marketing mix includes: » Data The internet allows businesses to gather and analyse data on consumers far more than was ever possible in the past. For example, if you go on the website of a business, it can track what you look at, for how long and what action you then take. It can monitor whether this is the first time you have visited and how you reached the site – for example, was it through a direct search or via an online advert? Was it through your laptop or your mobile phone? This all provides extraordinary amounts of data on » » » » » » 3.3 3.3.6 Place (channels of distribution) A business may improve its effectiveness by reviewing its distribution, as this may influence its market coverage, the level of service provided and its costs. Many people underestimate the importance of distribution, but it is often vital to the success of a product. You will only sell chewing gum or newspapers if they are widely distributed and well displayed, for example. consumers that, with advances in technology, can be processed quickly and cheaply, allowing very targeted marketing actions. When developing a promotional campaign online, a business can set criteria which again allow very focused marketing. Google adverts, for example, can run in a given region for selected search terms. Facebook ads can target people in a particular age range with particular interests, hobbies or lifestyles. Collecting the right data, analysing and using it effectively can enable very focused marketing. Price The internet allows prices to be changed according to when people order (for example, how far in advance of an event), what time of day they order, whether they have visited the site before, whether they have bought from you before. The ability to adjust the price based on many factors so that there is no ‘one’ price is known as dynamic pricing. Businesses such as airlines and online retailers such as Amazon use dynamic pricing very effectively. Promotion Businesses can promote their products online and target who their adverts reach depending on, for example, where you are searching from and which terms you are using to search. Businesses can get others to help promote their products through viral marketing, where their own campaign is forwarded via social media (such as Twitter and Facebook) by individuals to their friends. Methods of promotion such as blogs and Twitter are cheap ways of communicating. Distribution Businesses can now sell direct to the customer online rather than selling through intermediaries. By selling directly through e-commerce, a business may need fewer physical stores. This is known as ‘clicks rather than bricks’. Product Some products can now be downloaded rather than having to be physically produced; for example, music and e-books. People Interestingly, people are not necessarily removed from marketing due to the internet. In fact, many businesses now promote in their websites the ability to talk to a customer service representative at any time. The internet can interest you in an item and the sales representative can help you with enquiries or to make your choice. Process The internet can make the buying process more convenient in that you can search more widely than in a main shopping street. Physical evidence The design of a store may be less significant with the internet, but the design of the website becomes the key. The appearance, the ease of finding information and navigating the site affect the customer experience. 139 9781398308114.indb 139 05/03/21 11:07 AM 3.3 CASE STUDY E-books AS LEVEL 3.3 The marketing mix Book publishers generated almost $26 billion in revenue in 2019 in the USA. Of this, total print sales were $22.6 billion and e-books took $2.04 billion, according to the Association of American Publishers’ annual report (2019). Those figures include fiction, trade and educational books. Questions 1 2 Despite the disruption of digital media in other industries (such as news publishing and music distribution), it seems that people still favour printed books. In part, it is the physical object. Cover designs, for example, can make a book appealing and something people want to own and have in their homes. Physical books act as a reminder of what you have read, they show others what you have read and they decorate your home. Analyse one factor that might affect sales of e-books. Evaluate the threat that e-books pose for printed books. [4] [12] Popular print genres include nature, cookery and children’s books while crime, romantic and thriller readers prefer to engage with novels via e-readers, says Nielsen Book International. In the UK, 63 per cent of physical book purchases are made by people aged under 44, while 52 per cent of e-books are purchased by those over 45, according to Nielsen. ▲ Figure 3.36 TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 5 Define the term ‘marketing mix’. [2] a Define the term ‘product life cycle’. [2] b Explain one way in which the marketing mix might change at different stages of the product life cycle. [3] a Define the term ‘extension strategy’. [2] b Explain one extension strategy with an example.[3] a Define the term ‘price penetration’. [2] b Explain one condition necessary for price penetration to be effective. [3] a Define the term ‘price skimming’. [2] b Explain one condition in the market for price skimming to be effective. [3] 6 a b 7 a b 8 a b 9 a b 10 a b Define the term ‘price discrimination’. [2] Explain one benefit of price discrimination to a business. [3] Define the term ‘brand’. [2] Explain one way in which developments in digital promotion help businesses. [3] Explain one possible objective of promotions. [3] Explain one way sales promotions can benefit a business. [3] Define the term ‘distribution outlet’. [2] Explain one benefit to a producer of a short channel of distribution. [3] Define the term ‘USP’. [2] Explain one benefit to a business of having a USP. [3] 140 9781398308114.indb 140 05/03/21 11:07 AM Data response question Harry Potter Harry Potter is a character who features in a series of seven children’s books by JK Rowling. The story is mostly set at Hogwarts School of Witchcraft and Wizardry, and focuses on Harry Potter’s fight against the evil wizard Lord Voldemort, who killed Harry’s parents as part of his plan to take over the wizarding world. Altogether, the books have sold well over 500 million copies, have been translated into more than 63 languages and reach readers via a variety of distribution channels. The success of the novels has made the author the highest-earning novelist in literary history. Although the author did not have any age group in mind when she wrote the books, the publisher initially focused on the market segment of young children, aged 9–11. Rowling, whose first name is Joanne, was asked to use her initials rather than her first name because it was thought that young boys would not be interested in reading a book written by a woman. Word-of-mouth reviews, especially among young males, have been an important part of the books’ success. Rowling’s publishers were able to build on this buzz by the rapid, successive releases of the first four books, which maintained interest in the brand. The launch of a new Harry Potter book was a great event, with long queues forming outside bookshops and some stores One of the most remarkable aspects of Harry Potter’s success is its appeal to adults, apparently reminded of classics of their own childhoods. Bloomsbury quickly acknowledged the purchasing power of these ‘kidults’ by issuing the Potter series as ‘adult hardbacks’, with covers redesigned using photographs rather than drawings. Following the original seven books and eight film adaptations, there are now four Wizarding World of Harry Potter theme parks (two in Florida, one in Hollywood and one in Osaka in Japan). The Warner Bros Studio Tour, The Making of Harry Potter, has had more than 8 million visitors since it opened outside London in March 2012. Rowling, who began writing the books as a single mother living on government benefits, has become hugely wealthy. In 2020, her fortune was valued at £650 million. Harry Potter even has its own spin-off prequel series, the five-star film Fantastic Beasts and Where to Find Them. 3.3 3.3.6 Place (channels of distribution) The first novel, Harry Potter and the Philosopher’s Stone, was published in 1997. Since its launch, the books have gained immense popularity and commercial success worldwide, also leading to films, video games and various merchandise – from ‘Quidditch’ chess sets to ‘HufflePuff’ wall hangings, ‘Goblet of Fire’ candle holders to ‘Hedwig’ pillowcases. opening at midnight to sell the first copies. Fan-generated content, helped by the growth of the internet, has been an important part of the Harry Potter success story. Fan sites such as www.the-leaky-cauldron.org and www.mugglenet.com help promote products and merchandise. Questions 1 2 3 Define the meaning of the following terms: [2] a ‘market segment’ b ‘distribution channel’. [2] Analyse one way in which the marketing mix has been [4] used to maintain sales of Harry Potter products. If no more Harry Potter books are written, evaluate the extent to which this means that sales of Harry [12] Potter must inevitably decline. 141 9781398308114.indb 141 05/03/21 11:07 AM 4 Operations management AS LEVEL AS LEVEL 4.1 The nature of operations 4.1 The nature of operations Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the factors of production: land, labour, capital and enterprise ★ inputs, outputs and the transformational process ★ how operations adds value ★ the meaning of effectiveness, efficiency, productivity and sustainability ★ capital-intensive and labour-intensive operations ★ the advantages and disadvantages of different operations methods: job, batch, flow and mass customisation. 4.1.1 The transformational process The process of transforming inputs into outputs is the responsibility of operations managers. They are there to make sure that the process occurs in the way that the business wants and that particular operations targets are met. For example, operations managers may be concerned with achieving a particular level of quality and ensuring that costs are not too high. The effectiveness of a business depends a great deal on the quality and cost of the operations process. If managers can improve the operations of the business, they can make it more efficient, increase the volume of output and improve quality. The marketing function identifies the opportunities within a market; the operations function then delivers this as effectively and efficiently as possible. Effective operations means the business is doing the right thing – that is, it is meeting its operational targets. The business produces these products in the right quantities and with the right specifications. Efficient operations means the business is doing what it does at a low cost – that is, it is producing and delivering its products in a cost-efficient manner. Effective operations should lead to more sales and profits. Poor operations leads to mistakes being made, which can result in having to replace items, recall products or even pay damages. Operations involves producing physical goods such as cars, but also providing services, such as schools and hospitals, which are intangible. These create particular issues: with physical products, managers will consider how much inventory (or stock) to hold whereas with services, it is not possible to hold inventory and so managers have to deal with queues if demand is high. The precise nature of operations will, therefore, vary from business to business. If you are running a hotel, for example, operations management involves making sure the rooms are ready, the kitchens meet health and safety requirements, the televisions, kettles and trouser presses in the rooms work, the towels are washed and dried and there is enough food to feed the guests. If you are running a tyre and exhaust centre, operations management involves making sure you have enough spare parts (held as inventory) so that you can fix a customer’s car quickly and safely, the equipment you have is suitable and working, and you can generate the bill accurately. If you are running a clothes shop, it involves making sure you have the right number and mix of clothes on display, the store layout is appropriate, the queues are not too long and there is a security system to prevent theft. GLOSSARY TERMS The output of a business is the total amount produced in a given time period. Inventory refers to the stocks held in a business, such as materials and semi-finished goods. Operations management oversees the planning, coordination and control of the transformation process, turning resources (inputs) into outputs. There are many different forms of transformation. These include: » changing the characteristics of materials, information or customers. For example, manufacturers take components and build something new with them. Beauty salons, hairdressers and cosmetic surgeons take people and improve their appearance (we hope!). Doctors, dentists, physiotherapists, psychiatrists and teachers all help us to improve some aspect of ourselves. Accountants take our receipts and turn them into a set of accounts to show investors or government tax inspectors. » changing the location of materials and information. Federal Express and Cathay Pacific simply move items or people around. Google helps you find something that is already there – it helps you to access information. 142 9781398308114.indb 142 05/03/21 11:07 AM An estate agent gives you information on houses that you might be interested in. This service saves time and money for the seller and helps the buyer sell the property more quickly. » changing the ownership of materials. Wholesalers buy in bulk from a number of producers. Retailers then buy from wholesalers because it is easier to deal with them than with every single producer: it reduces the number of transactions and makes the process simpler. The transformation process of a business is ongoing and dynamic. If the output produced is not acceptable or needs to be improved, the business will have to change the inputs and/or the way it produces. It will then monitor the results and, if necessary, change again. Change may also be due to external factors; for example, increasing concern about the environment has influenced what is produced and how. Using factors of production Operations will involve the management of its factors of production, such as: » Land This will include location decisions and finding the right base for a business, while considering issues such as the cost and ease of access to supplies. In some operations processes, such as farming, managing the land is a key part of the transformation process. On the other hand, choosing the right site is essential to a retail operation. Being close to transport links is essential to exporters. » Labour This refers to the number and the skills of people you employ; for example, in sectors such as sport, music and computer programming, the skills of employees are absolutely critical. and machinery. These are vitally important in sectors such as online businesses, where the technology is at the centre of the business, or car production, where production-line technology determines output, quality and flexibility. » Enterprise This refers to the ability of employees to come up with new ideas, to find solutions to problems and be creative. This determines what other resources are used and what the business offers. Enterprise is very important in sectors such as advertising and consultancy. Operations managers must decide on the right combination of resources for the transformation process given the desired targets and constraints, such as budgets. This will depend on factors such as the nature of the process, as well as the cost and availability of different resources. The stages of the transformation process The operations process involves all the different stages, including: » producing the initial idea (for example, in a research laboratory) to developing prototypes and testing these to check the product works and is safe to launch » designing the best method of production to be efficient and to hit volume and quality targets » deciding on the levels of inventory which should be held to keep production going and just in case anything goes wrong » ensuring production goes according to plan » delivering to the next stage in the process, such as a retailer » if necessary, handling the recall of products if there are faults. 4.1 4.1.1 The transformational process When designing its transformation process, a business must consider questions such as: » What level of output will be provided? Is the business aiming to produce hundreds, thousands or millions of units? How many customers does the business expect to have? » What quality of service will be provided? How many people will be served in the shop? Will the business deliver its products to people’s homes? What will its policy be if people want to return items? » How will the business provide the service? Will it provide it online or via shops? Will it use high staffing levels or invest in more equipment? » What aspects of the process will the business undertake for itself and what elements will be outsourced to or bought in from other providers? The business may decide to manage the shop itself but get cleaners in to tidy up, employ accountants to do the finances and use specialists to design the decor. It may produce a range of clothes but simply do the design work itself and get someone else to produce them, like Benetton; alternatively, it may design and manufacture the products itself, like Zara and IKEA. All these decisions will have an impact on the costs, flexibility and the complexity of running the business. » Capital This refers to capital goods such as equipment STUDY TIP Remember that operations management can affect the volume of production, the costs and the quality of the product. Operational decisions will be linked to the other functions; for example, to sales, the overall finances of the business, and the skills and number of employees required. Operations management involves all the stages of the transformation process and therefore is directly involved in the process of adding value. The more efficient the operations process, for example, the fewer resources are used up for the output produced and so more value can be added. Similarly, the better quality the product and the more effectively that it meets customer needs, the more likely sales are to increase and the more the customer may be willing to pay for the product, which increases the value added. 143 9781398308114.indb 143 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 4.1 The nature of operations 4.1 Marketing is responsible for identifying the needs of customers; this department must work with operations to find the best way of fulfilling these needs while at the same time meeting the business objectives. For example, marketing will identify the key benefits customers want and the prices they are willing to pay; operations must then see if it can meet these targets at an appropriate cost. If operations can deliver the right combination of products at the right time and quality, and do this efficiently, it will be adding value to the business. Effective operations provides something customers want and are able to pay for at a cost that is profitable for the business. The operations of a business will, therefore, affect the value added because it will affect factors such as: » the amount of resources used and how they are used, affecting cost of production. The more efficient the operations are, the less waste there is and the lower the cost per unit should be. » the quality of production and factors such as speed of delivery, which will affect how much customers will pay and how many sales are made. CASE STUDY Mondelēz International Mondelēz International is a snacks business that sells its products all over the world. Its product portfolio includes chocolate, biscuits, gum and candy. These include worldfamous brands worth billions of dollars such as Cadbury, Oreo, belVita, Milka and Trident. Part of the success of the business is due to the effectiveness and efficiency of its operations. According to the company, the manufacturing process at Mondelēz International includes: l safety and environmental measures. These measures are to ensure that the business meets global, national and local safety, security and environmental standards and regulations l planning and scheduling production, and ensuring that the correct supplies of raw materials and packaging materials, labour and finished goods to meet production and meet customer demands are in place l developing new production methods and processes l ensuring the quality of products l acquiring, installing and maintaining capital equipment and ensuring this remains functional. Operations jobs include production operators, who are in charge of the production lines, and plant managers, who have overall responsibility for their area and who are constantly seeking to improve the production process. Questions 1 2 Explain one way that operations management can add value for Mondelēz International. Evaluate the importance of effective operations management to Mondelēz International. [3] [12] 4.1.2 Efficiency, effectiveness, productivity and sustainability The importance of productivity in operations The importance of efficiency and effectiveness in operations One measure of efficiency is productivity. This measures the output produced given the inputs used up. Productivity is very important to businesses because managers will want to get the most from the resources that they have. Greater productivity increases efficiency because: » the more output produced from a given input, the lower the unit cost » the less input needed for a given level of output, the lower the unit cost. The operations manager will want the operations process to be both effective and efficient. An operations process is effective if it achieves its set target; for example, it produces the target of 200 units a day. The process is efficient if it does not waste resources and if it minimises costs given the quantity and quality required. A production process may be effective but inefficient if it is producing the target but at a high cost. Equally, it may be efficient at what it does but ineffective if it is producing the wrong thing or the wrong quantity. STUDY TIP Effectiveness focuses on what you do. Efficiency focuses on how you do it. That is, greater productivity leads to higher efficiency. Labour productivity specifically measures the output per worker. The equation to calculate this is: labour productivity = total output number of employees Labour productivity measures the output of a business in relation to the number of employees. For example, if 10 people produce 50 units in total each week, their productivity is 5 units each. The higher the labour productivity, the more is produced per person per time period. 144 9781398308114.indb 144 05/03/21 11:07 AM Productivity is a crucial concept in operations management because it can have a significant effect on the cost of producing a unit. The higher the productivity, the more units each worker is making and, if wages are unchanged, the labour cost per unit will be cheaper. As a result, managers are constantly seeking ways of improving labour productivity because this means the firm can either make more profit per unit, can reduce the price to become more competitive or can produce more. Improving the effectiveness of the business may therefore be directly related to improving the productivity of its resources. Imagine a juice drinks business where employees are squeezing the fruit by hand; if they bought a juicer, productivity would increase so that more customers could be served or fewer staff might be required. 4.1 GLOSSARY TERM Productivity measures the output per hour, per person or per machine. 4.1.2 Efficiency, effectiveness, productivity and sustainability HANDLING DATA Copy and complete Table 4.1. Assume that employees are paid $200 each per week. ▼ Table 4.1 Calculating labour productivity Number of employees Weekly wage bill ($) Output (number of units) Productivity (output/number of workers) 100 $20 000 1 000 10 $20 100 ? 2 000 ? ? Labour cost per unit (weekly wage bill/number of units) 50 ? 1 000 ? ? ? ? 2 000 40 ? How can productivity be increased? Investment in equipment and technology Changing the way the work is done Increasing the number of hours worked Ways to increase productivity Training Motivating employees ▲ Figure 4.1 Ways to increase labour productivity Labour productivity may be increased by using a variety of techniques. » Increasing the number of hours worked If employees work more hours or more days each week, this could increase their output. However, this is not necessarily a long-term means of increasing employees’ productivity because they are likely to get tired and stressed, and may therefore become less productive in the long term. Also, there is a limit to how many extra hours can be worked. » Training This is a very important way of increasing productivity. Training can increase employees’ output by helping them to gain more skills and to learn new and better ways of doing things. » Investment in equipment and technology If employees have modern and more efficient machinery, they should be able to make more output than colleagues who are using outdated equipment. As the UK’s Department of Business and Skills says when commenting on the low productivity in the UK compared with many other countries: ‘A worker can be 100 per cent efficient with a shovel but it won’t count if his international counterpart is equipped with a JCB!’ » Changing the way that work is done If the way in which a product is made is changed, this can affect the speed and the effectiveness of the production process. Many firms have implemented teamworking in recent years, resulting in improved productivity levels. If activities in the process can be combined and undertaken simultaneously rather than in sequence, this speeds up production and enables higher productivity. » Motivating employees If employees can be motivated (perhaps by offering more rewards or by giving people more responsibility – see Chapter 2.2) effort and productivity may increase. At any moment, managers will have to consider which of the above options are available given the firm’s resources, and which will work best when it comes to boosting productivity. In one business the issue might be motivation; in another it might be a lack of modern equipment. If managers can boost productivity, they will be improving the performance of the business. 145 9781398308114.indb 145 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 4.1 The nature of operations 4.1 CASE STUDY Finance Against Warehouse Receipts so the returns the farmers gain are low. To help improve the situation, the Standard Chartered Bank has helped develop various financing schemes to enable farmers to get the finance they need. One of these is called Finance Against Warehouse Receipts. Under this scheme, farmers use their crops as collateral; the corn, soya or wheat act as the security for the loan. ▲ Figure 4.2 Nyiombo Investments Ltd is now able to meet more than 60 per cent of Zambia’s fertiliser demand. It is often very difficult for farmers in Africa to get loans in order to buy essential materials such as seeds, fertilisers and pesticides. This is because they lack assets to act as collateral and so many banks are not willing to take the risk. Without these resources, farming is inefficient and For example, through this scheme, Standard Chartered has been able to finance farmers’ borrowing to buy fertilisers. The use of these fertilisers has boosted average crop yields to over a tonne per hectare – a significant increase in productivity. The programme has been so effective that it has helped the country move from importing maize to producing bumper harvests and becoming an exporter. Questions 1 2 Explain one way you could measure the productivity of a farm. [3] Evaluate the ways in which farmers might improve the productivity of their farms. [12] CASE STUDY Assembly lines The Model T Ford was produced between 1908 and 1927. During that time, Henry Ford introduced assembly line techniques which dramatically increased productivity. Each car moved along a line with parts being added to it; individual workers specialised in a particular aspect of production. As a result, producing a car took 93 minutes instead of 12 hours and this brought down unit costs so much that the price could fall from $890 to $240. The ability to produce a reliable car at a relatively low price made this a tremendous success; so much so that, at its peak, the Model T accounted for 50 per cent of all cars in the USA and 10 per cent of all the cars in the world. Questions 1 ▲ Figure 4.3 One of the first assembly lines was for the Model T. 2 Analyse one reason why unit costs usually decrease when productivity increases. [4] Evaluate the possible implications of introducing assembly line techniques. [12] Employee resistance to higher productivity » they do not want to work longer or harder » they do not want to learn new skills » they fear that higher productivity levels may lead to job While managers might be eager to increase productivity, employees may resist such efforts, because: » they feel it is unfair that they are producing more unless losses they receive higher rewards. 146 9781398308114.indb 146 05/03/21 11:07 AM STUDY TIP Remember that employees may not welcome efforts to increase productivity. Also, increasing productivity may lead to a fall in quality if production is rushed. The importance of sustainability in operations Sustainable operations are operations that meet the present needs of the business and, indeed, society without compromising on the ability to meet future needs – they do not use up resources that could be used in the future. For example, if energy is sourced from non-renewable sources, such as coal-fired generators, this is a non-sustainable source – the coal is being used up. If, however, the energy a business uses comes from wind power, the wind cannot be used up (it is renewable). Sustainability also involves considering the impact of the operations of a business on the environment – does it pollute? Does it create emissions? Does it generate waste? Customers and society as a whole are much more aware of climate change issues and of the relationship between businesses and the environment. This awareness is because we have more information on the damage that has been done to the environment and there is a greater appreciation that the need for change is becoming urgent. Becoming more sustainable therefore involves: » using more resources that are not used up by consuming them, such as recycled materials » using fewer resources generally » recycling and reusing resources more » reducing the negative impact of a business’ activities on the environment. Being sustainable will: » involve change. This will need planning and will involve training and getting employees to understand the need for change » involve costs for new equipment. However, the benefits are: » These actions are good for the environment and therefore good for society as a whole. » These actions may attract customers, employees and investors who are looking for businesses who behave in this way. » These actions may avoid negative comment in the media. » These actions may be necessary by law or may be in advance of future mandatory changes so the firm does not have to be reactive. 4.1 4.1.2 Efficiency, effectiveness, productivity and sustainability Customers are increasingly interested not only in what a business produces but also how it produces it. For example, customers may want to know where supplies come from and how employees are treated. They may also want to know how sustainable the operations process is. The implications for a business of the greater interest in sustainability are: » the need to reconsider what is produced. For example, in the car industry there has been a very significant increase in the demand for electric vehicles in recent years rather than diesel or petrol; this is because electric vehicles are less harmful to the environment. National and local governments in many countries are introducing legislation to force the switch to electric vehicles » the need to reconsider how products are produced. For example, can renewable sources of energy be used? Can waste be reduced and can fewer resources be used in the process? » the need to reconsider the packaging used. A great deal of packaging in the past has been non-recyclable. Plastic packaging has come under particular attack because of the levels of plastic found in the sea and the impact of this on sealife. GLOSSARY TERM Sustainable activities are those that meet the needs of the business or of society without compromising on the ability to meet future needs. CASE STUDY Coca-Cola Coca-Cola, the world-famous drinks company, says that its purpose is clear: to ‘refresh the world’ and ‘make a difference’. It says it does this by creating loved brands and ensuring these are produced sustainably. The company says it aims to make a difference in people’s lives, communities and the planet as a whole by doing business in the right way. In 2018, Coca-Cola launched its approach to sustainability, called World Without Waste, with what it said was a simple, focused purpose: to make the world’s packaging waste problem a thing of the past. World Without Waste has three fundamental goals: l to make 100 per cent of its packaging recyclable, globally, by 2025 l to use at least 50 per cent recycled material in its packaging by 2030 l to collect and recycle a bottle or can for each one that it sells by 2030. Coca-Cola is aiming to make packaging part of a circular economy, with a focus on the collection of 100 per cent of its products and an increase in the recycling it does. Its goal is to create what is called a ‘closed-loop system’ in which old bottles and cans can become new bottles and cans. Questions 1 2 Define the term ‘sustainable operations’. Evaluate the importance of sustainability to the success of Coca-Cola. [2] [12] 147 9781398308114.indb 147 05/03/21 11:07 AM 4.1 How often do you include sustainable packaging in your How often do you include sustainable purchasing decision? Global top 10 countries in 2019 (%) packaging in your purchasing decision? Always Usually AS LEVEL 4.1 The nature of operations In the case of labour-intensive processes, many of the costs are variable, whereas in capital-intensive processes, costs are mainly fixed. CASE STUDY 10 25 10 7 9 20 23 24 45 Sometimes 47 Never 17 Millennials 43 25 27 Gen Xers Baby boomers ▼ Table 4.2 Advantages and disadvantages of labour- and capital-intensive processes Labourintensive processes 46 Capitalintensive processes 21 Average Source: McKinsey & Company ▲ Figure 4.4 Sustainable packaging – influence on purchasing decisions (%) Question 1 Evaluate the significance of the above data for businesses. [12] 4.1.3 Capital-intensive and labour-intensive operations A capital-intensive process is one that involves a relatively high proportion of machinery and equipment relative to other resources. Imagine a bottling process using a production line and producing millions of bottles a day. Other examples of capital-intensive processes are car manufacturing, oil refining and airlines. A capital-intensive process can produce high quantities of a standardised product at a relatively low unit cost (as the costs are spread over so many units). However, a capital intensive process: » can be expensive to set up with investment in technology » can be relatively inflexible in terms of producing different versions of the product (although technology means that flexibility is now improving) » is expensive per unit if only a few items are produced. A labour-intensive process uses a relatively high proportion of people (such as full-time, part-time and temporary staff) compared to other resources; for example, a design business, hotels, or a fruit-picking business. Using a high proportion of labour can enable the business to be very flexible and produce a wide range of personalised services. However, it may limit the volume of products that can be produced. Advantages Disadvantages Production may be flexible to customer needs May take time to train staff with necessary skills Less expensive to set up than buying equipment Product may vary in consistency and quality Employees can use skills and initiative to be creative Volumes produced may be low Can produce high volumes Can be expensive to set up Output can be standardised and consistent High fixed costs increasing break-even output May be able to Can be difficult to produce continuously customise products to individual customer needs ▼ Table 4.3 Capital-intensive versus labour-intensive processes Capital-intensive processes Labour-intensive processes Expensive to set up Lower set-up costs Can produce high volumes May involve lower output levels Can achieve lower average costs if volume is high May be relatively expensive for high volumes as high amounts of labour are needed May be relatively inflexible Can be quite flexible GLOSSARY TERMS Capital-intensive production means there is a high proportion of capital (for example, machinery) used relative to other factors of production. Labour-intensive production means there is a relatively high proportion of labour (employees) used relative to other factors of production. STUDY TIP Whether a process should be capital or labour intensive will depend on factors such as the importance of a personal service, the finance available for investment and the volume of output required. 148 9781398308114.indb 148 05/03/21 11:07 AM 4.1.4 Operations methods: job, batch, flow, mass customisation Job process Different types of operation processes Batch process Flow process ▲ Figure 4.5 Different types of operation processes There are different types of operation methods. Some of these are: » Job production This involves one-off production. Imagine the work of a portrait artist, wedding CASE STUDY 4.1 4.1.4 Operations methods: job, batch, flow, mass customisation Mass customisation process photographer or architect. Each item is unique for each customer, which means that production is very flexible. It tends to require a wide range of skills because of the range of jobs that may be done. It also requires good project management skills because each order is unique and will have different planning requirements. As a result, job production tends to be quite expensive. » Batch production This occurs when items move together from one stage of a process to another. For example, when producing bread you bake one batch at a time. This approach is cheaper per unit than job production because you are producing products in groups. At the same time, you have some flexibility to change the recipe or approach from one batch to another. » Flow production This involves large-scale production using production-line technology. It is capable of huge volumes (for example, of cans of beans or bottles of water) but produces relatively standardised products. Products ‘flow’ from one stage to another. It is relatively expensive to set up to buy the production equipment and is not especially flexible in terms of producing a variety of products. However, if the volume of production is high, the set-up costs can be spread over many units, meaning the unit costs will be relatively low. Mass production suits mass markets where demand is stable and high. » Mass customisation This is a relatively new development made possible by technological advances. This type of process is on a large scale but, whereas mass production usually lacks flexibility, this technology enables a variety of models to be produced Coca-Cola and COVID-19 In 2020, Coca-Cola opened the world’s fastest bottling production line in Chengdu, Sichuan province. This was part of the United States-based Coca-Cola’s efforts to increase its manufacturing capacity and investment in China. The new plant is able to produce 120 000 cans every hour, while the current industry average ranges between 66 000 cans and 90 000 cans every hour. This equates to 260 000 metric tons of products every year, worth around 1.3 billion yuan ($183 million). This is also Coca-Cola’s only automatic production line that is able to produce a variety of different packaging specifications simultaneously. Coca-Cola’s first production plant in China was built in 1999 in Chengdu. This more recent investment was part of the company’s attempts to increase work and resume production after the 2020 Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic. This involved investing in equipment renewal and technical transformation, and upgrading facilities. Globally, Coca-Cola experienced significant changes in consumer buying patterns in 2020, with significant falls in the buying of drinks through distribution channels known as ‘away-from-home channels’, such as shops. To expand its range of products, Coca-Cola has recently combined forces with the Chinese dairy business China Mengniu Dairy Co. This joint venture will produce and sell chilled milk, which is expected to have a real potential for growth in China. Coca-Cola is also offering a new range of ready-to-drink coffee products in China under the Costa brand, to further benefit from the country’s rising ready-to-drink market. Costa Coffee entered the Chinese market in 2006 and now has over 500 stores there. Questions 1 2 Explain one way in which the Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic affected Coca-Cola’s sales. [3] Evaluate the benefits of this new production line for Coca-Cola. [12] 149 9781398308114.indb 149 05/03/21 11:07 AM on the same production line. VW, for example, uses the same basic car platform for many of its cars. Mass customisation generally involves heavy investment in technology. 4.1 AS LEVEL 4.1 The nature of operations ▼ Table 4.4 Operations processes Type of production Features Job One-off, unique, tailor-made items Batch Items move as a group from one stage of the process to another Flow Items move continuously from one stage of the production process to another Mass customisation Large-scale production with the flexibility to produce a number of different models Problems of changing from one method of production to another Changing from job to batch to mass production will depend on the nature of demand. Mass production requires high volumes and therefore is not appropriate for job production, where each item is unique. Batch production enables relatively high outputs and some flexibility (for example, printing batches of different magazine titles) but is not appropriate if a customer wants something unique. Moving from job to batch to mass production will require investment in capital equipment. It will enable higher volumes (assuming the demand is there) but there will be less flexibility in terms of tailoring the product to customer needs. TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 a b Define the term ‘operations management’. Explain one way in which effective operations management can increase the profits of a business. 2 Define the terms ‘effectiveness’ and ‘efficiency’. 3 a Define the term ‘labour productivity’. b Explain one way of increasing productivity. 4 a If output is 300 units and the number of employees is 20, calculate the labour productivity. b Explain one reason why a business might want higher productivity. 5 Explain one reason why employees may resist attempts to increase labour productivity. 6 a Define the term ‘sustainable operations process’. b Explain one reason why sustainability is important to a business. 7 a Define the term ‘labour-intensive’. b Explain one benefit of a labour-intensive production process compared to a capital-intensive production process. 8 Explain one reason why a business may adopt a capital-intensive production process rather than a labour-intensive production process. 9 a Define the term ‘job production’. b Explain one benefit of batch production compared with job production. 10 a Define the term ‘flow production’. b Explain one benefit of mass customisation to a business. Data response question [2] The Singaporean economy [3] [4] [2] [3] Singapore has a highly developed and successful freemarket economy. The economy depends heavily on exports, particularly of electronics, petroleum products, chemicals, medical and optical devices, pharmaceuticals, and on Singapore’s vibrant transportation, business, and financial services sectors. [2] [3] [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] In the last ten years, the economy of Singapore has grown by an average of 5 per cent a year. The country’s productivity has also grown over the same period by about 1 per cent a year, which matches that of other developed economies. The majority of the population in Singapore has benefited from a growth in earnings and a rise in their standard of living. Even so, productivity gains have been slower than in the past due to more reliance on people for growth; for example, in the service sector. The government of Singapore is eager to improve productivity and sees this as a key driver of economic growth. It is focusing on ways of improving productivity through a number of programmes and schemes. Singapore has attracted major investments in advanced manufacturing, pharmaceuticals, and medical technology production. Source: www.forbes.com/places/singapore/?sh=5268e7dcc959 [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘productivity’ [2] b ‘economic growth’. [2] Analyse one reason why an increase in productivity can help businesses and the economy to grow. [4] Evaluate the ways in which the Singaporean government could help businesses to improve their productivity. [12] 150 9781398308114.indb 150 05/03/21 11:07 AM 4 Operations management AS LEVEL 4.2 Inventory management 4.2.1 Managing inventory Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ how to manage inventory ★ how to interpret inventory charts ★ the importance of supply chain management ★ just in time (JIT) versus just in case (JIC) inventory management. 4.2.1 Managing inventory The costs and benefits of holding inventory Purpose of inventory The term ‘inventory’ refers to products that the business owns but will use up during the operations process. Inventory was previously also called stock. Types of inventory Raw materials Work in progress Finished goods General supplies ▲ Figure 4.6 Different types of inventory Types of inventory include: » raw materials – these are items used in the production process » work in progress (semi-finished goods) – these are items where some work has been done on them but they are not complete » finished products – these are goods that are ready to be sent to the customer » general supplies – these are items that are used to keep the business going, such as supplies of cleaning materials. These inventories are held: » to enable production to take place and so that orders can be met » just in case anything goes wrong. For example, you may want to hold excess materials in case there is a problem with deliveries from the supplier; you may want to hold inventories of semi-finished items in case there is a breakdown in part of the system; you may want to hold finished goods in case there is a rush order from a customer. The benefits of holding inventory are that you have products ready if you need them, and if there are any delays or breakdowns in the process you can continue to operate. This means sales can continue and the business generates revenue. However, holding inventory can lead to: » costs of storage – for example, the costs of a warehouse facility » opportunity cost – because the money invested in inventories could be used elsewhere to earn money. Money in inventory is therefore ‘tied up’ and not generating more returns » security costs – to protect the materials from damage or theft » the risk of the inventory depreciating, that is, becoming out of date – this may be because the inventory goes off (in the case of food) or becomes unpopular (in the case of fashion items) and so is wasted. Buffer inventory, reorder level and lead time » Buffer inventory is the minimum amount of inventory a business wants to hold just in case of problems. » The lead time is how long it takes from ordering the supplies from a supplier to them arriving at the business. » The reorder level is the amount of inventory left at which a business needs to place an order so that the new inventories arrive before the business goes below its buffer level. » The reorder quantity is the amount ordered each time. Inventory (stock) control charts Inventory control charts can highlight how much inventory is being used up, how much to reorder and when. 151 9781398308114.indb 151 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 4.2 Inventory management 4.2 In Figure 4.7, the business uses up 200 units a week at a constant rate. It wants to always hold 100 units as a buffer inventory just in case. The lead time is one week. This means the business needs to reorder at 300 units. As the supplies are being made and delivered (which takes one week) another 200 units will be used up, which means that when the order arrives, the business is down to its buffer of 100. The reorder quantity in this case is 800 units a month (given that the business expects to use up 200 units for each of the four weeks). Figure 4.7 assumes that the usage rate of the inventory is constant each week. Inventory 900 (units) 800 400 Reorder level 300 Buffer inventory 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 Time (weeks) Run out of inventory 400 Reorder level 300 200 Buffer inventory 100 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10111213141516 Time (weeks) ▲ Figure 4.7 Inventory control chart In Figure 4.8, we see a situation where the inventory starts to be used up at a faster rate after week 8 and the business therefore runs out of inventory before new supplies arrive. This is known as an ‘inventory out’. Inventory 900 (units) 800 700 600 500 400 Reorder level 200 0 500 0 500 100 600 100 600 300 700 200 700 0 Inventory 900 (units) 800 Buffer inventory 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10111213141516 Time (weeks) Run out of inventory ▲ Figure 4.8 Example of a business running out of inventory In Figure 4.9, the supplies do not arrive – perhaps due to a problem at the supplier because inventory was not re-ordered – leading again to an inventory out. ▲ Figure 4.9 Effects of failing to reorder Inventory (stock) control The decision on how much inventory to hold is a tradeoff between the costs of holding the inventory and the problems that might occur if inventory is not held. The minimum amount of inventory that a firm wants to hold at any time is known as the buffer inventory (or the safety inventory). If the level of inventory falls below the buffer level, there may be a risk of running out; this could either halt production or mean that customers have to be turned away because no finished goods are available. Several factors influence the level of buffer inventory a business holds: » the rate at which inventory is generally used up. The faster inventory is used up, the more the firm will have to hold at any moment » the warehousing space available. The smaller the space the firm has for storage, the lower the level of inventory » the nature of the product. If the product is fragile or likely to depreciate, the firm will not want too much inventory in case it breaks or loses value rapidly » the reliability of suppliers. The more reliable suppliers are, the fewer buffer inventories the firm needs to hold, because it knows it can get more as and when required » the suppliers’ lead time. The lead time is the time it takes for products to arrive from when they are ordered. If the lead time is two days, for example, this means that it takes two days for supplies to arrive once you have ordered them. The shorter the lead time, the smaller the amount of inventories a firm needs to hold. If, however, the lead time is long, the firm will need to hold more inventory to last while it waits for a delivery. Effective inventory management involves making sure that the business does not have too much or too little inventory. 152 9781398308114.indb 152 05/03/21 11:07 AM Supply chain management HANDLING DATA Businesses will have suppliers. These suppliers will often have suppliers, and these businesses may also have their own suppliers. There is therefore a chain of suppliers from the raw materials through to the finished product. The supply chain refers to all the different stages involved in making, distributing and selling a good or service, beginning with the material through to the production of parts, through to the distribution and sale of the product. 800 600 500 400 Reorder level 300 200 100 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Time (weeks) ▲ Figure 4.10 Inventory control chart 1 2 3 What is the reorder quantity in the inventory chart above? What is the lead time? How many units are used up each week? CASE STUDY COVID-19 and retailers The Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic of 2020 created major problems for retailers. In many countries, retailers of non-essential products were forced to shut down for extended periods. For clothes retailers, this meant that they had inventory that would be seen as out of fashion. Inditex, the world’s biggest fashion retailer, announced that it was writing off over $300 million worth of inventory. This means the company reduced its valuation of what the inventory was worth. Some retailers responded to the virus by cutting prices to try and sell their existing inventory. H&M of Sweden cut prices by up to 70 per cent. Other retailers cancelled orders of inventory as they did not think the customer demand would be there. Once lockdown was over and people came out to start shopping, retailers then faced the problem of not having enough inventory that customers wanted to buy. Questions 1 2 Explain one reason why clothes retailers hold inventory. Evaluate the factors that influence how much inventory clothes retailers should hold. [3] [12] Think of the food in a McDonald’s restaurant. Farmers will have raised animals that are sent to abbatoirs, and the meat is then sent to processing facilities before being distributed to the restaurants. Farmers will also grow other foodstuffs, such as lettuce, which will be sent to the McDonald’s outlets. Wheat will have been grown and this will be sent to grain mills and then to a factory to produce buns. The range of ingredients used in McDonald’s foods will be created through a complex set of relationships with suppliers. Supply chain management involves managing the flow of goods and services, and includes all the different processes that transform raw materials into final products. Effective supply chain management means that these interrelationships between suppliers are managed well. This can lead to: » lower costs, because the process is more efficient » fewer mistakes being made » greater co-ordination of what is delivered, when and in what order » better-quality supplies » less time between orders and delivery. 4.2.1 Managing inventory Inventory (units) 700 4.2 Effective supply chain management can therefore help provide a business with a competitive advantage. Equally, poor supply chain management can cause delays, increase costs and lead to poor quality. Businesses will want to consider their responsibilities in relation to their suppliers. For example, to what extent do they want to know how their suppliers produce? Businesses are increasingly being questioned about all aspects of their supply chain, such as the ingredients in their products, the source of their supplies, the working conditions and treatment of their employees. Businesses must consider the processes they want to have in place to manage these aspects of their supply chain. Many businesses now have a code of conduct of their suppliers to ensure that these organisations meet the standards of the business selling the final product. Greater media coverage has made businesses think more, not just about how they behave but also about how their suppliers behave. GLOSSARY TERMS The supply chain refers to all the different stages involved in making, distributing and selling a good or service, beginning with the material through to the production of parts, through to the distribution and sale of the product. Supply chain management involves managing the flow of goods and services, and includes the different processes that transform raw materials into final products. 153 9781398308114.indb 153 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 4.2 Inventory management 4.2 CASE STUDY COVID-19 and supply chains In recent years, there have been major worldwide shocks which have threatened the global supply chains of many businesses. For example, there have been the September 11 terrorist attacks in 2001; the SARS virus of 2002; the financial crisis of 2008 and the trade wars between the USA and China in 2019 and 2020. All of these changes have damaged global trade, and the use of global supply chains after the global financial crisis has grown more slowly relative to world income than in the decade before. It is possible that the consequences of the Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic in 2020 will deal an even bigger blow to supply chains than these other events. The World Trade Organization estimated that global trade would fall by up to 32 per cent in 2020. China’s Hubei province, where the Coronavirus outbreak began, is a manufacturing hub which produces components for many industries such as cars, electronics and pharmaceuticals. The closure of factories, ports and airports affected companies across the world and has also contributed to contracting trade. One reason that many businesses were affected so badly is because they had no plan if their supply chain was seriously disrupted. They had built a chain of efficient, low-cost suppliers but their plans did not allow for unexpected interruptions. Since the pandemic began, many businesses have started to look at bringing supply closer to home. However, this often involves higher costs and does not make use of the specialisms which certain regions around the world have developed. Questions 1 2 Explain two factors that influence whether a business chooses local suppliers. Evaluate how supply chain management can affect the competitiveness of a business. [6] [12] CASE STUDY The clothing supply chain A recent UK parliamentary report, Fixing fashion: clothing consumption and sustainability, stated the following: Garment production is one of the world’s biggest and most labour-intensive manufacturing industries, with estimates of those directly employed ranging from 25 million to 60 million people. Since the 1980s, many leading Western fashion retailers have been sourcing their clothes from countries with low labour costs and poor environmental governance. This shift in production has been facilitated by a 90 per cent fall in shipping costs between the late 1950s and 2015, as shipping containers revolutionised trade in goods. Most of the garments sold in the UK are produced in Asian countries. This fashion model means that consumers in the UK ‘are getting pleasure and enjoyment from fashion, and that is coming at a cost to workers and the environment in exterritorial, overseas production routes, as well as agriculture.’ Poor pay and conditions are standard in global garment supply chains according to evidence submitted by the global trade union, IndustriALL. It stated that: ‘Workers work long hours, often far beyond legal limits, for poverty wages and in conditions that breach Occupational Health and Safety (OHS) standards. The wages of most garment workers are no higher than the level of the minimum wage in their country, which in many cases is well below the level of subsistence. Excessive working hours are a continuing and entrenched problem. Production peaks are managed by relying on excessive overtime. Workers are compelled to work extremely long hours in order to supplement their basic earnings towards a level where they can support themselves and their families. Precarious employment conditions are rife, with temporary contracts, agency work and subcontracting the norm. Violations of the right to freedom of association are commonplace, unionisation rates are extremely low and collective bargaining is rare.’ A 2016 report into Corporate Leadership on Modern Slavery found that of 71 leading retailers in the UK, 77 per cent believed there was a likelihood of modern slavery occurring at some stage in their supply chains. Poor working conditions in fashion supply chains hit the headlines on 24 April 2013, when the Rana Plaza building in Bangladesh collapsed. The building housed five garment factories where 1138 people died and another 2500 were injured, making it one the largest industrial disasters in history. The victims were mostly young women. Source: https://publications.parliament.uk/pa/cm201719/ cmselect/cmenvaud/1952/report-files/195205.htm © Parliamentary Copyright Questions 1 2 Analyse one reason why most garments sold in the West are produced by suppliers in Asia. [4] Evaluate the ethics involved in the management of the clothing supply chain. [12] 154 9781398308114.indb 154 05/03/21 11:07 AM 4.2.2 Just in time A different approach to inventory control is known as ‘just in time’ (JIT). Just-in-time production occurs when firms produce products to order. Instead of producing as much as they can and building up inventories, firms only produce when they know they can actually sell the items. Similarly, components and supplies are only bought in by a firm as and when they are needed. The aim of just-in-time production is to reduce a firm’s inventory levels by as much as possible. In an ideal world there would be no inventories at all; supplies would arrive and be used to produce items that are sold immediately to the final customer. The advantages of this system are: » A just-in-time approach should provide a firm with tremendous flexibility; firms produce what is required, when it is required. In the past, firms have tended to try to estimate what demand would be and produce this amount in advance of actual sales. This system works as long as demand has been estimated correctly. » JIT production should reduce costs. With no inventories, the firm does not have to pay for warehousing or security. The firm also avoids the opportunity cost of having money tied up in inventories. » JIT production should help minimise wastage. If goods are produced and left to accumulate as inventories, they are likely to get damaged, to depreciate, to go out of fashion or to be stolen. JIT avoids these issues. This means that JIT is part of a lean approach to business. Lean production seeks to minimise the waste of any resource, such as time and materials, to make a business more efficient. Although the just-in-time process has many advantages, there are several potential problems or disadvantages: » The system relies on suppliers providing parts and components at exactly the time they are needed. If this type of flexible and reliable supplier cannot be found, the system breaks down. » JIT can cause problems if the suppliers fail to deliver on time. The manufacturer has no buffer inventory and so cannot produce. For example, the earthquake in Japan in 2011 was a disaster for those directly affected by it. It also caused enormous problems for businesses operating a JIT process and reliant on supplies from Japan. With a delay in supplies, they struggled to produce. The closure of suppliers due to the Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic in 2020 had similar disastrous effects for those reliant on their products. » The JIT system also means that the firm is vulnerable to action taken by employees. Any stoppage can be 4.2 GLOSSARY TERM Lean production is an approach that continually seeks to reduce any form of wastage in the production process. 4.2.2 Just in time One approach to inventory control is known as ‘just in case’ (JIC). This is the traditional approach in which businesses hold inventory just in case there are problems with suppliers or just in case there is an increase in demand. By holding excess inventory, businesses can keep producing and selling even if suppliers cannot deliver and even if demand suddenly spikes. However, the disadvantage of JIC is that inventory has to be stored, maintained and protected, and this costs money. extremely expensive because production is halted completely. » Switching to JIT can lead to an increase in costs because of the extra reordering. Because parts are ordered much more frequently, the firm may lose bulk discounts and will also have more administration costs. STUDY TIP The right level of inventory to hold will depend on factors such as how well it can be stored, the costs to store it, the reorder time, the expected level of demand and the business’ operations strategy. Using just in time Running a just-in-time system is complex and places many demands on a business. It requires: » Excellent relationships with suppliers Businesses need to be able to rely on suppliers to deliver goods at precisely the right time. They cannot afford delays as this halts production. Also, the goods must be of perfect quality as the manufacturer has no inventories to replace faulty supplies. A firm must be able to trust its suppliers completely. » Reliable employees Because the business does not have many (if any) inventories at any stage of the process, the firm cannot cope with stoppages. If strikes occur, for example, the whole production process stops. A business cannot supply customers using inventories as none exist. JIT relies upon maintaining a good relationship between employers and employees. » A flexible workforce To ensure that production can respond to demand, a firm needs a flexible labour force. This means that if someone is ill, another employee must be able to cover for them, or that if demand is high in one area of the business, people can be moved to that area to help out. Firms using JIT expect employees to be ready to work anywhere, anytime. People must change to meet the demand for different products because JIT is focused entirely on matching supply to customer orders. Introducing just-in-time production involves: » investment in machinery which is flexible and can be changed from producing one type of item to another without much delay » training employees so that they have several skills and can do a variety of jobs (multi-skilling) » negotiation with employees so that their contracts are flexible and allow them to move from one job to another » building relationships with suppliers who can produce just in time as well. 155 9781398308114.indb 155 05/03/21 11:07 AM 4.2 CASE STUDY Toyota AS LEVEL 4.2 Inventory management of the Centre for Automotive Industry Research at Cardiff Business School, Cardiff University, explained that the problem arose because they relied on parts coming in from Japan. Toyota uses a just-in-time supply system, which allows very little slack in the system. Once supply is interrupted, it does not take long for other factories to be affected. Experts have been recommending for years that manufacturers diversify their supply base. After all, recent history is full of examples of widespread supply chain disruptions and their consequences for manufacturers who were reliant on too few sources – from the terrorist attacks on 11 September 2001 to Hurricane Katrina in 2005 and the cloud of volcanic ash from Iceland that shut down Europe’s skies in 2010. ▲ Figure 4.11 The earthquake and tsunami in Japan (2011) caused problems for companies using JIT systems. Questions In April 2011, the Japanese car maker, Toyota, had to temporarily halt production at its UK enginemanufacturing plant on Deeside, Flintshire, and five other of its factories across Europe. The stoppage came after Japan was hit by an earthquake and tsunami. A director 1 2 Analyse one way in which lean-production techniques might benefit Toyota. [4] Evaluate whether Toyota should stop using leanproduction techniques given the risks of disruption to supply. [12] TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 2 Define the term ‘opportunity cost’. Explain one reason why a business might hold inventory. 3 Explain one cost of holding inventory. 4 Explain one factor that influences the amount of buffer inventory held by a business. 5 a Define the term ‘lead time’. b Explain one factor that might influence the lead time of a supplier. 6 Explain one reason why supply chain management is important to a business. 7 Define the term ‘just-in-time production’. 8 Explain one reason why a business might use just-in-time production rather than just-in-case production. 9 Explain one possible problem of adopting just-intime production. 10 Explain one factor that influences the right level of inventory for a business to hold. Data response question [2] Zara [3] The international retailer, Zara, is famous for its ‘fast fashion’. It produces relatively small quantities of any one design and quickly changes the designs to ensure it stays up to date with fashion. Store managers monitor designs in other stores and sales patterns, and send orders each week directly to the company’s own factories. Unlike many other retailers, Zara has not subcontracted production, and produces in Europe rather than Asia to ensure it keeps control of quality and can respond quickly. It has its own team of 200 designers able to imitate any new bestselling designs that hit the fashion world. It designs more than 12 000 items a year. It can design and get an item in its stores in weeks, whereas its competitors take months. Its approach is very much just in time; it produces in response to demand rather than ahead of it. [3] Questions [3] 1 2 [3] [3] [3] [2] [3] [3] [2] 3 Define the term ‘inventory’. [2] Analyse one possible advantage to Zara of holding relatively little inventory. [4] Evaluate the issues involved if a retailer wishes to adopt a fast-fashion approach. [12] 156 9781398308114.indb 156 05/03/21 11:07 AM 4 Operations management AS LEVEL 4.3 Capacity utilisation and outsourcing In this chapter we examine: ★ the meaning and measurement of capacity ★ the significance and measurement of capacity utilisation ★ the impact on a business of operating under or over maximum capacity ★ the impact on a business of outsourcing. In this chapter, we examine issues relating to the maximum output a firm can a produce, which is known as capacity. A business will not want to have capacity sitting idle but at the same time won’t want to have too little capacity, so getting the capacity right is an important aspect of operations planning. For example: a Existing output is 300 units a week, maximum output is 500 units a week. Capacity utilisation = (300 ÷ 500) × 100 = 60 per cent b Existing output is 400 units a week, maximum output is 500 units a week. Capacity utilisation = (400 ÷ 500) × 100 = 80 per cent 4.3.1 Significance and measurement of capacity utilisation Imagine a concert where the stadium is completely sold out, with 30 000 in the audience; this means that capacity utilisation is 100 per cent, which is good for the promoter of the event. But what if you have a theatre that is half-full? This means that its capacity utilisation is only 50 per cent. The capacity of a business is the maximum amount it can produce given its existing resources, and it depends on the number and quality of its factors of production. What is the amount and what is the standard of equipment available? How many staff does the business have and how well trained are they? How efficient is its transformation process? Over time, the capacity can be increased with more investment, but at any one moment there will be a maximum number of orders that a business can cope with. The capacity of a bus company can be measured by how many passengers it can carry. The capacity of a restaurant is how many meals it can serve. The capacity of a school is how many students it can accept. The capacity of a plane is how many passengers it can take. Capacity utilisation measures the existing output relative to the maximum. It can be calculated using the following equation: per cent capacity = existing output over a given time period × 100 maximum possible output over a given time period 4.3.1 Significance and measurement of capacity utilisation Chapter overview GLOSSARY TERMS Capacity measures the maximum amount of output a firm can produce at a given moment with its existing resources. Factors of production are inputs into the transformational process of business, such as land, labour, capital and enterprise. Capacity utilisation measures the existing output relative to the maximum possible output. HANDLING DATA 1 2 3 If capacity is 800 units and present output is 200 units, calculate the level of capacity utilisation. If capacity utilisation is 20 per cent and capacity is 3000 units, calculate the present level of output. If capacity utilisation is 20 per cent and present output is 4000 units, calculate the capacity. 157 9781398308114.indb 157 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 4.3 Capacity utilisation and outsourcing 4.3 CASE STUDY Suzuki In 2020, Suzuki, the motor vehicle producer, announced that it intended to increase its capacity in Myanmar. The company invested in a new production line for four-wheeled vehicles at its plant in south-eastern Yangon to handle tasks such as the painting of car bodies. Suzuki has two factories in the country. The investment is estimated to be roughly 12 billion yen ($108.91 million) and it will increase the factory’s floor space tenfold to 42 000 square metres, from the current 4000. The factory had previously been importing painted car bodies from other countries, including India, and assembling the vehicles in Myanmar. With growth expected in Myanmar’s new car market, Suzuki has decided to set up a production system that could supply demand quickly. As a result, the factory’s production capacity should increase to 40 000 vehicles per year from a previous 10 000. STUDY TIP Remember that the capacity of a business will affect the sales it is trying to achieve and, therefore, its human resource planning and financial position. There is little point generating more demand if there is not the capacity, unless the business is willing to let others produce for it and/or have queues and waiting lists. The impact of operating under capacity If capacity utilisation is low, it means that the existing output is relatively low compared to what could be produced. This is inefficient because resources are not being fully utilised. The business could be producing more and, assuming the demand was there, earning more revenue and profit. The train could have more passengers, the health club could have more members, the sandwich business could be making more sandwiches. A business will, therefore, usually want a high level of capacity utilisation. Higher levels of capacity utilisation are desirable because they spread the fixed costs of a business over more units. The fixed costs of a business are those costs that do not change with output; for example, the rent on a building or the interest payments on a loan. As output expands, these fixed costs can be divided by more units. For example, if fixed costs are $10 million and 1 unit is produced, the fixed cost per unit is $10 million; if 10 million units are produced, the fixed cost per unit is $1. Higher capacity utilisation therefore helps reduce unit costs and, therefore, increase profit margins. Imagine you were renting a market stall for $500 and you sold 250 items. Each item would have to earn $2 simply to cover the rental costs. If you sold 1000 items, each one would only have to earn 50 cents to cover the fixed costs – this is because as your output increases, the fixed cost per unit falls. This is very significant because it means According to the Automotive Association of Myanmar, sales of new cars in 2019 were 21 916, an increase of 25 per cent from 2018. Suzuki holds 60 per cent of Myanmar’s market. Toyota plans to begin operating its first factory in the country in the near future. Chinese manufacturers are also due to enter Myanmar to benefit from growing demand. The opportunity for Chinese manufacturers has increased with improved quality and less concern from younger buyers about the brand. Questions 1 2 Explain one factor that determines the capacity of [3] Suzuki. Evaluate the reasons why Suzuki expanded capacity [12] at its Myanmar factory. there are major cost advantages of having higher capacity utilisation. A business with low capacity utilisation not only wastes resources but has high unit costs. This will reduce profit margins if the price stays the same. If the firm tries to increase the price to cover the higher unit costs, it may find that sales fall and the situation becomes even worse. Improving the position of the business may therefore involve increasing the capacity utilisation, either by boosting demand (which may be through marketing activities) or reducing the capacity of the business if some of it is no longer needed. Methods of improving capacity utilisation Your capacity is under-utilised (that is, capacity utilisation is low) if demand is not matching the level of output you are able to provide. For example, you have a cinema that can take 400 people but there are only 80 watching the film (this is 20 per cent capacity utilisation); you have a café with 40 tables but only 4 are occupied at the moment (this is 10 per cent capacity utilisation). Capacity underutilisation therefore occurs when demand is too low. In this situation the business may: » do nothing If this is seen as a temporary issue, the business may accept under-utilisation for a short time (for example, when a World Cup football match is on television, the number of high-street shoppers falls; capacity utilisation in restaurants is usually lower during the week compared to the weekend) » renew its marketing activities to boost demand For example, changes in the promotional strategy may be made: new offers, increased efforts by the sales team or more advertising may help increase sales 158 9781398308114.indb 158 05/03/21 11:07 AM » reduce the level of capacity If, over time, demand GLOSSARY TERMS Capacity under-utilisation occurs when a business is producing less than the maximum amount it can produce, given its existing resources. Rationalisation occurs when a business reduces the scale of its operations and reduces its capacity level. Subcontracting occurs when one business employs another business to undertake some of the work. High levels of demand relative to capacity If demand is high, a business may be operating close to 100 per cent capacity utilisation. This may be possible in the short run, but it may put pressure on resources if the business is operating at full capacity for a sustained period of time. Employees may feel under pressure and become tired. There may not be time for day-to-day maintenance and repair of equipment, increasing the risk of breakdown or failure. A business may, therefore, wish to operate below 100 per cent capacity utilisation over a period. If demand is above the normal capacity of a business, managers may respond in various ways. In the short term, they may try to increase the capacity by opening longer and asking employees to work more hours than usual. Another response might be to subcontract output to other producers. This brings risks because the original business is no longer directly responsible for the quality. It is also expensive because the subcontractor will want to make a profit. However, using a subcontractor can allow a business to continue to meet its customers’ orders and may maintain goodwill. Other responses to high demand include: » starting a waiting list This can increase the sense of exclusivity, which may suit premium brands, but customers may switch to another business where they can buy the products they want. » increasing prices Higher prices can be used to reduce demand. This can increase profit margins, but the business will need to set the price at the right level to avoid ending up with demand becoming too low. If demand looks as if it is going to remain high, a business may look to invest to increase its capacity over time. For example, a business may build new production facilities if it thinks the demand will justify this investment financially. Capacity shortage If demand is too high for the firm’s capacity, there is a capacity shortage; for example, there are more people wanting tickets for a gig than there are places, there are queues outside the nightclub, or there is a waiting list for a product. In this situation a business may: » do nothing You may think that the fact that the product is in short supply relative to demand adds to its appeal. Some clubs might want to build on the image that they are difficult to get into. Morgan sports cars used a waiting list of several years but simply saw this as evidence of the appeal of their cars – they did not want to increase their output. You may also think that the excess demand is temporary and so not want to make any major changes, given that it may not last (for example, it may be the latest fashion trend to wear a certain brand of sunglasses or t-shirt, or it may just be a particularly busy day or night). In this situation people will simply have to wait. A business may start a waiting list or limit the number any one person can buy » expand capacity If you believe demand is likely to remain high then you may increase capacity. This will require investment (for example, you may need more people, more equipment and bigger premises) but may well be worthwhile due to the extra sales you can generate » outsource If you cannot meet all the demand yourself, you may use other producers to produce for you. This increases the amount you can supply but you need to be careful that quality does not suffer and, because the outsourcing suppliers will want to make a profit, your own profits may be less on the units they make compared to you making them yourself. Alternatively, a business may outsource some of its non-core activities so that it can focus on the essential elements of the business. For example, in a school the governors may decide to outsource activities such as the catering, the maintenance and the security so that they can focus on teaching and learning. This may enable managers to concentrate on what they do best and make use of the skills and experience of specialists in other areas. Caterers that supply to many schools, for example, may have economies of scale that make it cheaper to use them than to try to do it yourself » increase the price If demand is too high relative to supply, a business may increase the price to bring demand down to the ‘right’ level. This is what happens in many markets. If demand for a particular company’s shares increases, there is only a certain number available 4.3 4.3.1 Significance and measurement of capacity utilisation is lower than capacity, the business may rationalise. Rationalisation means the business may reduce its capacity levels. For example, you may reduce the number of staff you have, you may sell off some of your production equipment if it is not needed, or you may sell off some land if this is not required. Of course, changing capacity levels may be easier in some businesses than others. If you run a taxi or delivery business, you could reduce the number of vehicles you operate fairly easily. However, if you run a cinema, it is not easy to split the cinema in half to reduce the capacity. If you have a café, you cannot easily sell off a quarter of it. In general, it is easier to reduce the labour input by making people redundant or asking them to go part-time. Reducing the land and capital inputs can be more difficult » subcontract for other firms If you do have excess capacity, you may offer your resources to other firms and produce on their behalf. This is subcontracting. Some shops may rent out part of their space to other businesses, for example. A food business may offer to produce for someone else and put the other firm’s brand name on the products. 159 9781398308114.indb 159 05/03/21 11:07 AM and so the holders of these can increase the price. If you have a house in an area that becomes very desirable then, given the higher levels of demand compared to supply, you can increase the price. The price can therefore act as a rationing mechanism to reduce the demand, and at the same time it can increase the profit margin per item. 4.3 AS LEVEL 4.3 Capacity utilisation and outsourcing 4.3.2 Outsourcing Outsourcing occurs when the business uses other producers to undertake some of its operations. A business may outsource some aspects of its operations which it does not regard as critical to what it does and/or where it may benefit from the expertise and scale of others. A business might outsource its catering and security, for example. Similarly, it may outsource its customer enquiry helplines to specialist call centres. There may be times when a business does outsource key parts of its process to help expand its capacity and ability to deal with customer orders. Outsourcing may enable a business: » to use the specialist services of another business An outsourcing supplier may be using specialist equipment which it is not cost-effective for the business to invest in for itself, given the scale of this particular operation. A school is likely to outsource the printing of its prospectus, because it prints relatively low volumes and it would not be cost-effective to have its own printing presses » to benefit from lower costs by using a business that specialises in an activity (such as customer credit checks) rather than trying to learn how to do it itself » to increase its capacity. However, when outsourcing, a business should consider: » the impact on costs The provider will want to take a profit and therefore the business needs to make sure that outsourcing is better value than doing it itself. Sometimes a business may outsource initially but, as the scale of the activity grows, it may be worth taking the activity back in-house » the impact on quality The quality of work from a specialist provider may be better than the business could produce itself, but the business needs to be sure. The business is not directly in control of what is happening and therefore must ensure that specifications and expectations are clear and that there are systems in place to monitor quality » reliability of delivery The outsourcing supplier must be able to deliver reliably, on time, so that the rest of the business’ operations are not held up » the response of the existing workforce By outsourcing, a business is moving production away from the business itself. This may lead to a loss of jobs. For example, if a business decided to outsource its design and marketing activities, this would reduce the need for these jobs internally. This may meet with resistance. GLOSSARY TERM Outsourcing occurs when the business uses other producers to undertake some of its operations. TEST YOUR LEARNING 5 Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 Explain one factor that might influence the capacity of a business. Define the term ‘capacity utilisation’. a If present output of a business is 400 units and capacity is 1200 units, calculate its capacity utilisation. b If capacity utilisation is 80 per cent and output is 400 units, calculate the capacity of the business. a Define the term ‘undercapacity’. b Explain one problem for a business of operating under capacity. [3] [2] [2] [2] [2] [3] Explain one way in which a business might improve its capacity utilisation. 6 Explain one way in which a business might respond to a capacity shortage. 7 Define the term ‘outsourcing’. 8 a Explain one benefit to a business of outsourcing. b Explain one disadvantage to a business of outsourcing. 9 If a business produces 200 units and its capacity utilisation is 70 per cent, calculate its capacity. 10 Explain one reason why higher capacity utilisation is likely to lead to lower unit costs. [3] [3] [2] [3] [3] [3] [3] 160 9781398308114.indb 160 05/03/21 11:07 AM Data response question Air travel in Indonesia Given the rise in air travel in recent years, many domestic and international airports have been operating over capacity. The government has highlighted the need for more infrastructure as a priority. Major improvement works are planned for existing airports with further plans for new ones to be built. Soekarno-Hatta International Questions 1 2 3 Define the term ‘capacity’. [2] Analyse one reason why the Indonesian government wants to increase airport capacity. [4] Evaluate the factors the Indonesian government should consider before deciding whether to expand airport capacity. [12] 4.3 4.3.2 Outsourcing Indonesia has seen a rapid rise in its number of air passengers, from 30 million in 2009 to over 115 million in 2018. This growth has been due to the growth of the middle classes and the appeal of low-price airlines. Indonesia has also increased in popularity as a holiday destination for international tourists; there were over 10 million international arrivals in 2018. As a result of this expansion, there are a number of plans to expand the capacity of the airports. Although airports and airlines were massively under capacity in early 2020, demand grew fast once travel started up again. Airport, near Jakarta, received 112 million passengers in 2018 – far above its intended capacity of 70 million. In December 2019, a third runway was opened to ease congestion; there are plans to build a new airport to serve Jakarta in the near future. Other improvements are planned around the country, including Kualanamu International Airport which serves Medan. A new airport is planned in Bali to help reduce congestion in the existing Ngurah Rai Airport in Denpasar. Although a site has been proposed on the island, Bali’s popularity as a tourist destination has put it under significant environmental pressure, with issues around water availability and safe sewage disposal. 161 9781398308114.indb 161 05/03/21 11:07 AM 5 Finance and accounting AS LEVEL AS LEVEL 5.1 Business finance 5.1 Business finance Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the reasons why businesses need capital – for example, for survival or growth ★ why businesses need short-term and long-term finance ★ the distinction between cash and profits ★ shortages of finance and business failure ★ working capital, trade receivables and trade payables, capital and revenue expenditure. 5.1.1 The need for business finance Any start-up business is likely to require finance to fund its market research and also for promotion to establish its brand and identity among potential customers. It can prove difficult for some start-up businesses to raise sufficient finance and this is an important reason why some business ideas never become reality. Businesses need finance for a variety of reasons; for example, to purchase assets such as supplies of raw materials and machinery. There are three major circumstances in which a business needs to raise finance. Businesses also need cash to allow them to start trading. Cash is required to pay the bills that arrive regularly, such as for supplies of raw materials or for services such as telephone and water. A newlyestablished business may not receive any payment from its customers for a period of time and it is important that the new business has sufficient funds to settle its debts. We will cover cash in more detail in Chapter 5.3. 1 When it is first started This is referred to as ‘start up’ finance or capital, for obvious reasons. The amount of finance raised by a business that is starting up is likely to be relatively small. An entrepreneur establishing a new business is unlikely to have access to large amounts of finance, and banks and investors may be unwilling to invest in an untried enterprise. GLOSSARY TERMS Start-up finance or capital may be used to purchase the assets that a business needs to begin trading. In the case of a manufacturing business, this may be to buy a lease, allowing the business to use a factory for an agreed period of time. Start-up finance may also be required to buy machinery and vehicles. Start-up businesses supplying services may purchase slightly different non-current assets such as leases on shops or offices. An asset is any item owned by a business that can generate an income for the enterprise. Capital is the money invested into a business either by its owners or by organisations such as banks. Non-current assets are assets that a business expects to hold for one year or more. Examples include property and vehicles. CASE STUDY Creating a STORM of interest The STORM Creative Events Agency was established by Keyis Ng. It is a fashion, lifestyle, events and public relations firm. Keyis Ng has had a huge impact on the Singaporean and regional fashion scene. The 24-year-old entrepreneur founded his company with a start-up capital of just $15 000. The company organises product launches, private parties, fashion shows and awards ceremonies to promote brands and business ideas. It is good at gaining press coverage for its events and uses its contacts in the media throughout Asia to gain extensive coverage of its innovative events. Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why an entrepreneur starting a new business would need to raise finance. [6] Evaluate the reasons why Keyis Ng was able to start the STORM Creative Events Agency with so little start-up finance. [12] 162 9781398308114.indb 162 05/03/21 11:07 AM Short- and long-term sources of finance A business may need short-term finance to pay its bills and to keep its suppliers happy. This is an important part of the management of cash flow. Managing cash flow can be difficult if a firm’s customers are late in making payments for goods and services they have purchased or if sales are unexpectedly low. In either case the firm is likely to be short of funds needed to purchase raw materials, pay wages and salaries, and it will need short-term finance to continue trading. Sudden increases in the costs of raw materials can also create a need for short-term finance. Short-term finance of this kind is usually repayable within a one-year period. Sometimes businesses need to purchase major non-current assets, such as land and buildings, or they may decide to expand or to take over other businesses. To do this they will require long-term finance which will be repaid over a period of time longer than one year and, often, much longer. Table 5.1 classifies a range of sources of finance according to whether they are short- or long-term. GLOSSARY TERMS Short-term sources of finance are needed for a limited period of time, normally less than one year. Long-term sources of finance are those that are needed over a longer period of time, usually over a year. ▼ Table 5.1 Classifying sources of finance Internal sources of finance External sources of finance Short-term sources of finance • Working capital • Retained profits • Overdrafts Long-term sources of finance • Retained profits • Sale of assets • Sale and leaseback • • • • • • • 5.1 5.1.1 The need for business finance 2 When it grows Many businesses seek to grow, and for some it is an important objective, as we saw in Chapter 1.4. When it is growing, a business will need finance for a number of reasons: – To buy additional non-current assets For example, in 2019, Amazon (an online retailer) announced that it was expanding its online grocery service, Amazon Fresh, in India and promised delivery within a few hours of an order being placed. This new service will be available to customers in some parts of Bengaluru and it will be extended to other cities later. In order to provide this service, the company would have needed to finance the purchase of a range of noncurrent assets, such as additional chilled cabinets to store perishable food and vehicles to deliver the groceries. – To hire and pay for new staff In Amazon’s case, this means hiring and training delivery drivers for its grocery service. As Amazon Fresh is to be extended throughout India, this could require a large amount of finance. – To buy additional supplies of groceries Amazon hopes to sell its groceries to a large number of customers and to provide rapid delivery. This will require it to hold at least some inventories (stocks) of groceries. Finance will be required to purchase these. 3 To survive Sometimes businesses need finance to survive. The ability of businesses to survive is often under threat in two situations: – When first established One-third of new businesses in the USA did not survive their first two years of trading. A new business may not survive for a variety of reasons, including a lack of customers or higher costs than forecast. If the new business can raise finance during this critical early period, it is much more likely to survive. – When facing a crisis Crises can take many forms, but they normally involve a loss of income from sales or higher than expected costs, or both. If a business can raise finance during a crisis, it is more likely to be able to pay its debts on time and to survive. It was for this reason that governments across the world took steps to increase the finance available to businesses during the Coronavirus (COVID-19) crisis in 2020. Bank loans Venture capital Mortgages Debentures Share capital New partners Government grants and loans • Crowdfunding • Microfinance The difference between cash and profits Profit is the surplus of sales revenue over total costs, if any exists, over a trading period. Just because a business is profitable, it does not mean that it will hold large sums of cash or even have enough cash. There are a number of reasons why this situation might arise: » Firstly, the business might sell large amounts of goods or services at profitable prices by offering customers 60 or 90 days to pay for their purchases. This will mean that the business has to find cash to buy supplies and pay employees several months before the cash from the sale of the product flows into the business. This problem can be worsened if the business pays its suppliers promptly. » Alternatively, a business such as a jeweller might hold large amounts of (expensive) inventory for customers to view before making a choice. This will result in large amounts of cash being tied up in the form of inventories and not available to the business for other purposes. 163 9781398308114.indb 163 05/03/21 11:07 AM » A business may have paid for non-current assets and 5.1 used large sums of cash to do so. These assets may support the business over many years, and they will lead to future inflows of cash. However, the outflow of cash would be at the start and may place pressure on a firm’s finances. Thus, a profitable business may find itself short of cash and possibly unable to settle its bills as they fall due. This could lead to the firm becoming insolvent and having to cease trading. A cash crisis is a major reason why many businesses fail. AS LEVEL 5.1 Business finance Periods of cash shortage Cash flows Cash inflows Cash outflows 0 Income and costs Income At end of the trading period income exceeds costs = profit Time Income Costs Costs Costs Income 0 Time End of trading periods ▲ Figure 5.1 Profit and cash STUDY TIP Business failure Do spend time mastering the distinction between cash and profits, as it is very important for the managers of businesses. If you are asked about cash flow, try to avoid drifting into arguments about profit and vice versa. A lack of finance is a common cause of business failure. A business fails when it is unable to pay its debts and is unable to continue trading. This is called insolvency. A business is judged to be insolvent when its debts (or liabilities) exceed its ability to pay them. In the UK, and many other countries, it is illegal for an insolvent business to continue trading. The process followed by businesses declared insolvent differs between companies and other types of business as illustrated in Figure 5.2. In the long term, however, a business has to make a profit to satisfy its owners. They have invested funds into the business, quite possibly by purchasing shares, and expect to see a return on their investment. This is only possible if the business makes a profit in the longer term. A business may survive for some time without making profits if its owners are prepared to be patient, but cash has to be managed carefully in the short term to ensure that bills can be paid on time and that the business survives. GLOSSARY TERMS Insolvency exists when a business’ debts (or liabilities) exceed the assets available to pay them. Liabilities refers to the money owed by a business to individuals, suppliers, banks and others. 164 9781398308114.indb 164 05/03/21 11:07 AM Unincorporated businesses (e.g. sole traders, partnerships) Bankruptcy Creditors receive some payments A business is judged insolvent Working capital Essential, to pay for day-to-day expenses and keep the business operating Liquidation Unsuccessful Administration Successful Continues trading ▲ Figure 5.2 Insolvency, bankruptcy, administration and liquidation 1 Bankruptcy A business whose owners are not legally separate from the business itself is known as an unincorporated business. The owners of these businesses do not have the protection of limited liability as discussed in Chapter 1.2. If an unincorporated business in the UK is unable to settle its debts, it will be declared bankrupt by a court of law. The assets owned by the bankrupt business will be sold; this can include the private possessions of the business’ owners, such as property and savings. The money raised from this sale will be shared between the individuals and organisations who are owed money (known as the creditors). It is unlikely that the creditors will receive all the money that they are owed as the business will not have assets of sufficient value to cover all its liabilities. 2 Administration and liquidation A company (that is, an incorporated business) that is judged to be insolvent will often have its assets sold to settle its liabilities. These assets will not include the private possessions of the business’ owners (normally shareholders). The process of selling assets for cash is called liquidation. The process of liquidation takes two forms: – Compulsory liquidation. This occurs when a creditor seeks an order from a court of law to have the business’ assets sold as it has not received payment of a debt. In such circumstances the court will appoint a receiver. A receiver is a business that specialises in taking control of an insolvent company and making arrangements for creditors to be paid. A receiver may be able to keep the business going if its finances are not too weak. However, it is very common for receivers to close the business down and to sell all its assets. – Voluntary liquidation. This is when the owners of the company decide to enter liquidation. This might be because they recognise the weakness of the business’ financial position. It can also occur when the owners of a company want to retire and are unable to sell the business as a growing concern. Some companies may decide to enter administration. By entering administration, a company receives legal protection from the threat of immediate liquidation. = Current assets • Cash in the bank • Trade and other receivables due to settle their accounts soon • Inventories – raw materials and components less 5.1 5.1.1 The need for business finance Incorporated businesses (e.g. companies) It is usual for an administrator to be appointed with the responsibility of protecting shareholders’ interests. Administrators attempt to keep the business trading, though they may have to sell some assets to do so. If the administrator is not able to keep the business trading by renegotiating and settling its debts, the company will face liquidation. Current liabilities (Debts payable in the short term) • Debts repayable to the bank, e.g. overdraft • Trade and other payables who expect to be paid in the near future • Tax due to authorities ▲ Figure 5.3 Working capital GLOSSARY TERMS Bankruptcy occurs when an individual, a sole trader or a partnership is judged unable to pay its debts by a court of law. Liquidation is the dissolution of a company by selling its assets to settle its liabilities. Administration is a process available to a company to protect itself while it attempts to pay its debts and to escape insolvency. STUDY TIP In some circumstances, current liabilities might be greater than current assets. In this case, working capital will be negative (and may be called net current liabilities). As a negative figure it is often shown in brackets. HANDLING DATA Last year Darwin Hotels Limited had current assets amounting to the value of $25.0 million and current liabilities totalling $19.9 million. 1 Calculate its working capital for last year. 2 This year its current assets fell by 5 per cent while its current liabilities rose by $1.1 million. Calculate its working capital for this year. 165 9781398308114.indb 165 05/03/21 11:07 AM AS LEVEL 5.1 Business finance 5.1 5.1.2 Working capital Working capital measures the amount of money available to a business to pay its day-to-day expenses, such as bills for fuel and raw materials, wages and business rates. Much attention is given to the capital firms choose to invest in non-current assets, but of equal importance to the success of a business is the capital set aside to finance regular transactions. Working capital is what remains of a business’ liquid assets once it has settled all its immediate debts (see Figure 5.3). It is possible to calculate the working capital of a business from its statement of financial position by using the following formula: working capital = current assets – current liabilities A statement of financial position records a business’ assets and liabilities. We look at statements of financial position (also known as balance sheets) in detail in Chapter 10.1. Working capital is important to all businesses. It has been described as the ‘lifeblood’ of a successful enterprise. If any business is unable to pay its bills promptly, then it may be forced to close down as a consequence of insolvency. However, working capital can also be a source of finance for a business. If a business manages its working capital effectively it may have a strong working capital position. To do this, it may need to: » make sure that its trade receivables (the money that it is owed from customers and any other groups) are received on time » ensure that it does not hold too high inventory (or stock) levels as this can tie up large amounts of cash for a business » pay its own debts (trade payables) as late as possible so that as much cash as possible is held in the business at any given time. If a business’ current assets exceed its current liabilities on a regular basis, this provides the business with a potential source of finance. However, this source of finance is only available on a short-term basis. GLOSSARY TERMS Working capital is the cash a business has for its day-to-day spending. Current assets are items owned by a business that can be readily turned into cash. Examples include cash, money owed by customers (trade receivables) and inventories (stocks). Trade payables is the amount of money owed by a business to its suppliers for goods and services that have been received but which have not been paid for. Trade receivables is the amount owed by a business’ customers for products that have been supplied but for which payment has not yet been made. CASE STUDY Melaka Limited raises $9.3 million for working capital Melaka Limited has sold $9.3 million of its shares to raise finance to ensure that it has sufficient working capital to fund its future plans. It sold 46.5 million new shares to raise the finance it required and the company’s directors said they were ‘delighted’ with the support of the shareholders in buying the shares. Melaka Limited operates in the oil and gas industry and is seeking to expand quickly and provide energy to the rapidly growing Asian economies. This involves the discovery and extraction of oil and gas from different locations including the Timor Sea and the Gulf of Thailand. In June 2020, the company announced losses of $5.7 million for the financial year compared to profits of $14.2 million for the previous financial year. Question 1 Explain two reasons why Melaka Limited might have needed large amounts of working capital. [6] Managing trade receivables and trade payables By managing trade payables and trade receivables carefully, businesses can reduce the chances of running out of cash and improve their working capital position. As we saw earlier, a shortage of cash is a major cause of insolvency. Most businesses are granted time to pay for products by their suppliers. For example, an airline might buy a large quantity of aviation fuel for $5 million from an oil company. This fuel might be delivered in March, but payment may not be expected until June. This means that the oil company is giving the airline credit (called trade credit) for three months. The $5 million will be a trade payable for the airline as it is money that it owes for goods it already has but for which payment is outstanding. This is a financial advantage for the airline as it is, in effect, a $5 million loan for three months on which no interest is charged. It is also an example of a trade payable – a short-term debt which has yet to be paid. In contrast, many businesses also give their customers time to pay for the goods and services that they buy. A coffee producer may sell large quantities of coffee to customers such as shops and cafés. The coffee producer may, for example, allow a large supermarket trade credit for two months when it places an order for coffee worth $2.5 million. This is a valuable order and the coffee producer will want to keep the supermarket as a customer. This means that the supermarket does not have to pay the $2.5 million for the coffee it has bought until two months after it arrives in its warehouses. From the coffee producer’s point of view this is a trade receivable, as it is a debt for goods supplied which has not yet been received. 166 9781398308114.indb 166 05/03/21 11:07 AM We will look at trade payables and trade receivables in more detail in Chapter 10.2. Revenue expenditure and capital expenditure We have seen that businesses need to raise capital to start up and to expand. Once a business has raised funds to finance its start-up costs, the business can start trading. If it takes a decision to expand, the business will require additional finance, in excess of that received from sales, to finance the purchase of additional non-current assets and other items. If the start-up or the expansion is successful, the new or newly expanded business will earn revenue from its sales. This will be used to buy more labour services and raw materials to enable it to continue trading. The expenditure carried out by a business can be divided into two categories: revenue expenditure and capital expenditure. Capital expenditure is on items that may be used many times, mainly non-current assets. A new computer system is an example of capital expenditure. Expenditure on items required to start up or to expand a business can be classified as capital expenditure. These will be shown on a business’ statement of financial position as they include the purchase of non-current assets. Revenue expenditure is on the goods and services needed by a business that will be used up in the short term as a normal part of its trading activities. Spending on employees’ wages is an example of revenue expenditure. Revenue expenditure is shown on a business’ income statement as it is part of a business’ trading costs or expenses. The differences between revenue expenditure and capital expenditure are summarised in Table 5.2. 5.1 ▼ Table 5.2 Revenue and capital expenditure Revenue expenditure Capital expenditure Explanation This is spending on assets that are used up in a relatively short period of time. This is spending on non-current assets that will be used by the business for a long period of time. Examples Spending on fuel, components and raw materials. Expenditure to purchase property, vehicles and production equipment. Possible effects on profits Revenue expenditure is essential to production but, if not controlled, can have an immediate and damaging effect on a business’ profits. This type of spending has no immediate effect on profits. However, capital expenditure is essential if a firm is to generate long-term profits. 5.1.2 Working capital Businesses can improve their working capital position by managing trade receivables and trade payables carefully. There are several actions a business can take: » It can delay its trade payables (or negotiate more trade payables) if possible. This will mean that it will hold cash within the business for longer, giving it a higher sum of cash within the business. » It can require that its trade receivables are paid by its customers within a shorter time period. This will bring quicker inflows of cash, again helping its trade balance. » Many businesses will seek to carry out both of the actions above, as each has a positive effect on their holdings of cash. GLOSSARY TERMS Revenue expenditure refers to the purchase of items such as fuel and raw materials that will be used up within a short space of time. Capital expenditure is the spending by a business on noncurrent assets such as premises, production equipment and vehicles. A statement of financial position is a financial statement that records the assets (possessions) and liabilities (debts) of a business on a particular day at the end of an accounting period. It was previously called a balance sheet. An income statement is a financial statement showing a business’ sales revenue over a trading period and all the relevant costs incurred to generate that revenue. CASE STUDY Vardhman Textiles Vardhman Textiles, one of India’s largest textile manufacturers, plans to increase its capital expenditure by 142 per cent in 2021–22 to finance the purchase of the new property and machinery needed for its planned expansion. The company expects to spend Rs. 7.5 billion compared to Rs. 3.5 billion in 2018–19. The company manufactures fibre, yarn, sewing thread and fabrics, and forecasts significant rises in its revenue from sales and consequently rises in its profits. ▲ Figure 5.4 A selection of textiles Vardhman’s recently released Annual Report judged that yarn exports would be affected due to a slowdown in demand owing to the Coronavirus (COVID-19) crisis 167 9781398308114.indb 167 05/03/21 11:08 AM AS LEVEL 5.1 Business finance 5.1 in 2020. However, it expects a revival in global demand and significant growth in yarn sales in 2021. The Report expects cotton prices to be relatively unchanged in 2021– 22 following a 6.1 per cent fall in cotton prices in 2019–20. At the same time, the prices paid by buyers of yarn have risen by 32 per cent to Rs. 210 per kilogram. Questions 1Define the terms: a ‘revenue expenditure’ [2] b ‘capital expenditure’. [2] 2 Evaluate the view that this capital expenditure will increase the profits earned by Vardhman Textiles. [12] TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 Explain one circumstance in which a business may need to raise finance. [3] 2 Explain one difference between short-term and [3] long-term sources of finance. 3 Explain one difference between cash and profits. [3] 4 a Define the term ‘bankruptcy’. [2] b Explain one circumstance in which a business [3] would be judged to be insolvent. 5 Explain one difference between compulsory liquidation and voluntary liquidation. [3] 6 Analyse one circumstance in which administration [4] might enable a company to avoid liquidation. [2] 7 a Define the term ‘working capital’. b Explain one reason why working capital [3] is important to all businesses. 8 Explain one difference between trade payables and trade receivables. [3] 9 Explain two ways in which a business might manage its trade receivables and trade payables effectively. [6] 10 Explain one difference between revenue expenditure and capital expenditure. [3] Data response question HW Limited is growing very quickly HW is a private company that manufactures machinery for export to businesses across the world. The company has grown quickly recently and has been keen to attract new customers. It expects to continue its fast growth in sales and needs to place a very large order with its suppliers for parts and components. HW has: l ordered increasing amounts of supplies needed to manufacture its machinery and has some overdue bills l offered trade credit to its customers allowing them 90 days to pay for deliveries l not been able to persuade its own suppliers to offer it more than 30 days’ trade credit for its purchases. HW has recently supplied a major customer with machinery valued at $14.6 million – easily its largest-ever order. The company is waiting for payment, which is due in 45 days. The company’s financial position is mixed: it is profitable but short of cash. Its products are well-designed, reliable and it is able to charge high prices. The company’s managers are very successful at keeping costs low. However, it has an urgent need for short-term finance and this is worsening. Last month HW faced a financial crisis and was unable to pay its suppliers. It feared that it might be forced into liquidation. However, it was advised to go into administration. The administrator was able to renegotiate the later repayment of some of its debts and the company survived. Questions 1 2 3 a b Define the term ‘liquidation’. [2] Explain one reason why HW had ‘an urgent need for short-term finance’. [3] Analyse one reason why HW is profitable but suffers [4] from cash-flow problems. Evaluate whether or not it was a good decision for HW to enter administration. [12] 168 9781398308114.indb 168 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5 Finance and accounting AS LEVEL 5.2 Sources of finance In this chapter we examine: ★ business ownership and sources of finance ★ internal and external sources of finance ★ the factors that affect the choice of sources of finance ★ how businesses select their sources of finance. 5.2.1 Business ownership and sources of finance The form of ownership (or legal structure) is a major influence on the sources of finance that are available to a business. We looked at the different types of business ownership in Chapter 1.2. Start-up businesses, many of which may be sole traders or partnerships, normally have a relatively limited range of sources of finance to draw upon as they represent a greater risk to potential investors and have few, if any, internal sources of finance for use. In contrast, a limited company has a greater range of sources of finance that it can use, including the sale of shares. In the UK, only public limited companies can benefit from being able to raise capital by selling shares on the London Stock Exchange, but all companies can sell their shares to individuals, with certain limitations. Table 5.3 sets out the major sources of finance available to each of the major legal structures and offers some consideration of factors that decision-makers in each case may take into account. We shall consider these sources of finance in more detail in the following section. 5.2.1 Business ownership and sources of finance Chapter overview ▼ Table 5.3 The legal structure of a business, possible sources of finance and key issues Legal form of business Possible sources of finance Key issues for consideration Sole trader or proprietor Owner’s savings, banks, suppliers, government grants and loans • Difficulty in providing security for those lending funds to ensure repayment (known as collateral) • Loss of control by owner • Businesses must provide evidence that they have potential to develop • Financial history of business/owner Partnership Partners’ savings, banks, suppliers, government grants and loans • Problems of introducing new partner • Lack of collateral • Potential expense of raising large sums of money • Should it form a limited company? Private limited company (ltd) Dependent upon the size of the private limited company: suppliers, banks, government grants and loans, venture capital institutions, private share issues • • • • • Public limited company (plc) Suppliers, banks, government grants and loans, venture capital institutions, public share issues via the stock exchange • State of economy and stock market • Ability to move to an area receiving government aid • Recent financial performance • Reputation of company and senior managers Disagreement among existing shareholders Difficulty finding suitable shareholders Loss of control by existing shareholders Lack of collateral for those lending funds Element of risk in a loan 169 9781398308114.indb 169 05/03/21 11:08 AM AS LEVEL 5.2 Sources of finance 5.2 5.2.2 Internal and external sources of finance We saw in the previous chapter that businesses need finance for a range of reasons. There are a number of sources from which they can raise finance. These can be split into two categories: » internal sources of finance from within the business » external sources of finance from outside the business. GLOSSARY TERMS An internal source of finance is one that exists within the business. An external source of finance is an injection of funds into the business from individuals, other businesses or financial institutions. Trade credit is a period of time offered by suppliers of goods and services before payment is to be made. and are not paid to owners. It is common for businesses to use these retained earnings as sources of finance. By using retained earnings for reinvesting, a business avoids paying interest on a loan and this can avoid heavy interest charges if a large loan is required. Furthermore, using this source of finance may avoid the need for a company to sell further shares, enabling existing shareholders to retain control if they continue to hold a majority of the shares. But using retained earnings can have substantial opportunity costs – that is, the business may lose out from not using these funds in another way. Reinvesting retained earnings may not be popular with shareholders who could receive higher dividends if retained earnings were reduced. Alternatively, the business may lose out on interest it may have received if it had held the money in an interest-paying bank account. This method of finance is only available to firms making a profit over a period of time. Even then, the profits may not be sufficient to purchase expensive non-current assets. Internal sources of finance Sale of unwanted assets The major internal sources of finance are owners’ investments, retained earnings, sale of unwanted assets, sale and leaseback of non-current assets and working capital. Firms can raise cash by selling assets that they no longer require – normally these are non-current assets. The sale of some assets can raise large amounts of finance for businesses. Thus, a business might have land, buildings or other assets that are not required and they may decide to sell to raise capital. In 2019, Murphy Oil Company, an American multinational, sold some assets it owned in Malaysia, including oilfields, for $2.13 billion. Murphy Oil Company was raising money to invest in shale oilfields in America which were expected to be highly profitable. Owners’ investments One source of finance is for the owners of the business to provide the funds from their own resources. This may involve the use of savings. Alternatively, the owners of a business may take out a personal loan using their house (or other assets) as security and invest this money into their business. They may also persuade friends and family to invest in their business, perhaps in return for part-ownership. Owners investing in their own business can be helpful in persuading others to invest. Banks and other financial institutions will often want to see evidence that business owners are willing to risk some of their personal capital in the enterprise before agreeing to make a loan or other investment. If the owners are not willing to risk investment in their own business, it will be more difficult to raise finance from other sources. Retained earnings Earnings from previous years are a major source of finance, particularly for smaller businesses. A company’s retained earnings are those profits from previous years that have not been paid to shareholders as dividends. For other types of business, they are the profits that remain in the business Raising finance in this way offers a key benefit in that the business is not committed to a stream of future interest payments, nor might its shareholders suffer dilution of control. However, the business would normally lose access to the assets it has sold. Sale and leaseback of non-current assets But what if the non-current assets will continue to be required by the business? A popular technique of raising funds in recent years has been sale and leaseback. Under this arrangement firms sell valuable assets and lease them back again. This means that they have the capital from the sale of the assets as well as the continuing use of these assets, so that their business is not disrupted. The major drawback is that the business now has to pay for the use of assets which previously were freely available. This may have a negative impact on long-term profits. CASE STUDY Ted Baker Plc in a sale and leaseback deal The British fashion clothing retailer, Ted Baker Plc, has sold its headquarters in King’s Cross, London, in a sale and leaseback deal. The company, which sells clothing in stores in ten countries, has received a reported £78.75 million for the property known as the ‘ugly brown’ building. This will allow the company to reduce the amount of debt that it has and the interest payments due on it. 170 9781398308114.indb 170 05/03/21 11:08 AM many of its shops due to the 2020 Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic. Although it continues to sell its products online, its managers estimate that sales have fallen by 68 per cent as a result of the store closures. Ted Baker’s financial performance has been poor in recent months. Ted Baker recorded a loss from trading of £23 million over the six months to August 2019, compared to a profit of £24.5 million in the same period in 2018. The company’s share price has fallen from around 500 pence in October 2019 to just over 100 pence in April 2020. Questions 1 2 Along with many other retailers, the company has suffered a heavy fall in sales when it was forced to close levels, chasing customers for payment (other organisations that owe the business money) more urgently and delaying payment to suppliers can raise cash generated from a firm’s working capital. STUDY TIP Do take care to distinguish between the sale of unwanted assets and sale and leaseback arrangements. The latter may be appropriate as a source of the finance if the assets are important to a business’ continued trading. If the assets are surplus to requirements, a simple sale may be the best option. Working capital As we saw in the previous chapter, working capital is the cash required by a business to pay for its day-to-day operations. Working capital is needed to pay for items such as fuel, raw materials and wages. Reducing inventory Owners’ investment Retained earnings Explain two reasons why Ted Baker might have [6] wanted to reduce its amount of debt. Evaluate whether or not a sale and leaseback deal was a good method for Ted Baker to raise finance at this time. [12] Firms might seek to improve terms they are offered for trade credit. Many suppliers grant their customers an interest-free period of grace in which to pay for goods and services they have received. From the customers’ point of view, this is a useful form of finance that helps fund working capital at the expense of the seller’s cash flow. The typical credit period offered to customers is 30 days. If a business can extend this period to, say, 60 days, it is equivalent to an interest-free loan lasting for two months. It may be, however, that suppliers are less willing Sale of unwanted assets Sale and leaseback 5.2 5.2.2 Internal and external sources of finance In 2020, Ted Baker Plc also announced that it was cutting 102 jobs and removing 58 vacant posts as part of a strategy to cut its costs. The retailer expects to save £12 million over the next two financial years as a result of these staff reductions. Working capital Internal Government grants Sources of finance Share capital Crowdfunding Microfinance Debentures External New partners Trade credit Debt factoring Venture capital Mortgages Bank overdrafts Bank loans Leasing and hire purchase ▲ Figure 5.5 Internal and external sources of finance 171 9781398308114.indb 171 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5.2 to offer discounts on selling prices if they grant generous trade credit terms. Although the receipt of trade credit is a means of improving a company’s working capital, it is technically an external source of finance. AS LEVEL 5.2 Sources of finance External sources of finance When individuals, other businesses or organisations such as banks or governments provide capital to a business, this is termed external sources of finance. Businesses are more likely to use external sources of finance when: » a large sum of finance is required (as they will find it more difficult to raise such sums internally) » the level of risk associated with the business is low, making it easier to persuade outsiders to invest or lend money » the company’s profit levels are relatively low, reducing the possibility of the use of retained profits. The following are some of the main external sources of finance. Share capital This is a very common form of finance for both start-up capital and also for additional capital in a later stage of the business’ life. Firms raise capital by selling, quite literally, a share in their business to investors. A share is simply a certificate giving the holder ownership of part (or a share) of a company. Owning shares is sometimes called having equity in a company. By selling large numbers of shares, companies can raise significant sums of capital. Issuing shares can be very expensive as it normally involves hiring the services of specialist financial experts, which means it is only appropriate for raising very large sums of capital. Share capital is available to both private limited companies and public limited companies. However, in the UK, it is much easier for public limited companies to sell shares for two reasons: » They can sell shares on the stock exchange. This is an efficient international market which brings together buyers and sellers of shares and sets share prices. » Unlike private limited companies, public companies do not need the permission of other shareholders to sell shares. Equally, existing shareholders can sell their shares freely. Both these factors make it easier to buy and sell shares in public limited companies and encourage shareholders to buy shares in the first place. There are a number of benefits from selling of shares or equity as a source of finance. Although a company will be expected to pay an annual return to shareholders (dividends), the level of this payment is not fixed and in an unprofitable year it may be possible for the company to avoid making any payment. Bank overdrafts A bank overdraft is perhaps the best-known method of short-term finance. It is a service offered by banks allowing a business to borrow up to an agreed limit for as long as it wishes. Overdrafts are a very flexible form of finance as the amounts borrowed can vary as long as they are within an agreed figure. They are also simple to arrange – established business customers can often arrange or increase the limit of an overdraft without completing any forms. However, overdrafts can be quite expensive, with interest being charged at between 4 and 6 per cent over the bank’s normal lending rate on a daily basis. This is not a problem unless a business seeks to borrow on overdraft over a long period of time. In these circumstances, it might be better for a business to convert its overdraft to a longer-term method of finance. A further drawback of using overdrafts as a source of finance is that banks can demand immediate repayment, although this is rare. Trade credit This is another form of short-term finance which is normally available for periods of 1–3 months. Trade credit is the period of time given by suppliers before payment for goods and services is due. Trade credit is really an interest-free loan offered by suppliers, usually for periods of 30–90 days. This can be invaluable for any business that is short of cash, and the absence of interest charges makes it more attractive than an overdraft. Leasing and hire purchase These are similar forms of finance in many ways, but they have one important distinction. Hire purchase is a means of buying goods whereby a buyer pays through a series of instalments, often paid monthly. In most cases, the goods do not belong to the purchasing business until the final payment is made. This operates similarly to a loan in that the business effectively has the finance to buy the goods and pays the cost back over time. Goods purchased on hire purchase may be more expensive than if the business was able to pay cash. Leasing also involves paying for non-current assets, such as vehicles and machinery, over a period of time. However, in this case the business never owns the assets; it is really renting them for a specific time period. It does, however, avoid the need for businesses to find large sums of capital to finance the purchase of expensive non-current assets. Bank loans Bank loans are relatively straightforward to arrange if the business that is seeking the credit has a satisfactory financial history. The bank gives the business an agreed amount of money and the business makes repayments over an agreed period of time. The amount repaid includes the amount of capital borrowed, plus interest. If the bank lending the capital considers the loan in any way risky then it is likely to charge a higher rate of interest. Small businesses, in particular, suffer from this effect. Normally banks charge about 2 per cent over their base rate of interest for bank loans. Interest rates can be fixed or variable. A fixed rate means that the interest rate charged will not change over the period of the loan; however, a variable rate may change. Banks will often require security for their loans and this will usually be in the form of property. Such security is often termed ‘collateral’. If the business defaults on the loan by not making repayments, the bank can sell the property or 172 9781398308114.indb 172 05/03/21 11:08 AM other assets held as collateral in order to recoup the money that was lent. In this way, the bank lowers the degree of risk it incurs in making loans to businesses. GLOSSARY TERMS A bank loan is an amount of money provided to a business for a stated purpose in return for a payment in the form of interest charges. Debt factoring takes place when banks provide up to 80 per cent of the value of a business’ debts immediately to provide an instant inflow of cash. Mortgages Mortgages are long-term loans granted by financial institutions solely for the purchase of land and buildings. The land or building in question is used as security or 5.2 Some businesses may choose to remortgage their premises to raise capital. A remortgage either increases the existing mortgage or establishes a mortgage where one did not exist before. This source of finance is particularly popular with small businesses. 5.2.2 Internal and external sources of finance Venture capital is funds (in the form of a mix of share and loan capital) that is advanced to businesses which are thought to be relatively high-risk. collateral for the loan. These loans can be for long periods of time – often up to 50 years. Mortgages can have fixed or variable rates of interest and are particularly suitable when a business wishes to raise large sums of money. Debentures Debentures are a special type of long-term loan to be repaid at some future date, normally within 15 years of the loan being agreed. The rate of interest paid on debentures is fixed. In some circumstances, debentures may not have a repayment date, representing a permanent loan to the business; this is an irredeemable debenture. Debentures are normally secured by using the business’ non-current assets as collateral. They are another form of loan capital. Holders of debentures do not have voting rights in the business. CASE STUDY Even banks need to raise capital India’s third-largest private-sector bank raised Rs 125 000 million ($1.76 billion) by selling shares in September 2019. Axis Bank said that its share issue was oversubscribed (meaning that the demand for shares was greater than the number for sale). The share price was Rs 629 each. Shares of Axis Bank were trading 1.3 per cent higher at Rs 703.70 on the Indian Stock Exchange following the share sale. The shares were sold to several large-scale foreign investors as well as to insurance companies. Amitabh Chaudhry, Axis Bank’s chief executive officer said ‘We will strive to ensure that we continue our growth journey and keep delivering the best value to our Venture capital Venture capital is an important source of finance for small to medium-sized businesses which are considered to be risky and therefore in some danger of failing. Venture capital is normally a mix of loan and share capital. Financial institutions (for example, merchant banks) provide venture capital, and wealthy individuals (who are known as ‘business angels’) are another source. Organisations and individuals providing venture capital frequently wish to have some control over the organisation to which they are providing finance. The business’ owners may need to sell some shares in their company (generally a minority stake) to the person or organisation providing the venture capital. Providers of venture capital may seek a non-executive director role in the business in which they are investing. Venture capital investors not only provide capital but also experience, contacts and advice when required, which distinguishes venture capital from other customers, shareholders and investors consistently and on a sustainable basis’. Raising this capital from an external source of finance will help Axis Bank to achieve its growth strategy. Source: www.vccircle.com/axis-bank-raises-1-76-bn-viashare-sale-to-gic-others-bain-capital-sits-out Questions 1 2 Explain one difference between external and internal sources of finance. Evaluate the case for and against Axis Bank raising finance by selling shares. [3] [12] sources of finance. However, a significant drawback is that providers of venture capital will not advance huge amounts to businesses. It is unusual for venture capitalists to lend in excess of $850 000 in a single deal. Debt factoring Debt factoring is a service offered by banks and other financial institutions. If businesses have sent out bills (also termed invoices) that have not yet been paid, they can ‘sell’ these bills to gain cash immediately. Selling or factoring debts in this way provides up to 80 per cent of the value of an invoice as an immediate cash advance. A further payment is made once the financial institution receives the payment of the invoice. It is usual for the financial institution to retain approximately 5 per cent of the value of the invoice to cover its costs of collecting the debts. However, in some circumstances, no payment may be required and, in others cases, a flat fee may be charged rather than a percentage payment. The process is summarised in Figure 5.6. 173 9781398308114.indb 173 05/03/21 11:08 AM Business 5.2 AS LEVEL 5.2 Sources of finance 1. Business supplies customer with goods and services. 5. Factor pays business remainder of debt when collected from customer; charges fees of approximately 5%. 3. Factor initially pays business approximately 80% of value of debts. Organisation providing factoring services 4. Customer pays factor full value of debts when due. 2. Business ‘sells’ debts to factor. Financial organisations such as banks provide debt factoring services Customer ▲ Figure 5.6 The process of debt factoring Many small firms believe that to lose up to 5 per cent of their earnings makes factoring uneconomic – this can eliminate much of their profit on the sale of their products. Their customers are also likely to be aware that the debts have been factored, which may cause them to worry about the business’ ability to manage its short-term finance. They may seek other suppliers if they believe the business is financially unstable. However, debt factoring does offer a number of benefits: » The immediate cash provided by the factor means that the firm is likely to have lower overdraft requirements and will pay less interest. » Factoring means businesses receive the cash from their sales more quickly. Debt factoring has become more popular for businesses in some countries. This is particularly true for small and medium-sized businesses, as overdrafts have become more difficult to arrange. Microfinance Microfinance is a term that describes the provision of financial services for poor and low-income clients. Although much publicity has been given to the granting of small loans, microfinance includes other basic financial services such as savings, the transfer of money and insurance for those on low and very low incomes. An important element of microfinance is that it supports the transfer of money from people earning reasonable incomes to poorer relatives and friends in different countries. Without the services provided through microfinance, this might not be possible. Improving access to such services allows those on low incomes to fund activities which will create incomes, build assets and protect against risks. Microfinance is regarded by many as a way of reducing poverty among low-income citizens across the globe. Microfinance can entail a transfer of money from high-income to lower-income countries. The case study below illustrates its workings and benefits. CASE STUDY Lendwithcare Lendwithcare ‘fights poverty and injustice in 87 countries around the world to help the world’s poorest people find routes out of poverty’. As part of its poverty-fighting work, Lendwithcare provides microfinance services. Large numbers of relatively wealthy individuals in high-income countries provide small amounts of funds to Lendwithcare. These are subsequently lent to entrepreneurs in low-income countries and repaid over a period of time. The loans normally help the entrepreneurs to establish or expand their businesses. Lendwithcare is seeking to organise microfinance for María del Carmen Jimenez’s business plan. María is 28 and a single mother with one child, and lives in Cariamanga in Ecuador. María is a primary school teacher. She has had the position for the last six years. Additionally, she runs a beauty parlour with her sister. Her sister works at the parlour full-time while María joins her each day after finishing teaching at school. María requested a loan in order to purchase new furniture and accessories for the parlour. Hopefully, this will make their business more attractive and bring in more customers. María would also like to purchase extra inventories, specifically creams, soaps and lotions, as many of their customers are women who ask for facials and make-up. María is seeking a loan of about $2000 and plans to repay it over one year. Source: https://platform.buildily.com/lend-with-care; www.lendwithcare.org Questions 1 2 Explain two reasons why banks in Ecuador might be unwilling to lend María $2000. Evaluate the arguments for and against lending María a small sum of money. [6] [12] 174 9781398308114.indb 174 05/03/21 11:08 AM Crowdfunding Crowdfunding is attractive for businesses as it avoids the need to deal with local banks, which can be bureaucratic and slow to make decisions. Furthermore, even if the banks agree to grant a loan to a business, they may charge higher interest rates than crowdfunders. GLOSSARY TERMS Crowdfunding has become popular in recent years, especially with small and medium-sized businesses, because banks in many countries have been unwilling to lend following the financial crisis of 2009–10. Equally, savers with spare cash have received very low interest rates and these have often been lower than the rate of inflation, meaning that savings are losing value over time. Consequently, savers have sought other ways to generate income from their savings. Microfinance is the provision of financial services for poor and low-income clients. Crowdfunding is a source of finance that entails collecting relatively small amounts of money from a large number of supporters (the ‘crowd’). CASE STUDY Crowdfunding: a different source of finance George Christakos owns and manages a restaurant in Nova Scotia, Canada. Facing the normal difficulties in raising capital, he decided to use his business’ customers as a source of finance. He wanted to enlarge the restaurant that he co-owned with his father, Leo, in the town of Halifax. George’s first choice as a source of finance, the bank, decided not to lend him any money. Not dismayed, George and his father decided to use crowdfunding to raise the finance they needed. Mr Christakos’ crowdfunding effort was unique, but entirely suitable for his business, and comprised three options for his customers. For investing $50, a customer was rewarded with lunch for two and two t-shirts. The option of a four-course dinner for two for investing $100 proved to be the most popular. For customers with larger sums to invest, George offered two dinners a year for the rest of the restaurant’s life. Government grants There are various grants and subsidised loans available to businesses from the UK government and other agencies within the UK. The government offers grants and loans to support business expansion, to provide funding for researching and developing new products, and to assist 5.2 5.2.2 Internal and external sources of finance Crowdfunding is a source of finance that entails collecting relatively small amounts of money from a large number of supporters (the ‘crowd’). Crowdfunding in a business context usually involves members of the ‘crowd’ each lending a small sum of money to the business. Occasionally, these small sums may be given as donations or represent early payment for the business’ goods or services. Online businesses (such as Kickstarter) exist to bring together entrepreneurs and large numbers of investors offering small sums of capital. The activities of businesses such as Kickstarter have helped to make crowdfunding a viable and popular source of finance for businesses, especially small ones. A number of entrepreneurs have set up internet-based businesses to meet the needs of savers and small and mediumsized businesses. They have acted as a link between the two groups, providing information on businesses seeking finance and administering loans provided by the ‘crowds’ of savers. Each saver may lend a relatively small amount to any business; this limits the effect if the business fails to repay the loan. Using crowdfunding as a source of revenue, the restaurant raised $23 000 from 115 contributors, 80 per cent of whom lived close to the restaurant. Crowdfunding campaigns can take many different forms. Some involve donations while others, such as Mr Christakos’ effort, involve the pre-purchase of goods or services. In any event, the goal is to raise capital. Questions 1 2 Analyse two reasons why a loan from the bank might have been George Christakos’ first choice of a source of finance. [8] Evaluate the major advantages and disadvantages to a small business of using crowdfunding as a source of finance. [12] businesses in buying new premises or improving existing properties. An estimated 4500 grants and financial programmes are available to UK organisations, amounting to a potential total value of £50 billion. Many other countries offer similar schemes. 175 9781398308114.indb 175 05/03/21 11:08 AM AS LEVEL 5.2 Sources of finance 5.2 Government grants will usually only cover a proportion of the total costs of a start-up or an expansion. There is also likely to be a great deal of competition from other businesses for government grants and there is usually a fixed amount of money available under most grant schemes. However, the major advantage of government grants is that entrepreneurs and businesses do not have to repay them as long as they meet any conditions under which the grant was given. The rate of interest The rate of interest charged by organisations granting loans can be a significant influence, especially if the loan is a large one. The interest rate charged will depend on the level of risk that the loan represents to the lender and the time period of the loan. A short-term loan to a high-risk business might be charged at a high rate of interest. CASE STUDY GLOSSARY TERM A government grant is a sum of money given to entrepreneurs or businesses for a specific purpose. HANDLING DATA A government provided a grant of 15 per cent of the start-up cost of a new business under one of its schemes. The amount of the grant was $375 000. How much was the start-up cost of the new business? New partners Pakistan’s cement industry faces high borrowing costs Paying interest on loans has become a major cost for Pakistan’s cement industry, given that interest rates have steadily risen to around 13 per cent at the start of 2020. Companies in the cement industry are paying high interest rates on long-term borrowing. This has led to calls for a reduction in interest rates amid fears that the high costs of financing loans might hit the level of profits made by firms in Pakistan’s cement industry. Some of the firms are considering issuing shares as an alternative means of raising the finance that they need. This is an option for small and medium-sized enterprises. A partnership (whether it has limited liability or not) can take on a new partner who will invest into the enterprise in return for becoming a partner and owning a share of the business. Similarly, a private limited company can decide to sell more shares, as long as the existing shareholders support the decision. In return for the ownership of a share of the business, the new partner(s) or shareholder(s) will provide an injection of capital. The industry’s financial position has been weakened further by poor levels of demand in Pakistan for concrete products and by a sharp decline in the level of exports to India. Sales of cement products have been flat in most countries, with the exception of China. Table 5.1 on page 163 classifies the sources of finance we have discussed according to whether they are short- or long-term, internal or external sources. You will note that retained profits can be classified as short- or long-term finance, as a business can opt to use this type of finance over any timescale. 2 5.2.3 Factors affecting sources of finance The managers of a business that is deciding on a source (or sources) of finance will be influenced by a number of factors, including the following. Cost of the source of finance For most businesses that are raising capital, the cost of alternative sources might be an important factor in making a decision as to the best source of finance. The costs incurred by firms raising capital can take a number of forms. Questions 1 Explain one benefit that Pakistani cement producers might receive from selling shares to raise finance. Evaluate the reasons why high interest rates have been such a burden for businesses in the cement industry in Pakistan. [3] [12] The costs of selling shares For a public limited company, a share issue can be an attractive option. However, this can be an expensive method of raising capital, as it entails considerable administration and promotion and, on occasions, a form of insurance to provide the funds if the sale is not successful. When shares are first sold by a company, it has to use the services of other expert organisations to organise the sale. It is common for companies to use merchant banks for this purpose. Public limited companies sometimes use rights issues to sell new shares. A rights issue involves selling additional shares to existing shareholders in proportion to the number of shares already owned. For example, existing shareholders may be offered the opportunity to buy one new share for each eight already held. Because of the relatively low cost of issuing shares in this way, it is usual for them to be sold at a slight discount to encourage sales. 176 9781398308114.indb 176 05/03/21 11:08 AM STUDY TIP Opportunity cost A decision to use a particular source of finance may have a cost in terms of what has to be given up as a consequence of the decision. For example, a decision to use sale and leaseback as a source of finance may appear to be a lowcost option. However, this source of finance will commit the company to paying each month or year for the asset that has been sold. Similarly, using retained profits for reinvestment into the company involves an opportunity cost which can be measured in terms of the reduction in the amount of profits available to pay dividends to shareholders. Finally, receiving trade credit from a supplier may be an attractive short-term source of finance, but it carries a possible opportunity cost in that the supplier may charge a higher selling price because it is, in effect, providing an interest-free, short-term loan. For many businesses, accessing sources of finance at the lowest possible cost is the most important factor. Flexibility Some sources of finance are highly flexible and can be adapted to meet a business’ precise needs. The most obvious example is an overdraft. This source of finance allows a business to overspend its current account or not according to its needs (but subject to an overall limit). Thus, a business can use its overdraft only when necessary and can avoid any interest charges at times when its finances are stronger. This flexibility has a cost, however: overdrafts are an expensive source of finance. Although government grants are appealing to many businesses because they do not normally have to be repaid, they can be an inflexible form of finance. Many grants are only available with strict conditions attached. Many UK government grants are only made if the business creates new jobs or at least maintains employment levels. Because of this, grants may not be a suitable source of finance in circumstances where labour is relatively expensive and the newly acquired finance could be used to introduce laboursaving technology. The need to retain control Some sources of finance may result in the original owners of the business losing some, or even complete control of it. 5.2 Smaller businesses that do not trade as companies can also lose some degree of control if they opt to use certain sources of finance. For example, venture capitalists may only agree to provide finance to what may be a risky business if a part of their investment is in the form of shares and they have a say in the management of the business. The uses to which finance is put Some sources of finance are particularly suitable in certain situations. For example, a business that is seeking to raise finance to purchase property and has to rely on loan finance will probably consider taking out a mortgage. As we saw earlier, a mortgage is a long-term loan (and can be available at relatively low rates of interest) and the combination of these two factors makes it an ideal source of finance to purchase property, which can be very expensive. 5.2.3 Factors affecting sources of finance Do not confuse the sale of new shares and second-hand ones. Firms sell newly issued shares directly to the shareholders. In contrast, second-hand shares are sold mainly through the stock exchange. When second-hand shares are sold on the stock exchange, it is not a source of finance for the company whose shares are sold – it is merely a means of the shareholder recovering the investment by selling the shares to another person or organisation. Certain forms of finance are only available if the person or organisation investing gains a say in how the business is managed. This is perhaps most obvious in the sale of shares. If a private or public company makes a succession of share issues, it may be that the number of new shares issued is greater than the number of ‘original’ shares. In this case, the new shareholders may gain control of the company. However, it may be possible for the company to issue shares that do not carry full voting rights. This can allow the original shareholders to retain control though, of course, it makes the issue of new shares much less attractive to potential shareholders. If the finance is being raised to fund a risky start-up, then an entrepreneur may experience difficulties in finding investors willing to put capital into the business. In this situation, a venture capitalist may be the best choice as this source of finance specialises in investing in relatively highrisk enterprises and may also provide support and guidance to novice entrepreneurs. Finally, if the finance is needed to fund additional working capital, perhaps because a business is expanding, then an overdraft or perhaps trade credit may be selected as the funding will only be required for a short period of time until the business achieves a higher level of sales and an increased inflow of revenue. This additional revenue can repay the overdraft or settle the outstanding trade credit. The level of existing debt If a business has substantial amounts of existing loans, banks may be unwilling to agree to increasing the amount of debt. Banks may judge that further loans will represent a risk to them as the interest payments may be considerable, especially if interest rates rise. In such circumstances, a business may be forced to seek alternative sources of finance, such as selling an asset (and possibly leasing it back) or selling shares if the business is a company. As a rule of thumb, if a business has borrowed more than half the total capital that it has raised, banks may judge further loans to be too risky. 177 9781398308114.indb 177 05/03/21 11:08 AM The preceding section has highlighted that a business will choose its sources of finance based on a number of factors, including cost, flexibility and the need to retain control. When making judgements on the most appropriate source of finance, managers must take into account a range of factors relating to the business’ internal position and the business environment in which it is trading. » The business’ financial situation Is it profitable? If so, it may be able to use retained profits as a source of finance or at least be able to provide evidence to banks and other trade payables (creditors) that it can repay loans. Alternatively, it may have assets that it can sell and lease back, or simply sell. » The business’ reputation A reputation as a reliable and popular business may also enable its managers to persuade suppliers to offer increased trade credit, which can fund short-term needs for finance. Equally, such a reputation will assist a business in negotiating loans, possibly at favourable rates of interest, or in persuading shareholders to purchase the company’s shares. » The business’ legal structure This will play a role in making the decision on the appropriateness of sources of finance. Thus, only companies will be able to elect to use share capital as a source to fund start-ups or expansions. » The business environment The environment in which the business is trading will also shape the decision. If sales in a market are growing, the business may be better able to finance the repayments on a loan as its revenues should increase in the future. On the other hand, if interest rates are high (making loan capital a relatively expensive source of finance), businesses may seek alternative sources. CASE STUDY Venture capital in China very scarce in 2020 50 At the time of writing, China is facing a lack of venture capital for its start-up businesses. The situation is not simply affecting start-ups, as established businesses that are seeking to grow are also starved of venture capital. There was a fall of over 65 per cent in investment in startups by venture capitalists in China and Hong Kong (called Greater China) in the first three months of 2020 compared to the same period in 2019. This increased the difficulties in raising capital experienced by many businesses through Greater China in a period which has become known as the ‘capital winter’. Figure 5.8 shows the dramatic decline in venture capital as a source of finance in 2020 as compared to previous years. Questions 1 2 Analyse two circumstances in which a business might choose to use venture capital as its primary source of finance. [8] Evaluate the other sources of finance that an entrepreneur starting a business in China in 2020 might choose to use. [12] STUDY TIP If a question asks you to suggest and justify a source of finance for a given situation, do not always select a single source. It is very common for businesses to use several sources of finance to fund a project, especially if a large sum of capital has to be raised. It may also be easier to justify the use of a mix of sources, as it reduces the impact of the disadvantages of any single source of finance. 45 40 35 US$ billion AS LEVEL 5.2 Sources of finance 5.2 5.2.4 Selecting the source of finance 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 2018 2018 2018 2018 2019 2019 2019 2019 2020 (1) (2) (3) (4) (1) (2) (3) (4) (1) Year (quarter) ▲ Figure 5.7 Venture capital provided in Greater China, quarterly 2018–20 Source: https://edition.cnn.com/2020/03/26/tech/china-startupfunding-coronavirus/index.html As you can see, a business will take a range of factors into account when selecting the best source (or sources) of finance to use. There is no single best source – it always depends on the circumstances. 178 9781398308114.indb 178 05/03/21 11:08 AM TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 a [3] [4] [4] [2] [6] [2] [3] [2] [3] [2] [3] [3] [4] [3] [6] Sunshine Tours looks to expand Sunshine Tours Plc is a London-based company that sells its shares on the London Stock Exchange. It sells holidays to European and American tourists. All of its holidays are based on the island of Mauritius. The company has suffered a decline in sales due to falling incomes in Europe and America, and its profits have steadily declined, reaching just £48 million in 2019. However, sales are forecast to rise over the next three years at an accelerating rate. The company’s directors wish to expand the business. The company already has large long-term debts, although it has repaid 30 per cent of these since 2017. Its business plan for 2021–24 sets out details of capital expenditure totalling £150 million, although the sources of finance to be used have yet to be decided. The company’s shares have been performing well, despite its recent dip in profits, and it has maintained impressive dividend payments to its shareholders. One of the directors believes that the company should raise all the capital it needs by selling shares. Another argues for the use of debentures as interest rates are low in the UK. 5.2.4 Selecting the source of finance Explain one source of finance that is available to a sole trader. b Define the terms ‘leasing’ and ‘hire purchase’. 2 a Define the terms ‘loan capital’ and ‘share capital’. b Define the term ‘sale and leaseback’. 3 Explain one advantage and one disadvantage of using debt factoring as a source of finance. 4 Define the term ‘microfinance’. 5 Using an example, explain one difference between short-term and long-term sources of finance. 6 a Define the term ‘venture capital’. b Explain one advantage to a business of using venture capital as a source of finance. 7 a Define the term ‘government grant’. b Explain one reason why it is easier for a public limited company to raise finance by selling shares than it is for a private limited company. 8 Explain one reason why a partnership may experience difficulties in raising large sums of finance. 9 a Define the terms ‘overdraft’ and ‘bank loan’. b Explain one disadvantage to a business of using an overdraft as a source of finance. 10 Explain one advantage and one disadvantage to companies of raising capital by selling shares. 5.2 Data response question Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘capital expenditure’ b ‘debenture’. Analyse two factors that the directors of Sunshine Tours Plc may take into account when deciding which sources of finance to use to raise the £150 million it needs. Evaluate whether or not Sunshine Tours Plc should sell shares as the only means of raising the capital it needs. [2] [2] [8] [12] 179 9781398308114.indb 179 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5 Finance and accounting AS LEVEL AS LEVEL 5.3 Forecasting and managing cash flows 5.3 Forecasting and managing cash flows Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the meaning and purpose of cash-flow forecasts ★ the interpretation and amendment of simple cash-flow forecasts ★ the methods that businesses can use to improve their cash flow. 5.3.1 Cash-flow forecasts The meaning and purpose of cash-flow forecasts should be included in the plan at the time they take place. A simplified cash-flow forecast is illustrated in Figure 5.8, which introduces opening and closing cash balances. These are the sums of cash held by a business at the start and end of a trading period. Businesses need to manage their cash carefully to ensure they have sufficient to pay their bills as they become due for payment. This means that businesses need to manage cash flows to ensure that cash can flow into the business in time to be available to make payments – that is, in time to meet cash outflows. Cash flow is the movement of cash into and out of a business over a period of time. A potentially profitable enterprise can fail because of poor management of cash flow. Businesses are especially vulnerable to cash-flow difficulties in their first months and years of trading and during periods of major expansion. It is for this reason that many financial institutions demand evidence that entrepreneurs and managers have planned the management of cash for a new or expanding enterprise before granting a loan. NOVEMBER Closing cash balance: + $35 000 DECEMBER Opening cash balance: + $35 000 DECEMBER Add total cash inflow of: $120 000 DECEMBER Net cash flow of ($20 000) DECEMBER Take away total cash outflow of: $140 000 GLOSSARY TERMS Cash is a business’ most liquid asset – it is notes and coins as well as funds held in the business’ bank accounts. A cash-flow forecast is a document that records a business’ anticipated inflows and outflows of cash over some future period, frequently one year. The structure of a cash-flow forecast Most businesses construct cash-flow forecasts. These are predictions of a business’ inflows and outflows of cash. Although cash-flow forecasts differ from one another, they usually have three sections and are normally calculated monthly. An essential part of cashflow forecasting is that inflows and outflows of cash DECEMBER Closing cash balance: + $15 000 JANUARY Opening cash balance: + $15 000 ▲ Figure 5.8 Opening and closing cash balances 180 9781398308114.indb 180 05/03/21 11:08 AM January 1 Cash in 2 Cash out March Net monthly cash flow 4 Opening Opening balance and closing Closing balance balances ▲ Figure 5.9 A typical layout for a cash-flow forecast Figure 5.9 shows a typical layout for a cash-flow forecast. Although the exact structure can vary, all cash-flow forecasts should contain the following elements. 1 Cash in The first section forecasts the cash inflows into the business, usually on a monthly basis. This section includes receipts from cash sales and credit sales. Credit sales occur when the customer is given time to pay (normally 30, 60 or 90 days) and are recorded in the forecast in the month in which the income is received. 2 Cash out The cash out (or expenditure) section will state the expected expenditure on the goods and services. Thus, a typical section might include forecasts of expenditure on rent, rates, insurance, wages and salaries, fuel, and so on. These are shown for the month in which the payment is made. At the end of this section, the total expected outflow of cash over the time period in question would be stated. 3 Net monthly cash flow The net monthly cash flow is calculated by subtracting the total outflow of cash from the total inflow. 4 Opening and closing balances The final section of the forecast has the opening balance and the closing balance. The opening balance is the business’ cash position at the start of each month. This will, of course, be the same figure as at the end of the previous month. The net monthly cash flow is added to the opening balance figure. The resulting figure is the closing cash balance for the month. It is also the opening balance for the following month. Cash-flow forecasts – a case study Steve Marshall is buying a bookshop. He knows that he needs to forecast his cash flow to help him to identify times when he might experience cash-flow problems. Knowing when he is likely to be short of cash gives him the chance to arrange an overdraft or short-term loan. His bank is unlikely to advance him a loan unless he constructs a cash-flow forecast. Steve has made the following forecasts about his business for the first four months of trading from June until September: » Steve has raised $75 000 from a bank loan and his savings to buy the lease on a property and to purchase books. He also intends that this money will be used to pay his start-up marketing costs. » Steve expects his business to have an opening cash balance of $2000 at the start of June. » Steve anticipates his cash sales to rise steadily for each of the four months (from $5750 to $9215) as his business becomes better known. However, he has already received an order to supply books to a local college. The order was for $10 000. He expects payment in September, but will buy the books in June, at the same time as he purchases his initial inventories. » Each month, Steve orders books from his suppliers to replace those he has sold. » He has to pay his own wages and those of a part-time assistant. These normally amount to $1500 each month. » Other costs including his rent, rates, heating and lighting amount to $1500 each month in June and July, but are higher in August and September. Steve’s cash-flow forecast (shown in Table 5.4 on page 182) illustrates many of the key principles. An important figure for each month is shown in the row entitled ‘Net monthly cash flow’. This simply records the balance between the inflow and outflow for the month. June is a good example of how this operates: in June, Steve had cash inflows from savings and borrowings of $75 000 and he expected to receive $5750 from book sales. At the same time, he planned to spend $94 500 on his initial purchase of books, as well as supplying the college’s order, and also on marketing, wages and rent. Thus, in June he expected his net cash flow (cash inflows less cash outflows) to be –$13 750 ($80 750 – $94 500). In cash-flow forecasts, negative figures can be shown in brackets or with a minus figure in front. Hence, the figure entered for net monthly cash flow in June is ($13 750). 5.3 5.3.1 Cash-flow forecasts 3 Net monthly cash flow February Cash sales Credit sales Total inflow Raw materials Wages Other costs Total outflow There are two main reasons why businesses might forecast their cash flows: 1 To support applications for loans Almost all new enterprises require loans to enable them to become established, and established businesses may need them during periods of expansion. Banks and other financial institutions are far more likely to lend money to a business that has evidence of financial planning. It is reassuring for the bank that the business’ managers understand the importance of cash and have planned carefully to avoid cash-flow crises. Cash-flow planning gives the bank more confidence that the entrepreneur or managers will be able to make the repayments of the loan as and when they are due. 2 To help avoid unexpected cash-flow crises Onefifth of newly established businesses fail within two years of starting trading. A high proportion of these fail because of cash-flow difficulties. Similarly, many large and established businesses encounter cashflow problems which can result in the closure of the business, as in the case of De La Rue, the British printer discussed in the case study on the following page. Planning can help avoid such difficulties. Cashflow planning can help to ensure that businesses do not suffer from periods when they are short of cash and unable to pay their debts. By forecasting cash flows, a business can identify times at which it may not have enough cash available. This allows it to make the necessary arrangements to overcome this problem. 181 9781398308114.indb 181 05/03/21 11:08 AM ▼ Table 5.4 Steve Marshall’s cash-flow forecast 5.3 June July August 75 000 0 0 5 750 7 500 8 475 9 215 0 0 0 10 000 80 750 7 500 8 475 19 215 Purchase of lease on shop 30 000 0 0 0 Purchase of books 59 000 4 500 5 000 6 100 Wages 1 500 1 500 1 500 1 500 Marketing costs 2 500 1 500 975 400 Other costs, e.g. rent 1 500 1 500 1 605 1 630 94 500 9 000 9 080 9 630 –13 750 –1500 –605 9 585 2 000 –11 750 –13 250 –13 855 –11 750 –13 250 –13 855 –4270 Cash in Savings and borrowings Cash sales Credit sales AS LEVEL 5.3 Forecasting and managing cash flows September Total cash inflow Cash out Total cash outflow Net monthly cash flow Opening balance Closing balance CASE STUDY Banknote printer runs short of cash In the United States of America, printing money and minting coins is the job of the Bureau of Engraving and Printing, part of a government department. But in the United Kingdom, banknotes and passports are printed by a private company, De La Rue. It is an irony that De La Rue is running low on cash. cash inflows. In 2018, the UK government decided to use another supplier for its new blue passports following the country’s decision to leave the European Union. In the following year, the Venezuelan central bank defaulted on a payment, resulting in De La Rue losing £18 million in income. De La Rue is one of the world’s major suppliers of passports and banknotes. It is thought to be the largest commercial printer in the world. The company’s cashflow problems have occurred despite the company earing £564.8 million in revenues and recording an annual profit of £31.5 million in 2019. Questions De La Rue’s survival has been put in doubt by two pieces of bad news in two years which will reduce its expected 1 2 Analyse two reasons why cash-flow forecasting is an important activity for De La Rue. [8] Evaluate the reasons why a company that earns profits of £31.5 million in a year might run out [12] of cash. HANDLING DATA Use the information in the De La Rue case study to calculate the percentage of De La Rue’s revenue that was profit in 2019. 182 9781398308114.indb 182 05/03/21 11:08 AM 2 Outflows differ from the forecast It is common for a business to experience higher outflows than forecast or for outflows to take place earlier than expected. Interpreting cash flows For example, Steve Marshall’s cash-flow forecast (Table 5.4) may have under-estimated the bookshop’s cash sales in June. The actual figure may have been $6750. This would result in a number of changes to Steve’s cash-flow forecast for June: » the business’ total cash inflow being $81 750 in June » the business’ net monthly cash flow becoming –$12 750 » the business’ closing balance becoming –$10 750. Interpreting a cash-flow forecast simply means reading the forecast and taking note of what it reveals. Managers will look at cash-flow forecasts in detail and will look for periods when the business is expected to be short of cash. This will be shown when closing balance figures are negative. A negative figure for a closing balance tells managers that, in that period, the business’ cash outflows have been sufficiently high to use up more than the cash that is available. It also tells managers that cash outflows are taking place before sufficient inflows have occurred. If managers can identify cash-flow problems before they occur, through the use of cash-flow forecasts, they are able to take remedial actions to prevent the problem occurring. They might, for example, arrange an overdraft with the bank to ensure they have enough cash available to pay bills on time. The case study of Steve’s bookshop also illustrates how the construction and interpretation of a cash-flow forecast can be of value to managers. Steve’s business will be short of cash during June, July, August and, to a lesser extent, September. The closing balances for these months indicate that he will require a maximum of $13 855 of additional cash in a month to enable him to pay his rent, wages, and so on. Knowing this in advance means that Steve can take steps to avoid a cash crisis, possibly by agreeing an overdraft with his bank. Although the use of cash-flow forecasts can help businesses to plan and manage their finances, the process does involve a degree of uncertainty. Managers cannot be certain about the accuracy of their forecasts of inflows, especially if they are engaging in a new venture, such as launching a new product or entering a new market. Most businesses will base their forecasts of cash inflows on the results of market research. However, this may not be accurate if the managers carry out insufficient primary research or rely on out-ofdate or inappropriate secondary research data. This is more of a risk for companies entering markets where less current data is available. Forecasting cash outflows accurately can also be difficult. Unexpected changes in the price of resources can result in forecasts proving to be very inaccurate. For example, between the start of January and the middle of March 2020, the price of a barrel of West Texas oil fell from over $63 to around $27, a decrease of 57.1 per cent. Forecasting cash outflows accurately can be challenging for businesses that use large quantities of products which have volatile prices, such as oil. Amending cash-flow forecasts Changes in a business’ circumstances can have a substantial effect on a business’ cash-flow forecast and it may have to be amended as a consequence. A cash-flow forecast may need amending for two broad reasons: 1 Inflows differ from the forecast This will be a concern if they are lower than forecast, perhaps because sales are lower than was expected or because payments are received later than anticipated. 9781398308114.indb 183 5.3 5.3.1 Cash-flow forecasts Interpreting and amending cash-flow forecasts The key figure here for Steve Marshall is the closing balance figure. This is still a negative figure, but a small one. As a result, Steve may need a smaller overdraft from his bank to ensure that he has sufficient cash to pay the bookshop’s costs in July. Cash outflow figures may also be different from the forecast, requiring amendments to be made. The handling data feature below gives an example of this. HANDLING DATA Use the information from Table 5.4 to answer the following questions. 1 What would the closing balance have been in September if marketing costs in September were $2150? 2 What would have been the opening balance for October? Methods of improving cash flow Trying to prepare accurate cash-flow forecasts is only part of the solution. Businesses have to decide how they are going to improve their cash position – if they identify a future problem with their cash position. A number of techniques can be used to improve a cash flow: » Reducing costs If a business is able to reduce its costs of production, this will lead to a reduction in the amount of cash flowing out of the enterprise and will strengthen its cash-flow position. This reduction in costs can be achieved in a number of ways. A manufacturing business may seek lower-cost resources to reduce its cash outflows. For example, a furniture manufacturer may opt to use timber from non-sustainable sources because it is cheaper. A business supplying services may seek to reduce wages by cutting hourly rates or reducing the number of employees. Such actions may result in undesirable side effects even if the business’ cash-flow position improves. Using lower quality resources may reduce the quality of a product and lead to a business having to reduce its prices, which may damage cash inflows. Moving away from the use of environmentally friendly (and more expensive) resources or cutting wages and/or employment levels may attract adverse publicity. The outcome may be a fall in sales, which could reduce cash inflows. However, it is possible that a business may opt to use techniques such as recycling to reduce the costs of acquiring raw materials. This can have a positive effect on the business’ image if it is perceived to be environmentally friendly and may result in rising sales. 183 05/03/21 11:08 AM » Improving the management of trade receivables and AS LEVEL 5.3 Forecasting and managing cash flows 5.3 trade payables Most firms receive some trade credit from their suppliers; this is known as trade payables. This means they may be given 30, 60 or 90 days to pay for supplies. If a business can persuade suppliers who have previously been reluctant to offer trade credit to do so, it will increase its trade payables figure and improve its cash-flow position. Remember that cash-flow management is a matter of timing; delaying payments always helps. Another important move might be to extend existing trade credit agreements from, say, 30 to 60 days. It may not, however, be possible for a small or newly established business to negotiate favourable credit terms if it does not have a suitable financial history. A business may also offer customers less favourable terms for trade credit. This means it reduces its trade receivables. This may require all customers to pay for products within 30 days, whereas in the past trade credit was for 60 days. Good control of trade receivables and trade payables can mean earlier inflows of cash and fewer bad debts. If a business is not actively chasing up customers to ensure that they pay, and pay on time, cash-flow problems may be the result. Firms can improve their cash-flow position by managing these inflows and outflows more effectively. Using sources of finance to strengthen a cash position We saw in the previous chapter that a business may raise finance through a number of sources of finance. Some of these sources can be particularly useful in helping to overcome a period of cash shortage. Debt factoring We saw in the previous chapter that a business can receive cash earlier by ‘selling’ its debts to a debt factor. Figure 5.6 on page 174 illustrates the stages involved in debt factoring. This technique offers the advantage of providing a significant and immediate inflow of cash, but it can damage the business’ profitability. It is likely that a debt factor will charge a fee equivalent to approximately 5 per cent of the total value of the debts and this will reduce the business’ profits on the transaction by the same percentage. HANDLING DATA Inara Industries has invoices to the value of $770 000 which it wishes to use for debt factoring. The factoring company has offered 80 per cent of the value of the invoices immediately and a further 15 per cent when they are paid by the customer in three months’ time. 1 How much will Inara Industries receive from the factoring company immediately? 2 How much will Inara Industries receive from the factoring company in total? Arranged short-term borrowing The majority of businesses have agreed an overdraft with their bankers. Overdrafts can be expensive but reasonably economical because a business only borrows when necessary. A short-term bank loan will also provide an inflow of cash, but it may be more costly in terms of interest charges. Sale and leaseback This method of improving cash flow entails a business selling a major asset – for example, a building – and then leasing it from the new owner. This provides a significant inflow of cash into the business, improving the immediate cash position, but commits the firm to regular payments to lease the asset, which may weaken its future cash position and its profitability. CASE STUDY Otago Communications suffers cash problems Otago Communications (OC) is one of New Zealand’s leading manufacturers of telecommunications equipment. It supplies large quantities of equipment to multinational companies throughout the world, offering generous trade credit terms. Its profits have been steady in recent years, though disappointingly low. Last month it announced its intention to sell one of its best-known factories to raise NZ$75 million of urgently needed cash. The company’s factory is located in a stylish glass and steel building in Dunedin, on New Zealand’s southern island. OC moved into the building in 2001 and enlarged it in 2007; it is currently the workplace for 1880 of the company’s employees. The company intends to sell and lease back the building as it is vital to its operations. Analysts estimate that it will raise NZ$200–300 million, which would provide a crucial cash inflow for the business. OC has suffered from well-publicised cash-flow problems, particularly in recent months – its cash position weakened by NZ$680 million over three consecutive months alone. A spokesperson for OC said: ‘We have enough cash resources to do what we need. But to cut costs and save cash we are looking at all possible options with no stones being left unturned. One of those is the possibility of selling one of our factories.’ Questions 1 2 Analyse two other ways in which OC could have improved its cash-flow position. Evaluate whether the advantages of OC’s planned sale and leaseback deal outweigh its disadvantages. [8] [12] 184 9781398308114.indb 184 05/03/21 11:08 AM Leasing Using leasing, a business simply leases (or rents) noncurrent assets (such as vehicles and computers) rather than buying them. This conserves precious reserves of cash and can have quite a significant impact on a business’ shortterm cash position, as non-current assets can be very costly. However, as with several of these techniques, it does require businesses to make a steady outflow of cash over time. We saw in the previous chapter that hire purchase is a means of obtaining credit for the purchase of a non-current asset. The business purchasing the asset pays a percentage of the purchase price as a deposit and the remainder in instalments over a lengthy period of time. This slows the Choosing a method of improving cash flow There is no single best method of improving a business’ cash flow. All the methods we discussed have their advantages and disadvantages, as summarised in Table 5.5. ▼ Table 5.5 The advantages and disadvantages of selected methods of improving a business’ cash flow Method Advantages Disadvantages Improved management of trade receivables and payables • Can be a ‘free’ method of improvement • Can be implemented relatively quickly • Available to most businesses • Reducing trade credit offered may result in a loss of customers • May not be available to new businesses or those without a reputation as reliable payers Debt factoring • Can generate large and immediate inflows of cash • Available to businesses with little power to negotiate favourable trade credit terms • Can reduce the amount of profit on each sale (by up to 5 per cent) • May not be viable for businesses making very small profits (such as start-ups) Short-term borrowing • Can be available to the business immediately • May be highly flexible (as in the case of an overdraft) • Businesses with weak cash positions may be unable to negotiate short-term loans • Can be a relatively expensive option as interest rates may be high Sale and leaseback • Avoids the need for any interest payments • Retains the use of the asset for the business and can raise large sums of finance • Only a business with saleable assets can engage in this method • This may reduce the business’ long-term profits by increasing expenditure Leasing • Avoids the need for large cash purchases on assets that may decline in value • Can allow businesses to use the most up-todate assets • The business is committed to regular, smaller outflows • The company does not own the assets that are used Reduction in costs • Can boost the business’ profitability as well as strengthening its cash-flow position • May improve the business’ image if it involves techniques such as recycling • May compromise quality of products if cheaper resources are used • Businesses may have to lower prices if quality is reduced Hire purchase • Can delay cash outflows by a considerable time period • May be used to finance the purchase of relatively expensive non-current assets, having a significant impact on a business’ cash-flow position • This is an expensive method of buying noncurrent assets and may reduce profitability • The business does not own the asset until the final payment is made 5.3 5.3.1 Cash-flow forecasts Hire purchase outflow of cash from the business and helps it to retain a larger holding of cash. As with leasing, this technique can strengthen a business’ short-term cash position substantially due to the high cost of non-current assets. The purchaser only becomes the owner of the asset once the final payment is made. Hire purchase may be used to finance the acquisition of relatively expensive assets such as vehicles and can therefore have a considerable impact on the business’ cash-flow position. 185 9781398308114.indb 185 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5.3 TEST YOUR LEARNING 1 2 AS LEVEL 5.3 Forecasting and managing cash flows 8 Short answer questions 3 4 5 6 7 a b Define the term ‘cash flow’. [2] Explain one reason why a business might forecast its cash flow. [3] Explain one reason why a profitable business may be short of cash. [3] Explain one reason why newly established businesses are vulnerable to cash-flow problems. [3] a Explain one difference between net monthly [3] cash flow and an opening balance. b A business has a closing balance of $10 000 at the end of October and has experienced a net monthly cash flow of $44 500. Calculate its opening balance in November. [2] a Define the term ‘cash-flow forecast’. [2] b Explain one benefit to managers of preparing a cash-flow forecast. [3] A business has the following cash-flow data for July: – an opening balance of $130 250 – cash inflows of $675 750 – cash outflows of $754 500. a Calculate its net cash flow for July. [2] [2] b Calculate its opening balance for August. A business has forecast the following cash-flow data for February: – cash inflows of $115 000 – cash outflows of $140 115. a Calculate the business’ net cash flow for the month. [2] b Its actual cash inflows were 10 per cent higher than expected. Recalculate its net cash flow. [3] a b Define the term ‘trade payables’. [2] Explain one method a business might employ to [3] improve its cash-flow position. 9 Explain one advantage and one disadvantage of the use of debt factoring as a method of improving a business’ cash-flow position. [6] 10 Explain two reasons why a small business suffering from cash-flow problems might prefer to arrange a short-term loan rather than rely on an overdraft. [6] Data response question Mugunga Mines Ltd The rising price of copper in world markets has resulted in the opening of new copper mines in Uganda. In the past, these might not have been considered profitable, however, the price of copper might continue to fluctuate in the future. Mugunga Mines Ltd (MM) is one company that reopened a small mine last year. It is a well-established company with valuable non-current assets and a good record for being profitable. Opening the new mine necessitated a large investment ($3.5 million) in mining equipment and preparatory work before mining could commence. The company’s customers have been given at least 60 days’ trade credit before paying for the copper they purchase and the size of their orders has risen quickly. The company had some cash-flow difficulties in the first year of operating the new copper mine. It has prepared a quarterly cash-flow forecast for the second year of trading for the copper mine, as shown in Table 5.6 below. One manager commented that the cash-flow forecast showed an improving cash position. ▼ Table 5.6 A cash-flow forecast for MM’s copper mine for Year 2 Quarter 1 $000s Quarter 2 $000s Quarter 3 $000s Quarter 4 $000s 875.5 875.5 923.0 923.0 998.7 998.7 1,075.4 1,075.4 313.6 500.5 100.8 914.9 (39.4) (125.5) (164.9) 322.6 501.2 102.1 925.9 (2.9) (164.9) (167.8) 366.3 502.5 107.8 976.6 22.1 (167.8) (145.7) Cash in Credit sales Total cash inflow Cash out Transport and distribution costs Wages and salaries Other costs Total cash outflow Net monthly cash flow Opening balance Closing balance 2 Questions 1 a b Define the term ‘trade credit’. Calculate the company’s closing balance for quarter 4. [2] [3] 3 387.7 503.1 108.7 999.5 75.9 (145.7) Analyse one reason why Mugunga Mines Ltd’s cash position is described by one manager as ‘improving’ over the year. [4] Evaluate whether debt factoring is the best way for the company to deal with any future cash-flow difficulties. [12] 186 9781398308114.indb 186 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5 Finance and accounting AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 5.4.1 Cost information Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ why businesses need accurate information on costs ★ the types of costs businesses have to pay ★ the full and contribution approaches to costing, including their uses and limitations ★ how cost information can be used for decision-making, including setting prices, to monitor and improve business performance, to calculate profits and for special order decisions ★ the calculation and interpretation of break-even output ★ the uses and limitations of break-even analysis. 5.4.1 Cost information GLOSSARY TERMS What is a cost? It is simply an expense paid by a business as part of its trading. Some of the expenses or costs firms have to pay include payments for raw materials, fuel and components, as well as wages and salaries. Costs are expenses that a business has to pay to engage in its trading activities. In contrast, revenues are a business’ income or earnings over a period of time. Total revenues are the sum of a business’ earnings from the sale of all its products. Total revenue is calculated by multiplying the selling price of a product by the number of products sold. revenue = quantity sold × average selling price Costs and revenues are vital data for most businesses. By comparing the total costs for a business over a period of time with the revenue that it earns, it is possible to calculate whether the business has made a profit or a loss. An important formula for almost every business is: profit (or loss) = total revenue − total costs Average selling × price per unit gives Number of units sold Variable costs + Fixed costs gives TOTAL REVENUE minus TOTAL COSTS gives 1 Profit if TR > TC 2 Loss if TR < TC 3 Break-even if TR = TC ▲ Figure 5.10 Costs, revenues and profits/losses Revenue is the income a business receives from selling its goods or services. The need for accurate cost information Calculating costs accurately can help managers to make a number of important decisions. By combining cost information with expected revenues, managers can calculate whether or not a business (or an element within it) is likely to make a profit or a loss. From this information, a range of other decisions may follow, including: » whether or not to start up a new business » whether to go ahead with a planned expansion » whether to take on a particular order from a customer, which may be unusual in some way » whether there is a need to reduce waste » whether to engage in some activity, such as increasing security to prevent loss or wastage. Without precise information on costs, managers cannot make decisions that are likely to prove beneficial to a business. For example, a business may be considering a decision to enter a new market and its market research may indicate the likely returns from this expansion. A critical element of the decision, though, will be to calculate the costs of doing so, enabling the business’ managers to forecast the likely profitability of this decision. Calculating the costs of this decision with a high degree of accuracy is not always easy, as we shall see later in this section. 187 9781398308114.indb 187 05/03/21 11:08 AM Variable costs Fixed costs In contrast to fixed costs, variable costs alter directly with the level of a firm’s output. This means that a firm increasing its output is likely to have to pay higher variable costs, whereas one reducing its output could expect variable costs to fall. Expenditure on fuel, raw materials and components are all examples of variable costs. Figure 5.11 relates to XYZ Computers Ltd, a business that produces computers. You can see that whether the factory produces 10 000 or 60 000 computers each year, the fixed costs faced by the business will remain the same at $5 million. 7 6 Fixed costs 5 XYZ Computers Ltd in Figure 5.12 faces variable costs of $500 for each computer it manufactures; this is necessary to pay for various items including the electronics, case and monitor. Thus, to produce 20 000 computers means the company faces variable costs of $10 million (20 000 × $500); to manufacture 50 000 results in variable costs of $25 million (50 000 × $500). Variable costs ($m) Fixed costs do not change when a business alters its level of output. For example, a business’ rent will not vary if there is an increase or decrease in the level of production. Other examples of fixed costs include management salaries and interest payments made by the business. Fixed costs ($m) AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 5.4 Types of costs 50 40 Variable costs 4 30 3 25 2 20 1 10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 Output of computers per annum (000s) ▲ Figure 5.11 Fixed costs The reason that these costs do not alter is that the business simply uses its existing facilities fully at times when it is receiving more orders. For example, in the run-up to warm summer weather, a manufacturer of sunglasses might increase its output, thereby using its existing production facilities more fully. The firm’s rent, rates and other fixed costs will be unchanged. Similarly, as winter approaches, sales and production of sunglasses are likely to fall, meaning some production facilities might be unused, but fixed costs will remain the same. 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 Output of computers per annum (000s) ▲ Figure 5.12 Variable costs It is usual to illustrate variable costs as a straight line, as in Figure 5.12. This suggests that expenditure on items such as fuel, labour, raw materials and components rises steadily along with output. Variable costs are drawn this way for simplicity. In the real world, the line may gradually flatten out as businesses frequently negotiate lower prices per unit when placing large orders. This means that XYZ Computers Ltd may be able to purchase components more cheaply, meaning that the variable costs associated with a production level of 50 000 computers might be $22.5 million. This means that the variable cost of each computer has fallen from $500 to $450. CASE STUDY High fixed costs in Mauritius Manufacturers of cement in Mauritius sold around 700 000 metric tonnes of the product in 2019. The island has a large number of construction projects, including the sports centre in Côte d’Or and the Metro Express, all of which lead to a large demand for cement. Until 2011, the government of Mauritius controlled the price of cement as it was concerned that prices might be too high and prevent development. A major cause of this was a lack of competitiveness in the industry. High fixed costs of production meant that it was difficult for new businesses to raise enough capital to enter the industry 188 9781398308114.indb 188 05/03/21 11:08 AM and compete effectively with established producers. As a consequence, the industry comprised two major suppliers. The degree of competition in the Mauritian cement industry has been reduced rather than increased. The two firms that existed in 2011 – Lafarge and Holcim – merged in 2015 to form a single company: LafargeHolcim Ltd. The calculation of total costs assumes that all the costs faced by a business are either fixed or variable. This means total costs can be calculated simply using the following formula: total costs = total fixed costs + total variable costs Total costs of production are an important piece of information for a business. Managers can use this information in taking decisions on levels of output and prices to be charged. For example, firms that have very high levels of fixed costs, perhaps due to needing expensive equipment, will seek to produce large quantities of output. This reduces the effect of fixed costs on the selling price by spreading them over a large quantity of sales. One point to note is that a business’ total costs when output is zero are only fixed costs, as without any production there cannot be any variable costs. Direct and indirect costs An alternative way of classifying the costs encountered by a business is to divide them into direct and indirect costs. Direct costs can be related to the production of a particular product and vary directly with the level of output. Examples include the costs of raw materials and fuel. Indirect costs are overheads that cannot be allocated easily to the production of a particular product and relate to the business as a whole. Indirect costs include the costs of marketing and administration. Indirect costs are generally recognised as difficult to control. Unless managers are vigilant, these costs can increase rapidly and reduce a business’ profits. Indirect costs are also called ‘overheads’ and are always fixed costs. Direct costs tend to vary with the level of production and are normally (but not always) variable costs. GLOSSARY TERMS Direct costs can be related to the production of a particular product and vary directly with the level of output. Indirect costs are overheads that cannot be allocated to the production of a particular product and relate to the business as a whole. Full costing allocates all the costs of production for the whole business. Therefore, these costs are absorbed into each output unit. This is also known as absorption costing. 1 2 5.4 Analyse two reaons why a business entering an industry may want to keep its variable costs as low as possible. [8] Evaluate the reasons why high fixed costs may have led to the cement industry in Mauritius having just one supplier after 2015. [12] The Honshu Motor Company This manufacturer of motor cars may incur direct and indirect costs as set out below. Direct costs • direct materials such as sheet steel and engine parts • direct labour, for example wages paid to employees on production line 5.4.2 Approaches to costing Total costs Questions Indirect costs • indirect labour costs, for example management salaries and wages paid to security staff • other indirect costs such as administration and distribution direct costs + indirect costs = total costs of production ▲ Figure 5.13 Direct and indirect costs of production 5.4.2 Approaches to costing The differences between full and contribution costing A problem faced by businesses when attempting to calculate costs accurately is allocating or dividing up indirect costs between different elements of the business. This can be a particular problem for large businesses that produce a range of products. One reason why it is difficult to calculate the total costs of producing a single unit of output is that indirect costs can be allocated in different ways and this can result in different cost figures. As a consequence, managers may take decisions that are incorrect. When a business produces a number of products using a single office or factory, it is difficult to calculate the total cost of producing a single unit of output of any of its products accurately. The problem it faces is how to allocate indirect costs such as marketing and administration. There are two approaches that can be taken. Full costing One method of deciding upon costs is full costing, which is used by many businesses. This is also known as ‘absorption costing’ and normally categorises costs as direct and indirect. This approach to costing involves charging all the costs of a particular enterprise to a unit of output. Thus, all the costs associated with the production of a particular product are ‘absorbed’ by it. This approach may require managers to allocate indirect costs to all the business’ different products. Full costing can allocate (or divide up) indirect costs between different products produced by a business using a range of criteria, such as the percentage of total indirect costs used in the production of each product. 189 9781398308114.indb 189 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5.4 Total cost of producing a particular product = Total direct costs AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs Divided by number of units = of output + Allocated share of indirect costs Total cost of a single unit of output ▲ Figure 5.14 Key relationships for full (absorption) costing Contribution costing The concept of contribution is an important one and is used in calculating break-even output, as we shall see later in this section. The use of contribution is based on clearly classifying costs as fixed or variable. Contribution can be calculated by use of the formula below: contribution = sales revenue – variable costs Contribution has two potential uses. Firstly, it is used to pay the fixed costs incurred by a business. Any contribution remaining after this transaction is profit for the business. profit = contribution – fixed costs It is possible to consider contribution in two broad ways: either in relation to a single unit of output or in relation to the entire output of a particular product or business. When contribution is calculated for the sale of a single product, we refer to it as contribution per unit. It is calculated by using the formula: variable costs of contribution selling price of one – producing that = unit of output per unit unit GLOSSARY TERMS Contribution can be defined as the difference between sales revenue and variable costs of production. Break-even is the level of production or output at which a business’ sales or total revenue is exactly equal to its total costs of production. Profits are the amount by which revenue exceeds total costs, although there are several different measures of profit. The full-costing method The full-costing approach normally divides costs into direct costs and indirect costs. To calculate the total cost of producing a single unit it is necessary to include all costs, both direct and indirect. This can be a tricky process if it is to provide accurate costing figures. The problem centres on allocating indirect costs or overheads in a way that represents the true costs of producing a product or operating a division within a business. We explore this in the case study on Palm Foods. The allocation of indirect costs in this way is unlikely to be entirely accurate. This has significant implications because, by changing the way that these costs are allocated, the profitability of different areas of a business can be affected. For example, in the Palm Foods case study, if the company’s accountants had decided to allocate indirect costs on the basis of the number of employees in each division, then the indirect costs allocated to the division producing meat 30 meals would have been: × $6 000 000 = $2 250 000. This 80 is $150 000 below the method actually used and would have boosted the profits of this division by a similar amount, assuming nothing else changes. HANDLING DATA The accountants in the Palm Foods case study might have decided to use the number of employees working in each of the company’s divisions as the basis for allocating its indirect costs. Calculate how the total indirect costs would have been allocated between the fish and vegetarian meals divisions if this method had been used. So, as we have seen, if a business makes two or more products, or operates multiple divisions or brands, full costing entails allocating (or absorbing) indirect costs as accurately as possible to the different parts of the business’ operations. If, for example, a business just produced two products, it could allocate its indirect costs taking into account the type of overhead: » Indirect costs such as rent or property taxes could be allocated or apportioned according to relative floor space taken up by the production of the two products. So, if product A takes up 60 per cent of the floor space, then 60 per cent of these fixed costs should be apportioned to product A. » Indirect costs such as wage costs associated with management and administrative staff could be allocated according to the number of people employed in the production of each product. As many businesses produce more than a single product, especially large-scale businesses, this approach to costing is widely used. It is also recognised by many governments as the accepted method to use in preparing financial statements. This trend is also increasing as markets become more global in nature and businesses have to extend their product ranges to meet the diverse needs of customers across the world. Nevertheless, when a business produces a range of products (as we can see in the Rajasthan Electronics Ltd case study) it requires managers to make difficult decisions to allocate indirect costs. 190 9781398308114.indb 190 05/03/21 11:08 AM CASE STUDY 5.4 Palm Foods allocates its indirect costs The company’s managers want to know the cost of production for its three divisions to help with their decision-making. They use the full-costing approach to do this. The company’s total indirect costs for 2019–20 were $6 million. The company’s accounts department has calculated some key statistics relating to the three divisions within the company. ▼ Table 5.7 Palm Foods’ key statistics Accounting item Meat meals Fish meals Sales revenue (%) 50 20 30 Number of employees on each production line 30 25 25 2 000 1 300 1 700 40 30 30 Area of the factory floor used by each division (square metres) Total direct costs incurred in production (%) Palm Foods’ accountants have decided to allocate the company’s indirect costs for 2019–20 according to the area of the factory’s floor space used by each of its three divisions. As a consequence, the indirect costs were allocated as shown below: l Meat meals: 2 000 × $6 000 000 = $2 400 000 5 000 1 l Fish meals: 300 × $6 000 000 = $1 560 000 5 000 Vegetarian meals 5.4.2 Approaches to costing Palm Foods manufactures a range of ready-to-eat meals aimed at high-income consumers. The company’s products can be divided into three divisions: l Meat meals: these contain a range of foods based mainly on chicken and lamb. l Fish meals: this is a smaller part of the company’s production and is becoming less popular. l Vegetarian meals: these are increasingly popular as meals on their own or as accompaniments to some of the company’s other products. l Vegetarian meals: 1 700 × $6 000 000 = $2 040 000 5 000 Questions 1 2 Calculate the allocation of indirect costs that would have resulted if the company’s accountants had used sales revenue as a guide. [6] Evaluate the ways in which the company should have allocated its indirect costs. [12] CASE STUDY Full costing at Rajasthan Electronics Rajasthan Electronics Ltd manufactures consumer electronics which are sold in Pakistan and other countries in Asia. The company’s production is divided into three product groups: televisions, microwave cookers and digital radios. The costs associated with the company’s production over the last financial year are shown in Table 5.8. The company’s managers use a policy of full costing to calculate its costs and profits on its three products, which are made in the same factory in Faisalabad. The company’s indirect costs were $120 million for the year. Rajasthan Electronics’ managers decided to allocate the company’s indirect costs on the basis of the percentage ▼ Table 5.8 Production costs at Rajasthan Electronics Ltd Televisions ($m) Microwave cookers ($m) Digital radios ($m) Revenue from sales 286 145 225 656 Direct materials costs 107 77 78 262 Direct labour costs 97 45 87 229 Total direct costs 204 122 165 491 52 27 41 120 256 149 206 611 30 (4) 19 45 Allocated indirect costs Total costs Profit Total ($m) 191 9781398308114.indb 191 05/03/21 11:08 AM AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 5.4 of revenue earned by each division. The calculations (with some rounding) carried out by the finance department are shown below: l Allocated indirect costs to televisions: 286 $120 million × = $52 million 656 l Allocated indirect costs to microwaves: 145 $120 million × = $27 million 656 l Allocated indirect costs to digital radios: 225 $120 million × = $41 million 656 l Total indirect costs = $120 million In the case of Rajasthan Electronics Ltd, the use of full costing makes it very difficult to judge with any certainty the precise financial position of the company’s three product ranges. There is a danger that the company’s senior managers may judge that the microwave division is The managers’ decision to allocate indirect costs in this way resulted in two of its divisions earning profits while the third, the microwave division, recorded a small loss. Not all of the company’s managers agreed with this approach to allocating indirect costs, and the managers of the microwave division were angry at suggestions that production of microwaves should be stopped as they were apparently making a loss rather than a profit. Questions 1 2 Analyse two other possible ways that Rajasthan Electronics Ltd might have allocated its indirect costs. [8] Evaluate whether or not Rajasthan Electronics Ltd should stop producing microwave cookers. [12] unprofitable and decide to discontinue production of this product. This could prove to be a poor decision for two reasons, as we shall see in the following continuation of the case study. CASE STUDY Further events at Rajasthan Electronics The managers of the microwave division are concerned about proposals to end production of their cookers. In response, they have recalculated the company’s profits for the past financial year using full costing but using a different basis for allocating indirect costs. l Allocated indirect costs to televisions: The company’s operations managers have recently reported that the production of televisions uses 46 per cent of the factory’s floor space, that digital radios uses 39 per cent and microwave cooker production takes place in 15 per cent of the available factory space. This was used as a basis to recalculate the profits from the three product ranges. Their revised calculations (again with some rounding) are shown on the right: l Allocated indirect costs to digital radios: $120 million × 0.46 = $55 million l Allocated indirect costs to microwaves: $120 million × 0.15 = $18 million $120 million × 0.39 = $47 million ● Total indirect costs = $120 million This allowed the managers to present a revised set of profit figures, as shown in Table 5.9. ▼ Table 5.9 Televisions ($m) Microwave cookers ($m) Digital radios ($m) Total ($m) Revenue from sales 286 145 225 656 Direct materials costs 107 77 78 262 Direct labour costs 97 45 87 229 Total direct costs 204 122 165 491 Allocated indirect costs Total costs Profit 55 18 47 120 259 140 212 611 27 5 13 45 This data shows that: 1 The microwave division may be profitable. 2 If production of microwaves is discontinued, the business’ fixed costs are unlikely to change and will have to be paid by the remaining two divisions, which will damage the profitability of the company. Questions 1 2 Analyse two reasons why a large business might use [8] full costing. Evaluate whether this is a more accurate way of calculating the company’s profits for its three product ranges than the approach based on the percentages of revenues earned by the divisions. [12] 192 9781398308114.indb 192 05/03/21 11:08 AM HANDLING DATA Use the data in the Rajasthan Electronics case studies to answer the following questions. 1 Calculate the percentage of total costs that are represented by direct labour costs. 2 5.4 Calculate the change in the company’s profits if it managed to reduce its direct materials costs by 10 per cent. Uses and limitations of the full-costing method 5.4.2 Approaches to costing Full costing has a number of uses as well as limitations. Some of these are summarised in Table 5.10 below. ▼ Table 5.10 The uses and limitations of full costing Uses Limitations • This approach to costing allows a business to take all of its costs into account before making pricing decisions. • Using the full costing is very common as this approach is recommended by the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS). • Managers have to give thought as to the most effective method of allocating indirect costs, which may result in an accurate approach. • It is difficult to allocate indirect costs accurately – the allocation is often based on proportions of direct costs. • It can result in bad decisions. Businesses may discontinue production of apparently unprofitable divisions, departments or brands. • If sales are below what is expected, allocated indirect costs per unit of production could be higher than forecast, meaning that a price that was expected to be profitable may not be. GLOSSARY TERM Contribution costing calculates the cost of a product solely on the basis of variable costs, thus avoiding the need to allocate fixed costs. The contribution-costing method Contribution costing is sometimes referred to as ‘marginal costing’. Contribution costing excludes fixed costs as a central part of the calculation and only allocates variable costs. This is valuable in a business that has a number of products, or several factories or divisions. A product or division that earns sufficient revenue to cover its fixed costs is likely to be viewed favourably by the managers of the business. If this is the case then the product will generate a positive contribution and assist in paying fixed costs or providing profit. The contribution-costing approach can be applied to the production and sale of a single unit of output or to the entire output of a product or products over a given time period. If a business would incur an additional cost of $100 in producing a single extra unit of output (this is its marginal cost) but would expect to sell that product for $125, then it would make a positive contribution of $25 on that unit of output. Alternatively, we can consider contribution costing for the entire production of a particular product or products as shown in Table 5.11. ▼ Table 5.11 Sales revenue, variable costs and contribution for a business producing three products Product A ($) Product B ($) Product C ($) Revenue from sales 175 000 342 750 55 250 Variable labour costs 87 150 169 700 14 525 Variable materials costs 32 000 88 560 12 770 Other variable costs 25 450 67 425 13 050 Total variable costs 144 600 325 685 40 345 Contribution 30 400 17 065 14 905 The example in Table 5.11 shows that product A contributes $30 400 towards paying fixed costs, product B $17 065 and product C $14 905. In total this is $62 370. If we assume that the fixed costs of the company for this period of time are $39 500, we can calculate the profits that the company has made. Total contribution: $62 370 Fixed costs: $39 500 Profit: $22 870 If a product makes a positive contribution, as is the case in Table 5.11, then it is worth the business continuing to produce it. There may even be an argument for continuing to produce it if it makes a negative contribution, as we shall see later. 193 9781398308114.indb 193 05/03/21 11:08 AM The difference between contribution and profit 5.4 It is essential to understand that contribution and profit are not the same thing. Contribution is the surplus left over from sales revenue (or total revenue) once variable costs have been paid. Profit is any surplus from sales revenue over a trading period once all costs have been paid. AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs The limitations of contribution costing and when it might be used As with full costing, contribution costing has a number of limitations. The main limitations include the following. » It can be difficult to distinguish between fixed and variable costs accurately. For example, some costs have elements of both and are known as semi-variable costs. One example of a semi-variable cost is landline telephone costs. The monthly line rental would be a fixed cost, because it remains the same irrespective of the level of business activity. However, the call charges are variable as they are likely to alter directly with a business’ level of activity. » Fixed costs do not always remain constant when the level of output alters. Some fixed costs tend to be higher as a result of a business increasing its level of output. For example, promotional costs or website maintenance costs may increase in line with production levels. This makes the division of costs into fixed and variable elements less accurate. » The tax authorities in some countries do not accept the use of contribution costing. For this reason, its use is less common than that of full costing. Contribution costing is likely to be used in a number of circumstances. It can help managers to decide whether to accept an order as it shows the variable costs of producing products. If a business receives a number of non-standard orders, it may use contribution costing to determine whether or not to accept such orders. We will explore this more fully in the next section. Businesses that produce many different products may be more likely to use contribution costing because the difficulties involved in allocating fixed (or indirect) costs between many different products can be too great. Any resulting cost figures may be judged inaccurate and any decisions taken on the basis of these figures may be incorrect. 5.4.3 Uses of cost information Calculating average, marginal and total costs Managers can calculate a number of costs to assist with decision-making. Three vital ones are: » average costs » marginal costs » total costs. GLOSSARY TERMS Average costs are the total cost of production divided by the number of units produced. Marginal cost is the extra cost resulting from producing one additional unit of output. In most situations the marginal cost of an additional unit of a product is the variable cost of its production. ▼ Table 5.12 Fixed, variable and total costs of producing televisions Level of production Fixed (million televisions) costs per year ($m) Variable costs ($m) Total costs ($m) 0 200 0 200 1 200 180 380 2 200 360 560 3 200 481 681 4 200 624 824 5 200 760 960 6 200 880 1 080 7 200 990 1 190 8 200 1 240 1 440 Average costs Average costs are simply total costs at any level of output divided by that level of output. They are also called unit costs. In Table 5.12, it is possible to calculate average costs at each level of output. For example: » At an output of 3 million televisions, the average cost is $681 million ÷ 3 million = $227 per television. » At an output of 5 million televisions, the average cost is $960 million ÷ 5 million = $192 per television. » At an output of 7 million televisions, the average is $1190 million ÷ 7 million = $170 per television. Average costs tend to fall as a business increases its production levels because its fixed costs are spread over a larger output, and so the amount allocated to each product is smaller as the level of production rises. HANDLING DATA Use the information in Table 5.12 to answer the following question. At what levels of output would the average cost of televisions be: a highest b lowest? 194 9781398308114.indb 194 05/03/21 11:08 AM Marginal costs Costs and pricing decisions The costs of production can have a significant influence on a firm’s pricing decisions. Average costs and prices (cost-plus pricing) Cost-plus pricing is the most commonly used method of setting prices. It involves deciding the price of a product based on the average cost of a single unit of the product. The average cost is calculated by dividing total production costs by the number of units that are produced. To this value is added an amount which is called a mark-up. The mark-up is, in effect, profit. Average cost plus mark-up is the price charged. For example, if a furniture manufacturer is aware that a single table costs $125 to produce and decides to price the table at $150, the pricing method is cost-plus. In these circumstances the manufacturer can be certain the product will sell at a profit, but may be less sure about the level of sales. Cost-plus pricing does not take into account the state of the market or actions of competitors. Scenario A The company produces 1000 bicycles during the year. Total production costs are $100 000 + ($50 × 1000) = $150 000 Average cost of producing one bicycle = $150 Scenario B The company produces 5000 bicycles during the year. Total production costs are $100 000 + ($50 × 5000) = $350 000 Average cost of producing one bicycle = $70 ▲ Figure 5.15 Average costs and production levels A firm can help to keep costs of production for each individual unit to a minimum by producing on the largest possible scale. Consider the two scenarios shown in Figure 5.15 for the London Bicycle Company. This company has fixed costs of $100 000 and each bicycle has variable costs of $50 for materials and labour. 5.4 GLOSSARY TERMS Cost-plus pricing is the process of establishing the price of a product by calculating its cost of production and then adding an amount which is profit. Contribution pricing is based on the notion that any price set that is higher than the variable cost of producing a product is making a payment towards fixed costs. Marginal costs and prices (contribution pricing) By knowing how much it costs to produce an additional unit of output, a business can be guided in setting prices or deciding whether to accept orders at specific prices. Marginal costs are based on the variable costs of production. Fixed costs will not be affected by the decision to supply additional units and so it is the contribution from any sale that is critical. Contribution can be calculated using the formula below: 5.4.3 Uses of cost information Marginal costs are the extra costs resulting from producing one additional unit of output. Marginal costs do not really take into account fixed costs, as they have to be paid whatever the level of production of the business. Thus, marginal costs are concerned with variable costs (the direct costs of materials and labour, for example). In most situations, the marginal cost of an additional unit of a product is the variable cost of its production. In the example of our television manufacturer in Table 5.12, we know that to produce 4 million televisions would result in a total cost of production of $824 million. If we assume that fixed costs are unchanged and that the variable cost of producing one more television is $200, the total cost will rise to $824 000 200 for 4 000 001 televisions. This means that the marginal cost of producing this one additional television is $200. Manufacturing in the circumstances of scenario B would allow the company to set lower prices for its bicycles or to enjoy higher profits – or both. For example, in scenario B it could reduce its price from more than $150 per bicycle to, say, $100. This would allow it to make a profit of $30 per bicycle and it is likely that sales would rise significantly due to the price fall, possibly boosting profits further. contribution = revenue – variable costs of production The concept of contribution is useful when taking pricing decisions. If the manager or owner of a business sets a price in excess of the variable cost of producing the product, then each sale will make a positive contribution to fixed costs. If sufficient sales are made, the enterprise will earn a profit. This approach to pricing is also called contribution pricing. For example, the manager of a restaurant may calculate that the typical variable cost of serving a meal to a customer is $12. If the restaurant charges customers an average price of $25 for each meal, then it will make a profit as long as it attracts enough diners. It is certain that the revenue received from each customer will contribute $13 ($25 − $12) towards fixed costs. Contribution pricing offers firms flexibility when deciding upon the amount to charge for their products. Businesses that have well-established products in high demand may be able to price significantly in excess of the variable cost of production. In these circumstances, each sale makes a major contribution to fixed costs and profits. Fashion clothing is an example of a product where prices are set considerably above variable costs. Thus, a business might charge the equivalent of $75 for a t-shirt that costs $10 to manufacture. The contribution of $65 from each sale is necessary because the business faces high fixed costs, spending heavily, for example, on marketing. Furthermore, products in the fashion industry have very short lives. 195 9781398308114.indb 195 05/03/21 11:08 AM AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 5.4 However, contribution pricing has its weaknesses. While setting a price that generates a positive contribution may result in the firm earning a profit, this depends upon the business in question achieving sufficient sales. This is far from certain as this approach to pricing places relatively little emphasis on the state of the market. Using contribution as a guide for pricing may result in low levels of sales because competitors’ prices are lower or their responses may be unpredictable. STUDY TIP Many students confuse contribution and profit, yet this distinction is vital and understanding it is important to gain top-level grades. Profit is revenue less all costs, while contribution is revenue less only variable costs. Using costs to monitor and improve business performance » the costs incurred by separate areas of the business (divisions or branches, for example) do not differ significantly without good reason » costs are not increasing unexpectedly and are similar to the forecasts set out in the company’s budgets » the business continues to hit its profits targets. We look at budgets in much more detail in Chapter 5.5. A business that operates many similar branches or outlets may compare the costs of its branches and seek to reduce costs to those achieved by the most efficient performer. In this way, the company uses cost data as indicators of best practice and seeks to duplicate this approach in other areas of its business to improve performance and profits. It may be possible for senior managers to set cost targets for areas of the business controlled by junior managers and to reward achievement of these targets. In this way, large organisations are more able to control costs and improve profits. Managers of all businesses constantly monitor costs to ensure that: CASE STUDY Starbucks expands in the Indian market The American coffee retail chain, Starbucks, opened its first coffee shop in India in 2012. Understandably, the market of 1200 million people was very attractive to the company, as incomes and a taste for coffee among Indians increased. However, selling in India required the company to change its approach in some ways. Starbucks, famous for its caramel macchiato and espresso, offered smaller and cheaper beverages to attract coffee drinkers in India. now has 157 outlets in ten Indian cities including Mumbai, Hyderabad, Chennai and Bengaluru. In 2019, Starbucks opened more than 30 outlets in India, the largest number of new store openings since 2012. However, Café Coffee Day is still India’s largest coffee shop chain. Questions In 2018, Starbucks also announced its plan to open outlets in the western state of Gujarat, where it opened five stores in the cities of Surat and Ahmedabad. Starbucks However, for a large-scale global business, such as Starbucks in the case study, it may be difficult to compare performance in different countries in this way because of huge differences in costs. Thus, monitoring and comparison of costs in this way is likely to be more effective if it takes place in a single country or within countries with similar costs for resources such as labour. Equally a trend of falling costs may provide an indication that profitable opportunities exist. For example, in 2019, the rental costs of retail properties in Hong Kong fell by over 10 per cent compared with the previous year. This cost information might assist a retail business to make a profitable decision on expansion. Thus, budgets can be used to monitor how well costs are controlled, but also to assist the business’ managers in improving the business’ performance. By using the cost Starbucks will continue to need to set its prices lower than in the United States if it is to increase its sales further in India. Starbucks’ expansion plan in India includes offering customers more vegetarian food options and adding new food items. 1 2 Analyse one reason why selling its products at lower prices in India might not necessarily reduce Starbucks’ revenue. [4] Evaluate the reasons why the costs of operating a coffee shop in Gujarat might be different from those in a state in the USA. [12] information, managers can take decisions to improve the business’ performance and, especially, its profitability. For example: » It may be able to reduce its costs following such an analysis. If it is placing increasingly large orders with its suppliers, it may be able to negotiate larger discounts for bulk orders. Alternatively, if it is not using all of its supplies, it may reduce the size of its orders and its costs. This is vital if the supplies are perishable. » Labour is a major cost for many businesses and especially those operating in the service sector. Monitoring labour costs is important to maximise profits. For example, if a business hires too much labour and that labour is not fully employed then the business is incurring costs that are not matched by revenue. Profitability will be damaged as a consequence. 196 9781398308114.indb 196 05/03/21 11:08 AM Using cost information to calculate profits Profits are the amount by which revenue exceeds total costs, although there are several different measures of profit. Figure 5.10 on page 187 illustrated that comparing the total costs for a business with the revenue that it earns over a period of time shows whether a business has made a profit or a loss. The key formula for profit is: profit (or loss) = total revenue − total costs At the end of a trading period, the managers of a business can calculate the business’ profits using its cost and revenue information. So, if a business generated sales revenue totalling $256.4 million during the financial year and incurred total costs amounting to $208.9 million, it could calculate its profits as follows: profit = $256.4 million – $208.9 million = $47.5 million In Table 5.12 on page 194 we considered the fixed, variable and total costs of producing televisions. Table 5.13 shows how this cost data can be used to calculate whether or not the business producing televisions makes a profit. Furthermore, it can be used to calculate the expected profit at different levels of output and to decide which might be most profitable. However, this is only possible when the company has the relevant revenue information as well. In this case, we assume that to sell higher quantities of televisions, the company has to sell its products at lower prices. This is why its revenue does not rise steadily with output. This cost information, when added to information about sales revenue (or total revenue), allows managers to calculate profits. The information in Table 5.13 suggests that the television manufacturer would make the highest profits if it produced (and sold) 5 million televisions per year. Of course, it is important to understand that this is forecast data and might not be completely accurate. However, it is an important aid to a business’ decision-making. ▼ Table 5.13 Sales revenue, total costs and profits from producing televisions Level of production Sales (million televisions) revenue per year ($m) Total costs ($m) Profits or losses ($m) 0 0 200 (200) 1 300 380 (80) 2 600 560 40 3 900 681 219 4 1 080 824 256 5 1 250 960 290 6 1 320 1 080 240 7 1 420 1 190 230 8 1 600 1 440 160 HANDLING DATA 5.4 5.4.3 Uses of cost information A business’ managers may look at cost data over a period of time. Changes in the figures may reveal underlying problems that can be corrected to improve the business’ profits. We can consider a few examples of using cost data in this way. » Rising labour costs within a business when output is not increasing could show that employees are working less efficiently. This could be caused by a range of factors, including a lack of training or poorly motivated employees. Once the cause of the rising labour costs has been identified, managers can take appropriate remedial action. » Rising costs of raw materials over time could indicate that there are high levels of waste or that suppliers have increased costs significantly. In either case, the cost information could alert managers to a problem which needs attention to improve profits. In 2020, Hasbro, the American toy manufacturer, said it would be seeking to manufacture more of its toys outside China due to the rising costs of producing in China. » A business’ fixed costs may increase more rapidly than might be expected over time. Managers responsible for controlling these costs may take action in response. Use the information in Table 5.13 to answer the following questions. 1 Assume the television manufacturer could always sell its televisions at $300 per television, no matter what its level of output. At what level of output would it make the highest profit? 2 Why is profit highest at this level of output? Contribution costing and special-order decisions One of the key advantages of using contribution costing is that it can help managers to make what are called specialorder decisions. GLOSSARY TERM Special-order decisions occur when a business’ managers have to decide whether or not to accept unusual customer orders. Special-order decisions Businesses sometimes have to make decisions on whether to accept orders that are not on their normal terms. For example, a firm might receive a large order for its products at a price significantly lower than it usually receives. Alternatively, a business might receive an order which offers a price above the usual but which requires special features or a very early delivery date, meaning the supplier is likely to incur additional costs in fulfilling the order. Firms faced with the dilemma of whether to accept this type of order are facing special-order decisions. In these circumstances, the concept of contribution can be applied to assist the business in reaching a decision on whether or not to accept the order. 197 9781398308114.indb 197 05/03/21 11:08 AM Margaret Roberts Woollens are very popular with tourists and sell for high prices, particularly during the summer season. The cost of wool and the wages paid to knitters means that the average variable cost of producing a single woollen garment is $30. To the surprise of the managing director of the firm, a large order is received from a national clothes retailer. The retailer requires 5000 sweaters and other garments, but is only willing to pay Margaret Roberts Ltd $32 per item. Should Margaret Roberts Ltd accept the order? AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 5.4 CASE STUDY Contribution is the key to making this decision. The firm would earn a positive contribution on each sale. Each woollen item sold would incur variables costs of $30, but would earn revenue of $32. Thus each sale would create $2 of contribution. Therefore, meeting the order would earn the business an additional $10 000 in contribution. This might mean profits would rise (or losses would fall) by $10 000. Questions 1 ▲ Figure 5.16 One unit on which contribution costing could be applied Margaret Roberts Ltd manufactures woollen sweaters for local shops at a standard price of $40. The sweaters Prices lower than normal It is not unusual for a firm to receive an order for a large quantity of its products at a price below that normally charged. Consider the case study above. A number of factors need to be taken into account when taking special-order decisions such as this. » Will additional fixed costs result from accepting the order? In the circumstances above, Margaret Roberts Ltd may have to hire additional factory space, increasing its overheads, meaning that additional contribution is required to meet these costs before extra profits are earned. Thus, if the firm has to pay an extra $10 000 in rent, then profits will be unchanged as a result of accepting the order. Therefore, having sufficient spare capacity is an important prerequisite of accepting such an order. » Might the order lead to higher variable costs? Accepting a large order might mean that workers are paid overtime, pushing up variable costs. Workers at Margaret Roberts Ltd might be paid higher hourly rates, meaning that the variable cost of producing a single item rises to $35. In these circumstances the order would not be worth accepting. » Before making a special-order decision (at a price below the norm), a business needs to ensure that the customer 2 Analyse two reasons why accepting this order may not increase the level of profits earned by Margaret Roberts Ltd. [8] Evaluate the non-financial factors the managers at Margaret Roberts Ltd might consider before deciding whether or not to accept this order. [12] will not simply resell the product to other firms at the usual selling price, thereby making a quick profit at the expense of the manufacturer. » A business may accept a lower price than normal, even if it doesn’t produce a positive contribution, if it believes that it will result in more sales at higher prices in the future. STUDY TIP When responding to questions on special-order decisions (or costing decisions generally) it is important to consider non-financial factors as well as financial ones. Read the case study or stimulus material carefully to ensure you pick up on any non-financial factors that may have been included as clues. Prices higher than normal It may appear a stroke of good fortune for a business to receive an order at a price above that usually levied. However, if the order requires products to have a specification higher than normal or to be delivered at short notice, it is likely that the supplier will face higher costs. This may make the order unprofitable. 198 9781398308114.indb 198 05/03/21 11:08 AM Qualitative factors Qualitative factors are often important in such decisions. Accepting an order such as that received by Margaret Roberts Ltd may offer long-term benefits. The customer may return with further orders and it may help to increase brand awareness in new markets. It may help the business concerned to achieve its corporate aims, especially if these are growth or increasing market share. On the other hand, the consideration of qualitative factors may result in a decision not to supply a special order. It may be regarded as too risky. For example, managers may believe that allowing their products to be sold in large quantities at lower prices could damage its brand image. It may, for example, make the product appear less exclusive and make it difficult to charge higher prices in other markets. Sales and profit margins may fall as a consequence. 5.4.4 Break-even analysis What is break-even analysis and why is it important? Break-even output is that level of output or production at which a business’ sales generate just enough revenue to cover all its costs of production. At the break-even level of output, a business makes neither a loss nor a profit. A business’ managers may use break-even analysis for a number of reasons: » to help decide whether a business idea will be profitable and whether it is viable » to help decide the level of output and sales necessary to generate a profit » to support an application by a business for a loan from a bank or other financial institution » to assess the impact of changes in the level of production on the profitability of the business » to assess the effects of different prices and levels of costs on the potential profitability of the business » to judge whether launching a new product or entering a new market will be profitable given expected sales forecasts. Contribution and break-even Contribution is an important part of break-even analysis. We saw earlier that contribution can be defined as the difference between sales revenue and variable costs of production. Contribution is calculated using the following formula: 5.4 contribution = revenue − variable costs Contribution can be used to pay the fixed costs incurred by a firm. Once these have been met fully, contribution provides a business with its profits. 5.4.4 Break-even analysis Once again, contribution is the key to the decision. If the selling price exceeds the variable costs and no additional fixed costs are incurred, the order would be worthwhile and would result in increased profits. Therefore, if Margaret Roberts Ltd had an order for a new style of sweater which needed more expensive wool than normal and had to be completed within six weeks, the firm would need to: » calculate the extra variable costs associated with the order – overtime pay for workers and more expensive materials, for example » consider whether it had sufficient spare capacity to meet the order – avoiding additional fixed costs » decide whether accepting the order would generate extra contribution and profits. Revenue from sales less Variable costs gives Contribution contribution is used to pay Fixed costs once fixed costs are paid, contribution provides Profits ▲ Figure 5.17 Contribution is the difference between sales revenue and variable costs of production. Profit is the surplus of sales revenue over all costs Calculating break-even output The manager of a business wishing to calculate the breakeven point or level of output will require the following information: » the selling price of the product » the variable cost of producing a single unit of the product » the fixed costs associated with the product (remember, fixed costs do not change as the level of production alters). This information is used within the following formula: break-even = output fixed costs selling price per unit − variable cost per unit This formula can be rewritten given that contribution is the result of taking away variable cost per unit from the selling price of a product: break-even = output fixed costs contribution per unit We will use the scenario set out in the following case study to illustrate the construction and interpretation of breakeven charts. 199 9781398308114.indb 199 05/03/21 11:08 AM AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 5.4 CASE STUDY Using break-even analysis Sarah Feng is planning to expand her restaurant chain and to open a new restaurant in New York, specialising in Cantonese food. She has a lot of experience in the industry, as she already operates 12 restaurants in Sydney and Kuala Lumpur. Her new restaurant will maintain her reputation for serving high-quality food in beautifully furnished buildings. Sarah plans to call her restaurant ‘The River Palace’. Sarah needs a loan to open The River Palace. She has already looked at a building which would accommodate up to 30 diners. She produced the figures set out in Table 5.14. ▼ Table 5.14 Sarah’s analysis for The River Palace Type of cost or revenue Amount Average selling price per meal at The River Palace $60 Variable costs per meal – ingredients, fuel, wages $35 Monthly fixed costs of the new restaurant – lease for the property, rent and rates Using this information, Sarah was able to calculate how many meals she will need to sell (or how many diners she has to attract) in her restaurant if the project is to break even. break-even = output fixed costs contribution per unit Sarah knows her fixed costs will be $10 000 each month and this figure is entered into the top of the formula. To fill in the bottom, Sarah has to take away the variable cost of producing a meal from the price the customer pays for a meal. The contribution earned from each meal in Sarah’s new restaurant is $25 ($60 − $35). Thus: monthly break-even output = $10 000 $25 $10 000 So, Sarah knows that, if her plan for The River Palace is to break even, she will need to attract at least 400 customers each month. If she attracts more than 400 customers, the project will make a profit. Sarah plans to open The River Palace on 25 evenings each month and would, therefore, break even if she had an average of 16 customers each night in the new restaurant. Questions 1 2 If Sarah increases her prices to an average of $70 per meal, calculate the level of her new break-even output. [6] Evaluate whether or not Sarah’s planned price increase would be a good idea. [12] = 400 diners While this calculation gives Sarah a quick guide to the number of customers her restaurant will need to break even, it tells her little more about the level of profit or loss The River Palace might make. A break-even chart is one way to work out the level of profits the business will generate if her forecast is proved to be correct. Break-even charts Sarah knows that The River Palace can seat a maximum of 30 customers per night and that she normally opens for 25 evenings each month. This means that her maximum number of customers each month is 750 (30 customers × 25 nights). When Sarah constructs her break-even chart, her horizontal axis will run from zero to 750 customers. The vertical scale on a break-even chart records costs and revenues. Normally revenues are the highest figure. At most, Sarah could attract 750 customers paying an average of $60 each. So, the highest revenue she could possibly receive is $45 000 ($60 × 750). Her vertical scale should have a maximum value of $45 000. Sarah’s break-even chart shows the monthly fixed costs she will have to pay: $10 000. This is illustrated in Figure 5.19. Variable costs are also illustrated. As variable costs are expenditure on items such as components and raw materials, these costs will rise along with output. If Sarah has an increasing number of people dining at The River Palace, she will need to buy more food and her wage bill will also rise. Variable costs always start at zero. The highest variable cost Sarah could encounter is to provide 750 meals, each having a variable cost of $35. The highest variable cost would therefore be $26 250 ($35 × 750). This maximum figure is connected by a straight line to the origin as shown in Figure 5.18. 200 9781398308114.indb 200 05/03/21 11:08 AM The maximum value on this axis is worked out by multiplying the maximum output by the average selling price (i.e. $60 x 750 = $45 000). 35 Variable costs 30 25 20 15 Fixed costs = $10 000 10 5 0 The origin The maximum figure on this axis is simply the maximum level of output. The new restaurant can seat 750 diners each month Total costs are simply the sum of fixed and variable costs. » If The River Palace has no customers in a month, it will not incur any variable costs. At zero output, total costs are the same as fixed costs. In Sarah’s case, this will mean a total costs figure of $10 000 per month. » At the other extreme, The River Palace might be full, with 750 customers each month. Sarah will add together fixed costs (still $10 000, of course) and variable costs at full capacity (750 customers’ meals each having variable costs of $35), equal to $26 250. Thus, total costs for the restaurant in these circumstances will be $36 250 ($10 000 + $26 250). The line connecting these two points represents total costs. This line should be parallel to the variable costs line and is shown in Figure 5.19. 45 Costs and revenues ($000) 35 30 This total costs line will be parallel to variable costs – the difference between the two lines is fixed costs Total costs = fixed costs + variable costs Variable costs 25 20 15 Fixed costs = $10 000 10 5 0 Revenue 45 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 750 Monthly output (customers) ▲ Figure 5.18 Fixed and variable costs on a break-even chart 40 Figure 5.20 shows the break-even chart with the revenue line included. To make the chart easier to read, the variable costs line has been left out in this case. The origin – all variable cost curves begin here 40 35 30 Total costs = fixed costs + variable costs Break-even occurs where total costs and revenue are equal 5.4 5.4.4 Break-even analysis Costs and revenues ($000) 40 Finally, the break-even chart shows the revenue The River Palace will earn. Sarah has already calculated that an average customer spends $60 on a meal in her restaurant. Once again, there are two extreme situations. » If The River Palace does not have any customers, it will not have any revenue. Thus the revenue line begins at the origin. » If the restaurant is full, Sarah expects each of the 750 customers to pay $60 on average. If The River Palace attracts this level of custom, it will earn $45 000 ($60 × 750). Costs and revenues ($000) 45 25 20 15 10 5 0 Fixed costs = $10 000 Break-even output confirming the earlier calculation 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 750 Monthly output (customers) ▲ Figure 5.20 The complete break-even chart The break-even chart tells Sarah that she needs 400 customers each month if The River Palace is to break even. This confirms the calculation we carried out earlier. However, a break-even chart provides much more information. Sarah can use it to read off the level of profit or loss her new restaurant will make according to the number of customers it attracts. If the River Palace attracts fewer than 400 customers each month, it will record a loss. The amount of the loss is shown on the graph by the vertical distance between the total cost line and the revenue line at the relevant level of output. Similarly, if the restaurant attracts more than 400 customers in a month, it will generate a profit that month. Here the profit is shown by the vertical distance between the revenue line and the total cost line. Figure 5.21 shows the level of loss and profit made by The River Palace if it attracts 200 customers and 600 customers per month. 100 200 300 400 500 600 700 750 Monthly output (customers) ▲ Figure 5.19 Including total costs on a break-even chart 201 9781398308114.indb 201 05/03/21 11:08 AM Revenue 45 5.4 Revenue earned from 600 customers = $36 000 40 Total costs Profit = $5 000 Total cost of supplying 600 customers = $31 000 30 Costs and reveunes ($000) AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 35 25 Total cost of supplying 200 customers = $17 000 Break-even point 20 Loss = $5 000 The margin of safety 15 10 Revenue earned from 200 customers = $12 000 5 Break-even output 0 100 200 300 400 500 600 Loss-making range of output Profit-making range of output 700 750 Monthly output (Number of customers) ▲ Figure 5.21 Showing profits and losses on a break-even chart CASE STUDY Nigerian films fail to break even The film industry in Nigeria is experiencing some good times. Much of this is due to the efforts of Kunle Afolayan, a 46-year-old director. Kunle has produced a series of films since 2005 which have impressed knowledgeable film critics and have received highly favourable reviews in the New York Times. make a lot of one-off noise, but people don’t remember them in six months’ time,’ he says. ‘That isn’t the kind of legacy I want to leave.’ Most of his films have been financed through a combination of his own earnings, bank loans and individual investors, though he has now attracted funding from further afield, receiving a Ford Foundation grant to make Citation. Despite this international acclaim, it remains difficult to generate profits from making films in Nigeria. His new film, Citation, about a scandal at Nigerian and Ghanian universities which came to light in 2018, began filming in 2020. Kunle predicts that it will ‘beat records’. The film is still showing and earning revenues, but some analysts believe it is unlikely to break even. The Ford Foundation was established by the Ford motor car manufacturing company. Yet box-office receipts are not Kunle’s main concern. ‘Nigerian films that are driven by commercial interests alone Source: https://econ.st/32pt6A6 Questions 1 2 Explain two actions that Kunle Afolayan might take to help make his latest film profitable. [6] Evaluate why investors might choose to invest in a film which is not expected to make a profit. [12] 202 9781398308114.indb 202 05/03/21 11:08 AM HANDLING DATA The margin of safety A break-even chart can be used to show the margin of safety, although this can also be calculated. The margin of safety measures the quantity by which a firm’s current level of sales exceeds the level of output necessary to break even. The following formula expresses the margin of safety as a number of units of output. margin of safety = current level of sales − break-even output In our previous example of The River Palace restaurant, if it is successful and attracts 600 customers each month, the margin of safety will be 200 customers (600 customers – 400 customers). This means that, in these circumstances, the restaurant could lose 200 customers each month before it reached break-even output and began to make a loss. This is shown in Figure 5.21 (page 202) for an output of 600 customers per month. There is an alternative method of calculation which expresses the margin of safety as a percentage of current sales. The formula to use for this is: margin of current level of sales − break-even output × 100 safety = current level of sales Using this formula for our example we would get: margin of safety = 600 − 400 600 × 100 = 33.3% This tells us that the restaurant could lose just over 33 per cent of its sales before it found itself in a break-even position. Most financial techniques have uses and limitations, and break-even analysis is no exception. The uses of break-even analysis include the following: » It is a simple technique, allowing most entrepreneurs to use it without the need for expensive training. Because of this, it is particularly suitable for newly established and small businesses. » It is a technique that can be completed quickly, providing immediate results. » It can be of value in supporting a business’ application to a bank for a loan. » By using break-even charts, a business can forecast the effect of varying numbers of customers on its costs, revenues and profits. » Break-even analysis can be used to analyse the implications of changing prices and costs on the enterprise’s likely profitability. 5.4 5.4.4 Break-even analysis Mike plans to open a business providing people with help to learn how to use computers and the internet. Mike thinks his fixed costs will be $21 000 per year and the variable costs of serving each customer will be $100. His average price per customer will be $240. He expects to have 200 customers in his first year of trading. 1 If his figures are correct, will he break even in his first year of trading? 2 Calculate his expected profit or loss during his first year of trading. The uses and limitations of break-even analysis However, break-even analysis has a number of limitations: » It assumes that all products are sold. For example, Sarah might assume that she will attract 600 customers each month. She will order the necessary food and hire sufficient staff. However, if only 500 turn up, she will not make the profit indicated for 600 customers on the break-even chart. » It is a simplification of the real world. Businesses do not sell all their products at a single price and calculating an average is unlikely to provide accurate data. The technique is also difficult to use when a business sells a number of different products. » Costs do not rise steadily as the technique suggests. As we have seen, variable costs can rise less quickly than output because of the benefits of buying in bulk. » Any break-even analysis will only be as accurate as the data on which it is based. If costs or selling prices are incorrect, then the forecasts will be wrong. Break-even analysis offers some support to businesses, and especially to start-up enterprises or those seeking to expand by launching new products and/or entering new markets. However, it is only a guideline and its value should not be overstated. Perhaps, most importantly, entrepreneurs and managers should bear in mind that the value of the technique depends on the use of reliable data for costs, prices and expected sales. GLOSSARY TERM The margin of safety measures the quantity by which a firm’s current level of sales exceeds the level of output necessary to break even. 203 9781398308114.indb 203 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5.4 TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 AS LEVEL 5.4 Costs 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Define the terms: a ‘costs’ [2] [2] b ‘revenues’. a Explain one difference between average costs [3] and marginal costs. b Explain one reason why average costs might fall as a business increases its level of output. [3] a Define the term ‘full costing’. [2] b Explain one way in which a large manufacturing business might allocate its overheads between the different products that it supplies. [3] Explain one reason why it might be difficult for the manufacturer in question 3b to allocate its overheads accurately. [3] Explain one reason why a business might refuse an order for its products at a price that is higher than [3] normal. Explain one reason why a business might decide to accept an order for its products at a price of $300 per unit when its normal selling price is $400 per unit. [3] Explain one way in which a business might calculate the marginal cost of a single unit of output. [3] Explain one reason why contribution costing avoids the need to allocate overheads. [3] a Define the term ‘break-even output’. [2] b A business sells its products for an average price of $40, has fixed costs of $100 000 and contribution per unit of $15. Calculate the level of output required to break even. [2] 10 a b Define the term ‘margin of safety’. [2] Calculate the margin of safety if a business has sales of 10 000 units per year and its break-even [2] output is 6500 units. Data response question The new hotel Santa Rosa Hotels has just opened its latest hotel in Huaraz, close to the Parque Nacional Huascarán in Peru. The area is a popular tourist destination and the numbers visiting are rising quickly. There are many other hotels in the area and the new hotel is not expected to be full at any time during its first year of operation. The hotel’s manager is keen to make the new business profitable and plans that every guest at the hotel will make a contribution to fixed costs. They are concerned about their pricing decisions, as labour and other costs are expected to rise significantly over the next year or two. Santa Rosa Hotels has not been a very profitable company since 2019 and its shareholders are keen to see an improvement in this area over the next year or two. Questions 1 2 3 Define the terms: a ‘contribution’ [2] b ‘fixed costs’. [2] Analyse one reason why it is important for the company to calculate its costs accurately. [4] Evaluate the case for and against the decision to use cost-plus pricing. [12] 204 9781398308114.indb 204 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5 Finance and accounting AS LEVEL 5.5 Budgets In this chapter we examine: ★ the meaning and purpose of budgets and the benefits and drawbacks of their use ★ the meaning, calculation and interpretation of variances. 5.5.1 The meaning and purpose of budgets What are budgets? Budgets are financial plans. Firms plan their earnings and expenditures using budgets. Budgets are usually drawn up on a monthly basis, over the period of a financial year. There are a number of types of budgets: » Sales revenue or income budgets These set out the business’ expected sales revenue from selling its products. Important information here includes the expected level of sales and the likely selling price of the product. A start-up business may have relatively low revenue budgets during its first few months of trading. It is likely that the sales revenue budgets will be increased as the business becomes better known. In contrast, an established business may have a large and loyal customer base and substantial inflows of revenue from a range of different products or brands, for different regions, or from a number of subsidiary companies. » Production or expenditure budgets Businesses need to plan their expenditure on labour, raw materials, fuel and other items which are essential for the process of production. Research is necessary to prepare accurate expenditure budgets. For example, an independent forecast in 2019 revealed that wages in countries in Asia are expected to rise by between 2.3 per cent and 12 per cent during the next financial year – this would be important data for Asian firms with large workforces. The production budget will also contain forecasts for expenditure on overheads and a cash budget as well. » Profit budgets This type of budget forecasts a business’ total revenue and total costs and shows whether it is expected to make a profit or loss over a future trading period. The Coronavirus (COVID-19) pandemic of 2020 led to numerous businesses revising their profit budgets following forecasts of substantial falls in revenue from sales. 5.5.1 The meaning and purpose of budgets Chapter overview STUDY TIP Remember that budgets are forecast data and may be incorrect. You should read any case study material carefully to see if there is any evidence about its likely accuracy and use this to help to develop your answers. CASE STUDY Hotels in Singapore Hotels in Singapore enjoy one of the highest rates of occupancy in the world. Data from the Singapore Tourism Board shows that 93.8 per cent of its hotel rooms were occupied in July 2019. This represents a small increase from the summer of 2018, when the rate was 92.5 per cent. Forecasters are expecting Singapore’s hotel occupancy rate to decline in the future. They have identified three reasons for this forecast: ● Hotels in Singapore are projected to lose customers to competitors located in Hong Kong, which is expected to become a more popular location for business conferences, boosting demand for hotels. ● A number of new hotels are due to open in Singapore during 2020, including the Singapore New Edition. This will increase the number of hotel rooms available. ● Many businesses have decided to reduce their travel and accommodation budgets. Fewer business travellers are forecast to stay in hotels in Singapore. These changes have already affected the financial performance of hotels in Singapore. In the autumn of 2019, Singapore Hotels Ltd reported that the average earnings from its rooms was $240. Since the summer of 2019, the average earning figure had fallen from just over $249. Questions 1 2 Analyse two reaons why the changes forecast in the case study might have a significant impact on the sales revenue budgets of the hotel division of Singapore Hotels Ltd. [8] Evaluate why it might be difficult for hotel companies in Singapore to forecast future sales revenues accurately at this time. [12] 205 9781398308114.indb 205 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5.5 There is the risk, of course, that the information in budgets may not prove to be accurate. For example, sales revenue budgets may be incorrect if there is an unexpected slump in sales due to, say, a change in consumers’ tastes and fashions, or the entry of a new competitor into a specific market. The benefits and drawbacks of budgets AS LEVEL 5.5 Budgets As with most techniques of financial control, there are benefits and drawbacks to the use of budgets. The benefits of budgets » Production or expenditure budgets allow managers to ensure that a business does not overspend. Senior managers receive their own budgets and can allocate these between the various parts of the department or area for which they are responsible. Figure 5.22 illustrates this process. As long as each individual budget holder makes sure that they do not spend more than the agreed figure, the business’ overall expenditure should remain under control. Modern technology makes the control and monitoring of such budgets easier. » Budgets allow senior managers to direct extra funds into important areas of the business. Thus, if a business is concerned that its product range is not selling well, it may increase its budgets in the areas of market research, research and development or advertising. » Budgets can be used to motivate employees. Employees can gain satisfaction from being given responsibility for a budget. Often large businesses use what is known as ‘delegated budgets’ whereby control of budgets is given to individuals and teams at all levels within the organisation. They may also gain satisfaction from keeping within a budget. As a result, their level of motivation and their performance may improve, benefiting the firm as a whole. In Chapter 2.2 we considered motivation in more detail. » Sales revenue budgets can also be used as targets for employees, possibly as part of the appraisal process. Employees may be motivated to improve their performance by the existence of targets in the forms of sales revenue budgets. » Information on expenditure budgets allows senior managers to examine those areas of a business that manage costs effectively. The most successful areas or divisions can become models for other parts of the business. Board of Directors (advised by Director of Finance) plans revenue and spending for financial year Production Human Resources Decides budget of $3m for marketing – Director of Marketing controls budget Public relations – $¾m for sponsorship and events Staff salaries and expenses – $1¾m for sales and marketing salaries, commission and expenses Advertising – $½m to pay for a series of advertising campaigns These budgets will be controlled by relevant managers. They may be further divided into, for example, a budget for expenses for the sales force. ▲ Figure 5.22 An example of using budgets within a company The drawbacks of budgets » If a business intends that a significant proportion of its employees should manage budgets (known as delegating budgets) then training will be required. Some people will not welcome the extra responsibility or feel confident in their ability to control finances. The cost of the training could be substantial, depending on the skills of the workforce. Furthermore, there could be teething problems as employees adjust to the new roles and responsibilities. 206 9781398308114.indb 206 05/03/21 11:08 AM » Allocating budgets fairly and in the best interests of the business is difficult. Some managers may be skilled at negotiating large budgets for the areas for which they are responsible. This might be at the expense of more worthy areas. Thus, for example, a manager responsible for the sales force in existing markets may receive a large budget allocation, while insufficient funds are given to developing new markets. » Budgets normally relate to the current financial year only and are short-term in nature. Therefore, managers might take decisions in order to keep within the current budget which is not in the longer-term interest of the business. For example, a decision to reduce the size of a workforce for budgetary reasons might result in competitors gaining more of the market over the next few years. Alibaba The Alibaba Group was founded in 1999 by 18 people led by Jack Ma, a former English teacher from Hangzhou, China. Its founders started the company to support small businesses, to help small enterprises to compete more effectively in China and globally. Initially the company created online marketplaces enabling buyers and sellers to meet and buy and sell products. By 2019, the company had grown very rapidly and employed 102 000 people, earned revenues totalling $56.15 billion and profits amounting to just under $12 billion. By 2020, Alibaba provided a wide range of services. Its websites provide: ● sales services for businesses and consumers l services for electronic payments l search engines for shopping l cloud computing services. Alibaba owns and operates a wide variety of different businesses throughout the world. For example, in 2018, Daraz, a Pakistani online store, was bought by the Alibaba Group, making the South Asian e-commerce platform an important part of Alibaba’s global operations. The Alibaba Group aims to grow quickly. It has set itself some important targets to ensure its continued growth. Three important targets are: l to have 2 billion global customers by 2036 l to create a further 100 million jobs l to support over 100 million profitable businesses on its websites. Questions 1 2 Different approaches to budgeting Incremental budgets Incremental budgets are a very simple approach to budgeting. In an incremental budget, figures from the previous budget are used as a basis for the new budget. According to circumstances, a small percentage change may be made to the previous figures to allow for alterations in costs or expected revenues. Incremental budgets work well in a stable business environment, where changes are relatively small and normally predictable. This approach to budgets is more common in less competitive or less changeable markets where profits are relatively stable. However, the use of incremental budgets can have a number of shortcomings. » It can encourage overspending by managers Managers may be encouraged to add a percentage to costs each year rather then looking at ways to reduce costs when using incremental budgeting. » Managers may ‘massage’ the data Some managers may forecast little growth in sales revenue but substantial increases in costs when drawing up incremental budgets. This would lead to them having favourable variances which could suggest the area has been managed efficiently. » It does not encourage risk-taking One of the main criticisms of incremental budgeting is that it tends to 5.5.1 The meaning and purpose of budgets CASE STUDY 5.5 Analyse two reasons why budgeting would be important to Alibaba while it is growing quickly. ‘It is impossible for Alibaba to draw up accurate budgets.’ Evaluate this view. [8] [12] allocate funds to the same use each year. Managers may find it difficult to acquire large sums for new and more risky activities. This may result in lower profits in the long term. GLOSSARY TERMS Incremental budgeting is a process where budget figures are minor changes from the preceding period’s budgeted or actual data. A flexible budget is a budget that is designed to change along with the sales volume or production levels. Flexible budgeting Flexible budgets (or flex budgets) avoid some of the problems that are associated with the use of variances within normal budgets. A common problem with the use of variances is that some of the variances may be due to external factors, such as a significant fall in sales due to an economy moving unexpectedly into a period of falling incomes. In such circumstances, it can be difficult to identify how much of a difference between a forecast and an actual budget is due to external factors and how much to poor management within the business. The use of flexible budgeting removes at least some of the effects of the external factors, allowing managers to analyse underlying issues. 207 9781398308114.indb 207 05/03/21 11:08 AM 5.5 In the example in Table 5.15, the managers would be able to see that sales were much lower than expected, at $600 000 rather than $750 000. The flexed budget adjusts other budget figures in the light of this change. This means that, in this case, direct costs will be divided by 750 000 and multiplied by 600 000 to reflect the change in sales revenue. ▼ Table 5.15 An example of a flexible budget AS LEVEL 5.5 Budgets Normal budgets ($000s) Flexible budgets ($000s) Budget Actual Budget Sales revenue 750 600 750 600 600 Overheads 200 204 200 200 204 Labour 180 162 180 144 162 Materials 220 201 220 176 201 Other costs 60 53 60 48 53 Total costs 660 620 660 568 620 90 (20) 90 32 (20) PROFIT Therefore, although costs fell as a result of the large drop in sales, they didn’t fall as much as may have been expected given the substantial reduction in output. Once the budget has been flexed, it is simple to see that all categories of costs recorded adverse variances and that they overspent in the context of the falling level of production. Contrast this with the original budget – the favourable variances for direct costs such as labour and materials may have suggested that the budget holders managed these costs effectively. HANDLING DATA 1 Look at the information in Table 5.15. If the flexed budget for sales revenue was $700 000, calculate the flexed budgets for labour and materials. Zero budgeting Gathering information can be time-consuming even if budgets are based heavily on the previous year’s figures. An alternative approach used by a number of firms is zero budgeting. Using this system, each expenditure budget is set at zero at the start of the budget setting process. Managers responsible for the areas covered by the budget (HR managers, for example) have to bid for budget and to justify the money they request. Using zero budgets can help firms in a number of ways: » It avoids budgets creeping up each year as one year’s budget is based on the figures from the previous year, plus a little to allow for inflation. In this way, it can assist a firm to control costs. » It helps firms adjust their spending as the relative importance of areas within the firm changes. For example, the purchase of an automated switchboard might mean that the budget for this area can be reduced. This money can be used effectively elsewhere in the business. Flexed budget Actual However, the process has a number of drawbacks too: » Zero budgeting is effective for setting production (or expenditure) budgets, but it has little relevance to sales budgets. To set a zero budget for sales revenue would be ridiculous. » Budgets might be allocated according to the negotiating skills of managers rather than the genuine needs of their areas or departments. GLOSSARY TERMS A budget holder is responsible for the use and management of a particular budget. Zero budgets exist when budgets are automatically set at zero and budget holders have to argue their case to receive any funds. The uses of budgets Measuring performance For many businesses, the figures in the profit budget will have an important influence on decision-making within the business. Comparing the actual profit figure with the budgeted figure for the trading period can be a useful measure of a business’ performance. A business’ managers will also use budgeted and actual data to assess the performance of elements of the business as well as its performance overall. We saw earlier (in Table 5.15) that the use of flexible budgets can strip out the effects of changes in the market and overall sales. The resulting budgetary data can be used to judge the effectiveness of, for example, the control of costs in different areas of the business. Those managers who return favourable variances on expenditure budgets may be judged more effective. A business’ budgets may also highlight the relative performance of a business’ divisions or sectors. Many multinational businesses operate in different regions of 208 9781398308114.indb 208 05/03/21 11:08 AM the world. Coca-Cola, the American multinational soft drinks company, produces and sells its products throughout the world. It separates its activities into five geographic divisions: North America, Africa, Asia, Latin America, Europe and other. The performance of these areas against the budgets that have been drawn up will assist the company’s managers in judging the performance of these five divisions. Allocating resources The provision of detailed budgets on expected sales can reveal much about the forecast performance of individual areas or divisions within a large business. This information can help managers to make decisions on which areas of the business are likely to perform well and those that may not. Using this information, managers can make decisions on how to allocate financial, human and other resources most effectively. We saw in the previous section that Coca-Cola operates five divisions in different regions of the world. The company’s managers may allocate more resources to those divisions that perform most successfully when actual performance is judged against budgeted data. It is not unusual for businesses to have budgets of many millions, or even billions, of dollars – this would certainly be the case for Coca-Cola. In such circumstances, it is impossible for a single person, or even a group of people, to effectively monitor these budgets to ensure costs are controlled and planned revenues are earned. A system of budgets allows a large number of people within the organisation to take a share of responsibility for managing finances. This process was illustrated in Figure 5.22 (page 206). In this way, budgets provide an effective means of allocating resources. Controlling and monitoring a business Budgets are an effective way of ensuring that a business does not spend more than it should. As long as every employee ensures that they do not spend in excess of their budget, costs should not get out of control. Equally, if those involved in sales meet their targets then the business should earn its planned level of profit. This should help the business to achieve its objectives. Managers may also take decisions based on the actual data in budgets through the calculation of variances. If, for example, sales budgets show substantial adverse variances, managers may question the quality of their products or their approach to pricing, as well as the accuracy of the market 5.5 Businesses use budgets to assess the viability of new projects, such as launching a new product or relocating to a new region or country. In this case, the research process involved in preparing the necessary budgets is helpful and the final budget figures are likely to have a major influence on a final decision by senior managers. 5.5.2 Variances Once a business has planned its sales revenue and expenditure, it is essential to monitor the accuracy of these financial plans by comparing the budget figures with the actual figures resulting from the business’ trading. Budgets can also provide a wealth of information to help managers take decisions on how to improve the performance of the business. » Analysing budgeted and actual expenditure This provides information on how successful the business is at controlling its costs. As a business grows, it is possible to judge the ability of different parts to manage its expenditure against given targets. If one area of a business is regularly overspending its budgets, managers may take action to reduce expenditure and, by so doing, increase profitability. Relevant actions might include addressing issues such as poor motivation, quality problems or not using capacity fully. Of course, if a business or part of a business fails to meet expenditure budgets regularly, it may be because the budgets are too low to be achievable. » Analysing sales revenue A business that fails to meet its sales revenue budgets for one or more of its products may need to consider why this is occurring. Prices may be too high when compared with those of competitors, the business may not be advertising sufficiently or not targeting the correct market segments, or the quality and/or design of the product may be inadequate. Good managers will use the information from analysing budgets to make decisions to improve the business’ sales performance. » Analysing profits budgets Profits below budget are likely to be a cause of concern for most businesses. These can be caused by excess expenditure or by revenue falling short of expectations or a combination of these factors. This scenario may prompt managers to examine means of cutting expenditure as well as boosting sales revenue. 5.5.2 Variances Budgeted data alone can be used as a measure of performance. It may be that a business’ budgeted profits are low or declining when compared to previous financial years. This may lead the business’ managers to take decisions to improve the financial performance of the business in advance of the year’s trading. This may entail changing prices and reducing costs in the short term. In the longer term, management teams may consider entering new markets and developing new products as a means of improving financial performance. research they undertook. Similarly, managers will respond to expenditure budgets that show significant variances – adverse or favourable. Adverse and favourable variances A variance occurs when an actual figure for sales revenue, expenditure or profits differs from the budgeted figure. Actual sales revenue or expenditure figures may be higher or lower than budgets. Variances are categorised as adverse or favourable. These two categories of variance are shown in Table 5.16 on page 210. 209 9781398308114.indb 209 05/03/21 11:08 AM ▼ Table 5.16 The two categories of variance AS LEVEL 5.5 Budgets 5.5 Favourable variances Adverse variances A favourable variance exists when the difference between the actual and budgeted figures will result in the business enjoying higher profits than shown in the budget. An adverse variance occurs when the difference between the figures in the budget and the actual figures will lead to the firm’s profits being lower than planned. Examples of favourable variances include: • actual wages less than budgeted wages • budgeted sales revenue lower than actual sales revenue • expenditure on fuel is less than the budgeted figure. Examples of adverse variances include: • sales revenue below the budgeted figure • actual raw material costs exceed the figure planned in the budget • overheads turn out to be higher than in the budget. Possible causes of favourable variances: • wage rises lower than expected • economic boom leads to higher than expected sales • rising value of currency makes imported raw materials cheaper. Possible causes of adverse variances: • competitors introduce new products, winning extra sales • government increases business taxes by unexpected amount • fuel prices increase as price of oil rises. $840 000. However, the actual figure was $790 000. In this case the variance (or difference) is $50 000. It is an adverse variance because it will result in the business’ profits being lower than forecast or its loss larger than forecast. In contrast, the business’ fuel costs are only $70 000, which is $5000 less than the budgeted figure. In this case, this is a favourable variance because this will result in the business’ profits being larger than forecast (or a smaller loss than budgeted). ▼ Table 5.17 Calculating variances The process of calculating a variance is simple, as shown by Table 5.17. It simply involves a comparison between the budgeted figure and the actual figure. In Table 5.17, the business had forecast that its sales revenue would be Cut prices if consumer demand is sensitive to price changes (price elastic) Improve company image PR donations to charities Cut wages or increase labour productivity increase amount produced per worker per hour Revenue/ Budget cost figure ($) Sales revenue Actual figure ($) 840 000 790 000 75 000 70 000 Raw material costs 245 000 265 000 Labour costs 115 000 112 000 Fuel costs Variance $50 000 (adverse) $5000 (favourable) $20 000 (adverse) $3000 (favourable) HANDLING DATA 1 Look at the information in Table 5.15 (page 208). Calculate the actual sales revenue required under the ‘normal budget’ to result in a favourable variance of $79 000. Calculating variances can give a business advance notice that its financial plans are inaccurate. This can be carried out each month and will show before the end of the financial Seek new markets at home or overseas Adverse sales revenue sales revenue less than planned Adverse production (cost) variances expenditure higher than planned Product range update or extend as appropriate Increase advertising and/or promotions Reduce waste use fewer raw materials and produce fewer faulty goods Seek cheaper raw materials purchase from overseas or in bulk ▲ Figure 5.23 Responding to adverse variances 210 9781398308114.indb 210 05/03/21 11:08 AM year that the firm’s finances are not as planned. This allows the business to take action to reduce expenditure or increase revenue at an early stage. Figure 5.23 summarises the range of actions that businesses may take in response to adverse variances. There are internal connections in budgets which are important to understand. For example, if a business experiences a rise in output and sales revenue above expectations, it will affect expenditure. If a product becomes unexpectedly popular and sales rise, the business may have to purchase more raw materials and hire additional labour. This is likely to result in adverse expenditure variances. Similarly, sales below those set out in the budget may lead to favourable variances for costs, as expenditure falls since less is produced. We considered this in the section on flexible budgets on page 207. It may be that variances are not the result of unexpected developments and changes in the markets in which businesses operate. Poor forecasting techniques can also result in unexpected revenues and expenditures, and therefore variances. Managers may make insufficient use of market research to forecast sales revenue. This can lead to adverse or favourable revenue variances. It may also result in inaccurate budgets for expenditure, as the managers will not have forecast correctly the amount of labour and other resources that the business needs to satisfy customers’ needs. Inaccurate budgets are also the result of inexperience on the part of managers, and variances will be more common when a business is new to a market and has no financial records on which to base forecasts. 5.5 5.5.2 Variances Firms may also need to respond to favourable variances. Production costs which are lower than planned may be regarded as beneficial. But sales revenue that is greater than anticipated might be caused by the firm selling more products than planned. In these circumstances, the business might not have sufficient supplies to meet future customer requirements. This could result in the loss of longestablished customers and should be avoided. Other factors leading to adverse and favourable variances STUDY TIP Questions asking you to analyse variances are common in Business exams. It is important for you to identify those areas in which major differences between planned and actual expenditure or revenue have occurred. This will help to give a focus to your answer. It is also very likely that you will be asked to suggest possible causes (or cures) for the variances. CASE STUDY BMW’s new factory in Mexico In 2019, the German car manufacturer, BMW, opened a new car factory in Mexico, approximately 400 km north of the capital city, at San Luis Potosí. The new factory uses ports on both the west and east coasts of Mexico for transporting components and to export finished vehicles. The company has invested more than US$1 billion in the new production location. The plant, which already employs 2500 people, has a high proportion of Mexican employees who have been trained in BMW’s approach to production. The factory at San Luis Potosí will build BMW’s most successful model series: the BMW 3 Series Sedan. This popular car has set the standard for performance, efficiency and design, and the company expects high sales of the new model. The new model does, however, face intense competition from the Audi 4 and Mercedes C class and others. In its new factory, robots and employees work directly alongside one another, making effective use of the strengths of each. Production began in April 2019, with the plant producing 240 cars per day by October. In 2020, the factory‘s production had risen to 580 cars per day, moving towards its annual production capacity of 175 000 units. ▲ Figure 5.24 Use of robots on BMW’s production line means that fewer workers are used. Questions 1 2 Analyse one possible factor that might result in the new factory recording adverse variances. [4] ‘The “intense competition” that the BMW 3 series will face is the most important reason for BMW drawing up budgets for the new factory.’ Evaluate this view. [12] 211 9781398308114.indb 211 05/03/21 11:08 AM AS LEVEL 5.5 Budgets 5.5 CASE STUDY ADL acts on budgets ADL is a television company in Argentina which produces and broadcasts a range of programmes and operates three satellite channels. It is particularly noted for producing documentaries and popular drama series. The market for making and broadcasting television programmes is growing rapidly in Argentina and other Spanish-speaking countries, although rates of growth vary widely over time. Last year’s growth in sales was 11.5 per cent, while the year before it was just 2.9 per cent. The company’s managers have just been reviewing its financial performance, including analysing its performance against budgets. Some of the data they considered is shown in Table 5.18 below. One of ADL’s managers said she believed that this budgetary data provided the best possible measure of ADL’s performance. ▼ Table 5.18 ADL’s budget data Budget ($m) Actual ($m) Sales revenue 3 347.8 3 999.4 Labour costs 1 552.2 1 840.3 288.1 A Materials costs 205.7 201.6 4.1 F Other costs 630.1 916.6 286.5 A Overheads 597.0 602.4 5.4 A 2 985.0 3 560.9 362.8 438.5 Total costs Profit/(loss) Variance Questions 1 Calculate the variances for the company’s total sales revenue, total costs and profits, stating whether each is adverse or favourable. [6] 2 One manager believed that ‘this budgetary data provided the best possible measure of ADL’s performance’. Evaluate this view. [12] TEST YOUR LEARNING Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 5 Define the terms: a ‘sales revenue budget’ [2] b ‘expenditure budget’. [2] a Explain one reason why setting budgets may lead to an improvement in the motivation of employees. [3] b Budgets are short-term in nature. Explain one reason why this might be a problem for a business. [3] a Explain one reason why it might be difficult for a business to forecast its sales accurately. [3] b Explain one way in which a change in the economy may make a business’ budgets inaccurate. [3] a Define the term ‘flexible budget’. [2] b Explain one reason why a business might decide to use a flexible-budgeting system. [3] a Define the term ‘zero budgets’. [2] b Explain one reason why a business might decide to use a zero-budgeting system. [3] 6 7 a b Define the term ‘variance analysis’. Explain one reason why it is important for managers to monitor budgets once they have been set. A business has the following budgetary data: [2] [3] ▼ Table 5.19 Budget ($m) Actual ($m) Sales revenue 254.75 295.10 Total costs 222.86 256.84 Calculate its profit variance and identify whether it is adverse or favourable. [4] 8 Explain one difference between adverse and favourable variances. [3] 9 a Explain one factor that may lead to a business having adverse variances on its profits. [3] [2] b Define the term ‘incremental budgeting’. 10 Explain one way in which budgets might help a large multinational company to manage its finances efficiently. [3] 212 9781398308114.indb 212 05/03/21 11:08 AM Data response question Nadal Ltd Last year, Nadal Ltd opened its 59th café in Ronda, southern Spain. This is its first café in this part of Spain and the company has only conducted secondary market research. The new manager in Ronda has no experience of cafés or financial planning, but they are experienced in retail and in managing people. Despite this, sales have risen steadily, if slowly, and customer feedback is positive. Budget ($) Actual ($) Sales revenue 11 500 10 990 Indirect costs 4 250 4 300 Direct costs 6 890 6 900 360 (210) Profits Questions 1 2 3 Analyse two problems that Nadal Ltd faced in [8] setting its budgets for the new café. a Calculate the profit variance for the first three [3] months of trading for the Ronda café. b Evaluate whether the benefits of drawing up budgets outweigh the drawbacks to [12] Nadal Ltd. ‘The managers at Nadal Ltd should be pleased with the performance of its café in Ronda.’ Evaluate this view. [12] 5.5 5.5.2 Variances Nadal Ltd’s cafés sell budget-priced drinks such as coffee and tea, as well as tapas and light meals. The company has succeeded despite, or maybe because of, the weak economic position in Spain. The company’s brand name is associated with low prices and value for money. The company plans to expand using finance raised mainly through loans. ▼ Table 5.20 Nadal Ltd, Ronda Café – budget figures for first three months of trading 213 9781398308114.indb 213 05/03/21 11:08 AM 6 Business and its environment A LEVEL Chapter overview In this chapter we examine: ★ the cases for and against nationalisation and privatisation ★ how the government might use the law to control a range of business behaviour ★ the effects of changes in political and legal factors on businesses and their decisions. The business environment Businesses do not operate in isolation and are subject to a range of external influences. This external environment is subject to constant change and these changes can mean different things to different businesses. For example, a change in the economic environment might lead to a fall in consumers’ incomes. This could cause a large reduction in sales for a business selling luxury products such as jewellery but have little impact on a retailer selling basic foods. Politi cal and leg al ntal me n o vir En omic Econ Internati ona l FORCES Responses to forces for change by entrepreneurs, directors, managers and other stakeholders pe ra p h ic Co m rs su FOR CHANGE pp lie de an d m og ti t o A LEVEL 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal So rs l ci a an d Technological Businesses cannot ignore changes in their environment and any single business is not sufficiently large or powerful to have any significant influence on this external environment. This means that all businesses have to make appropriate responses to changes in their external environment to ensure that they remain competitive and, for many enterprises, as profitable as possible. The factors which make up the external environment for businesses differ. A small business that grows vegetables and fruit for sale in a local market is likely to be subject to different external forces compared to a multinational company that sells consumer electronics globally. Despite this, the elements making up the external environment for businesses can be classified as shown in Figure 6.1. We shall consider each of these elements of the business environment over the next three chapters. In particular, we will consider the impact of changes in these elements and how such changes might affect decisions taken by businesses. The political environment A range of political decisions can help to determine the business environment. For example, governments throughout the world take decisions on the extent to which they will become involved directly in the production of goods and services. In some European countries, government-owned businesses supply a range of products including water and electricity. The government in the USA tends to rely on privately owned organisations to supply most products to consumers. ▲ Figure 6.1 The external environment within which businesses operate 214 9781398308114.indb 214 05/03/21 11:08 AM 6.1.1.1 The advantages and disadvantages of privatisation In some countries, privatisation has been accompanied by the reduction in government subsidies and grants to industry and by legislation limiting the state’s role in business matters. This approach to managing the business environment is described as laissez-faire (where the government intervenes as little as possible) and puts faith in a greater degree of self-regulation by businesses. Nationalisation is a policy which has the opposite effect to that of privatisation, as shown in Figure 6.2. There are recent signs that some governments are pursuing policies, including nationalisation, which involve a greater degree of state control over business. This has been driven by a number of factors, including the perceived weak performances of privatised businesses in some economic sectors. The Coronavirus (COVID-19) crisis of 2020 has also resulted in some governments being forced to take a greater degree of control over economic activity. At the time of writing, it remains to be seen to what extent this will be a permanent state of affairs. » Increased efficiency This is a key argument for 6.1.1 governments implementing a policy of privatisation and was used to justify its use in the UK from 1980 onwards. Managers in government-owned businesses do not normally share in profits and may be set targets other than making profits. In a privatised business, managers are responsible to shareholders who expect to receive a share of profits. Managers also often receive a share of profits. These factors encourage managers to cut costs and increase efficiency. There is some evidence that businesses do operate more efficiently once privatised. » Operational independence Managers in stateowned businesses often have to meet targets set by governments. Such targets might include maintaining employment levels, rather than producing as efficiently as possible with whatever size workforce is optimal. Being free of any government targets, privatised businesses can become more competitive and may, in the longer term, be more profitable. » Higher levels of investment and innovation Governments are often unable to afford to invest enough to ensure a business remains competitive. They may have other priorities, such as investing in health care services, which are important if they want to be re-elected. Privatising a business may mean that its new owners are more willing and able to invest in establishing production methods and in developing new products which make the business more competitive. This can secure its long-term future. 6.1.1.1 The advantages and disadvantages of privatisation The issue of privatisation is a central part of the debate about the extent to which the government should intervene in the economy. Over time, governments in diverse economies such as Argentina, Malaysia, New Zealand and the UK have implemented policies to reduce the state’s role in the economy, to allow markets and businesses to operate with the maximum degree of freedom. In part, this has been achieved through the policy of privatisation whereby stateowned enterprises are sold to the private sector. The advantages of privatisation The disadvantages of privatisation » Some industries are not suited to competition The Can be achieved through a policy of privatisation Can be achieved through a policy of nationalisation A more laissez-faire approach to managing the business environment Lesser Extent of the state’s role in the economy Greater ▲ Figure 6.2 Nationalisation and privatisation We shall consider privatisation first. There are, not surprisingly, advantages and disadvantages to privatising businesses. The main advantages and disadvantages of privatisation are set out below. GLOSSARY TERMS Privatisation is the process of transferring organisations from state ownership to being owned and controlled by individuals and other businesses in the private sector. Nationalisation is the transfer of a privately owned organisation to the control of the state. Innovation is the development of new ideas into new products or new methods of producing products. nature of some industries means that it can be most efficient to have just a single producer – this is termed a ‘natural monopoly’. For example, it makes sense to have a single firm supplying tap-water to households in a particular area. If this single business is privately owned, it would lack competition and may charge high prices and offer poor services, as customers would have no choice. Privatising such businesses would be unlikely to offer benefits to consumers or to promote efficiency. » The need to protect consumers Some industries, such as health care and education, are not well-suited to private ownership. The risk in privatising businesses in these types of industries is that private businesses might prioritise profits over, for example, patient care in a hospital. Many countries in the world operate public health services for these reasons. » Short-termism There is a risk that the managers of some privatised businesses may focus on short-term profits to satisfy shareholders through rising share prices and high dividend payments. However, this might be achieved at the expense of investing in projects which would provide long-term profits, ensuring the viability of the business over many years and its ability to provide employment and pay taxes to the government. 215 9781398308114.indb 215 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.1 An assessment of privatisation Privatisation will not always be successful. Firstly, it depends on the industry. Some industries such as airlines and telecommunications have enjoyed much increased levels of efficiency and profits following privatisation. It has proved less effective in industries such as public transport and health care, where the profit motive is not so important. Privatisation has generally been more successful in creating efficient and fair industries when regulators have been established. Regulators can ensure that competition is fair and that dominant firms do not exploit their market power at the expense of competitors and customers. In particular, it is important that governments avoid privatisation where it would create a private monopoly (a single supplier of a particular product) as the lack of competition may result in high prices and poor products. 6.1.1.2 The advantages and disadvantages of nationalisation Nationalisation occurs when the state takes control of privately owned enterprises. It is not surprising that there are also advantages and disadvantages associated with a policy of nationalisation. The advantages of nationalisation » Businesses can operate in the public interest Privately owned businesses normally operate with a profit motive – though there are exceptions. Nationalising a business means that the government can set its objectives. These objectives can be in the interests of society as a whole and not just based on making the maximum possible profits for the owners of the private business. The East Coast Main Line is a major railway route between London and Edinburgh in the UK. This route was privatised in 1997 but returned to state control in 2008, when the private company operating it suffered financial difficulties. It was managed successfully by the state until 2015, when it was once again privatised before being taken into state control once more, as the second private company operating it faced financial problems. This shows that there are circumstances in which it is challenging for a private company to make sufficient profits while operating a business in the public interest. » The treatment of employees There is some evidence to suggest that employees are more likely to be exploited within a privatised business. Governments often privatise businesses to cut the costs of operating them. So, for example, many government buildings in the UK are cleaned by employees belonging to private companies. Private cleaning companies win contracts for cleaning by offering to provide such services at very low costs. The pay, conditions and job security for cleaners and other employees in state-run businesses tend to be better than in their privatised equivalents. » Levels of long-term investment There is some controversy over whether state or private ownership results in higher long-term levels of investment. However, there is a school of thought that governments are more likely to provide the long-term investment needed to create important services for the public, such as railways and electricity supply networks. Governments across the world have provided the investment necessary to create high-speed railways. The disadvantages of nationalisation » Political interference Opponents of nationalisation argue that governments are subject to political pressures and take decisions that please voters rather than making sound business sense. Some governments have pursued policies which have led to nationalised businesses hiring too many workers. This has boosted employment (often in poor regions) but has resulted in high costs and uncompetitive enterprises. Subsequently, governments are often unwilling to make redundancies for fear of the bad publicity that will result. » Inefficiency This is perhaps the major criticism of nationalised businesses. The managers of some nationalised businesses are not expected to meet targets that would be common in privately owned enterprises. Nationalised businesses are also sometimes shielded from the full force of competition from overseas businesses. These factors can remove the incentive for managers to produce up-to-date and desirable products at the lowest possible cost, thereby offering the greatest value to consumers. It is this perceived weakness that has prompted many calls for privatisation. » Reduced competition Nationalisation can discourage competition. Governments that privatise industries frequently reduce the regulations governing that industry at the same time. This encourages more businesses to enter that industry. The outcome is often more choice and lower prices than would be the case with a nationalised business. GLOSSARY TERM Regulation is the enforcement of principles or rules that result from the passing of a law or series of laws. An assessment of nationalisation As with privatisation, it is not possible to say that nationalised businesses will perform better (or worse) than their privately owned equivalents. Inevitably, it depends on the circumstances. However, it is possible to say that the advantages of a nationalised business are more likely to outweigh its disadvantages in the following circumstances: » where high-quality managers are appointed and clear targets are set » where the central government does not try to manage the business » where sufficient investment is available for short- and long-term investment needs » where the interests of all stakeholders are considered and not simply the need to generate profits. 216 9781398308114.indb 216 05/03/21 11:08 AM ▼ Table 6.1 A comparison of privatisation and nationalisation Nationalisation Management Transferred by the state to be managed by the private sector Owned and managed by the state instead of the private sector Examples In 2015, the Australian government sold NSW Ferguson Marine Engineering, a shipbuilding Electricity to the private sector for more company, was nationalised by the Scottish than $16 billion. Government in 2019. Key benefits • Increased efficiency • Operational independence • Higher levels of investment and innovation • Better treatment of employees • Operate in public interest • The state can provide a reliable source of long-term investment Key drawbacks • Some industries not suited to competition • The need to protect consumers • Short-termism • Political interference • Inefficiency • Reduced competition Circumstances in which more likely to be successful • Industries open to global competition, such as airlines or telecommunications • Industries requiring a high degree of innovation • Natural monopolies such as water supply • Non-profit services such as health care STUDY TIP Do think about the cases for nationalisation and privatisation in different situations. You should appreciate that there is not a simple answer to the question of which is best. Thinking about the circumstances in which each is best will deepen your understanding and improve your ability to develop arguments and make judgements on this issue. 6.1.1.3 How a government might use the law to control business activity The law is a framework of rules governing the way in which societies operate. Laws are sometimes called legislation. These rules apply to businesses as well as individuals. The legal framework influences businesses in a number of ways, affecting almost all areas of business activity. Marketing, production, employment, relationships with customers and competitors, and even decisions on location are examples of areas of business activity that can be influenced by laws. STUDY TIP You do not need to know about specific laws, but you would benefit from some knowledge of the major laws in your country relating to the aspects of business behaviour covered below. You should also consider the effects they have on local businesses. This chapter will use examples of laws in operation in the UK to illustrate the explanations. 6.1.1 6.1.1.3 How a government might use the law to control business activity Privatisation Laws relating to employment practices, working conditions and pay These laws govern the relations between workers, employers and trade unions. The UK government has a range of laws which it uses to control the ways in which people are employed in the UK. Governments can use laws to control a range of issues related to employment, including: » employment practices » conditions of work » wage levels. Some examples of the employment laws in the UK are shown in Figure 6.3. Working time regulations Working conditions Health and Safety at Work Act Collective labour law The Minimum Wage Act Pay Laws relating to employment practices, working conditions and pay Employment practices Employment Relations Act The National Living Wage Individual labour law The Equality Act ▲ Figure 6.3 Employment legislation 217 9781398308114.indb 217 05/03/21 11:08 AM Employment practices A LEVEL 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.1 Employment practices refers to the way in which businesses treat their employees from hiring until the end of their relationship with the business. Most countries have a range of laws covering issues relating to individual employees and groups of employees within the workplace. Laws relating to individual employees are frequently designed to ensure that all employees are treated fairly and equally. In recent years, there has been a focus in many countries on avoiding discrimination against particular groups of employees. The UK passed a key piece of antidiscrimination legislation in 2010, as outlined below. » The Equalities Act 2010 This Act replaced a number of earlier anti-discrimination laws in the UK (such as the Disability Discrimination Act) to simplify legislation in this area. The Act relates to nine protected characteristics which cannot be used as a reason to treat people differently or unlawfully. Each person in the UK is protected by this Act, as everybody has one or more of these characteristics. The protected characteristics are: – age – disability – gender reassignment – marriage and civil partnership – pregnancy and maternity – race – religion or belief – sex – sexual orientation. This Act makes unfair treatment unlawful in the workplace, in education and when supplying goods and services. Employees in many countries are protected against unfair dismissal. Unfair dismissal is the termination of a worker’s employment contract without a legal reason. In the UK, legislation relating to unfair dismissal only relates to workers once they have been in a particular job for one year or more. There are a limited number of reasons why an employee might be dismissed: » where a job no longer exists – this is redundancy » gross misconduct – examples of this include theft from the employer or behaving violently at work » failing to carry out duties in a ‘satisfactory manner’ » another substantial reason – for example, the ending of a temporary contract. All other reasons for dismissal are considered unfair. Employees who think they have been unfairly dismissed can claim compensation by taking their case to an industrial tribunal. There are also laws that govern relationships between employers and groups of employees. This is often referred to as collective labour law. This group of laws applies to the operation of industrial relations and collective bargaining as well as the activities of trade unions. Employers and employees are likely to negotiate on a variety of matters. These negotiations may include items such as working conditions and other workplace rules, pay, hours of work, holidays, sick leave, retirement benefits and health care benefits. Some examples of these laws in the UK, as well as a later one granting more powers to trade unions, are described below. » Employment Act 1980 Under this Act employers were no longer obliged to negotiate with unions – many unions were derecognised as a consequence. » Trade Union Act 1984 This legislation made a secret ballot of employees a legal requirement before unions could take any industrial action against employers, such as strikes. » Trade Union Reform and Employment Rights Act 1993 Unions were required to give employers a minimum of seven days’ notice before taking official industrial action. It also abolished minimum pay rates, although laws establishing minimum wage rates were introduced by a different government in 1999. » Employment Relations Act 1999 Under this Act, a trade union with a membership exceeding 50 per cent of the employees in any particular business can demand union recognition and the right to introduce collective bargaining. Laws relating to employment practices can quickly become outdated, as business practices and operations change. Governments in countries throughout the world are under pressure to ensure that laws relating to all aspects of employment are up-to-date and fit for purpose. One matter which is receiving a lot of attention in many countries across the globe is that of the insecure employment of workers in the so-called gig economy. A ‘gig’ is a term used to describe a single piece of work, such as delivering a meal or transporting a passenger in a taxi. At the core of the gig economy are app-based platforms that allocate work in small quantities – making deliveries, driving passengers or cleaning homes. People working in the gig economy are not classified as employees, but contractors. As a consequence, they do not receive guaranteed hours of work or amounts of pay. However, from the point of view of companies operating in the gig economy, using workers in this way can be an effective means of controlling labour costs. The case study below looks at the response of law-makers in the American state of California to the gig economy. GLOSSARY TERM The gig economy is a labour market in which short-term contracts or freelance work are common, as opposed to permanent jobs. 218 9781398308114.indb 218 05/03/21 11:08 AM CASE STUDY 6.1.1 New laws affect the USA’s gig economy The legislation came into effect at the start of 2020 and states that, if a company directs a worker in the way they perform their tasks or includes their work as part of their regular business, they must class that worker as an employee instead of a contractor. The new law may have an effect on other states. Trade unions and other employee groups are calling for similar legislation in New York, Washington State and Oregon. Many people working in the gig economy have been classified as contractors without access to benefits including minimum wage rates, sick pay and holiday pay. We will explore the gig economy and other new employment practices further in Chapter 7.4. Examples of occupations in the gig economy include taxi drivers, food-delivery workers, construction workers and those employed in nail salons. It was predicted that the new law would affect at least 1 million workers in California. But the new law threatens the business models (and possibly the futures) of gig economy companies like Uber and Lyft, which employ large numbers of people as contractors to reduce costs and increase profitability. The law has received a lot of criticism from some businesses for potentially reducing employment levels and the growth of businesses. Questions 1 2 Analyse one possible way in which the managers of a Californian business in the gig economy might respond to this new law. [4] Evaluate the case for and against the passing of this new law in California. [12] ▼ Table 6.2 The legal requirements for paid holidays in a selection of countries Working conditions Country The term ‘working conditions’ refers to a range of factors affecting an employee’s experiences at work, including hours of work and paid holidays, as well as their safety and security in the workplace. Legal entitlement Notes to paid holiday per year China 16–26 days Precise figure depends on length of employment with the enterprise USA – No federal or state laws on paid holidays Singapore 18–25 days Precise figure depends on length of employment with the enterprise Iran 53 days This includes 27 days of paid public holidays Many countries have laws relating to working hours. The European Union (EU) operates its Working Time Regulations, which were introduced in 1998. This European Union legislation set a limit of 48 hours on the number of hours that employees could be required to work each week. Employees can opt to work longer hours if they wish, but employers cannot insist that they do so without inserting an appropriate clause in their employment contract. The regulations also gave employees an entitlement to four weeks’ paid annual leave. Although the UK has left the European Union, these laws will remain in place until and unless new ones are passed. It is increasingly common for employees to have an entitlement to a period of paid holiday each year. These legal rights are also part of the Working Time Regulations mentioned above. This law applies to most employees who are paid at their normal rate. The amount of paid holiday set out in employment legislation varies considerably between non-EU countries. Table 6.2 offers some examples. 6.1.1.3 How a government might use the law to control business activity The government in California (one of the USA’s most prosperous states) has passed a new law that makes it mandatory for contract (or gig) workers to be treated by companies as employees. The intention is to improve job security and working conditions of employees in the state’s gig economy. Uber’s use of contractors has enabled the company to operate taxi services in cities across the world. Laws relating to health and safety in the workplace are an important element of the conditions of work for all employees, especially those working in potentially dangerous industries, such as mining. The International Labour Organisation (ILO) reports that there are more than 2.78 million deaths per year in workplaces throughout the world. Additionally, there are some 374 million non-fatal work-related injuries each year resulting in more than 4 days of absences from work. The human cost of this is vast and the economic burden of poor health and safety practices is estimated at 3.94 per cent of global gross domestic product (GDP) each year. In this case, GDP measures the total value of output produced by the world’s economy over a year. 219 9781398308114.indb 219 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.1 » providing protection against dangerous substances. Health and safety legislation has been enacted to discourage dangerous practices by businesses and to protect the workforce. The legislation in the UK is designed to prevent accidents in the workplace and has developed steadily over the last 30 years. The main Act in the UK is the Health and Safety Act of 1974. This is an example of delegated legislation, whereby parliament gives responsibility to government departments to update the scope of the legislation as necessary. This process avoids any particular aspect of legislation taking up too much of parliament’s time. Businesses are required to protect the health and safety of their employees ‘as far as it is reasonably practicable’. This means that the business concerned must have provided protection appropriate to the risks. Thus, a chemical manufacturer would be expected to provide considerable protection for its employees. The Act also requires employees to follow all health and safety procedures and to take care of their own and others’ safety. In the UK, the Health and Safety Executive (HSE) oversees the operation of the Act and carries out inspections of businesses’ premises. The HSE also carries out investigations following any serious workplace accident. The Health and Safety at Work Act gives employers a legal obligation ‘to ensure that they safeguard all their employees’ health, safety and welfare at work’. The Act covers a range of business activities, including: » the installation and maintenance of safety equipment and clothing » the maintenance of workplace temperatures » giving employees sufficient breaks during the working day Wage levels Pay rates are another area relating to employment in which a high proportion of countries have passed laws. Many countries have minimum wage laws, which set out wage rates below which businesses must not pay. The use of minimum wage laws is illustrated in Figure 6.4 below. 100% 91% 73% 97% 89% Note: The ILO has 187 members, meaning few countries are not members. Source: International Labour Organisation; Minimum wage setting in Europe and beyond – the ILO perspective, 18 September 2019, David Mosler ▲ Figure 6.4 The proportion of ILO members in different regions of the world that operate minimum wage legislation Minimum wage rates can vary within countries. Some are not the same throughout the different regions of a country. In the USA, some states (for example, Alabama and South Carolina) do not have any minimum wage laws and the rates can vary significantly in other states. In 2020, the minimum hourly wage rate in Wyoming was $5.15 compared to $13 per hour in California. Other countries have passed minimum wage laws which impose different minimum rates for different occupations. For example, India has a large number of different minimum wage rates for some selected occupations. The UK’s National Minimum Wage Act came into force on 1 April 1999. The key features of this legislation are: » a general hourly minimum wage rate for workers aged over 24 » separate minimum wage rates for those aged 16–17, 18–20 and 21–24 » all part-time and temporary workers must be paid the minimum wage. In April 2016, this legislation was supplemented by the introduction of the national living wage in the UK. This applies to employees aged 25 and over and pays a significantly higher rate than the minimum wage. In 2020, the rate was set at £8.72 per hour. UK minimum and national living wage rates are raised each year to ensure that these wages at least keep up with the current rate of inflation. In November 2020, the University of Massachusetts Amherst, the National Bureau of Economic Research and the IZA Institute of Labor Economics carried out research 220 9781398308114.indb 220 05/03/21 11:08 AM into the effects of minimum wages. Their conclusions were that even the UK’s relatively high minimum wage rates had little negative impact on employment rates, while substantially increasing the pay and living standards of low-paid employees. Laws relating to marketing behaviour Since 2014, the Competition and Markets Authority (CMA) has overseen legislation relating to marketing activities in the UK. It seeks to improve the position of consumers by giving them information to allow them to make better choices when purchasing goods and services. It also protects consumers by prosecuting businesses that offend against marketing legislation and by negotiating voluntary codes of practice with producers of goods and services. 6.1.1 It is also necessary to protect the public from improper use of the power of advertising. It involves a combination of legal controls and self-regulation. » The Trade Descriptions Act 1968 This Act makes misleading descriptions of goods and services an offence. » The Advertising Standards Authority This body supervises the operation of this code of practice. It is an independent body; its members are not in the advertising industry. The ASA protects the public and deals with their complaints. CASE STUDY 6.1.1.3 How a government might use the law to control business activity The law covers the marketing activities of businesses in most countries. Approximately 80 per cent of countries have passed laws to protect consumers from the marketing activities of businesses. The scope of these laws varies and there is a general criticism that they are not updated sufficiently to reflect changes in marketing behaviour, such as the use of the internet. The UK has a series of laws designed to safeguard consumers against: » businesses charging excessively high prices or rates of interest » unfair trading practices; for example, selling quantities less than those advertised » unsafe products, such as children’s toys with sharp objects or toxic paint » having insufficient information on which to take purchasing decisions. There is a considerable quantity of marketing legislation in the UK. The Acts listed below represent a few highlights. » The Consumer Rights Act 2015 replaced three major pieces of marketing legislation in the UK. This Act was introduced to modernise the law in this area, making it simpler and stronger. The Consumer Rights Act states that all products (including, for the first time, digital products as well as physical products) must be of satisfactory quality, fit for purpose and as described. All products must meet the following standards: – Products must be of satisfactory quality. Goods shouldn’t be faulty or damaged when purchased. – Products should be fit for the purpose they are supplied for and offer the consumer the benefits promised. – The goods supplied must match any description given to consumers, or any models or samples shown to consumers. » The Consumer Credit Act 1974 This Act lays down that consumer credit can only be given by licensed organisations. It also sets out the terms under which credit may be given. Queensland to ban ‘junk food’ adverts The government of the Australian state of Queensland has banned junk food advertising at government-owned locations in a bid to eliminate poor diets and obesity among children. The state’s Health Minister, Steven Miles, said the unhealthy marketing activities would be stopped throughout the state. The advertising sites affected will include bus stops and train stations. ‘Junk food advertisers target kids, we know that, and obesity in childhood is a leading indicator of obesity in adulthood,’ Mr Miles said. ‘This is about doing what we can to protect our kids from the kind of marketing that leads them to make unhealthy choices.’ ‘Obesity is a real challenge for our community, for our hospitals and the health services, but also for the individuals who are suffering – this is really just a decision about the government leading by example and saying that we will use our spaces to advertise healthier options,’ he said. Jane Martin is the executive manager of the Obesity Policy Coalition, a group pressing the Australian government to take action against obesity. Ms Martin approved this decision by the government of Queensland, noting that young people are particularly susceptible to junk food advertising. The governments of other Australian states are considering passing similar laws to control marketing activities. Source: www.abc.net.au/news/2019-04-21/junk-food-adsbinned-queensland-government-crackdown/11034284 Questions 1 2 Analyse two ways in which laws can constrain the activities of fast-food businesses. [8] Evaluate the extent to which laws of this type benefit the stakeholders of fast-food restaurants in Queensland. [12] 221 9781398308114.indb 221 05/03/21 11:08 AM Laws relating to competition A LEVEL 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.1 Competition law is intended to protect businesses and consumers from the effects of anti-competitive practices. Most governments believe that free and fair competition in markets brings many benefits. The UK government set out the importance of competition to its economy in 2001: Vigorous competition between firms is the lifeblood of strong and effective markets. Competition helps consumers get a good deal. It encourages firms to innovate by reducing slack, putting downward pressure on costs and providing incentives for the efficient organisation of production. As such, competition is a central driver for productivity growth in the economy, and hence the UK’s international competitiveness. Source: UK Department of Trade and Industry Businesses operating in the UK are subject to UK and, at the time of writing, to EU competition law, although this may change after 31 December 2020. The major competition laws in the UK are: » the Competition Act 1998 » the Enterprise Act 2002 » the Enterprise and Regulatory Reform Act 2013. Competition law in the UK operates in three main areas: 1 Cartel activity Cartels involve two or more businesses working together to limit the extent of competition that exists in a market; they are considered to be a serious form of anti-competitive practice. Cartels are agreements between businesses not to compete with each other, for example, on price, discount levels, credit terms or in respect of particular customers or in particular areas. The outcome is that consumers will be disadvantaged, primarily because they will have to pay a higher price (agreed by the cartel) than would otherwise be the case. In addition, the economy will be damaged by a lack of competitiveness among its businesses. 2 Abuse of a dominant market position The law defines a dominant market position as ‘a position of economic strength enjoyed by an undertaking which enables it to prevent effective competition being maintained in the relevant market by affording it the power to behave to an appreciable extent independently of its competitors, customers and ultimately of its consumers.’ Such markets can be national or local, as well as the whole of the EU. Abuse of such a position can take a number of forms, including: – imposing unfair purchase or selling prices or other unfair trading conditions – limiting production, markets or technical development to the prejudice of consumers – imposing unfair and inconsistent terms on different trading partners. 3 Other anti-competitive practices These could include agreements with suppliers not to sell below certain prices, limiting production to drive up prices, agreeing not to sell to a competitor’s customers, etc. This also includes mergers and takeovers which may be harmful to the competitive process in markets. The scope of UK and EU competition law Cartel activity Abuse of a dominant market position Other anti-competitive practices ▲ Figure 6.5 The extent of competition law GLOSSARY TERMS A cartel exists when two or more businesses collude to control prices and/or output, thereby limiting competition and increasing profits. A merger is the combining of two or more firms into a single business, following an agreement by the firms’ management teams and shareholders. A takeover occurs when one company acquires complete control of another by purchasing more than 50 per cent of its share capital. Mergers and takeovers Takeovers and mergers have the potential to provide businesses with a high degree of market power, as they create larger enterprises. They can also lead to a reduction in the degree of competition within a market. The competition authorities in the UK are required to assess whether a merger or takeover should be prohibited on the basis of whether it can be expected to lead to ‘a substantial lessening of competition’. In the UK, the primary responsibility for the regulation of mergers and takeovers lies with the Competition and Markets Authority (CMA). Mergers will be assessed by the CMA if: » the business being taken over exceeds a given size (a sales revenue exceeding £70 million), or » the newly merged business would control 25 per cent or more of its market. Key UK competition laws The legal framework for the UK’s competition policy is provided by the Competition Act 1998, the Enterprise Act 2002 and the Enterprise and Regulatory Reform Act 2013. » The Competition Act 1998 prohibits cartels and abuses of dominant market position. It also outlaws concerted practice; for example, when businesses agree to divide up a market and not to compete in each other’s ‘part’ of the market. The penalties for breaching this Act can be severe. Businesses may be fined up to 10 per cent of their worldwide sales revenue if they enter into an anti-competitive agreement or abuse a dominant market position. » The Enterprise Act 2002 amended earlier laws and strengthened the power of the UK authorities to deal with anti-competitive practices and market dominance. This Act has a number of important provisions: – It places a clear focus on the impact of the business’ activities on the degree of competition. Practices 222 9781398308114.indb 222 05/03/21 11:08 AM means that businesses may be sued for damages by third parties that have been harmed by their anticompetitive actions. – The assessment of mergers is influenced less by politicians and is more independent. » The Enterprise and Regulatory Reform Act 2013 The main provisions of this Act, relating to competition, are as follows: – It created the CMA, bringing together the Competition Commission and the competition work of the Office of Fair Trading. Thus, a single organisation is responsible for competition policy. – It makes it quicker and simpler for businesses, especially small and medium-sized enterprises, to make legal challenges to anti-competitive behaviour. – It also makes it easier for consumers and small businesses who have suffered loss due to anticompetitive behaviour to obtain redress. CASE STUDY US authorities approve T-Mobile and Sprint merger The competition authorities in the United States have approved a merger between two of the country’s biggest mobile telephone service providers: T-Mobile and Sprint. The new business will be valued at $26.5 billion. On the face of it, this deal reduces the number of mobile telephone providers in the USA from four to three. The deal was finally approved after the two companies agreed to sell some of their assets to another company. The deal includes agreement that Dish, a satellite dish supplier, will buy Boost Mobile, Virgin Mobile, Sprint’s prepaid business, and ‘certain’ other assets currently owned by the two companies. This will position Dish as the fourth major US mobile telephone provider, replacing the one that will be lost once T-Mobile and Sprint merge. The two companies will be required to provide at least 20 000 cell sites and hundreds of retail locations to Dish, and it will also get unrestricted access to T-Mobile’s network for seven years as it works to build a mobile network of its own. The law and business location decisions Many countries have legal systems which control where businesses can locate. It is not unusual for businesses to be located in particular areas – often alongside other businesses. So, many towns and cities create industrial estates where business can locate. Retailers may be limited to certain streets – often where other shops already operate. Many countries, including the United States, make it illegal to locate businesses outside designated zones. Businesses that want to build new premises may need to apply for permission from the authorities. Applications for new premises are decided in line with national and local policies. Points for consideration include: When T-Mobile and Sprint announced their merger plan, they claimed that their combined assets would make them a stronger competitor to the other two companies in the market: AT&T and Verizon. T-Mobile and Sprint said they would be able to reduce prices for consumers and more quickly offer the new 5G service across America. These claims have faced harsh criticism from consumer groups and some experts. Questions 1 2 Analyse one reason why reducing the number of companies selling products in a particular market might be harmful to consumers. [4] The American competition authorities ruled in favour of the merger. Evaluate whether or not this is a good outcome. [12] 6.1.1 6.1.1.3 How a government might use the law to control business activity are judged as to whether they create a ‘substantial lessening of competition’ rather than whether they are ‘in the public interest’. – It imposes tougher penalties on those involved in cartels by criminalising their activities. Directors or other people involved may be fined or sent to prison for up to five years if involved in cartel activity. Company directors may also be disqualified from being a director for up to 15 years. – It empowers consumer organisations to make complaints (known as ‘supercomplaints’) to the CMA about markets that are not working well for consumers. For example, in 2018, this legislation was used to make a complaint about businesses charging loyal customers higher prices than new customers for the same products. – There are greater opportunities for victims of anti-competitive behaviour to gain compensation. Consumer bodies will be able to make claims on behalf of individuals who have suffered. This » the size, layout and external appearance of buildings » proposed means of access and impact on the neighbourhood » availability of infrastructure, such as roads and electricity supply » how the proposed use of the development relates to the rest of the neighbourhood. Another factor influencing business location which has a legal dimension is the use of special economic zones. These are areas within individual countries where business and trade laws are different from the rest of the country. They are designed to attract businesses to locate there. Governments pass laws to allow businesses locating in these areas a range of benefits such as tax 223 9781398308114.indb 223 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.1 holidays, financial support, and fewer laws and regulations relating to employment and international trade. Often these special economic zones are sited in poor regions of the country. By 2018, 147 economies operated special economic zones including China, India, Bangladesh, Saudi Arabia, the Philippines, South Korea and the UAE. 6.1.1.4 The impact of changes in political and legal factors on businesses and business decisions Laws and particular goods and services Changes in political and legal factors frequently lead to more intervention in business matters. For many businesses, this can be a disadvantage as such interventions can result in increased costs of production, as businesses in most nations are legally obliged to employ a number of nonproductive employees. For example, health and safety laws may require the appointment of safety officers. In addition, other costs of production may increase as businesses have to pay minimum wage rates and locate in what may be costly places. Similarly, the requirement (under the Equalities Act in the UK) to make ‘reasonable’ alterations to the working environment to enable the employment of people with disabilities adds to production costs. Governments use laws to control the production, sale and consumption of a range of goods and services. Legal controls may be applied to particular products for a number of reasons: » The production and consumption of these products may result in damage to the natural environment. » The goods and services may be harmful to consumers and they may also be addictive. » Their consumption may have adverse effects on others or on society generally. Globally there are many products that are subject to legal constraints; we shall consider a small selection. Some of the more common ones include: » tobacco » alcohol » medicines » gambling » vehicles with diesel and petrol engines. Governments tend to take a range of steps to control businesses that produce and sell these products, as well as consumers who use them. » Taxation Governments may impose heavy taxes on the sale of products, such as tobacco and alcohol. This is intended to discourage consumption, though it also acts as an important source of revenue for many governments. Tobacco taxes in many countries form more than 50 per cent of the selling price of the products. » Limiting sales Governments may control the sale of products directly to a lesser or greater degree. The use of vehicles with petrol and diesel engines is restricted in many cities including Singapore, London, Milan and Stockholm. Equally, there are commonly age limits on those who can buy and consume certain products, such as gambling and tobacco. It is thought that such products can be particularly harmful to younger people. In some countries (for example, Canada), strong alcohol can only be purchased from a relatively small number of licensed shops. » Outright bans on production and consumption The sale of alcohol is banned in a number of Muslim countries and some states in India. All forms of gambling are illegal in Cambodia and Qatar. » Restricting sale to ensure safe consumption Many countries control the sale of products, such as medicines, to ensure that consumers use them safely. The intention is for consumers to receive the health benefits with minimal risks. In most countries, only specified shops and other outlets with suitably qualified staff are allowed to sell certain medicines. Changes in laws relating to employment practices, marketing behaviour or competition, or decisions to raise minimum wage rates, may all have negative effects on businesses. Such changes can be critical if they increase costs of production and the business concerned operates in a globalised market with very price-conscious customers. If rival businesses operating in other countries do not face similar increases in costs of production, they will operate with a competitive advantage. Such changes may result in some businesses losing sales, market share and profits. However, there can be positive consequences for businesses from political and legal changes. Changes in employment and other laws can help to motivate the workforce and improve the performance of the workforce. For example, employees who work in a safe and secure physical environment will be more contented and probably more productive. Employers will also avoid the costs, delays and bad publicity caused by accidents at work or employee complaints about poor conditions. Furthermore, freedom from arbitrary dismissal may encourage a more co-operative and productive workforce, enhancing the performance of the business. The effects of legal and political changes may be greater for small firms that have fewer resources and are less able to keep up with changes in employment and other laws, and may not be able to afford to respond in the appropriate manner. Larger firms are more likely to employ specialists and are more likely to be prepared for, and able to finance, change. They may also be able to afford employment lawyers to advise them on avoiding some of the effects of a new piece of legislation. STUDY TIP Do think about political and legal changes in a balanced way. The effects on businesses do not always have to be negative, as we have seen. Also think in a structured way about how businesses might respond to such changes. Considering the likely effects on, and responses of, each functional area of a business may be helpful. 224 9781398308114.indb 224 05/03/21 11:08 AM CASE STUDY 6.1.1 Vietnam increases its minimum wage rates The country has different minimum wage rates in four regions, determined by the level of economic development in each region. Zone 1 covers urban Hanoi and Ho Chi Minh City. Zone 2 covers rural Hanoi and Ho Chi Minh City, as well as Can Tho, Da Nang and Hai Phong. Zone 3 includes provincial cities and the districts of Bac Ninh, Bac Giang, Hai Duong and Vinh Phuc. Zone 4 comprises the rest of the country. Business responses to the effects of changes in the political and legal environment Most businesses will take decisions necessary to offset the effects of the change in their political or legal environment as far as possible. If the changes are judged favourable, businesses will consider how to take advantage of the new circumstances. Business decisions could take a number of forms, which include the following. » Changes in production methods Legal and political changes may lead to decisions whereby businesses use fewer employees in the production process and replace them with capital equipment. Some businesses, particularly footloose multinationals that can move location easily, may decide to close production facilities and produce elsewhere. » Selling or buying assets Businesses may take the decision to sell part of their operations if they need to meet the requirements of competition authorities when According to a survey released by an employment website, salaries in Vietnam are rising faster than other Asian countries but still remain low – and lower than in countries such as China. Vietnam’s minimum wage increase of 5.7 per cent is higher than last year’s figure of 5.3 per cent, but lower than that in 2018 and 2017. Vietnam has been considered a low-cost location for multinational businesses and is a popular location for many well-known multinationals. Samsung, Bosch, Panasonic and General Electric all have operations in the country. Questions 1 2 Analyse two possible effects of this change in minimum wage rates on businesses located in Vietnam. [8] Evaluate the best way for businesses in Vietnam to respond to this change in minimum wage rates. [12] contemplating a merger or takeover. Conversely, changes in laws relating to conditions of work, including health and safety, might result in the purchase of new assets to meet changed legal requirements. » Changes in prices and target markets Rising costs may force some businesses to pass these onto consumers in the form of higher prices, if market conditions allow. Other businesses may decide to target other market segments which may be willing to pay higher prices. » Decisions to cut production and/or develop new products Political and legal changes can lead to businesses deciding to stop producing certain products and to supply other products. Legal changes in many countries have led to tobacco sales falling significantly. Some tobacco manufacturers have responded by closing factories, while others have switched production to vaping products. TEST YOUR LEARNING b Short answer questions 1 2 3 4 Define the terms: a ‘privatisation’ [2] b ‘nationalisation’. [2] a Explain one advantage of privatisation. [3] b Explain one reason why some industries may not be suited to privatisation. [3] a Explain one advantage of nationalisation. [3] b Explain one reason why nationalised industries may be less efficient than those in the private sector. [3] a Define the term ‘trade union’. [2] 5 6 7 Explain one reason why laws relating to employment practice need to be updated regularly. Explain one way in which minimum wage rates might vary within a single country. a Explain one way in which laws relating to marketing behaviour might affect businesses. b Explain one type of business activity that competition law is designed to prevent. Explain one action that a government might take to control the production, sale and consumption of particular goods and services. 6.1.1.4 The impact of changes in political and legal factors on businesses and business decisions The Vietnamese government increases its minimum wage rates each January in line with the cost of living. A new minimum wage rate for workers, which will result in an increase in monthly pay of up to 300 000 Vietnamese dong, equivalent to approximately US$14, was introduced in January 2020. This represented an increase of approximately 5.7 per cent in the country’s minimum wage rates. [3] [3] [3] [3] [3] 225 9781398308114.indb 225 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.1 External influences on business activity: Political and legal 6.1.1 8 Explain one reason why political and legal changes might reduce the competitiveness of a business. [3] 9 Explain one reason why the existence of laws to control employment practices may be beneficial to businesses. [3] 10 Explain one way in which a business might respond to a change in the law which increases its costs of production significantly. [3] One director of MD said that the effects of the changes to laws on working conditions would damage the company’s future performance. Data response question Questions MD vehicles 1 MD is a multinational company that manufactures vehicles and has factories in several countries. The company’s workforce is becoming less productive over time and profit margins are falling as a result. The market for cars is increasingly price competitive, although MD is a brand that is highly valued by customers and demand for its cars is not strongly sensitive to price. A new government has been elected in one of the countries where MD produces over 30 per cent of its cars in a very large factory. This government has announced changes to laws governing working conditions which will come into force in one year’s time. These include: ● an increase in the number of days of paid holiday from 15 to 20 ● an extension of health and safety laws. The new government has also taken a decision to nationalise one of MD’s most important suppliers of components which is sited close to its factory. This was an unexpected change and MD’s directors are concerned about the impact it may have on its operations. 2 3 Analyse one possible effect on MD of the government’s decision to nationalise one of its major local suppliers. [4] Evaluate the decisions that the company might take in response to the changes in the laws relating to working conditions. [12] One director said that ‘the effects of the changes to laws on working conditions would damage the company’s future performance.’ Evaluate this view.[12] Essay question 1 Evaluate whether or not new laws designed to promote competition are in the interest of all the stakeholders of a business. [20] 226 9781398308114.indb 226 05/03/21 11:08 AM 6 Business and its environment A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic In this chapter we examine: ★ how governments assist businesses and promote enterprise ★ the ways in which governments constrain business activity ★ government macroeconomic objectives ★ the effects of macroeconomic objectives and economic performance on business activity ★ the government’s economic policies – fiscal, monetary and supply side policies – and their impact on businesses. Every business is affected to some degree by the national (or global) economy in which it operates. An economy is an immensely complex thing. It comprises millions of buyers (or consumers) and hundreds of thousands of businesses all making decisions to spend, hire labour, use certain machinery, produce more or less, lend money or borrow it to produce goods and services. This is then complicated further by the actions of governments that intervene in the working of the economy in order to achieve their social and economic objectives. Most governments aim to manage economies so as to maximise the standard of living of the country’s inhabitants, while pursuing other goals such as protecting the environment. The UK government aims to achieve economic stability in its management of the economy by avoiding, whenever possible, sudden and dramatic changes in the performance of the economy. A country’s economic environment is made up of two main elements: » The factors which reflect the performance of that economy as well as other economies; for example, how fast prices are rising (inflation) and the number of people who do not have a job (unemployment). » The actions taken by governments to achieve the desired economic performance. 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic Chapter overview The factors which make up the economic environment are summarised in Figure 6.6. Government policies affecting the economy Policies to support businesses and promote enterprise Fiscal policies Monetary policies Supply-side policies Exchangerate policies Policies to avoid market failure Businesses in the economy Inflation The exchange rate Unemployment Economic growth Elements of economic performance affecting the economy ▲ Figure 6.6 Influences on the economic environment 227 9781398308114.indb 227 05/03/21 11:08 AM How governments help businesses There are a number of ways in which governments may provide help to businesses throughout the economy. Developing an effective infrastructure Governments benefit from having a strong economy. It provides employment for the country’s inhabitants and a source of taxation for the government. The government is able to use the tax revenues it receives to pursue its objectives, such as providing education and health services. For these reasons, all governments intervene in the economy to help businesses and to encourage enterprise. An economy’s infrastructure is essential for its businesses to be able to operate. Without effective systems of transport, communications and energy supply, businesses would not be able to engage in production and supply goods and services. Infrastructure can also help to determine the competitiveness of a country’s businesses. If energy, transport and communications are provided efficiently and relatively cheaply, it can help to reduce the operating costs of businesses and sharpen their price competitiveness. GLOSSARY TERMS Some governments recognise the importance of up-to-date infrastructure to economic success and invest relatively heavily. Figure 6.7 shows the relative amounts invested in infrastructure in a selection of countries between 2008 and 2017. Governments may invest directly or use a mixture of state and private investment to develop their infrastructures. In recent years, there have been more projects, of greater scale and complexity than ever before, being proposed and progressed. High-profile examples include a new bridge linking Hong Kong to Macau and Zhuhai, Thailand’s Eastern Economic Corridor, Australia’s Inland Rail project and the Dubai Solar Park (this is the world’s largest single-site solar installation, to which more than US$4.3 billion of private investment has been committed). Enterprise is the skill needed to make new ideas work. Infrastructure refers to the physical and organisational factors necessary to allow both society and an economy to operate effectively; for example, transport and communication networks. A joint venture occurs when businesses collaborate on a project (or projects) but do not formally join together all of their activities. 2.0 1.8 Infrastructure investment (% GDP) A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 6.1.2.1 How governments might help businesses and encourage enterprise 1.6 Australia 1.4 1.2 1.0 Japan Turkey UK India 0.8 Germany 0.6 USA 0.4 0.2 0 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 2013 2014 2015 2016 2017 Year Note: This data relates to transport infrastructure investment only. GDP is a measure of the value of a nation’s output. Source: OECD; https://data.oecd.org/transport/infrastructure-investment.htm ▲ Figure 6.7 Infrastructure investment in a selection of countries, 2008–17, as a percentage of GDP HANDLING DATA Look at the data presented in Figure 6.7 and answer the following questions. 1 The graph shows infrastructure investment as a percentage of GDP. Why might the USA’s investment in transport infrastructure have been higher in 2017 than that of Turkey? 2 In 2016, Germany’s investment in its infrastructure, measured in billions of euros, was higher than in 2015. Explain how this happened, given that the graph in Figure 6.7 shows a decline between 2015 and 2016. 228 9781398308114.indb 228 05/03/21 11:08 AM The UK has taken some important decisions on its infrastructure. It has not invested as heavily as some other countries in its infrastructure over the past 30 years, although investment has risen since 2009. Partly as a response to this, the government prepared its infrastructure spending plan for the period to 2033. How businesses benefit from investment in infrastructure Infrastructure projects create significant opportunities for businesses as well as providing better facilities (such as road and rail transport for them to use). There are obvious opportunities for firms in the construction industry to benefit from expenditure on building new roads, bridges and power stations. These can result in strategic decisions to expand production or to engage in joint ventures with competitors to deliver on large infrastructure projects such as the Crossrail Project in London. Other businesses in a wide range of industries are also likely to benefit from orders associated with improving the UK’s infrastructure. For example, the Crossrail Project has resulted in Bombardier (a Canadian multinational engineering company) supplying an order for 65 new trains for the Crossrail railway. This order created 760 new jobs to build the trains and 80 jobs to maintain them once they are operational. Bombardier has a contract to build 60 per cent of the new trains that will be needed in the UK as it improves its infrastructure. Providing advice to businesses The provision of advice to companies can be a relatively inexpensive means of supporting businesses and helping them to become more competitive. Governments can offer advice in a number of areas, including: » raising capital and managing finance » managing employees effectively; for example, offering guidance on recruiting, training and keeping employees » trading overseas – governments may offer advice on how to sell products in specific overseas markets » developing new products and processes of production. Many governments operate websites which offer a range of advice and contacts for those starting new businesses and managing existing ones. For example, the USA federal government operates a small business hub which provides a wide range of advice for the country’s small businesses. Providing services for businesses Governments can support business activities in other ways apart from offering advice. to operate systems designed to match unemployed workers to potential jobs. In this way, they can help to reduce the costs to businesses of finding suitable new employees. In the UK, the government operates Job Centre Plus to bring employers with vacancies and unemployed workers together. A new government website named Universal Jobmatch has been introduced, allowing unemployed workers to search for employment; employers can upload and manage their own vacancies while searching for prospective employees. Similarly, governments can support businesses by providing training or helping businesses to provide their own training. The Indian government funds programmes providing training and has also established the National Skill Development Corporation (NSDC) as a public–private sector partnership to stimulate investment in training. » Helping businesses to raise finance Governments may provide loans and grants directly to businesses, usually to invest in new equipment, buildings or other facilities. They may also guarantee loans provided by banks. This makes banks more willing to lend to what might be high-risk businesses, as the government guarantees the repayment of the loan should the business default on payment. We look at how the UK government helps businesses financially in more detail below. » Supporting businesses trading overseas It is common for governments to support businesses that are exporting goods and services overseas. In the UK, the government supports businesses that are exporting, or planning to do so, through the work of the Department for International Trade. This department helps businesses to acquire the skills and contacts necessary for exporting and provides advice about exporting to particular countries. It also offers help in winning contracts overseas, on using technology to facilitate exporting and by organising trade shows and exhibitions to showcase UK businesses and exports. 6.1.2 6.1.2.1 How governments might help businesses and encourage enterprise The National Infrastructure Plan details about £375 billion of investment in energy, transport, communications and water projects by 2033. The insurance industry also plans to spend £25 billion by 2020 using customers’ payments in pension and other funds to finance this investment. Examples of the UK’s programme of investment in infrastructure include the Crossrail Project in London, the development of a new nuclear power station at Wylfa, North Wales, and, controversially, the building of a high-speed rail line, known as HS2, to connect London to Birmingham and, later, Manchester and Leeds. » Recruitment and training It is common for governments Government policies to encourage enterprise Governments generally seek to establish an enterprisefriendly business environment, which will encourage people and organisations to develop their ideas as well as to establish and expand their businesses. Governments pursue policies to promote enterprise for many reasons: enterprise creates jobs, increases the taxes paid to the government and, of course, today’s new enterprises can become tomorrow’s multinational businesses. Establishing or expanding a business can be a risky process for those involved: entrepreneurs may give up safe, wellpaid jobs and owner-managers may mortgage homes to borrow money to expand businesses. It can go wrong, but the aim of much government support is to promote enterprise and to reduce the degree of risk. Decisions and actions by governments and their agencies encourage and promote the development of enterprise and innovation. The UK encourages enterprise in a number of 229 9781398308114.indb 229 05/03/21 11:08 AM 6.1.2 ways, both financial and non-financial. These have changed significantly in recent years as the importance of enterprise to the government has increased. A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic Financial support for enterprise The British Business Bank is a government-owned business development bank. It manages all UK government programmes that help smaller businesses to gain access to finance. It was established in 2012 to help make sure finance markets for small and medium-sized businesses work effectively. It does not lend directly to businesses, but it will work alongside private-sector partners. It will pull in more private-sector funding to maximise its impact. At the end of the 2018–19 financial year, the bank had lent £6.6 billion to 89 000 businesses. Its lending activities increased by 27 per cent in that year. Some of the national schemes of financial support for enterprise (specifically smaller businesses) overseen by the British Business Bank are shown below, but these are supplemented by a variety of regional and local policies. » The New Enterprise Allowance This is available to the long-term unemployed who want to start their own business. It is in two parts: a weekly allowance totalling £1274 over 26 weeks and access to a loan of up to £2500. » Start-up loans This scheme provides loans to businesses of up to £25 000, with the average being £7200. There is a fixed interest rate of 6 per cent and repayment can be made over any period between 1 and 5 years. » Enterprise Finance Guarantee (EFG) EFG is a loan guarantee scheme. It allows banks and other lenders to offer small businesses which lack security or a proven track record a normal commercial loan. Lenders can use EFG to help businesses arrange loans and overdrafts. Loans can be guaranteed from £1000 to £1.2 million. Small and medium-sized businesses with annual sales revenue below £41 million can get EFG-backed loans. Between its launch in 2009 and 2018, EFG has supported the provision of over 29 000 business loans to a value of over £3.2 billion. CASE STUDY Malaysia urged to make social enterprise scheme simpler Social enterprises are businesses which have clear social objectives, such as helping those on very low incomes or protecting the environment. A scheme in Malaysia designed to help this type of business will increase growth rates in this sector. However, Malaysian entrepreneurs have argued that the government must offer greater incentives and fewer regulations. Twenty-two diverse social enterprises have received accreditation recently for this scheme. The scheme gives social enterprises tax deductions as well as the opportunity to apply for grants. However, some entrepreneurs state that registration is not easy to manage. ‘The documentation process is very data-intensive. Aspiring or new social enterprises will find it difficult so there must be an easier process,’ said Kuhan Pathy, co-founder of Masala Wheels, a social enterprise that supports disadvantaged young people. Non-financial support for enterprise The UK government provides a range of support, advice and inspiration for entrepreneurs establishing and growing their businesses. A focal point of government support for enterprise is its website ‘Business is Great’. The Department for Business, Innovation and Skills (BIS) is the key UK government department concerned with developing and providing enterprise support. It works with businesses, financial institutions and other government departments to help UK businesses start up, grow and succeed. In many Asian countries, such as Malaysia, incomes have risen but governments have continued to struggle with poverty in towns and cities, unequal educational opportunities and environmental issues. This has led a number of countries (Thailand and Vietnam, for example) to pass laws intended to encourage and support social enterprises. Some critics of these laws think that too many regulations will limit the growth in numbers of social enterprises. Source: www.reuters.com/article/us-malaysia-socialenterprisescheme/cut-the-paperwork-malaysia-urged-to-makesocial-enterprise-scheme-simpler-idUSKBN1ZT19A Questions 1 2 Analyse two ways in which the Malaysian government might encourage the creation of more social enterprises. [8] Evaluate the view that any government intervention into a market will lead to significant long-term [12] constraints on some businesses. One element of the BIS’ work has been to develop ‘growth hubs’ across the UK. Since May 2016, the UK has 39 growth hubs across the country. They are communication networks bringing together local and national, public- and private-sector partners – such as Chambers of Commerce, universities and banks – co-ordinating local business support and connecting businesses to the right help for their needs. Businesses that have been in contact with a growth hub are growing faster than other businesses in terms of sales revenue (9 per cent compared to 2.5 per cent on average) and employment (8 per cent compared to 0.1 per cent). 230 9781398308114.indb 230 05/03/21 11:08 AM necessary to develop new products and processes. The government established UK Research and Innovation in 2018. This new organisation operates across the whole of the UK with a combined budget of more than £6 billion. » The government offers a range of schemes to help entrepreneurs and businesses to develop new products and processes. These include help to develop the ideas (in terms of expertise, advice and funding) as well as support on how to protect ideas (known as intellectual property or IP). CASE STUDY The Four Anjels bakery In 2010, four entrepreneurs established Four Anjels bakery in Gloucestershire, England. It operates with the vision of employing ‘passionate bakers to make hand-made products’. Initially the bakery had just five employees but has since grown to have 40 staff and major customers including Caffè Nero. It is possible to judge that the support the Four Anjels received was effective: by 2020 the bakery was operating 24 hours a day, five days each week. After six years of successful operation, the business’ owners realised that changes would be required in order to continue their planned development and growth. Project manager Phil Stevens said: ‘We knew that we needed to relocate to new premises, but we also saw that we were entering a period of significant change. We needed guidance to manage the change efficiently and further business support around the issues that would naturally come from a period of change and rapid growth.’ The team consulted a range of different business advisors and consultancy services, but could not find the kind of support they needed. Phil was sceptical of the advice they received, feeling it was not considering fully the needs of their specific business. ‘When we made contact with the growth hub and were introduced to our business guide, Sarah Gregg, we knew from the very first meeting that we had found the right partner. She took the time to really get to grips with our business and requirements, and then showed us how the growth hub could provide us with effective support.’ The four entrepreneurs attended a number of growth hub events. Meeting a financial advice panel ‘provided a valuable focus and delivered real results’ according to Sarah Gregg. The UK government also seeks to encourage enterprise and to develop the relevant skills in young people. It: » recruits young business owners to volunteer as enterprise champions to talk to young people about establishing and running their own enterprises » works directly with schools and colleges to encourage the use of schemes. For example, it promotes the ‘Enterprise Village’ to help schools to set up businesses. ▲ Figure 6.8 Source: www.thegrowthhub.biz/the-buzz/ news/case-study-four-anjels 6.1.2 6.1.2.1 How governments might help businesses and encourage enterprise Other aspects of BIS’ work to provide a more ‘enterprisefriendly’ environment in the UK include: » Reducing the number of regulations which constrain business activity. The government operates a policy of removing two regulations for each new one created. » BIS works with the tax authorities in the UK (HM Revenue and Customs) to offer support to new and small businesses by reducing the tax they pay on any profits and also the cost of employing people. » Supporting innovation through helping researchers, developers, innovators and businesses, together with universities, to bring together the skills and technology Questions 1 2 Analyse two reasons why the support provided by Gloucestershire growth hub was an important element in expanding Four Anjels. [8] ‘Non-financial help is more important than financial support to establish an enterprise-friendly business [12] environment.’ Evaluate this view. The effects of enterprise policies The impact of these policies to encourage enterprise and innovation is greatest among smaller organisations. It has a substantial impact on strategic decisions made by the owners of such businesses by influencing decisions on whether to start an enterprise or to expand it. However, these policies also stimulate innovation in organisations of all sizes. In many ways, this could affect functional decision-making significantly as managers seek to expand operations, hire additional employees to produce innovative products and plan marketing campaigns to promote them. 231 9781398308114.indb 231 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 6.1.2.2 How governments might constrain business activity In the previous chapter, we considered a range of laws which might constrain the activities of businesses. For example, many governments have passed laws constraining the production, sale and consumption of certain products such as alcohol, tobacco and gambling. Laws that affect businesses are supplemented by regulations in many countries. Regulations are used to set out how businesses should respond to laws. The most common forms of regulation are government regulation and self-regulation. Government regulation is a natural extension of legislation, in that it defines and controls some of the ways that a business or individual can operate in order to follow the law. A very straightforward example is food packaging in Canada, which must, at the very least, be packaged with both English and French wording. The use of regulation Regulation can relate to a variety of business activities, including pricing and their impact on the environment. There are a number of aspects of regulation that affect business activity in the UK and shape the economic environment in which all firms operate. These include: » Regulation with the aim of creating free and fair competition between businesses Regulation can relate to any industry or business in the UK that is not operating in the best interests of consumers. The focus of most regulation is to protect the consumer by ensuring that there is sufficient competition within specific industries and to eliminate any trading activities that are not in the interests of consumers. Such activities may include businesses limiting the range and variety of products available to consumers. Regulators can take a number of actions to protect the interest of consumers, such as controlling prices, taxing profits that are judged to be ‘excessive’, and allowing new entrants to an industry to have access to the facilities of existing producers. Regulations constraining business activity operate in every country. In 2020, Chinese regulators investigated Luckin Coffee Inc for uncompetitive activities; at the same time, regulators in America were investigating whether Apple’s credit card infringed some of the country’s rules. » Regulation of certain high-profile industries such as banking Some industries in the UK and elsewhere are regulated particularly closely because of their potential to act against the interests of consumers or their ability to damage the economy. Banking and financial services are examples of such industries. Governments in a number of countries have passed new laws constraining the activities of banks and other businesses supplying financial services such as insurance. These new laws have led to regulations which are imposed and monitored by relevant authorities, often central banks. In 2020, the banking regulator in the United Arab Emirates investigated the behaviour of a Pakistani bank to determine whether or not it had breached the country’s financial laws. » Regulation of privatised monopolies to protect consumers and other businesses We saw in Chapter 6.1.1 that privatisation brings advantages and disadvantages. Regulations are used to protect consumers, especially when state-owned monopolies have been privatised. In the late-twentieth century, the UK privatised many state-owned monopolies that supplied products including water, electricity and gas during the 1980s and 1990s. This meant that these monopolies became private companies and the government established regulators (Ofwat, Ofgem and Ofcom, for example) to ensure that the companies did not abuse their market positions. The role of these regulators is to act to ensure that consumers’ interests and those of other businesses are protected and that these natural monopolies do not charge excessive prices and make excessive profits. » Self-regulation In some industries, governments have permitted self-regulation to operate, usually through a code of conduct which all businesses within the industry agree to abide by. The government reserves the right to impose legal controls if a code of conduct is judged to be ineffective. Such self-regulation can be overseen to ensure that firms in industries subject to legal controls operate properly and as intended. For example, the Indian government has proposed using self-regulation to control the content that is available on the internet throughout the country. India already uses self-regulation to limit the activities of the print and broadcast media. Other ways in which governments might constrain business activity Governments can intervene in markets to constrain the activities of businesses in other ways apart from imposing regulations. » By subsidising production of good and services When a government offers a business or an industry a subsidy, it effectively pays a part of the costs of production. This encourages a greater increase in output of that product as it becomes more profitable to produce it. However, this can have negative effects on those businesses that supply goods and services which compete with the subsidised products. In a number of countries, governments offer subsidies to kerosene producers. These affect the competitiveness of businesses supplying gas or solar power and may result in some failing or not growing as they might have done without the subsidies to their competitors. » Providing information on products Many consumers are unable to make informed and good-quality buying decisions on health and education products. Governments intervene in a range of markets through the use of advertising to give consumers relevant information to help them make better buying decisions. Such advertising may impact negatively on industries such as those supplying alcohol, tobacco and gambling. 232 9781398308114.indb 232 05/03/21 11:08 AM » Implementing a range of economic policies We shall see later in this chapter that governments can intervene in markets by implementing a range of policies, such as altering interest rates or changing the level of expenditure on goods and services supplied by privately owned businesses. One reason for governments to intervene in the operation of a market is market failure. When a market operates correctly, it responds to the signals given by prices and increases or reduces the resources used by businesses in the market to supply more or less of the product. Over time, global oil prices have risen from $30 per barrel in 2016 to more than $60 per barrel at the start of 2020. The price has risen because consumers of oil (individuals and businesses) have demanded more of the product. In response to the signal of rising prices, oil companies have sourced new supplies of oil and have increased production. The failure of markets to work properly can come about for a number of reasons. Most governments have taken steps to attempt to limit the extent of each type of market failure. 1 Monopolies and cartels The existence of monopolies and cartels might mean producers have too much power, resulting in insufficient output and high prices. As a consequence, consumers may receive too little of certain products, resulting in a lower standard of living. Governments frequently pass laws to encourage competition and to restrict a wide range of anticompetitive activities. Such laws prohibit the abuse of monopoly power (for example, by raising prices excessively to boost profit margins) and the operation of cartels. Such laws protect consumers from the adverse effects of monopoly power. Offending firms are normally fined, sometimes very heavily. 2 Damage to the environment Producers that pollute the environment are not paying the full costs of production. For example, they might discharge toxic waste into a river rather than paying for it to be taken away and treated. These costs are imposed on someone else. It is often governments (and therefore taxpayers) that have to pay to clean up the pollution. This means that part of the costs of production are paid by a third party. Costs passed on in this way are called external costs, and they can result in severe environmental damage and problems for future generations. This type of market failure creates oversupply of certain products as producers (and ultimately consumers) do not pay the full cost of production. Some industries (for example, palm oil producers) have received criticism for the environmental damage arising from the deforestation that has accompanied huge increases in the supply of this type of oil. 6.1.2 6.1.2.3 How governments deal with market failure 6.1.2.3 How governments deal with market failure Governments tend to control external costs in three main ways. They can impose indirect taxes (that is, a tax that adds to the selling price of a product) with the aim of raising the costs of production to account for the external costs paid by other groups in society. This should lead to higher prices and lower profit margins, discouraging production and consumption of the products. Alternatively, governments can levy fines on businesses that damage the environment and thereby impose costs on others. Finally, a government may pass laws to ban processes and products that cause external costs. 3 Consumers and producers possess insufficient information about products Some consumers may have too little information about the benefits of buying products, such as health and education services. As a result, they may buy too little of them and there will be an inadequate supply of these products – this is a form of market failure. Governments frequently intervene in these markets to encourage consumers to buy these types of products, either by subsidising them or by supplying the products themselves and providing them without charges. This form of market failure is likely to result in undersupply, as too few resources are allocated to producing goods and services in these markets. However, it can also result in the over-consumption of some products (drugs, for example) if consumers are unaware of the dangers they pose. To overcome this type of market failure, governments frequently provide information about the benefits or drawbacks of products. For example, in many countries there have been health information programmes to advise smokers of the danger to health of consuming tobacco. Many such programmes have been successful and there has been a sharp decline in tobacco consumption in many countries. 4 Poaching of skilled labour If a business invests heavily in training its workforce to provide jobrelated skills, it can expect a consequent increase in productivity as a reward for devoting resources to training. However, one possible outcome is that highly skilled employees become attractive to rival businesses, who are able to offer them higher wages as they have not paid the training costs. Such poaching of labour can result in too few resources being allocated to training for fear of poaching. Thus, the market fails. Overcoming the poaching of labour is difficult for any government. If it has sufficient funds available, it may provide some training itself and can offer tax benefits to businesses that engage in staff training. However, such approaches can be very costly to have any significant effect. GLOSSARY TERM Market failure occurs when a market does not work properly and resources are not allocated correctly. 233 9781398308114.indb 233 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 STUDY TIP Market failure is a strong argument for government intervention in the economy and can provide a powerful line of analysis when responding to questions on the merits (or otherwise) of state involvement in the business environment. 6.1.2.4 Macroeconomic objectives of governments and their impact on business activity Every government in the world operates with a number of macroeconomic objectives. The key macroeconomic objectives for the UK are as follows. » Sustainable economic growth This means that the value of the economy’s entire production of goods and services should increase over time. However, this should be at a rate which is sustainable – this means that it can be maintained over time while minimising the damage to the environment. » A steady and low rate of inflation The UK government’s inflation target at the time of writing is 2.0 per cent, meaning that it aims to have prices rising in the UK at this rate annually. This is a major economic objective which the Bank of England pursues on behalf of the government. » Low levels of unemployment It is not possible to eliminate all unemployment in an economy. The UK government (along with many others) wants to achieve a level of employment whereby those who are able and willing to work have a job. These macroeconomic objectives have implications for businesses, as they influence the economic environment in which all businesses operate. In the following sections, we will look at each of the government’s main economic objectives in more detail, along with the impact they can have on business activity. Economic growth the rate of economic growth result in the business cycle, which we consider later in this section. If the rate of economic growth is negative (that is, if the economy is getting smaller) for six consecutive months, then it is said to be in recession. Economic growth is normally judged through the changes in the level of gross domestic product (GDP), which measures the value of a nation’s output of goods and services. In February 2020, the GDP of the UK was £2 264 855 million. The population of the UK is approximately 66 million, giving a GDP per head (or per capita) equal to £34 316. Governments seek to increase this figure over time, as it represents a rise in the country’s standard of living. Most countries’ economies experience economic growth over a period of time, though, in the short term, economies may stagnate or even decline in size. Figure 6.9 illustrates the quarterly economic growth rates for the UK from 2010 until 2020. Governments usually aim to maintain steady and sustained economic growth over a period of time. However, this is a difficult target to achieve, as the operation of the business cycle tends to create the fluctuations apparent in Figure 6.9. Governments use counter-cyclical policies (including control via interest rates and taxation levels) to attempt to eliminate the more extreme fluctuations. High rates of economic growth are not desirable, as they tend to result in slumps whereby economic growth may become negative. Governments can stimulate growth as a consequence of their economic policies. Short-term growth can be encouraged by cuts in interest rates and taxation which fuel borrowing and spending, leading to greater output and, hence, economic growth. The danger is, however, that firms and individuals purchase products from overseas, promoting growth in foreign economies. Supplyside policies may be put in place to achieve sustained economic growth. This type of policy involves increasing the productive capability of the economy by improving the skills of the workforce, encouraging more people into employment and promoting competition within markets to increase output and GDP. Economic growth is an increase in the value of goods and services produced by a nation’s economy. Fluctuations in GLOSSARY TERMS Macroeconomics is the study of the behaviour of a whole economy and the factors that can influence it. Unemployment is the number of people who are seeking a job but are unable to secure one. Microeconomics is the study of smaller parts of an economy, such as the behaviour and decision-making of businesses and individual consumers. A recession is characterised by falling levels of demand and declining levels of output and employment over at least a six-month period. Economic growth is an increase in the value of goods and services produced by a nation’s economy over a period of time. A slump takes place when production is at its lowest, unemployment is high and there are many business failures. Inflation is a sustained rise in the general price level and a corresponding fall in the value of money. Supply-side policies are a range of measures designed to improve the free operation of markets and, therefore, the total amount that is produced (or supplied) by an economy. 234 9781398308114.indb 234 05/03/21 11:08 AM 3 6.1.2 GDP 2.5 2 1 2010 2012 2014 2016 2018 2020 Year Source: Trading Economics (Office for National Statistics) ▲ Figure 6.9 Economic growth rates in the UK, 2010–20 CASE STUDY UK’s economic growth slows The UK’s Office for National Statistics (ONS) has stated that growth in gross domestic product (GDP) was flat overall in the last quarter of 2019, as consumer spending was low over the Christmas shopping period and manufacturing output fell sharply. The growth rate slowed in the third quarter of 2019, although annual growth did increase slightly to 1.4 per cent in 2019, just above the 2018 economic growth rate of 1.3 per cent. However, the ONS reported that the economy grew by 0.3 per cent in December from the previous month, faster than expected, and suggesting that the decline in economic growth might be short-lived. Surveys show that the service sector – which accounts for about 80 per cent of the economy and includes hotels, shops and restaurants – also recovered to show the strongest growth since mid-2018. However, economists said the underlying momentum of the economy slowed over the year as a whole. Manufacturing output fell sharply in the fourth quarter, owing to weaker levels of production in the car industry, effectively finishing 2019 in recession after three consecutive quarters in contraction. The ONS said quarterly GDP growth had been declining during 2019, continuing the slowing that has been experienced over the previous five years. Questions 1 2 Analyse one reason why economic growth is an important macroeconomic objective for most governments. [4] ‘The economic data provided in the case study represents bad news for all UK businesses.’ Evaluate [12] this view. The case for economic growth is not clear-cut. Growth brings disadvantages as well as advantages for businesses. These arguments are summarised in Table 6.3. 6.1.2.4 Macroeconomic objectives of governments and their impact on business activity 1.5 ▼ Table 6.3 The benefits and drawbacks of economic growth for businesses The benefits The drawbacks • High rates of economic growth provide the government • Not all regions within an economy benefit equally during with increased tax revenues permitting greater periods of economic growth. For example, firms selling in expenditure on health, education and transport, prosperous regions of a country are likely to enjoy increased benefiting all businesses and encouraging further growth. sales, while those in less prosperous regions may only see a • Growth provides opportunities for all in society. marginal increase in revenues. Individuals benefit from greater chances of promotion; • Growth may result in shortages of labour and other materials. high levels of consumer spending encourage enterprise. This may result in higher wages and prices, fuelling inflation Businesses small and large may thrive in a growing and creating uncertainty among the business community. environment. • Growth places individuals and businesses under pressure. • Businesses generally enjoy higher sales and increased Workloads increase and decisions may be rushed. In these profits. Expansion is likely for firms selling income circumstances, it may prove impossible to maintain the quality elastic products such as cars and foreign holidays. of management and businesses may lose co-ordination and a Growth creates new markets for products. clear sense of direction. 235 9781398308114.indb 235 05/03/21 11:08 AM Economic growth and the business cycle All countries suffer fluctuations in the level of GDP and business activity within their economies. At times spending, output and employment all rise; during other periods, the opposite is true. The value of a country’s output over a period of time is measured by a nation’s gross domestic product – this figure is dependent upon the level of economic activity. A rising level of economic activity will be reflected in a higher level of GDP. GLOSSARY TERM The level of economic activity refers to the amount of spending and production in an economy. Governments generally aim to have smooth increases in the level of economic activity over time. The business cycle describes the regular fluctuations in economic activity (and GDP) occurring over time in economies. Figure 6.10 illustrates a typical business cycle. Trade cycles generally have four stages: » Recovery or upswing as the economy recovers from a slump; production and employment both begin to increase. Consumers will generally spend more in these circumstances as they are more confident in the security of their employment. Initially, businesses may respond cautiously to signs of increasing consumer confidence. No major decisions are required to meet rising demand while spare capacity exists – firms simply begin to utilise idle factories, offices and other assets. As business confidence increases, firms may take the decision to invest in further non-current assets (factories, machinery and vehicles, for example). Employees experience less difficulty in finding jobs and wages may begin to rise. » A boom follows with high levels of production and expenditure by firms, consumers and the government. Booms are normally characterised by prosperity and confidence in the business community. Investment in non-current assets is likely to increase at such times. However, many sectors of the economy will experience Gross domestic product A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 Boom pressure during booms. Skilled workers may become scarce and firms competing for workers may offer higher wages. Simultaneously, as the economy approaches maximum production, shortages and bottlenecks will occur as insufficient raw materials and components exist to meet demand. Inevitably this will result in their prices rising. The combination of rising wages and rising prices of raw materials and components will create inflation. It is the existence of inflation that usually leads to the end of a boom. » A recession occurs when incomes and output start to fall. Technically a recession exists once GDP has fallen for two successive three-month periods – that is, for six months. Falling sales will begin to eat into businesses’ profits. In circumstances such as this, governments in the UK and elsewhere have tended to lower interest rates in an attempt to stimulate demand and sales. Despite the falling interest rates, falling profits are likely to result in plans to invest in new factories and offices being delayed or abandoned. The level of production in the economy as a whole may stagnate or even fall. The amount of spare capacity within the economy will rise. Some businesses will fail and the level of bankruptcies is likely to rise. » A slump often, but not always, follows a recession. In some circumstances, an economy may enter the upswing stage of the business cycle without moving through a slump period. Governments may take action to encourage this by, for example, increasing their own spending or lowering interest rates. A slump sees production at its lowest, with high unemployment, and increasing numbers of firms will fail. Figure 6.10 illustrates a smooth and regular trade cycle in operation. In reality, the change in gross domestic product is likely to be irregular, as economic cycles of different duration and intensity operate simultaneously. The business cycle is a major influence on the performance of businesses. As the economy moves from one stage of the cycle to another, businesses can expect to see substantial changes in their trading conditions. Trend of r time GDP ove Recovery or upswing Recession or downswing Slump 0 Time ▲ Figure 6.10 The stages of the business cycle 236 9781398308114.indb 236 05/03/21 11:08 AM The impact of economic growth and the business cycle 6.1.2 Table 6.4 identifies some actions that different businesses might take in response to the business cycle. However, not all businesses are equally affected by the changing trading conditions, as summarised in Table 6.5. ▼ Table 6.4 The trade cycle and business actions Key features Likely reactions by business • • • • • • Opportunity to charge higher prices • Rising numbers of business start-ups • Businesses take decisions to invest in non-current assets • Businesses operate nearer to (or at) full capacity Boom • Rate of inflation increases • Bottlenecks in supply of materials and components • Some firms unable to satisfy demand • Profits probably high – but hit by rising costs • Firms face increasing pressure to increase prices • Businesses seek alternative methods to increase output • Wage rises offered to retain or attract skilled labour • Managers plan for falling levels of demand Recession • • • • Government reduces interest rates Firms reduce production as demand falls Spare capacity rises Business confidence declines and investment is cut • Profits fall • Firms seek new markets for products – possibly overseas • Some products may be stockpiled • Workers laid off – or asked to work short-time • Financially insecure firms may become bankrupt or insolvent Slump • Increasing number of bankruptcies and insolvencies • Government lowers interest rates further • High levels of unemployment • Low levels of business confidence and consumer spending • • • • Increasing consumer expenditure Existing spare capacity used Production rises Business confidence strengthens Investment increases Firms offer basic products at low prices Businesses may close factories to reduce capacity Large-scale redundancies may occur Marketing concentrates on low prices and easy payment deals ▼ Table 6.5 Products affected and unaffected by the business cycle Firms supplying these products may be significantly affected by the business cycle Firms supplying these products are unlikely to be affected to a great extent by the business cycle – in fact demand may rise for some of these products in a recession/slump • • • • • • • • • Leisure air travel Sports and leisure goods Jewellery Household furniture Cars A number of businesses may find that demand for their products is relatively unaffected as the business cycle moves through its stages and the rate of economic growth alters. Producers and retailers of basic foodstuffs, public transport and water services may notice little change in demand for their products. This is because these are essential items consumers continue to purchase even when their incomes are falling – demand for them is not sensitive to changes in income. Demand for other categories of products is more sensitive to changes in income levels and therefore the stages of the business cycle. Examples include foreign holidays, electrical Fuel, including petrol, gas and electricity Cigarettes and tobacco Water and sewage services Unbranded basic foods 6.1.2.4 Macroeconomic objectives of governments and their impact on business activity Stage of business cycle Recovery or upswing products such as televisions and laptops, and construction materials such as bricks and windows. Businesses selling basic foodstuffs might have to take little or no action to survive a recession; in fact, demand for their products might increase as consumers switch from more expensive alternatives. At the other extreme, businesses supplying materials to the construction industry could be hard hit, as firms delay or abandon plans to extend factories and build new offices. Their position might be made worse by a fall in demand for new houses, as hard-up consumers abandon schemes to move home. 237 9781398308114.indb 237 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 CASE STUDY Pakistan misses economic growth target government should take action to support the country’s economy to achieve sustained economic growth. In its report, the SBP pointed out that the output of Pakistan’s larger manufacturing businesses fell by nearly 6 per cent in comparison with the previous year. The industries affected by this decline included construction and vehicle manufacturing. In view of this, the report suggested that Pakistan could not be expected to achieve its GDP growth target of 4 per cent. The central bank has previously predicted a growth rate of around 3.5 per cent for Pakistan’s economy; other economists fear it might be as low as 2.4 per cent. The country’s growth rate would need to be around 7 per cent to maintain living standards for its rapidly-growing population. ▲ Figure 6.11 The State Bank of Pakistan Questions Pakistan’s central bank has estimated that the rate of economic growth in the country for the financial year 2019–20 will not reach the 4 per cent target that was set. 1 The State Bank of Pakistan (SBP) has analysed Pakistan’s economic performance and recommended that the HANDLING DATA Assume that Pakistan’s average annual population growth is 1.75 per cent. Given that the country had 219 million inhabitants in 2019, what will be the revised forecast for 2025? Economic growth and the business cycle are permanent features of the economic environment for firms. The effects of changes in the business cycle vary from industry to industry. Firms selling goods whose demand is sensitive to changes in income (known as income elastic goods), such as designer clothes and foreign holidays, may find that sales rise in a boom and fall during recession. Conversely, businesses selling staple products, such as foodstuffs, where demand is not income elastic may be relatively unaffected by the business cycle. It is possible to argue that the business cycle will only provoke short-term responses in many firms, because its effects are relatively short-lived. Booms and slumps do not last forever and businesses can take actions to see them through difficult trading periods. During boom periods, managers may increase prices to restrict demand and increase profitability; they may subcontract work to other firms or seek supplies from overseas. Equally, in conditions of recession or slump, lay-offs may occur or short-time working may take place while overseas markets are targeted to increase sales. Well-managed firms will predict the onset of a boom or slump and take appropriate action in advance. 2 Analyse two effects on businesses in Pakistan of the country’s rapid growth in population. [8] ‘The expected fall in the economic growth rate will have differing impacts on the country’s businesses.’ Evaluate this view. [12] Short-term responses may be all that are required if governments are successful in eradicating the more extreme effects of the business cycle. Inflation Inflation can be defined as a persistent rise in the price level and the associated fall in the value of money. For many businesses, a low rate of inflation is not a problem. As long as wages are rising at about the same rate or higher, a low constant rate of price increase simply serves to help maintain demand. Inflation only becomes a major problem for businesses when it is high, rising rapidly or (worst of all) is doing both together. Inflation in the UK, and in many industrialised nations throughout the world, has been at historically low rates over the last 15 years or so. The UK’s rate of inflation was 0.7 per cent (as measured by the CPI – see below) in September 2020, and is forecast to remain around 2 per cent until 2023. How is inflation measured? The UK government measures the rate of inflation by use of the Consumer Price Index (CPI). The CPI was introduced in December 2003 and measures the average monthly change in the prices of goods and services purchased by households in the UK. The government will use this to set targets for inflation in the future. The CPI is calculated using more than 700 separate goods and services for which price changes are measured throughout the country. 238 9781398308114.indb 238 05/03/21 11:08 AM » Wage rises If trade unions and employees are successful The causes of inflation There are a number of factors that may cause inflation. Economists tend to classify the causes of inflation as demand-pull or cost-push factors. The cause of inflation can be an important factor for businesses as it provides some indication of likely future government policies to control inflation. Demand-pull inflation Cost-push inflation Cost-push inflation occurs when firms face increasing costs due to factors such as rising wages or increasing costs of raw materials and components. This type of inflation can arise from a number of sources. 6.1.2 6.1.2.4 Macroeconomic objectives of governments and their impact on business activity Demand-pull inflation occurs when the demand for the country’s goods and services exceeds its ability to supply these products. As a consequence, prices rise generally as a means of restricting demand to the available supply. The underlying cause of this might be the government allowing firms and businesses to have too much money to spend, perhaps as a consequence of cutting taxes or lowering interest rates. in negotiating pay increases significantly above the rate of inflation, then further price rises might be the result. This becomes more likely if productivity is not increasing, allowing businesses to offset some of the increased wage costs against additional production. However, labour market conditions can influence the rate of wage increases and, therefore, inflation. For example, wages in Spain fell by about 20 per cent between July 2011 and January 2014 as jobs were scarce and the rate of unemployment rose above 20 per cent. This contributed to the country’s very low inflation rate. » Imported inflation One of the hidden causes of inflation is rises in import prices. The UK and Belgium are susceptible to this type of inflation as they are ‘open’ economies, importing large quantities of raw materials, components and finished goods. Import prices rise when the exchange rate is falling and more of the domestic currency is required to purchase a given amount of a foreign currency. Although exporters might complain about rising exchange rates, they do help to control inflation. GLOSSARY TERMS The Consumer Price Index (CPI) measures the rate of inflation based on the changes in prices of a basket of goods and services. Cost-push inflation happens when firms face increasing costs due to rising wages or increasing costs of raw materials and components. Demand-pull inflation occurs when the demand for the country’s goods and services exceeds its ability to supply these products. 6 CPI 4 2 0 –2 2010 2012 2014 2016 2018 2020 Year Source: https://tradingeconomics.com/united-kingdom/inflation-cpi ▲ Figure 6.12 Inflation in the UK 2010–20 239 9781398308114.indb 239 05/03/21 11:08 AM Comparing the rates of inflation in Uruguay and Indonesia The annual inflation rate in Uruguay increased to 10.86 per cent in April 2020 from 8.32 per cent in the previous month. It was the highest inflation rate since June 2016, as prices rose further for food and non-alcoholic products, and housing. Uruguay’s exports declined by 40 per cent between April 2019 and March 2020. Indonesia’s annual inflation rate declined to 2.67 per cent in April 2020, the lowest since March 2019 and below market expectations of 2.77 per cent. Prices rose more slowly for housing and utilities, food, drinks, and food and restaurant services. On a monthly basis, consumer prices rose 0.08 per cent in April, the least since October 2019. 10 CPI 8 6 4 2 2010 2012 2014 2016 2018 2020 Year Source: https://tradingeconomics.com/uruguay/inflation-cpi ▲ Figure 6.13 Inflation in Uruguay 2010–20 10 8 CPI A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 CASE STUDY 6 4 2 2010 2012 2014 2016 2018 2020 Year Source: https://tradingeconomics.com/indonesia/inflation-cpi ▲ Figure 6.14 Inflation in Indonesia 2010–20 Questions 1 Analyse one likely effect of Uruguay’s high rate of inflation on its businesses. 2 [4] ‘Indonesian businesses have operated in a better macroeconomic environment than those in Uruguay.’ Evaluate this view. [12] 240 9781398308114.indb 240 05/03/21 11:08 AM The impact of inflation on business Types of unemployment Inflation can have a number of effects on businesses. » Many businesses may suffer falling sales in a period of inflation. Consumers might be expected to spend more during inflationary periods, as they would not wish to hold an asset that is falling in value. However, research shows that people save more (perhaps due to uncertainty) and sales for many businesses fall. » It can be difficult to maintain competitiveness (and especially international competitiveness) during bouts of inflation. Rising wages and raw material costs may force firms to raise prices or accept lower profit margins. Firms operating in countries with lower rates of inflation may gain the edge in terms of price competitiveness under such circumstances. People can be unemployed for a number of reasons. Governments find it useful to distinguish between the various types of unemployment, as each type requires a different remedy. Although many different types of unemployment exist, we shall focus on three main types. Unemployment Unemployment remains an important issue in most countries. It is important because it represents a waste of resources if labour is unused: if all available workers were used, the country concerned would be able to produce more and its citizens would enjoy a higher standard of living. The social effects of high and prolonged rates of unemployment can be devastating – poor health and crime are just two factors associated with unemployment and poverty. 1 Structural unemployment Economies continually change: some industries die and others emerge to replace them. Structural unemployment occurs due to fundamental changes in the economy whereby some industries reach the end of their lives. Structural unemployment occurs for a number of reasons: – the adoption of new methods of production – significant and permanent changes in demand – increasing competition from overseas – rising income levels, meaning demand for some products declines. 6.1.2.4 Macroeconomic objectives of governments and their impact on business activity Inflation can offer some benefits to businesses, however. Some analysts suggest that low and stable rates of inflation may be beneficial. A steady rise in profits can create favourable expectations and encourage investment by businesses. Inflation can also encourage long-term borrowing and investment by businesses, as the value of their repayments (in real terms) declines over time. 6.1.2 But structural change in the economy also offers opportunities to businesses. Rising incomes and technological developments have led to the development of the mobile phone industry. This industry employs a large number of people in manufacturing the product, supplying networks and in retail outlets. Structural unemployment is a difficult problem for governments to solve. Because large numbers of employees may no longer have the skills that employers require, training is an important part of any solution. Other approaches include encouraging foreign producers to establish themselves in the country to provide employment for those with skills not needed by domestic businesses. The UK has been particularly successful in attracting motorvehicle producers from across the world. GLOSSARY TERM Structural unemployment occurs due to fundamental changes in the economy whereby some industries reach the end of their lives. 9 Unemployment rate 8 7 6 5 4 3 2010 2012 2014 2016 2018 2020 Year Note: The unemployment rate is the percentage of the workforce who do not have a job but are looking for one. ▲ Figure 6.15 UK unemployment Source: https://tradingeconomics.com/united-kingdom/unemployment-rate 241 9781398308114.indb 241 05/03/21 11:08 AM 6.1.2 Competition from overseas New methods of production Causes A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic Effects Changing patterns of demand Structural unemployment Certain skills no longer needed New opportunities Localised unemployment ▲ Figure 6.16 Causes and effects of structural unemployment 2 Cyclical unemployment Cyclical unemployment arises from the operation of the business cycle – a topic we considered in detail earlier in this chapter. The boom stage of a business cycle will see this type of unemployment minimised as firms increase their production levels. At this stage of the business cycle, those who have been unemployed for some time (and with relatively few skills) may find work. At the other extreme, much of the unemployment experienced during a slump will be cyclical. The effects of cyclical unemployment can be considerable as unemployment increases substantially in the move into recession. Some businesses seek to protect themselves against cyclical unemployment by the introduction of profit-related pay. Such schemes allow pay to fall during a recession along with profits, reducing the need to make workers redundant. 3 Frictional unemployment People moving between jobs cause frictional unemployment. If a person leaves one job, they may not be able to move into a new position immediately. While they are searching for new employment, they are classified as frictionally unemployed. The government providing improved information on job vacancies available may reduce the level of frictional unemployment. A healthy economy will have some amount of frictional unemployment as people move between jobs. GLOSSARY TERMS Cyclical unemployment is caused by the operation of the business cycle, rising in slumps and falling in booms. Frictional unemployment exists because people may be temporarily out of work between leaving one job and starting another. Inventories are the raw materials and other items necessary for production to take place. They also include finished products that have not yet been sold. STUDY TIP It is important to relate the impact of unemployment (or changes in other economic factors) to the precise type of business under consideration. Some businesses rely heavily on labour as a key element of production – this is more likely to be true of businesses that supply services. Hence, a change in the level of unemployment will have a greater impact on this type of business. The impact on businesses of changing unemployment levels Rises in unemployment can have serious implications for businesses, though the precise impact and likely responses of firms will depend upon their circumstances and the type of unemployment. Cyclical unemployment might result in businesses suffering from falling sales. In the short term, firms may be able to add any surplus production to inventories. Alternatively, businesses may seek new markets, perhaps by selling overseas. Not all businesses will be equally affected by changes in unemployment levels. Businesses selling essential products may be relatively unaffected by cyclical unemployment, while suppliers of luxury products could suffer substantial reductions in sales. Structural unemployment can have a significant effect on businesses because it is frequently highly localised and often very persistent. For example, high levels of unemployment suffered by former coal-mining communities would have considerable implications for most businesses in the locality. Unemployment brought about by the decline of an industry also has an impact upon associated industries. For example, falling production in the UK’s shipbuilding industry contributed to the decline in the country’s steel industry. If there is a need to reduce output then rationalisation and redundancy might follow and factories and offices may be closed. Research and development plans may be abandoned or postponed as firms seek to reduce their costs to match their (reduced) revenues. A predicted fall in the level of demand may encourage the firm to diversify, possibly into foreign markets. Businesses may consider mergers with other firms to help reduce costs or to broaden product ranges. Periods of low unemployment cause different problems for businesses and provoke different responses. Falling unemployment and accompanying skill shortages create problems that take time to solve. Businesses look to the government to assist through the provision of state training schemes and the development of relevant vocational courses in schools and colleges. In the UK, governments have attempted to support industry in these ways. Migration is the movement of people between countries or regions with the intention of settling in the new location. 242 9781398308114.indb 242 05/03/21 11:08 AM » Businesses may invest in training schemes to develop the required skills in their employees. This may entail giving relatively junior or unskilled employees additional skills to enable them to carry out a wider range of activities. This can be a risky approach, however, as unscrupulous competitors may poach skilled employees once training is completed. The skills shortage creates difficulties for many businesses and opportunities for others. Recruitment agencies and firms providing training for other businesses may enjoy increasing demands for their services during a period of skill shortages. CASE STUDY Global migration 20% and over 10–19% 5–9% 1–4% <1% No data Source: United Nations Report on International Migration, 2019 (page 13) ▲ Figure 6.17 International migrants as a percentage of the total population, 2019 Migration is the movement of people between different countries. Over the last 20 years, many European and North American countries have experienced significant inflows of migrants from parts of the Middle East, Africa and Asia. According to the UN, ‘in 2019, more than half of all international migrants worldwide lived in Europe and Northern America, with roughly 82 million residing in Europe and nearly 59 million in Northern America’. Although some people have left countries in Europe and America, the inflows have generally been much larger, creating a positive net inflow of migrants. Figure 6.17 shows the percentage of the population that are migrants in most countries. The impact of migration depends upon a number of factors and not just the size of the net migration flow. If migrants possess suitable skills and are primarily of working age, they offer substantial benefits to businesses in countries such as the UK and Australia. They can assist in overcoming skill shortages and reduce the expenditure that firms must make on training. In addition, the increased supply of people into the labour market may help to prevent wages from rising. This is especially likely if migrants are willing to work for lower wage rates. 6.1.2 6.1.2.4 Macroeconomic objectives of governments and their impact on business activity However, businesses can take action. » Skill shortages encourage the development of capitalintensive methods of production in manufacturing and service industries. Using technology to replace labour can boost productivity, thereby enhancing international competitiveness. » Businesses may relocate to take advantage of more plentiful and cheaper sources of skilled labour. However, in the case of the UK, this may require location outside Europe as most of the EU is experiencing similar skill shortages. Source: United Nations Report on International Migration 2019 (page 6), www.un.org/en/development/desa/ population/migration/publications/migrationreport/ docs/InternationalMigration2019_Report.pdf Questions 1 2 Analyse two benefits that Australian businesses might receive from a net inflow of migrants. [8] Evaluate whether a net inflow of migrants affects the competitiveness of businesses in the receiving nation. [12] 243 9781398308114.indb 243 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 The economic environment and business strategy growth. These plans may include increasing innovation as part of the development of new products, entering new markets or pursuing a policy of takeovers and mergers. Figure 6.18 summarises some of the major economic variables that might impact upon businesses’ strategic planning and decision-making. The diagram also emphasises the interrelationships that exist between the elements that make up the economic environment for businesses. A business’ strategy is simply the long-term plans through which it seeks to attain its corporate objectives – that is, the objectives of the whole business. For example, a business may have growth as a major corporate objective and will develop plans to achieve the desired rate of Business cycle • Boom • Slump Unemployment varies according to stage of the business cycle Unemployment State of labour market • Type (e.g. frictional) • Skill surpluses • Location • Skill shortages • Migration flows • Skills in surplus Business strategy e.g. • Growth • Rationalisation Inflationary pressures more likely in a boom • Market dominance • Diversification • Technological leadership Inflation • Rate of price increase • Trend in price change • Rate relative to that in other countries Inflation and interest rates tend to rise and fall together Interest rates • Levels, relative to other nations • Trend: rising/falling Close links between interest and exchange rates Exchange rates • Level and trend • Affect all firms but especially those trading overseas ▲ Figure 6.18 Business strategy and the economic environment 6.1.2.5–7 Government macroeconomic policies and their impact on businesses Governments operate a number of different policies with the aim of providing the best possible economic environment for businesses. This entails adjusting the level of activity in the economy to avoid the excesses of booms and slumps. The government’s economic policies can be divided into the following categories: 1 Monetary policy Using this policy, the government (or the central bank, such as the Bank of England, acting on its behalf) manipulates the amount of money and/ or interest rates within the economy in order to achieve the desired level of economic activity. 2 Exchange rate policy This is often regarded as a part of monetary policy and involves the manipulation of the value of a country’s currency. This can affect the economy by changing the prices of exports and imports and, thereby, the price competitiveness of the country’s businesses. 244 9781398308114.indb 244 05/03/21 11:08 AM GLOSSARY TERMS Monetary policy is controlling the amount of money and/ or interest rates within the economy in order to achieve the desired level of economic activity. Exchange rate policy is the deliberate adjustment of the value of a country’s currency to achieve desired changes in the prices of imports and exports. Fiscal policy is the use of taxation and public expenditure to manage the level of activity in an economy. Monetary policy This type of economic policy involves adjusting the amount of money in circulation and, hence, the level of spending and economic activity. Monetary policy can make use of one or more of the following: » adjusting interest rates » controlling the money supply » manipulating the exchange rate (which we will consider separately). Although at times all three techniques have been used, more recently governments have tended to rely upon altering interest rates to manage the economy. Since 1997, in the UK, the Monetary Policy Committee of the Bank of England has had responsibility for setting interest rates. Giving this power to central banks is common in other countries, too. For example, the Reserve Bank of India performs a similar role. In the UK, the Monetary Policy Committee sets interest rates monthly with the aim of achieving the government’s target for inflation while attaining long-term growth in the economy. Table 6.6 highlights the aims that may lie behind authorities altering interest rates and, importantly, the implications for individuals and businesses. ▼ Table 6.6 Changes in interest rates – objectives, impact and business decisions Rising interest rates Falling interest rates The likely objectives of increasing interest rates include: • reducing the level of consumer spending • limiting inflationary pressure in the economy • slowing the level of economic growth (as measured by GDP) • avoiding increasing imports creating a deficit on the balance of payments. Reductions in interest rates may be introduced with the following objectives in mind: • reducing levels of unemployment • stimulating the level of production in the economy • promoting exports sales by reducing the exchange value of the currency • increasing rates of economic growth in the economy. (In general, higher interest rates will assist in dampening down an economic boom.) (Reducing interest rates can assist an economy in recovering from a slump.) The likely impact on businesses of increasing interest rates include: • Many businesses may experience falling sales as consumers increase savings. • Demand for products purchased on credit may decline significantly. • The cost of borrowing, whether short- or long-term, is likely to increase for businesses, possibly cutting profit margins. • Increased value of the currency increases the prices of exports while reducing import prices. The impact on businesses of falling interest rates include: • Demand and sales are likely to increase, especially for products bought on credit. • Production is likely to be stimulated, increasing employment. • Export sales of price-sensitive products may increase while imports become less competitive. • Businesses may undertake increased investment, promoting growth in industries such as construction. Examples of how businesses’ decisions may be affected by increasing interest rates include: • Businesses may cancel or defer investment plans as they may be too costly with higher interest rates. • Firms reduce levels of inventories as they seek to cut borrowing costs. • New marketing campaigns might be introduced, possibly based on low prices, to attract consumers. • Some businesses may seek to borrow money from overseas if interest rates are significantly lower in foreign countries. Examples of how businesses’ decisions may be affected by falling interest rates include: • Businesses may decide to increase investment in new factories and new products as borrowing is cheap and consumer spending may be forecast to rise. • Firms may invest in advertising campaigns to attract new customers at a time of cheap borrowing. • Businesses may offer attractive ‘buy now, pay later’ deals to attract customers as they can afford to increase borrowing to finance this. • Some businesses may seek to use cheap finance to finance takeovers of rivals or suppliers. 6.1.2 6.1.2.5–7 Government macroeconomic policies and their impact on businesses 3 Fiscal policy This refers to the government’s use of taxation and public expenditure to manage the economy. By adjusting the levels of taxation and government expenditure, the government can alter the level of activity within the economy. 4 Supply-side policies These are designed to improve the free operation of markets and, therefore, the total amount that is produced (or supplied) by the economy. Privatisation is one type of supply-side policy, along with limiting trade union power and providing training for unemployed workers. 245 9781398308114.indb 245 05/03/21 11:08 AM A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 Broadly speaking, rises in interest rates depress the level of economic activity and reductions promote an expansion of economic activity. Interest rates are the price of borrowed money. Although the Bank of England sets the base rate, many other interest rates operate in the UK. The precise rate of interest charged on a loan depends on several factors, including the time period of the loan and the degree of risk attached to it. In the UK, expenditure is particularly sensitive to changes in interest rates. One prime reason for this is mortgage interest payments. Millions of UK consumers have mortgages, which are large loans taken out to purchase houses. A rise in interest rates increases the payments made on mortgages, leaving less money available for other types of expenditure. Similarly, a cut in rates reduces mortgage payments, freeing money for other forms of expenditure. The impact on businesses and their decisions of changes in interest rates The impact of rising interest rates will depend upon the size of the change as well as the initial rate. A small increase at a relatively high level of rates will have little impact, while a larger increase from a low base rate will have a significant impact, prompting businesses to take significant decisions. Not all businesses are affected equally. We can identify several categories of businesses that are particularly susceptible to changes in interest rates: » Small firms are often affected greatly by changes in interest rates, as they have smaller financial reserves and a relatively greater need for borrowing. The Bank of England estimates that every 1 per cent rise in interest rates costs the UK’s 1.5 million small firms an extra £200 million in interest rate payments. Significant rises in interest rates can lead to substantial increases in bankruptcies or insolvencies among small firms. » Even larger firms with high levels of borrowing can be affected by alterations in interest rates. For example, a rise in rates can lead to a hefty increase in interest payments, forcing firms to reduce costs elsewhere or to pass on the extra expenses in the form of higher prices – if this is possible. Alternatively, a cut in interest rates offers a substantial reduction in expenses to such firms, improving their competitiveness. » Firms trading overseas are affected by alterations in interest rates. Rising interest rates tend to lead to an increase in the country’s exchange rate. This occurs because individuals and businesses overseas purchase, say, rupees to invest in Indian financial institutions to benefit from higher interest rates. Rising demand for a currency tends to increase its price – or its exchange rate. A fall in interest rates would have the opposite effect. CASE STUDY Consumer debt worries in Russia The monetary authorities in Russia have been concerned by a sharp increase in unsecured borrowing by the country’s consumers. Any borrowing that is unsecured is not guaranteed by collateral such as property or other saleable assets. Credit cards and some bank loans are examples of unsecured borrowing. In 2019, around 5 million Russians were using more than 50 per cent of their incomes to repay unsecured loans. Any financial institution offering new loans of more than 10 000 roubles ($154) will be subject to the new rules. Before being able to offer unsecured loans, banks in Russia will be required to assess the extent of a consumer’s previous borrowing and the proportion of However, it is not only the direct effects of altering interest rates that affect businesses. The use of interest rate policy by the authorities can have a profound impact upon the general economic environment in which businesses operate. The Reserve Bank of India changes interest rates to assist the Indian government in achieving its economic objectives. This means that altering rates affects the level income already used to repay existing debts. If banks do make any ‘risky’ unsecured loans, they will be required to hold increased reserves to cope with any consumers who do not repay their debts. Forecasts by the Russian Central Bank suggest that growth rate of consumer borrowing will decline in the last three months of 2019 to about 10 per cent, from 22 per cent in 2018. Questions 1 Evaluate whether or not the effects of a continued rise in unsecured borrowing will be entirely bad for [12] businesses in Russia. of unemployment, inflation and growth existing in the economy. Changes in interest rates also change business managers’ expectations of these key economic variables, affecting their day-to-day and strategic decisions. Table 6.7 illustrates the relationship that exists between the level of interest rates and key economic variables such as economic growth and unemployment. 246 9781398308114.indb 246 05/03/21 11:08 AM ▼ Table 6.7 Interest rates and other economic variables Rising interest rates Falling interest rates Unemployment Unemployment increases as levels of production decline Unemployment decreases as the level of economic activity rises Inflation Falling demand and output reduces inflationary pressure Increasing output and spending causes prices to rise, fuelling inflation Economic growth Will slow as businesses cut output and investment Is stimulated by cheaper loans and rising business investment Exchange rates Exchange value of currency is likely to rise Exchange value of currency generally falls Quantitative easing (QE) Since March 2009, interest rates in the UK have been held at very low levels by the Bank of England. In March 2020, the rate was cut to 0.1 per cent, the lowest figure ever, as part of the government’s response to the Coronavirus (COVID-19) crisis. Many other countries have very low rates of interest at the time of writing. Rates in Hungary, Hong Kong, South Korea, the USA and New Zealand are all below 1 per cent. Such low interest rates limit the flexibility of authorities responsible for monetary policy. There is no real possibility to lower rates further to expand production and to help the economy achieve higher rates of economic growth. When interest rates can go no lower, a central bank’s only monetary policy option is to pump money into the economy directly. That is quantitative easing (QE). The way the central bank does this is by buying assets – usually financial assets, such as government and corporate bonds – using money it has simply created. The institutions selling those assets (either commercial banks or other financial businesses such as insurance companies) will then have ‘new’ money in their accounts, which then boosts the money supply. The hope is that this money is subsequently used to purchase goods and services and to boost output and growth. In 2020, the UK government announced a new programme of quantitative easing with a total value of £200 billion to help to stimulate the economy as part of its response to the Coronavirus crisis. Quantitative easing has also been used by central banks in Japan, Sweden, the USA and Brazil. Business decisions and changes in monetary policy Businesses can be affected significantly by changes in monetary policy, both the use of quantitative easing and changes in interest rates. Such changes may prompt a range of decisions by businesses, depending on the scale and expected duration of any changes in monetary policy. We consider a small sample below. » Borrowing Changes in interest rates directly affect the cost of borrowing; quantitative easing can affect them indirectly. Businesses will be likely to adjust the amount they borrow and invest in the light of changes in 6.1.2 interest rates. For example, a period of very low interest rates (as is the case in North America and much of Europe at the time of writing) may encourage decisions on investment as any funds needed will be relatively cheap, making it likely the profits on a project will be higher. » Prices Reductions in interest rates may give a business more flexibility to raise prices as consumers will be more able to afford loans to buy products. A rise in rates might put pressure on businesses to reduce prices for some products – especially those (such as cars) normally bought using loans. » Product development Falling interest rates might encourage businesses to invest in developing new products as the cost of doing so may be reduced. Alternatively, rising rates may persuade businesses to adapt existing products to reduce production costs and boost price competitiveness. » Cutting costs Rising rates may provoke bouts of costcutting as businesses seek to reduce the debts on which they have to pay interest. This can lead to decisions affecting many parts of a business including the sale of assets, reductions in the size of the workforce and ceasing production of less successful products. GLOSSARY TERMS 6.1.2.5–7 Government macroeconomic policies and their impact on businesses Other economic variables Debt is an amount of money that has been borrowed by a business but not yet repaid. An exchange rate is the price of one currency expressed in terms of another. For example, the US dollar might be worth 0.78 euros. Exchange rates An exchange rate is simply the price of one currency expressed in terms of another. Thus, at a particular time, the Chinese yuan may be worth 3500 Vietnamese dong or 4.9 Thai baht. London is one of the premier international centres for buying and selling foreign currencies – each day transactions total billions of pounds. Exchange rates between most currencies vary regularly according to the balance of supply and demand for each individual currency. 247 9781398308114.indb 247 05/03/21 11:08 AM The effects of exchange rate changes A LEVEL 6.1.2 External influences on business activity: Economic 6.1.2 Exchange rates can change significantly over time. A rise in the value of a currency is an appreciation; a decline in its value is termed a depreciation. In October 2018, the American dollar exchanged for 32.49 Uruguayan pesos ($U). By May 2020, the exchange rate was $1 = $U44.21. This meant that the value of the Uruguayan peso had depreciated by just over 36 per cent over the period. Alternatively, the value of the American dollar had increased (or appreciated) by the same amount. HANDLING DATA In May 2020, an American company exported cars to Uruguay at an average price of $32 000 per car. Assuming no other changes, how much would an average car sell for in Uruguay? Changes in the value of currencies affect the prices of exports and imports, as shown in Table 6.8. ▼ Table 6.8 The effects of changes in the value of the Uruguayan peso The exchange rate of Uruguayan pesos Prices of Uruguayan exports overseas (in foreign currencies) Prices of imported goods in Uruguay (in pesos) Appreciates (rises) Increase Fall Depreciates (falls) Fall Increase Using the information in Table 6.8, we can see that the fall in the value of the Uruguayan peso against the American dollar between October 2018 and May 2020 would have had the following effects (assuming no other changes): » Prices of Uruguayan exports to the United States of America (for example, wool from its Corriedale sheep) would have fallen by approximately 36 per cent. Sales would be likely to rise as a consequence, and Uruguayan exporters would receive the same amount in pesos per kilogram of wool. » American products (for example, software for computers) imported by Uruguay would have been up to 36 per cent more expensive. However, the price the Americans received in dollars would not have changed. It is likely, however, that because prices were higher in Uruguay, American companies would sell smaller quantities of their products. Small changes in the exchange rates of most countries occur all the time as demand for the currency and supplies of it alter. A series of slight rises and falls over a period of time is not necessarily a major problem for industry. Of more concern is a sustained rise or fall in the exchange rate, or a sudden and substantial change in the exchange rate. Governments often seek to control fluctuations in exchange rates (as we shall see later this chapter), as exchange rate changes can create uncertainty for a number of reasons. » If firms agree deals priced in foreign currencies, they may receive more or less revenue from a particular transaction than expected if the exchange rate alters in the intervening period. Thus, a deal to sell clothes to France may give Bangladeshi manufacturers less revenue than anticipated if the contract is agreed in terms of euros and the Bangladeshi taka then rises in value against the euro. In these circumstances, the quantity of euros stated in the contract will convert into a smaller number of taka, causing a shortfall for the exporter. » Changing exchange rates can affect prices and sales in overseas markets, even if the exporter avoids direct exchange risk by insisting on payment in domestic currency. For example, a London-based clothes designer may sell clothes overseas but stipulate that they are paid in pounds sterling. A rise in the value of the pound may mean that foreign retailers are forced to increase the prices of the clothes to maintain profit margins. As a consequence, sales may be lower than expected, giving the London-based design company less revenue than forecast. » Competitors may respond in unexpected ways to exchange rate changes. Foreign firms may reduce prices to offset the effects of an exchange rate change, putting rivals under pressure to do the same or lose market share. ▼ Table 6.9 Changes in exchange rates Exporters How might Zimbabwean firms respond to a rising value of the Zimbabwean dollar? How might Zimbabwean firms respond to a falling value of the Zimbabwean dollar? • Allow prices to rise in foreign markets reducing probable sales. Remember, exporters receive the same price in dollars for each overseas sale but will sell less in this situation. • Leave prices unchanged in overseas markets. Sales should be unchanged but the exporter will receive fewer dollars from each sale. • Exporters could allow prices to fall in overseas markets as a result of the exchange rate change. They will receive the same amount in dollars from each sale but should achieve higher sales. • Increase their prices to maintain price levels in terms of the foreign currency. Sales should remain constant (depending on competitors’ actions) and revenue should rise in dollars as a result. Neither of these options is attractive to exporters – a rising exchange rate is bad news. 248 9781398308114.indb 248 05/03/21 11:08 AM Domestic producers How might Zimbabwean firms respond to a rising value of the Zimbabwean dollar? How might Zimbabwean firms respond to a falling value of the Zimbabwean dollar? • Reduce prices to compete with cheaper imports. • Enjoy the benefits of cheaper imports of materials and components. • Emphasise other elements in the marketing mix; for example, the quality of the product. • Enjoy increased sales as a result of rising prices of competitors’ imported products, assuming foreign businesses do not hold prices down. • Increase prices (to some extent) to enjoy increased revenues from each sale. • Beware the increased cost of imported raw materials and components. Remember that products are not sold on the basis of price alone. When considering the likely consequences of a change in exchange rates, it is important to note that factors such as quality, reputation, after-sales service and meeting delivery dates are important influences on buyers’ decisions. GLOSSARY TERMS A currency appreciates when its value rises against another currency or currencies. A currency depreciates when its value declines against another currency or currencies. The impact of changes in e